ꢀ
ꢀ
6.2.4 | June 2013 | 3725-77601-001H
Polycom® CꢀMA® System
Operations Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Polycom CMA System Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
Field Input Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
Change a Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Set Up Video Call Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Set Up Automatic Softupdate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Set Up Conference Templates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Set Up Directory Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Distribute Polycom Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Polycom, Inc.
iii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Scheduler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Administrator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Administrator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Operator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Auditor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Admin Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Provisioning Profiles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Server Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Conference Menu Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Conference States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
General Scheduling Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Add/Schedule a Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
iv
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Edit a Participant’s Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Select a Bridge for a Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Join an Active Conference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Conference Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Conference Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Participants List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Participant Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Participant Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Endpoint Menu, Views, and Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Monitor View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Polycom, Inc.
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Endpoint Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Provisioning Best Practices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Bundled Provisioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Endpoint Passwords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
vi
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
View Device Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Reboot an Endpoint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Delete Peripheral . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Display Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Polycom, Inc.
vii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Package . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Package . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Device Summary Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Device Status Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Device Alerts Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
viii
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Provisioning Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Network Device Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Monitor View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
View Device Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Add an MCU Manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
Edit an MCU Bridge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Delete an MCU Bridge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
View Bridge Conferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
View Bridge Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
View Bridge Meeting Rooms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Polycom, Inc.
ix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
MCU H.320 Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
MCU H.323 Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
MCU Gateway Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Local Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Local Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Roles and Permissions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
View User Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Add a Local User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Edit a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
Delete a User . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Unlock a User Account . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
Manage Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Import Enterprise Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Edit a Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Delete a Group . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Manage User Roles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
x
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
View the List of User Roles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Add a User Role . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Add a Favorites List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Edit a Favorites List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Delete a Favorites List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Site Statistics Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
H.323 Call Detail Records Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Conference Type Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Gatekeeper Message Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Define Log Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
View and Export System Log Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
CMA System Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
Polycom, Inc.
xi
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Dashboard Panes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
System Administration Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Conference Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
Add a Conference Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Edit a Conference Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Delete a Conference Template . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Disable Conference Auto-Launch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Overbooking Dial-in Participants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
View the Rooms List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Add a Local Room . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Add an Enterprise Room . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Edit a Room . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
Delete a Room . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
Areas Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
How Areas Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
Area Best Practices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
View Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
Create Area Administrator Role . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
Assign Devices to Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
Associate Users with Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
xii
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Delete an Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Multiple Forests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
Viable options: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
View the Global Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
Set or Change the GAB Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372
Edit an Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
Polycom, Inc.
xiii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Assign Address Books to Groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379
Delete an Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
Change Address Book Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
Set the Default Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
Copy an Address Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
Server Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Sites List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
Site Links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
Site-to-Site Exclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
Territories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
Network Clouds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
Device Registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
Direct Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
Routed Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
xiv
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Communications Server 2007 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407
SNMP Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
Internal Databases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
External Databases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426
Database Restoration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427
Database Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427
Polycom, Inc.
xv
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Certificate Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
Delete a Certificate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
xvi
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Add Machine Accounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 460
View the Sites List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464
View Site Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
Assign Locations to a Site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
Edit Site Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
Delete a Site . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
Set Up SIP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
Edit SIP URI Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
Site Link Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478
View the Site Links List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
Add a Site Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
Edit a Site Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 479
Delete a Site Link . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480
Site-to-Site Exclusions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480
Add a Site-to-Site Exclusion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
Edit a Site-to-Site Exclusion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
Territories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482
Edit a Territory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482
Delete a Territory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
Add a Network Cloud . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
Edit a Network Cloud . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
Polycom, Inc.
xvii
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Delete a Network Cloud . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
Dial Plan Service Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485
Simplified Dialing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486
View the Services List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 490
Add a Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 490
Pattern Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
View the Dial Rules List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
Add a Dial Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
Edit a Dial Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 498
Least-Cost Routing Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 498
Determining Area Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502
E.164 Alias Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 504
xviii
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Set Up Remote Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511
Add a Remote Alert Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 516
Auditor Responsibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 522
Gatekeeper Cause Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 535
Polycom, Inc.
xix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
xx
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1
Polycom® CMA® System Overview
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system and includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
Polycom CMA System Features and Capabilities
The CMA system is an integrated scheduling and device management
platform for video conferencing that can include these features:
•
The Polycom CMA Desktop client for Windows and MAC operating
systems—an easy-to-use video and audio conferencing application that
lets your users see and hear the people they call on their desktop system.
•
•
Automatic provisioning for dynamically-managed endpoint systems and
scheduled provisioning for standardly-managed and legacy endpoints.
Automatic softupdates for dynamically-managed endpoint systems and
scheduled softupdates for standardly-managed and legacy endpoints.
•
•
On-demand conferencing using embedded MCUs or external MCUs.
Conference scheduling via the CMA system Web Scheduler or the
optional Polycom Scheduling Plugins for Microsoft® Outlook® or IBM®
Lotus® Notes.®
•
•
•
Advanced routing to distribute audio and video calls across multiple
conferencing platforms (MCUs), creating a single seamless resource pool.
Firewall management capabilities which enable videoconferencing across
firewalls.
Gatekeeper as well as alternate and neighboring gatekeeper functionality.
Polycom, Inc.
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
Access to user and room directories for on-demand and scheduled calls.
Directory services include:
— Presence and contact list functionality for dynamically-managed
endpoints.
— Global Address Book for a single directory structure or Multiple
Address Books for multiple managed directories.
— H.350 and LDAP directory functionality. H.350 defines a directory
services architecture for multimedia conferencing for H.323, H.320,
SIP and generic protocols.
•
•
•
Device monitoring and management.
Conference monitoring and management.
An optional high-availability, redundant management server
configuration.
Polycom CMA System Models
Polycom offers two CMA system models.
•
The single microprocessor CMA 4000 system supports up to 400
concurrently registered endpoints and 240 concurrent calls. Integration
with a corporate directory and an external database is optional. The CMA
4000 system is not available in redundant configurations or maximum
security configurations.
•
The dual microprocessor CMA 5000 system can support up to 5000
concurrently registered endpoints and 3000 concurrent calls in direct
mode and 1500 concurrent calls in routed mode. The CMA 5000 system is
also available in an optional redundant configuration.
Integration with a corporate directory is optional for CMA 5000 systems.
Integration with an external database (Microsoft SQL Server) is required
for redundant CMA 5000 systems or for CMA 5000 systems supporting
more than 400 concurrently registered endpoints and 240 concurrent calls.
Minimum System Requirements
The Polycom CMA System Release Notes describe the minimum system
requirements for your CMA system. To find the most current Release Notes, go
Converged Management Application CMA 4000 & 5000.
Any scheduled call that requires an external MCU requires a Polycom RMX™
or Polycom MGC™ conferencing platform. For example, any conference with
a dial-in participant requires an external MCU. And some features and
2
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom® CMA® System Overview
services, such as Conference on Demand also requires an RMX or MGC
system. Not all conferencing features are supported on all RMX system. For
more information about supported functionality, see the Polycom RMX System
Release Notes for your conferencing platform.
Working in the Polycom CMA System
This section includes some general information you should know when
working in the CMA system. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Log Into the Polycom CMA System
To log into the CMA system web interface, you need:
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer® 6.0, 7.0 or 8.0, Mozilla FireFox® 3.5 or 3.6, or
Apple Safari 3.2, 4.0 or 5.0.
If your system is operating in maximum security mode, you may use only
Microsoft Internet Explorer.
•
•
Adobe® Flash® Player 9.x or 10.x
The IP address or host name of the CMA system server and your
username, password, and domain.
Note
The CMA system user interface is best viewed with an SXGA display resolution of
at least 1280x1024 pixels. The minimum support display resolution is XGA
1024x768 pixels.
Generally, you get three opportunities to enter the correct password. After
three failed attempts, the system returns an error message.
Polycom, Inc.
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To log into a CMA system
1
Open a browser window and in the Address field enter the CMA system
IP address or host name.
— If prompted to install the Adobe Flash Player, click OK.
— If you receive an HTTPS Security Alert, click Yes.
— If you see a login banner, click Accept to accept the terms and
continue.
If you cannot connect to the system, there may be certificate issues.
2
When the CMA system Log In screen appears, enter your Username and
Password.
3
4
If necessary, select a different Language or Domain.
Click Login.
If you log in as an administrator, you see the CMA system Dashboard.
For more information about roles and the functionality associated with
Field Input Requirements
While every effort was made to internationalize the CMA system, not all
system fields accept Unicode entries. If you work in a language other than
English, be aware that some CMA system fields may accept only ASCII or
extended ASCII characters.
Filter and Search a List
In the CMA system interface, information is often summarized in lists or grids.
Lists that include many items may have filters or searchable fields, which
allow you to view a subset of items or search for a specific entry. The available
filtering options depend on the type of information in the list. For example in
the conference list:
•
•
If you select Custom Date as the filter, a calendar filter field appears.
If you select Ongoing Plus as the filter, an attribute option appears. You
can select the attribute Conference Name and enter all or part of the
conference name into the associated text field.
In general, most text filter fields are ASCII only and the CMA system search
function is a case-insensitive, substring search. That means when you enter a
search string, the CMA system looks for that string whereever it occurs
(beginning, middle, or end) in the word or number.
4
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom® CMA® System Overview
However, if the CMA system is integrated with an Active Directory, the CMA
system uses the LDAP search function for searches of the directory. LDAP
searches are prefix-searches that include an appended wildcard. In this case,
when you enter a search string, the system looks for that search string only at
the beginning of the indexed fields.
For example, all of the following searches for a participant will find Barbara
Smithe:
Barbara
Smithe
Bar
Smi
To optimize LDAP searches, the CMA system (and its dynamically-managed
endpoints) searches only indexed LDAP fields and a limited set of attributes.
The attributes include:
ObjectCategory
memberOf
DisplayName
GivenName
Sn
Cn
Samaccountname
groupType
distinguishedName
objectGuid
These are the requested attributes to be returned by the search:
Sn
Givenname
Mail
Ou
Objectguid
Telephonenumber
Cn
Samaccountname
Memberof
Displayname
Objectclass
Title
localityName
department
Change a Password
For local users, CMA system password requirements (for example, password
length and password age) are managed by the CMA system administrator. For
enterprise users, CMA system password requirements are managed by
Microsoft Active Directory.
Polycom, Inc.
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To change your system password
1
2
3
4
5
Click Settings in the top-right corner of the page.
In the Settings dialog box, click Change Password.
Enter your Old Password.
Enter a New Password.
Confirm the new password and click OK.
Log Out of the Polycom CMA System
To log out of the CMA system
Click Log Out in the top-right corner of the page.
Restart or Shut Down a Polycom CMA System
You have several options for an orderly shutdown or restart of a CMA system
in non-emergency situations.
The options for an orderly shutdown or restart of the system include:
•
Use the Shutdown option on the user interface when you must disconnect
the CMA system server for some reason; for example, to move it. All CMA
system functionality is stopped during a Shutdown.
•
If the system interface is not available and you must shut down the
system, press once (but do not hold) the power switch on the CMA system
server. This is equivalent to selecting the Shutdown option described
previously.
•
Use the Restart option on the user interface when you must cycle the CMA
system for some reason; for example, if the system locks up or loses
connection with the database.
If you have access to the CMA system user interface, you can also stop future
scheduled conferences from starting automatically and wait for active
conferences to end before performing an orderly shut down or restart of the
system.
During a restart, the system will drop all IP conferences. In general, ISDN
conferences will not drop. Also, endpoints registered to the gatekeeper will
drop. IP endpoints not registered with the gatekeeper can continue in
conference.
6
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom® CMA® System Overview
To restart or shut down a CMA system
1
(Optional) To stop future scheduled conferences from starting before you
perform the restart or shutdown:
a
b
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.
Check the Conference Auto-Launch Disabled check box and click
Update.
c
Go to Admin > Dashboard.
d
Monitor the Today’s Conferences section to determine when all
active conferences are completed.
2
Go to Admin > Dashboard and click Restart
required.
or Shutdown
, as
In a redundant CMA system configuration, if you requested a shutdown
of the primary server, the system displays a warning indicating that it is
initiating a failover.
If you select Restart, it may take the CMA system up to 10 minutes to
shutdown and then restart all server processes.
Emergency Shutdown of a Polycom CMA System
You have two options to perform an emergency shutdown of a CMA system.
Use these options only when you must immediately cut power to the server.
•
•
Press and hold the power switch on the CMA system server.
Pull the system power cord.
After an emergency shutdown (that is when you press and hold the power
switch, or you pull the system cord, or you lose power to the system), a system
battery may continue to cache information until the battery runs out. In this
case, the system enters an error state. To recover, you must connect a keyboard
and monitor to the CMA system and boot the system to clear the error
message. Then the system can begin recovery.
Polycom, Inc.
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
8
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2
Polycom CMA System Configuration
This chapter describes the configuration tasks that may be required, based on
your system design and installation to complete your implementation of a
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system after First
Time Setup. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
IMPORTANT
If during First Time Setup, you enabled the Maximum Security option, please see
how the system operates in this configuration.
Add DNS SRV Record for Polycom CMA System Services
You must configure the DNS server, if you wish it to resolve queries for the
CMA system by the CMA system’s host name or IP address.
We recommend that the DNS server be configured to find the CMA system by
its fully qualified domain name (FQDN). This ensures that client systems
running desktop Polycom CMA Desktop can access the CMA system.
Polycom, Inc.
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The DNS should also have entries for your Active Directory server (if different
from the DNS) and for the external database server being used by the CMA
system.
Note
If you configure the DNS server to use two or more Active Directory servers, make
sure that the servers have the same services available.
To dynamically manage endpoints (which includes automatic provisioning,
automatic softupdate, and presence) right out-of-the-box, they must be able to
automatically discover the CMA system. This means you must add the DNS
service record (SRV record) for the CMA system. The lookup key for this
service record is _cmaconfig._tcp. So the record will resemble this:
__cmaconfig._tcp.customerdomain.com 86400 IN SRV 0 0 443 cma5000.customerdomain.com
For more information about DNS, DNS records, and how DNS works, see
Microsoft Technet
Configure the Connection to the External Database
If during First Time Setup you did not configure the CMA system to use an
external Microsoft SQL Server database, but need to do so now, see “Database
Note
It is not recommended, but you can create the CMA system databases manually
using Microsoft SQL scripts. Contact Polycom Global Services to request the
creation scripts.
Integration with an external Microsoft SQL Server database is required for
redundant CMA 5000 systems or for CMA 5000 systems supporting more than
400 concurrently registered endpoints and 240 concurrent calls.
Configure the Connection to an External Enterprise Directory
If during First Time Setup you did not configure your CMA system to use an
Connecting to an enterprise directory allows users to enter their network
usernames and password to log into CMA system. It also allows users to
access the enterprise directory when selecting conference participants.
10
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Configuration
Configure Redundancy
You can install the CMA 5000 system in a fault-tolerant, high-availability,
redundant configuration. The CMA 4000 system is not available in a
redundant configuration.
A redundant CMA system configuration requires the installation of two CMA
system servers on the same network. During First Time Setup, you are
instructed to assign these two servers physical IP addresses. Once the two
page 431 to finish implementing redundancy.
Set Up Video Call Routing
The video call routing setup includes the gatekeeper, site topology, gateway
and MCU dial plan services, and bandwidth management.
You can perform the following tasks:
•
•
•
•
•
Handle inbound ISDN calls and route them to correct endpoints.
Enable outbound IP- based calls.
Connect through a firewall using an SBC device.
Allow or deny calls to and from unregistered endpoints (rogue calls).
When you have a third-party MCU that registers with the gatekeeper
using standard H.323 protocol, add gateway and MCU dial plan services
manually.
•
•
•
•
•
Define new sites and site links.
Add IP-to-ISDN call routing using least-cost routing.
Define neighboring gatekeepers.
Enable routing of H.323 calls to neighboring gatekeepers.
Define a site for each physical location in which a LAN or an ISDN
connection exists. If you use VPN connections, you can consolidate
distinct physical locations into a single logical site to simplify
management tasks.
•
For each site, define the subnets in which the video endpoint systems are
deployed. It is important that the IP addresses used by the endpoints
belong to only one subnet at a site.
•
•
Define least-cost routing tables only when you use the least-cost routing
feature.
Customize default dialing rules.
Polycom, Inc.
11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Set Up Automatic Provisioning
The CMA system automatic provisioning feature allows an administrator to
configure one or more endpoints with the standard set of information the
registering endpoints need to operate within the network. This eliminates the
need to configure each endpoint individually.
Automatic provisioning is enabled at the endpoint, but the CMA system must
have automatic provisioning profiles for both the endpoint and the site at
which the endpoint resides.
To ensure out-of-box usability, the CMA system comes with default automatic
provisioning profiles. However, to create your desired user experiences, you
should:
•
•
Create customized automatic provisioning profiles for endpoint types.
Edit provisioning profile for each site.
Set Up Automatic Softupdate
The CMA system automatic softupdate feature allows an administrator to
upgrade the software on one or more endpoints with a standard software
package. This eliminates the need to upgrade each endpoint individually.
The automatic softupdate feature is enabled at the endpoint. At start up and at
designated intervals, endpoints in automatic softupdate mode automatically
look for a new softupdate profile and package on the CMA system.
To implement automatic softupdates, you must create a softupdate package
for each endpoint type you wish to support with updates.
Set Up Conference Templates
The CMA system uses conference templates and global conference settings to
manage system and conference behavior.
The CMA system has a Default Template and default global conference
settings. You may want to create additional templates with different settings
or change the global conference settings.
12
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Configuration
Set Up Directory Services
Directory services provide information about all users, endpoints, and
resources on your video communication network.
To set up CMA system directory services, complete the following tasks:
1
Register devices. On endpoints, you must set the gatekeeper and/or
Global Directory Server (GDS) to point to the CMA system IP address or
DNS name. We recommend using the IP address to prevent data
inconsistencies.
It may take a device up to 5 minutes to register with the gatekeeper and
indicate an online status.
Most device information is automatically populated in the CMA system
through the gatekeeper registration or Global Address Book access. You
must review the information for these devices in the CMA system
Directory Setup page and fill in missing information.
To select endpoints when scheduling conferences, you must first associate
them with a user or conference room by editing the specific user or room
settings. For more information, see “Endpoint and Peripheral
2
Set up users and associate them with endpoints. Unless your CMA
system is integrated with an enterprise directory, you must enter all user
information manually including endpoint association. If your system is
integrated with an enterprise directory, general user information (First
Name, Last Name, UserID, Password, E-mail Address) is directly pulled
from the directory and cannot be changed. However, you must still
associate enterprise users with endpoints. For more information, see
3
4
Set up groups, add members, and associate them with provisioning
Set up rooms and associate them with endpoints. Unless your CMA
system is integrated with an enterprise directory that includes conference
rooms, you must enter all room information manually including
endpoint association. For more information, see “Room Overview and
Set Up a Certificate for the Polycom CMA System
By default, the CMA system uses httpsand a self-signed certificate for its data
interchanges. As a best practice, we recommend replacing the CMA system
self-signed certificate with a certificate from a Certificate Authority. For more
Polycom, Inc.
13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Distribute Polycom Applications
The CMA system allows you to download several Polycom applications for
use in specific environments. This includes two scheduling plugins and two
desktop video applications. These are:
•
•
These are discussed in the following topics.
Note
•
•
•
The Polycom RealPresence Desktop can be downloaded from the Polycom
The Polycom RealPresence Mobile application for Android™ can be
The Polycom RealPresence Mobile application for iPhone® and IPad® can be
Distribute Polycom CMA Desktop for Windows Systems
IMPORTANT
•
On a Windows XP system, the user installing the Polycom CMA Desktop must
sign in with administrative privileges. On a Windows Vista system, the user
installing the Polycom CMA Desktop must sign into the Administrator account.
•
The following procedures assumes you have implemented DNS lookup and
Windows authentication for single sign on.
To deploy the CMA Desktop client to users, you have at least four distribution
options
Option 1: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via an E-mail link
You can copy the link for the CMA Desktop client from the CMA system
Downloads page into an E-mail that you can send to users.
To do this, copy and paste the CMA Desktop link (for example,
http://10.47.9.136/SoftUpdate/vvl/CMADesktop_4_1_1_1010/CMADesktop.exe) from
the Downloads page into an E-mail to be sent to users. Include the IP address
of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the E-mail
to users.
Option 2: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via the management system
You can provide users access to the CMA system, from which they can
download the CMA Desktop client.
14
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Configuration
To do this, copy and paste the IP address of the CMA system into an E-mail to
be sent to users. Include usernames and passwords (as required) in the E-mail
to users and instruct them to access the Downloads link.
Option 3: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via a desktop management or
group policy object
Distribute the .exeinstallation file as a desktop management or group policy
object to a location on client systems and provide directions to users on how to
run the executable.
To do this, build a desktop management or group policy object that writes the
.exeinstallation file to a directory (for example, C:\temp) on the user’s local
system. Include the command for executing the file in an E-mail to be sent to
users. For example:
C:\temp\CMA Desktop.exe”/s /v"/qn SBSERVERTYPE=2 SBSERVERADDRESS=nnn.nnn.nnn.nnn
Include the IP address of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as
required) in the E-mail to users.
Option 4: Distribute the CMA Desktop client via a .zip file
Zip the .exeinstallation file and send it in an E-mail to users. Include the IP
address of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the
E-mail to users. For endpoints on the public network that will be accessing the
system through a firewall, include the IP address of the Polycom VBP system
rather than the CMA system.
Distribute Polycom CMA Desktop for MAC OS Systems
IMPORTANT
•
On a MAC system, the user installing the CMA Desktop client must sign in with
administrative privileges and an Administrator account.
•
The following procedures assumes you have implemented DNS lookup and
MAC authentication for single sign on.
To deploy the CMA Desktop for MAC OS clients to users, you have at least three
distribution options
Option 1: Distribute the CMA Desktop for MAC OS client via an E-mail link
You can copy the link for the CMA Desktop for MAC OS clients from the CMA
system Downloads page into an E-mail that you can send to users. To do this,
copy and paste the CMA Desktop for MAC OS link (e.g.,
http://10.47.9.136/SoftUpdate/vvl/CMADesktopMac_5_1_0_7458/CMADesktop.dmg)
from the Downloads page into an E-mail to be sent to users. Include the IP
address of the CMA system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the
E-mail to users.
Polycom, Inc.
15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Option 2: Distribute the CMA Desktop Mac client via the management system
You can provide users access to the CMA system, from which they can
download the client. To do this, copy and paste the IP address of the CMA
Desktop Mac system into an E-mail to be sent to users. Include usernames and
passwords (as required) in the E-mail to users and instruct them to access the
Downloads link.
Option 3: Distribute the CMA Desktop Mac client via a .dmg file
Send the .dmgfile in an E-mail to users. Include the IP address of the CMA
system and usernames and passwords (as required) in the E-mail to users. For
endpoints on the public network that will be accessing the system through a
firewall, include the IP address of the Polycom VBP system rather than the
CMA system.
16
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Operating in Maximum Security
Environments
This chapter describes how the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system operates when in Maximum Security mode. It
includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Maximum Security Mode Overview
The CMA system provides a Maximum Security option for those businesses
that must adhere to the most stringent security protocols.
You can only enable the Maximum Security option during First Time Setup.
The process is irreversible and has significant consequences, as many CMA
system features aren’t supported in this mode.
Polycom, Inc.
17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
In maximum security, the CMA system does not include support for the
following features:
— Operation on the CMA 4000 platform or in a redundant system
configuration
— CMA system gatekeeper functionality
— External databases
— Legacy endpoints. Only HDX systems operating in dynamic
management mode are supported.
— ISDN scheduling
— Global Address Books
— Standard (scheduled) management and monitoring of endpoints
— Presence
— SNMP
— Remote desktop
— Integration with Microsoft (MS) Exchange for calendaring
— Integration with MS Office Communications Server or MS Lync
— Support for the Polycom CMA Desktop clients or the Polycom
Scheduling Plug-ins for Microsoft Outlook and IBM Lotus Notes
— Least Cost Routing
— Audio only conferences
— Online help
The following sections describe in detail the operational differences for a CMA
system in Maximum Security mode.
Conference Scheduling in Maximum Security Mode
Conference scheduling functionality is available to users assigned the basic
Scheduler, Advanced Scheduler, and Operator roles. The conference
scheduling workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode
does not change. However, because all conferences must be hosted on RMX
conferencing systems, the MCU Settings for all Conference Templates has
changed in the following ways:
•
•
The Supported MCUs section lists only RMX systems.
The Always Use MCU option on the Conference Template page is not
available (grayed-out); it is always enabled and cannot be changed.
18
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Endpoint Management in Maximum Security Mode
Endpoint management functionality is available to users assigned the Device
Administrator role. Users assigned the standard Administrator role may only
monitor endpoints.
The endpoint management workflow on a CMA system operating in
maximum security mode changes in that it only supports HDX endpoints
operating in dynamic management mode. The system changes made to
support this workflow change include:
•
•
•
The Scheduled Provisioning and Scheduled Software Update pages and
the ACTIONS associated with them are not available.
Only HDX endpoints that are automatically provisioned by the CMA
system are displayed in the endpoint list.
The ACTIONS on the Endpoint > Monitor View page changes as follows:
Actions
Use this action to...
Add
Not available. Endpoints can only be added to the
system during automatic provisioning.
Search Devices
Not available.
•
•
The Device Summary section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page does
not change.
The Device Status section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page changes
as follows:
Field
Description
Gatekeeper
Registration
The status of the device’s registration with the
gatekeeper service always indicates
Unknown.
Directory
The status of the device’s registration with the Global
Registration
Directory Service always indicates
Not Registered.
Presence
Not available.
Registration
Exchange
Not available.
Registration
SIP Registration
Device Managed
Not available.
Indicates Heartbeat Timeout.
Gatekeeper
Address
The IP address of the gatekeeper to which the device is
registered.
Last GK
Not available.
Registration
Polycom, Inc.
19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
ISDN Line Status
Type
Not available.
ISDN Assignment
Type
How the ISDN type was assigned to the device. This
always indicates Undefined.
Device ISDN Type
Not available.
•
•
The Call Info section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page does not
change.
The Device Alerts section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page changes
as follows:
Field
Description
Errors
Device error message text always shows Gatekeeper
Unregistered.
•
The Provisioning Details section of the Endpoint > Monitor View page
does not change.
Network Device Management in Maximum Security Mode
Network device management functionality is available to users assigned the
Device Administrator role. Users assigned the standard Administrator role
may only monitor network devices.
The network device management workflow on a CMA system operating in
maximum security mode changes in that it supports only RMX conferencing
systems. The system changes required for this workflow change include:
•
The VBPs and DMAs pages and the ACTIONS associated with them are
not available.
•
•
The ACTIONS on the MCU > Monitor View page do not change.
The Add New Device dialog box for the RMX MCU does not change. Note
that when operating in maximum security mode, the Admin ID for an
MCU is the CMA machine account created on the RMX system just for this
purpose and the Password is the password designated for this CMA
machine account.
20
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Polycom RMX Systems in Secure Mode
The CMA system automatically detects when a Polycom RMX system is
operating in secure (HTTPS) mode. By default, in non-secure (HTTP) mode,
the Polycom RMX system uses port 80 for its communications and in secure
(HTTPS) mode, the Polycom RMX system uses port 443 for its
communications.
You can determine via the CMA system interface whether or not a Polycom
RMX system is operating in secure mode by viewing the HTTP port number
If an administrator changes the secure mode setting on a Polycom RMX
system, the CMA system will lose connection to the RMX, but will
automatically regain it using the correct protocol. The CMA system may take
up to a minute to restore the connection.
User Management in Maximum Security Mode
User management functionality is divided among different roles: Scheduler,
Operator, and Administrator.
Scheduler
Users assigned the basic Scheduler and Advanced Scheduler role can add
guest participants to the Guest Book.
The Guest Book workflow for schedulers on a CMA system operating in
maximum security mode has not changed.
Operator
Users assigned the Operator role can add, edit, and delete guest participants
from the Guest Book as well as add, edit, and delete their own Favorites lists.
The Guest Book and Favorites workflow for operators on a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode has not changed.
Administrator
The administrator’s user management functionality and workflow on a CMA
system operating in maximum security mode has changed significantly.
When integrated with an enterprise directory (Microsoft Active Directory), the
CMA system can have only one local account—the default administrator
account used to access and administer the system. This account cannot be
deleted in any circumstances.
Polycom, Inc.
21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
When integrated with an enterprise directory, this local administrator can
perform the following user management functions:
•
•
•
Integrate the CMA system with Active Directory. Note that when you
integrate the CMA system with an Active Directory, all local users other
than the default local administrator are removed from the system.
Edit a subset of enterprise user attributes, such as their role, area, or
endpoint associations. This allows the local administrator to assign the
Administrator role to enterprise users.
Troubleshoot and administrate the system if the Active Directory
connection to the system is lost.
When not integrated with an enterprise directory, this local administrator can
perform the following user management functions:
•
Add and edit local user attributes including their contact information and
other user attributes such as their role, area, or endpoint associations.
•
Delete local users.
Note
As a best practice, use this local administrator account for user management tasks
on the CMA system. Do not use it to log into managed devices.
The user management workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum
security mode has changed in the following ways:
•
Once integrated with an enterprise directory, the local administrator can
see enterprise users as well as associate them to endpoints, roles, and areas
(when applicable).
•
Administrators cannot create custom roles with a custom set of
permissions. The system has only pre-defined roles and associated
permissions as described in “Default CMA System Roles and
The system changes required to support this workflow change are:
— The User Roles page and the ACTIONS associated with it are not
available.
— The ACTIONS on the User > Users page includes an additional
command, so that you can view the permissions that come with the
role a user has been assigned.
Action
Use this action to...
View Permissions
Display the set of permissions that come with the user’s
assigned role.
22
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
•
•
Administrators cannot assign users more than one role.
The system change required to support this workflow change is:
The user interface for assigning roles (Add/Edit User > Associated Roles)
has changed to a radio button list from which you can assign only one role
from a set of mutually exclusive, predefined options.
Via the Edit function, local administrators can now enable and disable
local users rather than permanently deleting their user accounts. This
function is only available for local users. Enterprise users must be enabled
and disabled in Active Directory.
Note
Disabled local users (when not integrated with an enterprise directory) still appear
in the CMA system Users list. However, disabled enterprise users (when integrated
with an enterprise directory) won’t appear in the CMA system User list if the Ignore
Disabled Enterprise Directory Users option on the Enterprise Directory page is
enabled.
The system change required to support this workflow change is:
The General Info tab of the Edit User dialog box now has an Enable User
option. By default, when a local user is created, this option is selected.
•
Via the Edit function, administrators can unlock user accounts that
become locked when a user reaches the Failed login threshold.
Note
Administrators cannot lock user accounts. This functionality is triggered only when
the failed login threshold is met.
The system change required to support this workflow change is:
The General Info tab of the Edit User dialog box now has an Unlock User
option. By default, when a local user is created, this option is not selected.
However, when a local user reaches the Failed login threshold, the
administrator can reset the lock by enabling the Unlock User option.
•
Users cannot be associated with an alert profile because a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode does not include remote alerts.
The system change required to support this workflow change is:
The Add/Edit User > Associated Alert Profile tab has been removed from
the user interface.
A CMA system has password requirements, local user account configuration
requirements, and session management requirements that affect local users
and local user accounts. For more information about these requirements, see
Polycom, Inc.
23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Group Management in Maximum Security Mode
Group management functionality is available to users assigned the
Administrator role.
The group management workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum
security mode has not changed except that users cannot inherit roles from
groups.
When not integrated with an enterprise directory, local administrators can add
local groups with local users. When integrated with an enterprise directory,
the single local administrator and any enterprise users assigned the
Administrator role can Add local groups, Import Enterprise Groups, and
Synchronize Groups with Active Directory.
Reporting in Maximum Security Mode
Reporting functionality is divided among different roles: Administrator,
Operator, and Auditor.
Administrator
The administrator’s reporting functionality and workflow on a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode has changed. Users assigned the
Administrator role can access the following system reports:
•
•
•
•
Endpoint Usage Report
Conference Type Report
System Log Files
Audit Log Files
Users assigned the Administrator role cannot access the following system
reports, since these reports have been removed from the system:
•
•
•
•
•
Site Statistics
Site-link Statistics
IP Call Detail Records
Conference Usage Report
Gatekeeper Message Log
24
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Operator
The operator’s reporting functionality and workflow on a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode has changed . Users assigned the
Operator role can only access the following system report:
•
Conference Usage Report
Users assigned the Operator role cannot access the following system reports:
•
•
•
IP Call Detail Records
Endpoint Usage Report
Gatekeeper Message Log
For more information on these reports, see the Polycom CMA System
Administrator’s Guide.
Auditor
Users assigned the Auditor role can access the following system reports:
•
•
•
Endpoint Usage Report
System Log Files
Audit Log Files
For more information on these reports, see the Polycom CMA System
Administrator’s Guide.
The Auditor role and workflow allows the auditor to:
•
View online the Endpoint Usage Report for selected endpoints.
The system change required to support this workflow change is:
The Endpoint Usage Report menu option and page is available from the
Reports menu, but the Generate Report and Download All CDRs options
are not available to the auditor.
•
Download the System Log Files.
The system changes required to support this workflow change are:
— The System Log Files menu option and page is available from the
Reports menu.
— The Download ALL command is available from the list of ACTIONS.
Backup and Delete audit log files.
•
The system changes required to support this workflow change are:
— The Audit Log Files menu option and page is available from the
Reports menu.
— The Backup and Delete command is available from the list of
ACTIONS. This option allows an auditor to backup and delete
selected audit logs. During this process, the CMA system requires that
Polycom, Inc.
25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
the auditor download and run a verification utility that performs a
checksum operation to make certain that the downloaded audit log is
complete and uncorrupted before the audit log is deleted from the
CMA system.
•
Change the audit log Alert Level.
The system change required to support this workflow change is:
The Change Settings command is available from the list of ACTIONS. By
default the audit log Alert Level is set to 70% of the Max File Size Usage,
which is 2 gigabytes.
Device Administration in Maximum Security Mode
Only users assigned the Device Administrator role can perform device
administration tasks.
In addition to the tasks described in the Endpoint Management in Maximum
Security Mode section, the device administrator workflow on a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode allows the device administrator to:
•
•
See the system Dashboard.
Add, edit, and delete machine accounts for endpoint systems.
The system change required to support this workflow change is:
The Machine Accounts menu option and page is available from the
Admin > Management and Security menu. Before the CMA system can
dynamically manage a HDX system, a device administrator must add a
machine account for the HDX system. This is the same username that the
HDX system administrator should enter on the HDX system for the
provisioning service. This allows the HDX and CMA systems to
authenticate and communicate without using a specific user’s account.
About Machine Accounts
Before the CMA system can dynamically manage HDX systems operating in
maximum security mode, a user assigned the Device Administrator role must
create an HDX machine account for each HDX that the CMA system will
manage. The machine account allows the endpoint to connect and authenticate
with the CMA system for dynamic management purposes without using the
endpoint user’s account.
The Add Machine Account dialog box includes the following information.
Field
Description
Enable Machine
Account
Select or clear this option to enable and disable
(respectively) the machine account you create for the
endpoint.
26
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Field
Description
Unlock Machine
Account
Select this option to unlock machine accounts that
become locked when they exceed the Failed login
threshold. This will only happen when the password
expires.
User ID
Enter a unique name for the machine account.
As a best practice, name the machine account in a way
that associates it with the corresponding device. For
example, if your company names endpoint systems for
the system user or room (for example, bsmith_HDXor
Evergreen_Room), then give the machine account an
associated User ID (bsmith_HDX_machineor
evergreen_room_machine).
Password/
Confirm Password
Enter a password for the machine account user ID.
This password must meet the Local Password
Requirements. This password expires in 365 days.
Description
Enter a meaningful description for the endpoint.
Associate with an
existing user or room
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with
a specific user or room. This may be a local or
enterprise user or room.
Associate with a new
room (created
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with
a system-generated room name.
automatically)
Once you have created this machine account on the CMA system, provide this
information to the appropriate HDX system administrator. They should enter
this User ID and Password as the User Name and Password on the HDX
Provisioning Service page.
Note that the machine account password expires after one year. After the
expiration, the HDX login will fail. After three failed login attempts, the
system locks the machine account. You can reset the password and unlock the
machine account by editing it and assigning a new password.
System Administration in Maximum Security Mode
Only users assigned the Administrator role can perform general CMA system
administration functions. The CMA system administration functionality and
workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode has
changed. The following sections describe the areas of functionality and how
they have changed.
Users assigned the Administrator role can see the system Dashboard, the
Admin menu, and the pages and ACTIONS associated with it.
Polycom, Inc.
27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Admin Menu
The Admin menu in maximum security mode changes in the following ways:
•
The Global Address Book, SNMP Settings, Gatekeeper Settings, and
Alert Settings menu options and their associated functionality have been
removed.
•
Removed gatekeeper functionality resulted in the following system
changes:
— The system cannot display bandwidth usage. Bandwidth usage for
sites, subnets, or site limits is always 0.
— Site exclusions cannot be enforced.
— Dial rules are required for ISDN calling in translating numbers, but
have no affect for IP calls.
— The system is not the gatekeeper, so it cannot perform address
resolution.
— E164 aliases assigned by the CMA system are not communicated to
the gatekeeper, so they cannot be resolved.
— Dialing rules can be configured on the CMA system, but they are not
communicated to the gatekeeper, so they cannot be implemented.
— Threshold alarms and hardware alarms are always 0.
— Site topology cannot provide a graphical representation of status
(color).
— The CMA system has no knowledge of external gatekeeper or its rules.
Conference Templates
As was noted before, because all conferences scheduled on a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode must be hosted on a RMX conferencing
system, the MCU Settings for all Conference Templates has changed in the
following ways:
•
•
The Supported MCUs section lists only RMX.
The Always Use MCU option on the Conference Template page is not
available (grayed-out); it is always enabled and cannot be changed.
Conference Settings
On a CMA system operating in maximum security mode, a setting is available
on the Conference Setting page. The Conference and chairperson password
length field allows an administrator to designate the required length of the
system-generated conference password and chairperson password. The
acceptable length for both of these passwords is six to 16 characters. By default,
the required length for both of these passwords is set to 15 characters.
28
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Note
Depending on the system settings, the scheduler may be allowed to change the
Conference Password or Chairperson Password. However, the password length
requirement still applies.
Other than this requirement, the conference settings, conference password,
and chairperson password workflow on a CMA system operating in
maximum security mode have not changed.
Provisioning Profiles
Because a CMA system operating in maximum security mode supports only
HDX endpoints running version 2.7.0J operating in dynamic management
mode, the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page and the ACTIONS
associated with it are not available.
The Automatic Provisioning Profiles page and the ACTIONS associated with
it has not changed on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode.
Software Updates
Because a CMA system operating in maximum security mode supports only
HDX endpoints running version 2.7.0J operating in dynamic management
mode, the Scheduled Software Update page and the ACTIONS associated
with it are not available.
The Automatic Software Update page and the ACTIONS associated with it
has not changed on a CMA system operating in maximum security mode.
Server Settings
The Server Settings menu for a CMA system operating in maximum security
mode has changed significantly. The following options have been removed:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Database
Calendaring Management
Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server Integration
Redundant Configuration
Remote Alert Setup
E-mail
In addition, you will also note the following changes and additions:
•
The Network settings page now includes the ability to enable IPv6 and to
include a preferred and alternate DNS server.
Polycom, Inc.
29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
•
•
The System Time page does not include the Minutes Between
Synchronization option when using an NTP server.
What was formerly titled the LDAP page is now titled the Enterprise
Directory page.
On the Enterprise Directory page:
— You must identify the enterprise directory by DNS Name. You cannot
identify the enterprise directory server by IP address.
— The Security Level defaults to StartTLS and cannot be modified.
•
•
•
The Reclaim Inactive CMA Desktop Licenses option has been removed
from the Licenses page.
The CMA Desktop Logo option has been removed from the Custom Logo
page.
The Include dynamically-managed devices in the Global Address Book
option has been removed from the Directory Setup page.
Management and Security
A CMA system operating in maximum security mode offers a Management
and Security workflow. The following sections describe the changes.
Server Software Upgrade
The Server Software Upgrade workflow on a CMA system operating in
maximum security mode has not changed.
Certificate Management
Because a CMA system operating in maximum security mode always operates
in encrypted mode, the Use HTTPS is not an option on the Certificate
Management page.
By default, to support encrypted communications and establish a minimum
level of trust, the CMA system includes a default key and self-signed
certificate. However, to implement a full certificate chain to a root certificate
authority (CA), a CMA system requires both a root CA certificate and a
identity server certificate signed by the root CA. Therefore, at some time you
must request these certificates from your CA. The question is when.
You must install the root CA certificate during First Time Setup. However, you
can complete First Time Setup with just the root CA certificate and the CMA
system default self-signed certificate. Then you can use the Certificate
Management page to finish certificate set up.
30
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Session Management
The Session Management page allows an administrator to change but not
disable the following settings:
Field
Description
CMA user interface
timeout
By default the CMA system user interface times out after 10
minutes of inactivity. Use this procedure to change the
timeout value for the user interface inactivity timer. Possible
value is 5 to 60 minutes.
Maximum number
of sessions per
user
The number of simultaneous login sessions per user ID.
Possible value is 1 to 10 sessions.
Maximum number
of sessions per
system
The number of simultaneous login sessions by all users.
Possible value is 2 to 50 sessions.
Note
If this limit is reached, but none of the logged-in users is an
Administrator, the first Administrator user to arrive is granted
access, and the system terminates the non-Administrator
session that’s been idle the longest.
Banner Configuration
The Banner Configuration page allows users assigned the Administrator role
to customize (but not disable) the long and short login banners.
A log in banner is the message that appears when users attempt to access the
system. Users must acknowledge the message before they can log in.
By default, the long banner field on the Banner Configuration page displays
the required Standard Mandatory Notice and Consent Provision for systems
operating in maximum security mode. The short banner field displays a
shortened version of this same notice.
The long banner is used for the CMA system log in banner. It is also
provisioned to HDX systems that the CMA system manages. The short banner
is provisioned to HDX systems that the CMA system manages for those
situations in which the long banner length exceeds the available display area.
The CMA system provides several sample long banners. You can use these
banners as is or edit them to create a custom long banner. The CMA system
provides a single short banner, which you can also customize. If you
customize the banners, remember that the long banner message may contain
up to 5000 characters. The short banner message may contain up to 1315
characters.
Polycom, Inc.
31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Local User Account Management
The Local User Account Management page allows an administrator to change
but not disable the following local user account settings:
Field
Description
Account Lockout
Failed login
threshold
Specify how many consecutive login failures cause the
system to lock an account. Possible value is 2 to 10.
Failed login window
(hours)
Specify the time span within which the consecutive failures
must occur in order to lock the account. Possible value is 1
to 24.
Customized user
account lockout
duration (minutes)
Specify how long the user’s account remains locked.
Possible value is 1 to 480.
Account Inactivity
Customize account
inactivity threshold
(days)
Specify the inactivity threshold that triggers disabling of
inactive accounts. Possible value is 30 to 180.
Local Password Requirements
The Local Password Requirements page allows an administrator to change
but not disable password security requirements by specifying password age,
length, and complexity.
Field
Description
Password Management
Maximum password
age (days)
Specify at what age a password expires. Possible value
is 30 to 180.
Minimum password age
(days)
Specify how frequently a password can be changed.
Possible value is 1 to 30.
Password warning
interval (days)
Specify when users start to see a warning about their
password expiration. Possible value is 1 to 7.
Minimum length
Specify the number of characters a password must
contain. Possible value is 8 to 18.
Minimum changed
characters
Specify the number of characters that must be different
from the previous password. Possible value is 1 to 4.
Reject previous
passwords
Specify how many of the user’s previous passwords the
system remembers and won’t permit to be reused.
Possible value is 8 to 16.
32
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Field
Description
Password Complexity
Lowercase letters
Specify the number of lowercase letters (a-z) that a
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.
Uppercase letters
Numbers
Specify the number of uppercase letters (A-Z) that a
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.
Specify the number of digit characters (0-9) that a
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.
Special characters
Specify the number of non-alphanumeric keyboard
characters that a password must contain. Possible
value is 1 or 2.
Maximum consecutive
repeated characters
Specify how many sequential characters may be the
same. Possible value is 1 to 4.
Reset System Passwords
The CMA system has several underlying service passwords. The Reset
System Passwords page allows an administrator to reset these underlying
service passwords. When you select this option, all of these underlying service
passwords will be changed to the same obscured system-generated value.
Dial Plan and Sites
The Dial Plan and Sites workflow on a CMA system operating in maximum
security mode has changed. The Least Cost Routing and Services menu
options and their associated functionality are not displayed. Also, because the
CMA system is not the gatekeeper, the CMA system Site Topology display is
less informative. It used data provided to it by the gatekeeper functionality.
Backup System Settings
A CMA system operating in maximum security mode offers the Backup
System Settings feature, which allows an administrator to create an archive
that includes not only a backup of the CMA system databases but also all CMA
system configuration settings.
The process for backing up the CMA system settings is documented in
Polycom, Inc.
33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To restore a system from a backup archive
1
Restore the system to its factory default configuration. You will need
the Restore to Factory Default DVD that shipped with the CMA system
server. This DVD has the base image of the CMA system server software.
WARNING
•
This is a last resort, so never do this without being instructed to do so by PGS
support.
•
•
This process will wipe out your system database and all other system data.
The Restore to Factory Default DVD is specific to the CMA system server type
and version.
2
3
Perform First Time Setup. For more information about First Time Setup,
see the Polycom CMA System Getting Started Guide for this release.
Restore the system configuration using the last archived configuration.
The archived configuration will overwrite the configuration that resulted
from First Time Setup. The only CMA system configuration settings not
included in the archive and thus not overwritten are the network settings
and the security certificates required for an operational system.
In cases when the CMA system is functional, but the configuration or database
is corrupted, the backup archive can also be used to return a CMA system back
to its last known good archive. As long as the network settings and security
certificates are operational, the last known good archive will return the CMA
system to its former functional state.
Network Intrusion Detection in Maximum Security Mode
The CMA system detects network intrusions by processing the Microsoft
Windows Firewall logs, inserting dropped packet information into a
temporary system database table, and identifying certain patterns in the data.
The CMA system detects the following types of instrusions: a fast port scan, a
slow port scan, a denial of service (DoS) attack, and a flood attack. These are
currently defined as:
•
•
•
•
Fast port scan:
10 connections in a 5-second time period from the same source IP.
Slow port scan:
100 connections in a 1-hour time period from the same source IP.
DoS attack:
100 connections in a 5-second time period to the same destination port.
Flood attack:
100 connections in a 5-minute window to any destination port from any
source IP.
34
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
If the CMA system detects an intrusion, it displays a system alert on the user
interface. The alert text will indicate the type of intrusion detected, such as:
•
•
•
Port scan detected. See audit log for details.
DoS attack detected. See audit log for details.
Flood attack detected. See audit log for details.
Troubleshooting in Maximum Security Mode
Troubleshooting Utilities
A CMA system operating in maximum security mode has most of the same
troubleshooting utilities of the standard commercial CMA system; however
the Traces functionality has changed and functionality has been added. The
following sections describe the troubleshooting utilities.
Windows Event Logs
There is no change in the Windows Event Logs function.
CMA System Logs
There is no change in the CMA System Logs function.
Database Backup
There is no change in the Database Backup function.
Test Network Connect
The Test Network Connect function allows you to perform a Traceroute or
Ping operation. Traceroute allows you to investigate the route path and transit
times of packets as they travel across an IP network. Ping allows you to test the
availability of a host on an IP network.
Synchronize Certificate Stores
The Synchronize Certificate Stores function allows you to reset all certificate
stores with the currently uploaded certificates and certificate revocation lists
(CRLs).
Systems
The Systems pane displays summary information about the devices that
access the CMA system. For a CMA system operating in maximum security
mode, systems are limited to Endpoints, MCUs, and Rooms.
Polycom, Inc.
35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
CMA Configuration
The CMA Configuration pane displays information about the configuration
of the CMA system. For a CMA system operating in maximum security mode,
configuration items are limited to Software Version, Hardware Version,
Enterprise Directory, Database, Time Source, and Enterprise Directory DC
(Domain Controller).
CMA Info
The CMA Info pane displays general information about the CMA system. For
a CMA system operating in maximum security mode, this includes the
following:
•
Standard information:
CPU Utilization, Paging File Utilization, Last Hard Start/Reboot,
Provisioning Operations in Progress operations, Software Update
Operations in Progress, Hardware Alarms, Threshold Alarms,
Temperature, Power Supply Status, Battery Status, and Cooling Fan
Status.
•
Additional information:
Total Memory, Free Memory, and Partition States.
CMA Licenses
There is no change in the CMA Licenses function.
Users Logged-In
The Users Logged In pane displays the type and number of users that are
currently logged into the system. For a CMA system operating in maximum
security mode, this includes a user role of Auditor.
Services
The Services pane displays information about the CMA system services,
including the running services and the stopped services. For a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode, there are 8 services rather than the 14
services in a commercial CMA system. The following table lists the services,
their purpose, and whether or not they are essential to the health of a CMA
system operating in maximum security mode.
Service
Manages the system’s...
Web processes
Comment
Essential
Essential
Essential
Apache2
MSSQLSERVER
OpenDS
Database processes
Site topology database
openfire
Presence/XMPP processes Not available
Polycom Cascader
Cascaded conferencing
processes
Required for
cascading conferences
36
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Operating in Maximum Security Environments
Service
Manages the system’s...
Comment
Polycom Conference
Scheduling Service
Conference scheduling
processes
Essential
Polycom Device Manager Device management
processes
Not Available
Essential
Polycom DialRuleService Dial rule management
processes
Polycom Gatekeeper
Polycom JServer
Gatekeeper processes
Not Available
Essential
Java processes including
LDAP, SNMP, device
management, Site
Topology, and
dynamically-managed
device logins and
provisioning.
Polycom Master Service
Polycom Serial COM
Basic operation processes
Essential
Serial port management
processes
Not Available
Polycom Service Monitor
Redundancy monitoring
processes
Not Available
Not Available
Polycom Global Address
Book
Global Address Book
management processes
Report Administration
The only Report Administration function supported on a CMA system
operating in maximum security mode is the Days to keep Conference and
Endpoint CDRs. All other Report Administration functions including
creating and storing a weekly archive of the CDRs are not available.
Polycom, Inc.
37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
38
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4
Polycom® CMA® System Conference
Scheduling Overview
This chapter providesan introduction to the Polycom® Converged
Management Application™ (CMA®) system video conference scheduling
functionality and operation. It includes these topics:
•
•
To log into the CMA system web interface, you need:
•
Microsoft Internet Explorer® 6.0, 7.0 or 8.0, Mozilla FireFox® 3.5 or 3.6, or
Apple Safari 3.2, 4.0 or 5.0.
If your system is operating in maximum security mode, you may use only
Microsoft Internet Explorer.
•
•
Adobe® Flash® Player 9.x or 10.x
The IP address or host name of the CMA system server and your
username, password, and domain.
Note
The CMA system user interface is best viewed with an SXGA display resolution of
at least 1280x1024 pixels. The minimum support display resolution is XGA
1024x768 pixels.
Generally, you get three opportunities to enter the correct password. After
three failed attempts, the system returns an error message.
To log into a CMA system
1
Open a browser window and in the Address field enter the CMA system
IP address or host name.
— If prompted to install the Adobe Flash Player, click OK.
— If you receive an HTTPS Security Alert, click Yes.
Polycom, Inc.
39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
— If you see a login banner, click Accept to accept the terms and
continue.
If you cannot connect to the system, there may be certificate issues.
2
When the CMA system Log In screen appears, enter your Username and
Password.
3
4
If necessary, select a different Language or Domain.
Click Login.
If you log in as an administrator, you see the CMA system Dashboard.
For more information about roles and the functionality associated with
Conference Menu Overview
This section includes some general information you should know about the
Conference menu and views. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
Conference Menu and Views
The Conference menu provides these views of the Conference list:
•
•
Future—Displays the list of future conferences in the main window.
Use this view to view and edit future conferences.
Ongoing—Displays the list of active conferences in the main window.
Use this view to manage ongoing conferences.
Users can only work with the conferences that appear in their Conference list.
By default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while
operators see all the conferences on the system. However, when areas are
defined, operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.
40
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview
The Conference views have these sections.
Section
Description
The views you can access from the page.
Views
Conference Actions The set of available commands. The constant commands in
the Conference views are:
•
•
Refresh
with current information.
—Use this command to update the display
Add
—Use this command to create a new video
and/or audio conference.
Conference List
The context-sensitive Conference list for the selected view.
Conference Details
Displays information about the selected conference. For
Conference
Features
Displays the status of system features for the selected
conference. For more information, see “Conference
Bridge (MCU)
Features
Displays the status of MCU features for the selected
conference. For more information, see “Bridge (MCU)
Participants
Displays the list of participants for the selected conference.
Participant Details
Displays information about the participant selected in the
Polycom, Inc.
41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Conference Views—Future and Ongoing
The Conference list in both the Future and Ongoing view has these fields.
Field
Description
Filter
Use the filter to display other views of the conference list,
which include:
•
Future Only - Displays scheduled conferences that
have not yet started
•
Today Only - Displays scheduled conferences
(completed, active, or future) for the current day and
active ad hoc conferences
•
•
Custom Date - Displays scheduled conferences
(completed, active, or future) for a selected day. Select
the day from the calendar.
Ongoing Plus - Displays active and future scheduled
conferences for the day. You can further filter this
request by Owner, Conference Name, Endpoint
Name, and Bridge.
•
•
Today Plus - Displays scheduled conferences
(completed, active, or future) for the current day, current
ad hoc conferences, and all future conferences. You can
further filter this request by Owner, Conference Name,
Endpoint Name, and Bridge.
Yesterday Plus - Displays completed scheduled
conferences for yesterday and earlier. You can further
filter this request by Owner and Conference Name.
These filters apply to scheduled conferences only. Ad hoc
conferences are not displayed in the filtered list.
For information on filters, see “Filter and Search a List”.
Export as Excel file
Status
Click this button to download the currently displayed
Conference list to a Microsoft Excel spreadsheet.
The state of the conference. For more information, see
Type
The type of scheduled conference. Possible values include:
•
Video Conference
—All conference participants
have video endpoints.
•
Audio Only Conference
—All conference
participants have audio endpoints. Audio only
conferences require an MCU.
•
•
Recurring Conference
a recurring series.
—The conference is one in
Multi-Bridge Conference —The scheduler assigned
the conference to multiple bridges and created bridge
links.
42
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview
Field
Description
Conference Name
The system- or scheduler-assigned name of the
conference. By default, the system assigns a conference
name and appends the day and date to that name. The
scheduler can change the system-assigned name.
Start Time
Bridge
The user-assigned start time for the conference. The
system appends the time difference between the local time
and the standard time.
If applicable, the user-assigned bridge for the conference.
Possible values are:
•
•
N/A—A bridge is not required for the conference.
<Bridge Name>—The user assigned the conference to
a single bridge. In this case, the bridge name is
displayed.
•
Multi bridge
—The user assigned the conference
to multiple bridges and created bridge links.
Owner
The conference creator.
Conference States
Conferences may be in the following states.
State
Description
Future
Conference
Scheduled conference that has not yet started. This
conference state is possible in all views except the
Yesterday Plus view.
Completed
Conference
A scheduled conference that occurred in the past. This
conference state is possible in all views except the Future
and Ongoing Plus view.
Active
Conference
A conference that is still active/ongoing. This conference
state is possible in all views except the Future and
Yesterday Plus view.
Active Alerts
Conference
The bridge on which the active/ongoing conference is being
hosted has sent an alert. Examples of events that will
trigger a bridge alert are:
•
A participant is connected in secondary mode (audio
only).
•
A conference is not yet full (i.e., not all scheduled
participants have joined the conference).
Polycom, Inc.
43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
State
Description
Declined
Conference
Applies only to conferences scheduled through the Polycom
Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft Outlook. This state
indicates that most participants did not accept the
conference invitation.
If your system is in maximum security mode, the Polycom
Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft Outlook is not available.
Conference End
Warning
The conference is ending, i.e., it is in its last five minutes
unless someone extends it.
Context-Sensitive Conference Actions
Besides the constant Refresh
and Add
actions, the Conference Actions
section may include these context-sensitive actions depending on the type of
conference selected.
Action
Available for future conferences only
Edit Use this command to edit the selected conference. For
Description
Available for future and past conferences
Delete
Use this command to delete the selected conference.
Available for future, past, and active conferences
Copy
Use this command to copy the selected conference.
Available for active conferences only
Manage
Operators only. Use this command to display the Manage
Conference page for the conference selected in the
Conference List. Use this command to manage
participants and endpoints in the selected active
conference. For more information, see “Manage an Active
Terminate
Operators only. Ends the selected conference.
44
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview
General Scheduling Information
You may find the following general topics useful when you are scheduling
conferences.
•
•
•
Scheduling Participants and Endpoints
When you schedule conferences, you select the participants you wish to join
the conference from your endpoint directory. Depending on your system
configuration, your endpoint directory may be the enterprise directory, the
Global Address Book, or one or more local address books. It may also include
Guest Book entries.
For participants that have multiple endpoints registered with the CMA
system, the system selects the participant’s default endpoint. You can change
to another endpoint by selecting it from the Call Info list or by editing the
participant.
You can schedule participants without endpoints into conferences. You cannot
schedule endpoints without owners into conferences. The CMA system can be
configured to allow you to overbook dial-in participants. In this case, dial-in
participants can be scheduled to dial into multiple conferences during the
same time period, but the system reserves resources for the participant for
only the first scheduled conference. Dial-out participants cannot be scheduled
into multiple conferences.
Also, if you schedule participants into conference as Dial In participants, the
conference will require external MCU resources.
Bridge Selection and Cascading
When a conference is scheduled with one of the CMA system scheduling
applications (Web Scheduler or Scheduling Plug-in for Microsoft Outlook or
IBM Lotus Notes) and the conference requires external MCU resources (such
as a Polycom RMX or MGC system), then by default the CMA system
automatically assigns the conference to a bridge. However, the system allows
users with the Advanced Scheduler role to select a bridge for their
conferences. It also allows them to create multibridge, cascaded conferences.
Bridge Selection
When scheduling a conference, users with the Advanced Scheduler role can
select a bridge to host their conference by selecting the Single Bridge option.
When they select this option, the system presents a list of bridges that have the
capabilities and resources required to host their conference.
Polycom, Inc.
45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Because this bridge list depends on the template selection, users should make
their template selection before selecting a bridge. Otherwise, they may select a
bridge that cannot meet their conferencing requirements. In this case, the
conference will fail to schedule.
Bridge Selection and Cascading Conferences
When scheduling a conference, users with the Advanced Scheduler role can
select the Multi Bridge option to create cascading conferences.
In some respects, a cascaded conference looks like a single conference, but it is
actually two or more conferences on different bridges that are linked together.
The link is created by a dial-out from one conference to a second conference
via a special cascaded entry queue.
Some reasons you may wish to create cascading conferences include:
•
•
•
To invite more conference participants than any single bridge can host
To connect different bridges at different sites into a single conference
To use the different capabilities of different bridges (for example, different
communication protocols, such as, serial connections, ISDN, etc.)
When you create a multibridge, cascaded conference, you must manually
select bridges and create the cascaded links between bridges by identifying the
originating bridge, the terminating bridge, and the network type (IP or ISDN).
The system displays an interconnection diagram that illustrates the cascaded
links. Once scheduled, each cascaded link appears as a participant in the
conference.
By default, the system automatically assigns participants to the “best bridge”
for them based on available capacity, location, and least cost routing rules.
However, you may also choose to manually assign participants to bridges.
Bridge Scheduling and Reassignment
When a conference is scheduled with one of the CMA system scheduling
applications (Web Scheduler or Scheduling Plug-in for Microsoft Outlook or
IBM Lotus Notes), by default the system automatically assigns the conference
to a bridge unless a user with the default Advanced Scheduler role intercedes.
If that bridge is down at the time the system starts the conference, the CMA
system attempts to dynamically reassign the conference to another bridge with
sufficient capabilities and resources.
•
If the system can successfully reassign the conference to another bridge,
the conference starts on the newly selected bridge, and the system sends
an updated conference email to all scheduled participants. This updated
email includes a new dial-in number that dial-in participants must use to
join the conference.
•
If the system cannot successfully reassign the conference to another
bridge, the conference fails to start. The system sends an email to notify the
conference organizer of the failure.
46
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom® CMA® System Conference Scheduling Overview
Some notes about bridge reassignment:
•
The bridge reassignment process only occurs when the system detects that
a bridge is down. It does not occur if the system determines that a bridge
does not have sufficient resources required to host the conference.
•
If the CMA system cannot find another bridge with the features and
capacity needed to support a conference, the conference fails to start. The
system does not attempt to modify the conference settings in any way.
Instead, the system sends an email to notify the conference organizer of
the failure.
•
•
The system will chain bridge reassignments. This means that if the next
bridge to which the system assigns a conference is down at the time the
system tries to start the conference, the system will try to reassign the
conference again.
If the bridge to which the system reassigns a conference has ad hoc
conferences on it, the CMA system is unaware of those conferences. The
reassigned conference may fail to start if ad hoc conferences are
consuming resources the CMA system expected to schedule. This is
known behavior and is avoided by applying the best practice of not using
bridges for both scheduled and ad hoc conferences.
Polycom, Inc.
47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
48
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5
Conference Scheduling Operations
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) system conference scheduling operations. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
Add/Schedule a Conference
By default, only schedulers and operators can schedule conferences.
Schedulers have two options for scheduling a new conference:
•
•
These options are discussed in the following topics.
Add/Schedule a New Conference
To add or schedule a new conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Future and click Add
.
In the conference scheduling page, enter a Conference Name and set a
conference Start Date, Start Time, and either an End Time or Duration.
Polycom, Inc.
49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
To make the conference recurring, click Recurrence and in the
Appointment Recurrence dialog box, set:
— Recurrence frequency (Daily, Weekly, or Monthly)
— Recurrence day (Sunday through Saturday)
— Recurrence range (Start date and End After occurrences or End by
date)
The maximum number of recurrences is 365.
— Click OK.
4
5
For an Audio Only conference, change the Conference Type to Audio
Only.
To change the template, click Default Template or Default Audio
Template and select a different template, if available.
Notes
•
•
•
Conference templates provide default conference settings. When you select a
different template, you are selecting the default conference settings for your
conference.
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are available to all users
who can schedule conferences. Other templates may also be available if they
have been assigned to users with your role.
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are stored in the system
database and their names are not localized.
6
To add conference participants from the local directory or enterprise
directory:
a
Enter all or part of a participant’s Last Name or First Name into one
of the name fields and click Add Participants.
The Add Participants dialog box appears with the list of participant
names that meet your search criteria.
Notes
•
Depending on the search domain, the search function may return different
•
The search results only include participants associated with endpoints.
b
c
Select the participant of interest’s name from the list.
The participant’s name appears in the underlying Selected
Participants and Rooms list.
Repeat steps a and b to add all domain participants and then click
Close.
50
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Scheduling Operations
7
To add a guest from the Guest Book:
a
b
Click Add From Guest Book.
In the Add From Guest Book dialog box, select the guest of interest’s
name from the list.
The guest’s name appears in the underlying Selected Participants
and Rooms list.
c
Repeat step b to add all participants from the Guest Book and then
click Close.
8
To add new guest participants (participants not available through the
local directory, enterprise directory, or Guest Book):
a
b
Click Add Guest.
Configure these fields in the Add Guest dialog box.
Field
Description
First Name
Last Name
The guest’s first name.
The guest’s last name.
Note
The system allows you to add multiple users with the
same first and last name into the Guest Book.
Email
The guest’s E-mail address. The system only validates
the structure of the E-mail address.
Note
The E-mail field is ASCII only.
Location
The location of the guest’s endpoint system. This is a
free-form field that the system does not validate.
How will the
participant
join the
Specify how the participant will join the conference.
•
In Person —The participant will attend the
conference by going to a room that is included in the
conference or joining another participant who is
attending the conference.
conference
•
•
Audio Only —The participant will attend the
conference by telephone. The system will either call
out to the participant or the participant will dial in.
Use Video—The participant will attend the
conference using a video endpoint system. The
system will either call out to the participant or the
participant will dial in.
This selection will in part determine what other fields of
the Add Guest dialog box you will need to complete.
Polycom, Inc.
51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Bit Rate
(Video only) Set as required. You can change the
connection speed for an endpoint up to the maximum
speed specified by the conference template.
Dial Options
Dial Type
Specify whether the guest will dial into the conference or
require that the system dial out to the guest.
Specify the protocol that the guest’s endpoint supports:
H.323 (IP), SIP (IP), or H.320 (ISDN).
This selection will determine what other sections of the
Add New Guest dialog box you will need to complete.
c
If the guest has an H.323 (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Number and
Number Type
The specific dial string for the guest, and the
format of the number that the MCU must resolve
to contact the guest. This may be an IP address,
E.164 address, H.323, or Annex-O.
For Annex-O dialing, in the Number field enter
the H.323.alias@IP, for example:
Notes
•
Polycom endpoints must register with a
gatekeeper before they will attempt an
Annex-O call.
•
You can enter a dial string for another MCU as
a guest. If so, you may need to specify the
conference ID in the Extension field also.
Extension
Use this field to connect the conference to
another conference on another MCU. In this field,
specify the conference ID or passcode for the
conference on the other MCU.
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on
the MCUs with which the CMA system is
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU
services.
52
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Scheduling Operations
d
If the guest has a SIP (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Sip URI
The SPI URI the MCU must resolve to contact the
guest.
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on
the MCUs with which the CMA system is
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU
services.
e
If the guest has an H.320 (ISDN) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Use Modified Dial
Number
Select this option first (as needed) as it will
determine the other fields you must configure.
Country
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number
is selected.) The country to which the system will
dial out to the guest. Click Select to view a list of
country codes.
Area/City Code
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number
is selected.) The area code to which the system
will dial out to the guest.
Number
The participant’s phone number.
Cannot be configured.
Extension
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on
the MCUs with which the CMA system has
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU
services.
f
Select Save to Guest Book to have this guest participant added to the
system Guest Book.
g
Click OK.
The guest’s name appears in the Selected Participants and Rooms
list.
9
Adjust the conference date and time as needed to match participant and
endpoint availability.
Polycom, Inc.
53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
a
Review their availability and adjust the conference date and time as
needed.
Notes
•
•
•
For participants who are associated with endpoints, the CMA system schedules
their availability according to the endpoint’s availability.
For participants with multiple endpoints, check the availability for each endpoint.
Click Call Info to change the participant’s endpoint.
Dial-in participants can be scheduled to dial into multiple conferences during the
same time period; dial-out participants cannot.
b
To edit a participant’s dial settings, select the participant from the
Selected Participants and Rooms list and click Edit. For more
information on editing participants settings, see “Edit a Participant’s
10 To add conference rooms to the Selected Participants and Rooms list:
a
b
Click Select Site.
Select the site of interest from the site list.
The conference room list for the selected site appears.
Select the conference room of interest from the list.
c
The conference room name appears in the underlying Selected
Participants and Rooms list.
d
Repeat steps b and c to add all required conference rooms and then
click OK.
11 If you have the Advanced Scheduler role, now is the time to assign
conference leadership roles, edit conference settings, and make bridge
12 To edit a participant’s dial settings, select the participant from the
Selected Participants and Rooms list and click Edit. For more
information on editing participants settings, see step 5 on page 57.
13 When finished, click Schedule.
The system verifies that it has a bridge with the capabilities and resources
required for your conference. If it does, the conference notification E-mail
appears with a message indicating Conference Successfully Scheduled.
14 To exit without sending an E-mail to participants, click Skip Email.
15 To send an E-mail notification to participants:
a
Copy additional people on the notification and/or add notes about
the conference.
Note that the To, CC, and BCC fields are ASCII only.
54
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Scheduling Operations
b
c
As needed, add information in the Enter additional notes to include
in the email section.
Click Send.
The system sends the conference notification E-mail. The Future view
appears. The conference appears in the conference list.
The E-mail that the CMA system sends can be read by E-mail systems that
accept plain text E-mails, iCal attachments, or vCal attachments.
Copy an Existing Conference
Future, ongoing, or past conferences can be copied as a template for a future
conference.
Users can only copy conferences that appear in their Conference list. By
default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while
operators see all the conferences on the system, unless areas are defined. In
which case operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.
To copy a conference
1
2
3
Go to the appropriate conference view.
Select the conference of interest and click Copy
.
If you used a template other than the default when you created the
conference, reselect the template.
4
5
Make the required changes to the conference date, participants, rooms, or
other settings. For information on performing these tasks, see
When finished, click Schedule.
The system verifies that it has a bridge with the capabilities and resources
required for your conference. If it does, the conference notification E-mail
appears with a message indicating Conference Successfully Scheduled.
6
To exit without sending an updated E-mail to your participants, click
Skip Email.
Polycom, Inc.
55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Edit a Conference
Only future conferences can be edited. Active or past conferences cannot be
edited.
Users can only edit the conferences that appear in their Conference list. By
default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while
operators see all the conferences on the system, unless areas are defined. In
which case operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.
To edit a future conference
1
2
3
Go to Conference > Future.
Select the conference of interest and click Edit
.
If you select a recurring conference, a dialog box appears asking if you
want to edit all conferences in the series or just the selected one. Make the
appropriate choice and click Edit.
The conference scheduling page appears.
4
To change the template, click Default Template or Default Audio
Template and select a different template, if available.
Notes
•
•
•
Conference templates provide default conference settings. When you select a
different template, you are selecting the default conference settings for your
conference.
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are available to all users
who can schedule conferences. Other templates may also be available to you if
they have been assigned to users with your role.
The Default Template and Default Audio Template are stored in the system
database and their names are not localized.
5
6
Make the required changes to the conference date, participants, rooms, or
other settings. For information on performing these tasks, see
When finished, click Schedule.
The system verifies that it has a bridge with the capabilities and resources
required for your conference. If it does, the conference notification E-mail
appears with a message indicating Conference Successfully Scheduled.
7
To exit without sending an updated E-mail to your participants, click
Skip Email.
56
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Scheduling Operations
8
To send an updated E-mail to your participants:
a
Copy additional people on the notification and/or add notes about
the conference.
Note that the To, CC, and BCC fields are ASCII only.
b
Click Send.
The system sends the updated conference notification E-mail. The
Future view appears. Your conference appears in the conference list.
Edit a Participant’s Settings
Participant’s settings for future scheduled conferences may be edited.
Schedulers cannot edit a participant’s settings for an active or past conference.
Users can only work with the conferences that appear in their Conference list.
By default, schedulers see only their conferences in the Conference list, while
operators see all the conferences on the system, unless areas are defined. In
which case operators see all the conferences for the areas to which they belong.
By default, users assigned other roles cannot view conferences.
To edit a participant’s settings
1
2
3
Go to Conference > Future.
Select the conference of interest and click Edit
.
If you select a recurring conference, a dialog box appears asking if you
want to edit all conferences in the series or just the selected one. Make the
appropriate choice and click Edit.
4
5
In the conference scheduling page, select the participant of interest from
the Selected Participants and Rooms list and click Edit.
In the Edit Participant Settings dialog box, edit the participant settings as
required.
Polycom, Inc.
57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
a
If the guest has an H.323 (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Number and
Number Type
The specific dial string for the guest, and the
format of the number that the MCU must resolve
to contact the guest. This may be an IP address,
E.164 address, H.323, or Annex-O.
For Annex-O dialing, in the Number field enter
the H.323.alias@IP, for example:
Notes
•
Polycom endpoints must register with a
gatekeeper before they will attempt an
Annex-O call.
•
You can enter a dial string for another MCU as
a guest. If so, you may need to specify the
conference ID in the Extension field also.
Extension
Use this field to connect the conference to
another conference on another MCU. In this field,
specify the conference ID or passcode for the
conference on the other MCU.
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on
the MCUs with which the CMA system is
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU
services.
b
If the guest has a SIP (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Sip URI
The SPI URI the MCU must resolve to contact the
guest.
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on
the MCUs with which the CMA system is
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU
services.
58
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Scheduling Operations
c
If the guest has an H.320 (ISDN) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Use Modified Dial
Number
Select this option first (as needed) as it will
determine the other fields you must configure.
Country
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number
is selected.) The country to which the system will
dial out to the guest. Click Select to view a list of
country codes.
Area/City Code
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number
is selected.) The area code to which the system
will dial out to the guest.
Number
The participant’s phone number.
Cannot be configured.
Extension
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on
the MCUs with which the CMA system has
registered. Leave this at Any Available Service
unless you have specific knowledge of MCU
services.
6
Click OK.
View Scheduling Information for a Conference
Users can only view scheduling information for the conferences that appear in
their Conference list. By default, schedulers see only their conferences in the
Conference list, while operators see all the conferences on the system, unless
areas are defined. In which case operators see all the conferences for the areas
to which they belong. By default, users assigned other roles cannot view
conferences.
To view the scheduling information for a conference
1
To see the scheduling information for a future conference, go to
Conference > Future. To see the scheduling information for an active
conference, go to Conference > Ongoing.
2
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click View.
Polycom, Inc.
59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The View conference page appears displaying the following details about
the conference:
Section
Description
Start Date
End Date
Duration
The date on which the conference started or will start.
The date on which the conference is scheduled to end.
The scheduled duration of the conference in hours and
minutes.
Recurrence
Owner
The recurrence information for the conference.
The person who scheduled the conference.
Type
The type of conference as identified by an icon. Hover over
the icon to determine the conference type.
Conference
Passcode
The conference passcode assigned to the conference.
For future conferences, users with the Advanced
Scheduler role can change this conference password. See
Chairperson
Whether or not the conference has a chairperson. This field
will include a participant’s name or N/A.
For future conferences, users with the Advanced
Scheduler role can assign a conference chairperson. See
Participants
List
Information for the participant, including
•
•
•
•
•
Name
Dial Mode
Participant Type
Access
Endpoint
3
Click Back to List to return to the conference list.
60
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6
Advanced Scheduling Operations
This chapter describes how users with the Advanced Scheduler role have
more options when scheduling conferences using the Polycom® Converged
Management Application™ (CMA®) system.
When scheduling conferences, advanced schedulers can:
•
•
•
Edit Conference Settings
By default, users with the Advanced Scheduler role can overwrite certain
conference template settings as described here.
Note
Two conferences scheduled with the same template may have different settings
and behavior if they are hosted on different types of MCUs. Minimize or eliminate
such differences by ensuring that all MCUs are similarly configured and that all
CMA system templates are synchronized with RMX profiles.
Schedulers can edit conference settings only for scheduled conferences. They
cannot edit conference settings for active conferences.
To edit the conference settings
1
On the conference scheduling page, as you are adding or editing a
conference, click Edit Conference Settings.
Polycom, Inc.
61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
As needed, configure these settings on the Conference Settings dialog
box. The settings that you can edit may depend on the template selected.
Setting
Description
Conference ID
By default, the system assigns a Conference ID. You
can change this ID to permit integration with third-party
scheduling tools. This identifier must be 8 or less
numeric digits.
Notes
•
The CMA system compares the Conference ID to its
database to verify that it is unique. If it is not unique,
you will be prompted to enter a new Conference ID.
•
If a conference is scheduled on a Polycom RMX
system and the room ID is the same as the assigned
Conference ID, then the conference will not be
created on RMX. The conference will launch on the
CMA system with an active status, but will display no
endpoints connected.
Conference
Passcode
By default, the system assigns an 15-digit Conference
Passcode and provides this passcode to participants
within the content of the conference notification E-mail.
You can change this passcode to another 9- through
16-digit number.
Enable
Chairperson
You can select a video chairperson to control the
conference from his or her video endpoint system. The
video chairperson must have a video endpoint system
and Chairperson conferences require an MCU.
Notes
•
If the conference template has the Conference
Requires Chairperson parameter enabled, then
Enable Chairperson is automatically selected and
cannot be changed.
•
If a conference is scheduled on a Polycom RMX
system and the RMX profile has Conference
Requires Chairperson selected but the template
does not, and the conference is scheduled without a
chairperson, then all users will remain in the waiting
room and will not be able to join the conference.
•
Polycom RMX 1000 systems do not support the
Chairperson feature.
62
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Advanced Scheduling Operations
Setting
Description
Chairperson
Passcode
If Enable Chairperson is selected, the system assigns
an 15-digit Chairperson Password and provides this
password to the video chairperson in a separate E-mail.
If Enable Chairperson is selected, the chairperson
must enter this 15-digit password at his or her video
endpoint to assume control of the conference.
You can change this password to another 4- through
16-digit number.
Dial Options
You have three options:
•
To create a conference for which the same dial-in
information and a PIN code are assigned to all
conference participants, use the Dial-In setting. This
setting allows participants to dial in from an audio or
video endpoint and connect to the same conference
on the MCU.
•
•
To dial out to all participants in the conference, use
the Dial-Out setting.
To allow participants both options, select
Dial-In+Dial-Out.
Note
When you change a conference from Dial-In to Dial
In+Dial Out, the selected resources remain set to
Dial-In. You must change them manually.
Always Use MCU
Video Mode
This setting forces the conference to an MCU and
prevents video endpoints from connecting to each other
directly. This setting is automatically selected and cannot
be changed when Audio Only is the conference type or
when Enable Chairperson is selected.
Determines the initial layout on a video endpoint's
monitor for a multipoint conference that requires an
MCU. The options are:
•
Switching.
Indicates that the display changes
each time the speaker changes, and everyone sees
the current speaker.
•
Select a Frame Count, then select the specific
layout for the frames.
The available layouts are Continuous Presence
settings.
Polycom, Inc.
63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Setting
Description
Bit Rate
Specifies the maximum connection speed for endpoints
in the conference. Individual endpoints that specify a
lower connection speed connect at that lower speed.
Endpoints that specify a higher connection speed
connect at the speed identified in the conference
template.
If you select a higher speed than an endpoint can
support, the system reduces the speed that endpoint;
however, the conference uses the default connection
speed for endpoints that can match it. If you place the
calls through an endpoint with an embedded MCU, the
behavior depends on the capabilities of that endpoint.
Bit Rate
(continued)
When the dial speed is higher than the number of
channels defined in the H.320 service for the endpoint,
you receive a warning. To continue, lower the dial speed
to less than or equal to the ISDN capability of the
endpoint.
Higher speed is important for high-quality video in a
conference. Because higher speeds use greater
bandwidth, scheduling a high-bandwidth conference
may limit the number of conferences that you can
reserve at one time.
64
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Advanced Scheduling Operations
Setting
Description
People + Content
Controls the ability for one endpoint to send two types of
data—a data stream and a video stream—over the same
bandwidth to display people and content. The receiving
endpoint handles the two video streams differently and
may display them on separate screens or through video
switching mode.
Endpoints that do not support the selected method
connect with either video through IP or audio only
through ISDN.
Select from these available settings:
•
None. Select this option when dual data streams are
not required.
•
People +Content (H.329). This enables the industry
standard H.239 dual streams for endpoints that
support H.239 or the Polycom proprietary People +
Content dual streams for older Polycom endpoints
without H.239 capabilities. The MCU requires that
conferences with People + Content use a minimum
speed of 192 K.
•
People and Content VO. This Polycom proprietary
technology works with PictureTel endpoints. Select
this option for older endpoints.
•
•
•
Visual Concert PC. Select this option for use with
Polycom ViewStation MP/512/SP/323 endpoints.
Visual Concert FX. Select this option for use with
Polycom ViewStation FX/EX and VS4000 endpoints.
Duo Video. This setting supports IP and ISDN and
is available with TANDBERG endpoints, in which
one part of the conference is set as the video
conference and the other as the presentation
conference.
Polycom, Inc.
65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Setting
Description
T.120 Mode
For MGC-hosted conferences only, selects the protocols
and specifications for multipoint data communication.
If your system is in maximum security mode, the T.120
options are not supported.
In the T.120 menu, select the speed for the T.120
connection. See your IT department to determine the
best combinations for your conferences. To disable the
T.120 mode, select None.
If you select T.120, these options may be available,
according to the participant’s endpoint and software:
•
Application Sharing. Allows two or more
participants to work on the same document or
application, even when only one participant has the
application. In application sharing, one participant
launches the application, and it runs simultaneously
on all other computers.
•
•
File Transfer. Enables participants to send files to
each other.
Chat or Whiteboard. Allows participants to
communicate with each other by writing.
In all of these modes, participants can view and hear
each other.
3
If the conference is configured for Chairperson or Lecturer modes, assign
participants leadership roles:
a
To assign a participant the lecturer role, in the Lecturer field select the
participant’s name from the list.
b
To assign a participant the video chairperson role, in the Video
Chairperson field select the participant’s name from the list.
Notes
•
If the Lecturer or Video Chairperson features are not available, then the
selected template does not support these features.
•
To be assigned Lecturer, a participant must have a manageable video endpoint.
4
or return to adding or editing the conference, as described in “Conference
66
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Advanced Scheduling Operations
Select a Bridge for a Conference
By default, when scheduling a conference, the CMA system will automatically
select a bridge for the conference. However, users with the Advanced
Scheduler role can select a specific bridge for a conference.
To select a single bridge for a conference
1
When you’re adding or editing a conference, after you’ve made all of
your other conference configuration choices, from the Bridge Selection
list select Single Bridge.
A bridge selection drop down list appears based on the template selection
and conference settings.
2
3
From the MCU list, select a specific MCU to host the conference.
Continue on to “Create a Cascaded Conference Across Multiple Bridges”
on page 67, as required, or return to adding or editing the conference, as
Create a Cascaded Conference Across Multiple Bridges
Users with the Advanced Scheduler role can create cascaded conferences.
To create a cascaded conference across multiple bridges
1
When you’re adding or editing a conference, after you’ve made all of
your other conference configuration choices, from the Bridge Selection
select Multi Bridge.
Note
If the Multi Bridge option is not available, then the system is not configured to
support this option.
The Schedule button changes to a Manual Cascade button and the
Recurrence button is grayed out.
2
Click Manual Cascade.
The People To Bridges dialog box appears displaying the selected
conference participants and their bridge assignments. Bridge assignments
default to Auto. These system assignments are based on bridge capacity
and/or least cost routing principles.
In the Selected Bridge Availability section, the system shows a count of
the available ports on the available bridges for the specified time period.
Polycom, Inc.
67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
If the port count is within 5% of the maximum ports available, it is
displayed in red.
3
To change a bridge assignment for a selected participant, click Auto and
select a bridge from the pull-down menu.
Note
A CMA system can only show port counts for conferences scheduled via the
system. Ad hoc conferences are not included in the port count.
4
When you’ve completed all bridge assignments, click Next.
The Bridge To Bridge Links dialog box displays a graphical view of the
selected bridges.
Note
If an MCU does not show up in the Bridge To Bridge Links dialog box, then the
MCU software does not support cascading.
5
6
To add a hub bridge (a bridge used to connect one bridge to another),
from the Available Bridges window, select a bridge and click Add
Bridge.
Specify bridge-to-bridge connections by selecting the bridges of interest
and clicking Add Link.
The link is graphically represented by an arrow. The bridge at the base of
the arrow dials to the bridge at the point of the arrow.
Note
A Polycom RMX system cannot dial a Polycom MGC, so do not link from an RMX
system to an MGC system.
7
In the Add Link dialog box, select the Link Type.
Notes
•
•
•
You can add links from a Polycom MGC system to a Polycom RMX system.
There is no support for ISDN cascaded links on RMX MCUs.
The lag time required to update cascaded links may cause more than one
participant to hear the prompt about being the first person to join the conference.
8
Return to adding or editing the conference, as described in “Conference
68
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Conference and Participant
Management Operations
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) system conference and participant management operations. It
includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Manage an Active Conference
The Manage Conference page provides a detailed view of a single active
conference and allows an operator to make some changes to the conference.
To manage an active conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click Manage
.
Polycom, Inc.
69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The conference page appears in a new tab displaying the Participants list.
The Participants list displays these settings:
Section
Description
Status
The state of the participant’s connection as identified by an
icon. Hover over the icon to determine the status.
Type
The type of conference as identified by an icon. Hover over
the icon to determine the type.
Name
The participant’s name.
Endpoint
The name assigned to the participant’s endpoint when it
registered or was added to the system.
Access
The endpoint’s network interface type. Possible values
include:
•
•
H323
ISDN
Address
Bit Rate
Dial Mode
The IP address or ISDN number of the participant’s endpoint
(if a dial-out).
The sum of the audio and video data transfer rate (in kbps)
of the participant’s endpoint.
How the participant joined the call. Possible values include:
•
•
Audio or Video Dial-In
Audio or Video Dial-Out
Bridge
The MCU on which the participant’s call resides.
3
Use these conference actions as needed:
Action
Use this action to...
Copy
.
Schedule a new conference that duplicates the
selected conference settings.
View
View information for the selected conference.
End an active conference.
Terminate
Extend Duration
Extend the duration of an active conference.
70
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Management Operations
Action
Use this action to...
Change Layout
For applicable endpoints.
Change the default video layout for the conference
display.
•
Switching.
Indicates that the display changes
each time the speaker changes, and everyone
sees the current speaker.
•
Select a Frame Count, then select the specific
layout for the frames.
The available layouts are Continuous Presence
settings.
Add Participant
Add one or more participants to the selected
conference.
Add Guest
Add a guest to the selected conference.
Add Room
Add one or more rooms to the selected conference.
Add Favorites
Add participants from one of your Favorites lists to the
selected conference.
Join Conference
Join the conference, monitor the conference, and talk
with participants as needed.
4
Use these participant actions as needed:
Action
Use this action to...
Mute
Unmute Audio
or
Mute or unmute the selected participant’s audio line
into the conference. This option appears only when the
conference is running on an external MCU. The Audio
column in the Participants list shows the current status
of this setting.
Block
Unblock Video
or
Block or unblock the selected participant’s video line
into the conference. This option appears only when the
conference is running on an external MCU. The Video
column in the Participants list shows the current status
of this setting.
Connect
Disconnect
or
Disconnect or reconnect the selected participant to the
conference. A disconnected participant is still
associated with the conference and cannot be
scheduled for other conferences.
Remove
Remove the selected participant from the Participants
list at which time the participant can be scheduled for
another conference.
Send Message
Send a message to the selected participant’s
registered Polycom endpoint. The message appears
briefly on the monitor for the selected video endpoint.
Polycom, Inc.
71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Action
Use this action to...
Acknowledge
Help
Acknowledge a request for help and send a message
to the requesting endpoint.
Manage Device
Open the web-based user interface for the selected
participant’s endpoint in a new browser window.
Save as Favorite
Function available when the selected participant has
an associated endpoint to which the system can dial
out.
Save the selected participant to an existing Favorites
List.
Connect All New
Function available only when the system is displaying
the New Conference Participants list.
Initiates the system dial out to new participants.
Add Additional Participants to an Active Conference
Operators can add additional participants to an active conference.
Note
Dial Out is the only Dial Option the system allows for adding participants to an
active conferences.
To add additional conference participants to an active conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click Manage
.
3
To add participants from the local directory or enterprise directory:
a
b
Click Add Participant
.
Enter all or part of a participant’s Last Name or First Name into the
appropriate field and click Search.
A list appears of participant’s names that meet the search criteria.
Notes
•
Depending on the search domain, the search function may return different
•
The search results only include users associated with endpoints.
72
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Management Operations
c
Select the participant’s name from the list.
The participant’s name appears in the underlying New Conference
Participants list.
d
e
Close.
If necessary, edit the new participants’ settings. See “Edit a
4
To add participants from the Guest Book:
a
b
Click Add Guest.
From the Guest Book dialog box, select the guest’s name from the list.
The guest’s name appears in the underlying New Conference
Participants list.
c
5
6
To add new guest participants (participants not available from the local
To initiate the system dial out to new participants, select the participants
of interest from the New Conference Participants list and click Connect
New Participants.
The system dials out to the participants and adds them to the conference.
Add a Room to an Active Conference
To add a room to an active conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click Manage
.
3
4
From the Conference Actions list, click Add Room.
From the Add Room dialog box, select the site location of the room.
The list of conference rooms at the site appears.
Select the conference room of interest.
5
6
The conference room name appears in the underlying New Conference
Participants list.
Click Close.
Polycom, Inc.
73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
7
To initiate the system dial out to the room, select the room from the New
Conference Participants list and click Connect New Participants.
The system dials out to the room endpoint system and adds the room to
the conference.
View the Video of a Participant in an Active Conference
To view the video of a participant in an active conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click Manage
.
3
Select a participant from the Participants list.
The selected participant’s video appears in the Conference Image section
of the interface.
4
Click Shuffle
to shuffle to the next participant’s video.
Join an Active Conference
By default, users assigned the Operator role can join an active conference to
offer conference support.
To join an active conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click Manage
.
3
From the Conference Actions list, click Join Conference.
The Join Conference dialog box appears.
4
5
6
If the conference uses bridge cascading, select a bridge for the call into the
conference.
If you have multiple endpoints, choose the endpoint to use to join the
conference.
Click Join Conference.
Your endpoint is added to the conference with your video blocked but
your audio not muted.
74
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Management Operations
Add a Participant from a Favorites List to an Active
Conference
By default, users assigned the Operator role can work with favorites lists.
To add a participant from a favorites list to an active conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click Manage
.
3
4
From the Conference Actions list, click Add Favorites.
From the Favorites List, expand the list of interest.
The names of the participants in the list is displayed.
Select the participant of interest from the list.
5
The participant’s name appears in the underlying New Conference
Participants list.
6
7
Repeat steps 4 and 5 to add all participants from the Favorites List and
then click Close.
To initiate the system dial out to new participants, select the participants
of interest from the New Conference Participants list and from the New
Participants Action menu, click Connect New Participants.
The system dials out to the participants and adds them to the conference.
Add/Save a Participant to a Favorites List
By default, users assigned the Operator role can work with favorites lists.
To add or save a conference participant to a favorites list
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
From the list of All Conferences, select the conference of interest and
click Manage
.
3
4
From the Participants list, select the participant of interest.
From the Participant Actions menu, click Save as Favorite.
The names of the participants in the list is displayed.
5
From the Save as Favorite Participant dialog box, select the Favorite List
to which to save the participant and click OK.
Polycom, Inc.
75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Manage a Participant’s Endpoint During a Conference
The Manage page also allows operators to manage conference participant’s
endpoints.
•
•
These context-sensitive commands only appear when the participant’s endpoint
supports the action.
These commands work for rooms on the participant list as well.
To manage a participant’s endpoint
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
Select the conference of interest and click Manage
The Participants list appears.
.
3
4
5
To view participants geographically, click
Double-click on the participant of interest.
.
Use these participant actions as needed. These actions are also available
from the View Participants Details dialog box.
Action
Use this action to...
Mute
Unmute Audio
or
Mute or unmute the selected participant’s audio line
into the conference. This option appears only when the
conference is running on an external MCU. The Audio
column in the Participants list shows the current status
of this setting.
Block
Unblock Video
or
Block or unblock the selected participant’s video line
into the conference. This option appears only when the
conference is running on an external MCU. The Video
column in the Participants list shows the current status
of this setting.
Connect
Disconnect
or
Disconnect or reconnect the selected participant to the
conference. A disconnected participant is still
associated with the conference and cannot be
scheduled for other conferences.
Remove
Remove the selected participant from the Participants
list at which time the participant can be scheduled for
another conference.
76
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Management Operations
Action
Use this action to...
Send Message
Send a message to the selected participant’s
registered Polycom endpoint. The message appears
briefly on the monitor for the selected video endpoint.
Acknowledge
Help
Acknowledge a request for help and send a message
to the requesting endpoint.
Manage Device
Open the web-based user interface for the selected
participant’s endpoint in a new browser window.
View a Participant’s Details During a Conference
This procedure describes how to view details for a participant’s endpoint
while it is in conference.
To view a participant’s endpoint details
1
2
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
Select the conference of interest and click Manage
The Participants list appears.
.
3
4
To view participants geographically, click
Double-click on the participant of interest.
.
The View Participant Details dialog box appears with the Call Properties
displayed. It includes the Near End and Far End video, the Participant’s
name, Status, Errors, Warnings, Endpoint Type, Address, Access, and Bit
Rate.
It also includes a list of Participant Actions. For more information about
these actions, see “Manage a Participant’s Endpoint During a Conference”
5
To view additional participant details, change the selection in the Call
Properties drop-down menu.
— If you select Device, you’ll see these participant details:
Setting
Description
Endpoint Type
Usually the endpoint model, such as Polycom HDX
system.
IP Address
Site
The IP address for the endpoint.
The location of the endpoint as identified by its IP
address and the subnet of the site.
Polycom, Inc.
77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Setting
Gatekeeper
GDS
Description
The gatekeeper with which the endpoint is registered.
The Global Directory Service for the endpoint. Usually
the Polycom Global Address Book.
Presence
Whether or not the endpoint is registered with a
Presence service, so that its availability can be
reported.
Device Managed Whether or not the endpoint is registered with a
Provisioning service, so that it can be configured
automatically.
ISDN Line Status The status of the ISDN line. Possible values include:
•
•
Operational
Non-operations
This field is blank for the following endpoint types:
PVX, MGC, RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.
Alias Type
Alias Value
If the endpoint has an alias designation, the type of
alias. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID, URL,
Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and
Unknown.
Value for the alias type shown.
— If you select Call Details, you’ll see these participant details:
Setting
Description
Video Protocol
The video connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using. Possible
values include:
•
H.261
H.261 is an ITU standard designed for two-way
communication over ISDN lines and supports
data rates which are multiples of 64Kbit/s. H.261
supports CIF and QCIF resolutions.
•
•
H.263
H.263 is based on H.261 with enhancements that
improve video quality over modems. It supports
CIF, QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and 16CIF resolutions.
H.264
Video Format
Video Rate
The video format, both transmission (Tx) and
reception (Rx), the endpoint is using.
The video bandwidth negotiated with the far site.
Video Rate Used The actual video bandwidth used in the call to the far
site.
78
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Management Operations
Setting
Description
Video Frame
Rate
Specifies the frame rate to use.
Video FEC
Errors
The number of Forward Error Correction (FEC) errors
that have been corrected in the current call.
Cause Code
Audio Rate
The audio bandwidth negotiated with the far site
Audio Protocol
The audio connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using.
— If you select Call Quality of Service, you’ll see these standard service
measurements: Total Packet Loss, % Packet Loss, Audio Packet Loss,
Video Packet Loss, Audio Jitter, and Video Jitter.
Terminate an Active Conference
To terminate an active conference
1
2
3
Go to Conference > Ongoing.
Select the conference of interest and click Terminate
Click Terminate to confirm the termination.
.
Delete a Conference
Users can delete future or past conferences. Users cannot delete active
conferences.
To delete a conference
1
2
Go to Conference > Future.
To delete a past conference, select the appropriate filter (such as
Yesterday Plus).
3
4
Select the conference of interest and click Delete
.
If you select a recurring conference, a dialog box appears asking you if
you want to delete just the conference you selected or all conferences in
the series. Make the appropriate choice. Active conferences in the series
cannot be deleted.
Polycom, Inc.
79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
5
Click Delete to confirm the deletion.
The conference is deleted. For future conferences, the system E-mails the
change to the conference owner and participants and releases the
participant and room resources.
80
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
8
Conference and Participant Details
This chapter lists the conference and participant detail fields for reference. It
includes:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Conference Image
The Conference Image section displays the selected participant’s video.
Shuffle to shuffle to the next participant’s video
Conference Details
The Conference Details section has these fields.
Section
Description
Owner
The name of the person who created the conference.
Schedulers only see the conferences they own.
Not applicable for ad hoc conferences.
Start Date/Time
For a scheduled conference, the start date and time of the
conference and the time difference between the local time and
the standard time.
For an unscheduled conference, the date and time the
conference started.
Polycom, Inc.
81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Section
Description
Duration
For a scheduled conference, how long the conference is
scheduled to last.
For a completed conference, how long the conference actually
lasted.
End Date/Time
Type
The date and time the conference ended
The type of conference. Possible values include:
•
•
Audio
Audio-Video
Status
The state of the conference. Possible values include:
•
•
Active
•
•
Finished
Future
Declined
Recurring
Whether or not the conference was scheduled as a recurring
conference
Connection
Connection information about the conference. Possible values
include:
•
•
•
Multipoint
Point To Point
Gateway
Bit Rate
The rate (in kbps) at which to transfer the conference audio or
video data
Schedule ID
System-assigned ID used for troubleshooting
System-assigned ID used for troubleshooting
Conf Monitoring
ID
Video Layout
The video layout for the conference: Video Switching or
Continuous.
Video Format
For a conference hosted on an MCU, the video format of the
conference data stream. Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
•
Auto
CIF
•
•
•
•
VGA
SVGA
XGA
QCIF
4CIF
16CIF
NTSC
Video Protocol
For a conference hosted on an MCU, the video protocol of the
conference data stream. Possible values include:
•
•
Auto
•
•
H.263
H.264
H.261
82
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Details
Section
Description
Audio Algorithm
For a conference hosted on an MCU, the audio compression
ratio of the conference data stream. Possible values are:
•
•
AUTO
G.711
•
•
G.722
Siren 7 (16 kbps)
Conference Features
The Conference Features section has these fields.
Section
Description
Conference
Passcode
The conference passcode, which is assigned either by the
system or the scheduler.
Chairperson
Option
Indicates whether or not the conference requires a
chairperson.
Note
The RMX 1000 system does not support the Chairperson
feature.
Chairperson
Passcode
The passcode the chairperson must enter to take control of
the conference. Not applicable when no chairperson is
designated.
Chairperson
The name of the chairperson. Not applicable when no
chairperson is designated.
Lecture Mode
The type of Lecture Mode, if any, that was selected when
the conference was created. Possible values are None,
Lecture, and Presentation.
Note
The RMX 1000 system does not support Lecture Mode.
Lecturer
The name of the lecturer. Not applicable when Lecture
Mode is None.
Lecture View
Switching
Indicates whether or not automatic switching between
participants is enabled.
Dual Stream Mode
Possible values are:
•
•
•
•
None
•
•
•
Duo Video
Unknown
People+Content
Visual Concert PC
Visual Concert FX
Polycom, Inc.
83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Section
Description
T120 Rate
Possible values are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
None
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
MLP - 62.4
MLP - 46.4
MLP - 40
MLP - 38.4
MLP - 32
MLP - 30.4
MLP - 24
MLP - 22.4
MLP - 16
MLP - 14.4
MLP - 6.4
MLP - 4
HMLP - Var
HMLP - 384
HMLP - 320
HMLP - 256
HMLP - 192
HMLP - 128
HMLP - 6.4
HMLP - 62.4
HMLP - 14.4
MLP - Var
MLP - 64.4
End Time Alert
Entry Tone
Exit Tone
Whether or not the system alerts participants to the end of
the conference by playing an end tone
Whether or not an entry tone is played to all connected
participants when a participant joins the conference
Whether or not an exit tone is played to all connected
participants when a participant disconnects from the
conference
Bridge (MCU) Features
The Bridge (MCU) Features section, which applies only for conferences that
use an MCU, has these fields.
Section
Description
MCU Name
The MCU device name hosting the conference. Not
applicable when the conference is not being hosted on an
MCU.
Numeric ID
The unique conference identifier assigned by the MCU
Whether or not the conference has an entry queue enabled
Entry Queue
Access
Note
The CMA system enables entry queues on a per MGC
basis and all conferences on an entry queue enabled MGC
will be scheduled with entry queue access.
84
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Details
Section
Description
Meet Me per Conf
Whether or not the a conference is a Meet Me conference,
for which a dial-in number is assigned, so that undefined
participants can connect to the conference
Conference on Port
(MGC only) Indicates whether or not the MGC is set to
Conference on Port, which conserves bandwidth and ports.
In this case, all participants are on a single video port and
use the same connection speed and video format.
Message Service
Type
Displays the type of messages participants joining the
conference hear. Possible values are:
•
•
•
•
None
Welcome (No wait)
Attended (Wait)
IVR
Message Service
Name
Name on the MCU of the Message Service. So, for
example, a service name IVR70 which provides the IVR
service
Participants List
The Participants section has these fields.
Section
Name
Description
The participant’s name
Call Info
How the participant joined the call. Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
•
Video Dial-Out
Audio Dial-In@<Address>
Video Dial-In@<Address>
In Person
Room Only
Polycom, Inc.
85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Participant Details
The Participant Details section has these fields.
Section
Description
Name
Type
The participant’s name
The type of conference connection. Possible values
include:
•
•
•
Audio Only
Audio-Video
Other (for In Person and Room Only participants)
Endpoint Name
The name assigned to the participant’s endpoint when
added to the system
Connection Status
The state of the participant’s endpoint connection. Possible
values include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Connected
Connecting
Declined
Disconnected
Disconnecting
Error
Unknown
Interface Type
The interface protocol of the participant’s endpoint. Possible
values include:
•
•
IP
ISDN
Number
Bit Rate
The IP address or phone number of the participant’s
endpoint (if a dial-out) or the participant’s port address on
the MCU (if a dial-in)
The audio or video data transfer rate (in kbps) of the
participant’s endpoint
86
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference and Participant Details
Participant Settings
The Participant Settings dialog box has these fields.
Section
Description
Name
The participant’s name.
Endpoints
Email
The participant’s managed endpoint(s) if available.
The participant’s E-mail address (ASCII only) for
participants or guests without managed endpoints.
Type
The type of participant. Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
•
Domain User
Local User
Domain Resource (a room)
Local Resource (a room)
Guest
How will this
participant join the
conference?
How the participant will join the conference. Possible values
include:
•
•
•
•
In Person (requires no dial settings)
Room Only
Audio Only (Dial in)
Use Video
Bit Rate
The audio or video data transfer rate (in kbps) of the
participant’s endpoint.
Dial Options
Available only if the participant is joining via a video
endpoint system. Possible values include:
•
•
Dial-In
Dial-Out
Dial Type
The protocol the audio or video endpoint system uses.
Select E.164, H323, IP (SiP IRI), or Annex-O. If no dial type
is selected, it defaults to E.164.
If you select a Dial Option of Dial-Out for a participant without a managed
endpoint, the Participant Settings dialog box has these additional fields.
Section
Description
Number
(H.323 and H.320 dial types) The participant’s phone
number
Extension
The specific dial string for the participant.
MCU Service
MCU service defined on the MCUs that the CMA system
has registered.
Polycom, Inc.
87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Section
Description
Country
(H.320 dial type only) The country to which the system will
dial out to the participant
Area/City Code
(H.320 dial type only) The area code to which the system
will dial out to the participant
Use Modified Dial
Number
(H.320 dial type only) Click this check box to add a specific
prefix to the participant’s phone number. The Number field
becomes active
Number
SIP URI
(H.320 dial type only) The complete modified dial number
as required to include PBX exit codes, dialing prefixes, or
other installation-specific dial string requirements.
SIP dial type only) The SIP URI the MCU must resolve to
contact the participant.
88
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
9
Endpoint Management Overview
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system’s endpoint management functions. It includes
these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Endpoint Menu, Views, and Lists
The CMA system Endpoint menu provides these views of the Endpoint list:
•
Monitor View—Displays the list of all registered and managed endpoints.
•
Peripherals View—Displays the list of all peripherals connected to
managed endpoints. Use this view to see the status of peripherals. See
•
•
Bundled Provisioning—Displays the list of available endpoint
Automatic Provisioning—Displays the list of dynamically managed
endpoints eligible for automatic provisioning. See “Automatic
•
Scheduled Provisioning—Displays the list of standardly managed
endpoints eligible for scheduled provisioning. See “Scheduled
Polycom, Inc.
89
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
Automatic Software Update—Displays the list of dynamically managed
endpoints eligible for automatic software updates. See “Automatic
•
Scheduled Software Update—Displays the list of standardly managed
endpoints eligible for scheduled software updates. See “Scheduled
All of the Endpoint views have the following information:
Section
Views
Description
The views you can access from the page.
The set of available commands. The constant command in
Actions
the Endpoint views is Refresh
, which updates the
display with current information.
Endpoint List
The context-sensitive Endpoint list for the selected view.
Device Information
Information about the endpoint selected in the endpoint list
including:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Monitor View
Use the Endpoint Monitor View to monitor and manage endpoints.
Endpoint List in the Monitor View
By default the Endpoint list in the Monitor View displays a list of all
endpoints that registered automatically with the CMA system gatekeeper and
endpoints that were added manually for management and monitoring
purposes.
90
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
The Endpoint list in this view has these fields.
Field
Description
Filter
Use the filter choices to display other views of the Endpoint
list, which include:
•
•
•
Type - Filters the list by type. For more information, see
Alerts - Filters the list by alert type: Help, Error, or
Warning.
Connection Status- Filters the list by connection
status: In a Call, Online, or Offline.
•
•
•
Name - Filters the list by system name entered.
IP Address - Filters the list by IP address entered.
Dial String- Filters the list by dial string (SIP, H.323, or
ISDN) entered.
•
•
Site - Filters the list by site location entered.
Area - (Available only when Areas are enabled.) Filters
the list by the area with which the endpoint is
associated.
•
VIP - Filters the list for VIP endpoints.
Status
The state of the endpoint. Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Online
Offline
In a call
Gatekeeper registered
Signalling unregistered
Error
All paired peripherals are connected without alerts
One or more paired peripherals are turned off or no
longer connected
•
One or more paired peripherals has an error
Mode
The management mode for the endpoint. Possible values
include:
•
•
Dynamic management mode
Standard management mode (no icon)
For a description of these modes, see “Endpoint
Name
Model
The assigned name of the endpoint.
The type of endpoint. For valid endpoint types, see
IP Address
Area
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.
(Available only when Areas are enabled.) The area with
which the endpoint is associated.
Polycom, Inc.
91
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Dial String
The dial string for the endpoint. If the endpoint has more
than one dial string, it displays one based on this order:
•
•
•
SIP
H.323
ISDN
Site
The site to which the endpoint belongs.
The user associated with the endpoint.
Owner
Actions in the Monitor View
Besides providing access to the endpoint views, the Actions section of the
Monitor View may also include these context-sensitive commands depending
on the selected endpoint type.
Action
Use this action to...
Available for all endpoint types
Add
Manually add an endpoint to the CMA system or find a
endpoint on the network.
View
Display all of the Device Details for the selected endpoint.
Details
Edit
Change connection settings for the selected endpoint. Note
that if this is a managed endpoint, the endpoint may
overwrite settings entered manually.
Delete
Delete the selected endpoints.
Search Devices
Search the list of endpoints by IP range. Searching by IP
range will not include endpoints that are
dynanmically-managed.
Available for only selected endpoint types
Manage
Open the selected endpoint’s management interface in a
separate browser window. This command is not available
for the following endpoint types: iPower, PVX, and Other.
Send Message
Send a text message (ASCII only, 100 characters
maximum) to the selected endpoint’s video monitor. This
command is not available for the following endpoint types:
TANDBERG, iPower, and Other.
Clear Help
Clear help for the selected endpoint on the CMA system.
92
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Action
Use this action to...
Reboot Device
Reboot the selected endpoint. This command is only
available for HDX-Series, RealPresence Group Series,
V-Series and VSX-Series endpoints with a Connection
Status of Online.
Search Devices
Allows you to seach for endpoints within a range of IP
addresses. The results message displays the number of
endpoints searched and the number of endpoints found
within the IP range.
Manage Owner
View Peripherals
Edit information for the user (owner) of the selected
endpoint. This command is applicable only when a user is
associated with the endpoint.
View information about peripherals. This command is only
available when one or more peripherals is connected to an
HDX-Series or RealPresence Group Series endpoint.
Associate User
Associate Area
Manually associate a user with the selected endpoint.
(Available only when Areas are enabled.) Associate the
selected endpoint to an area so that only specified users
can manage it.
For information about these endpoint actions, see “Endpoint and Peripheral
Peripherals View
Use the Peripherals View to monitor peripherals connected to dynamically
managed endpoints.
Peripherals List in the Peripherals View
By default, the Peripherals list displays a list of all peripherals that are
connected or have been connected to endpoints managed by the CMA system.
Polycom, Inc.
93
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The Peripherals list in this view has these fields.
Field
Description
Filter
Use the filter choices to display other views of the Endpoint
list, which include:
•
•
Type - Filters the list by type. For more information, see
Paired Endpoint- Filters the list by the HDX or
RealPresence Group Series to which the peripherals are
connected.
•
•
IP Address - Filters the list by IP address entered.
Hardware Version - Filters the list by hardware version
entered.
•
Software Version - Filters the list by software version
entered.
Status
The state of the peripheral. Possible values include:
•
•
Connected
- Peripheral is connected to the endpoint.
Disconnected
- Peripheral is turned off or no longer
connected to the endpoint.
•
•
Error
- Endpoint reports an error with the peripheral.
Blank - Endpoint is not reporting that the peripheral is
connected.
Paired Endpoint
Name of the endpoint to which the peripheral is connected or
Not Paired. The Not Paired designation means the
peripheral was connected to an endpoint, but it is not
connected to one now.
Type
The type of peripheral.
Serial Number
IP Address
Area
The serial number of the peripheral.
The IP address assigned to the peripheral, if applicable.
(Available only when Areas are enabled.) The area with
which peripheral is associated. The peripheral inherits its
area from the endpoint to which the peripheral is connected.
Hardware Version
Software Version
The hardware version of the peripheral.
The software version of the peripheral.
Actions in the Peripheral View
Besides providing access to the peripherals, the Actions section of the
Peripheral View may also include these context-sensitive commands
depending on the selected peripheral type and its status.
94
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Action
Use this action to...
Delete Peripheral
(Available only when the peripheral is no longer paired with
an endpoint.) Delete the peripheral from the Peripheral
View list.
Display
Applications
(Available only for peripherals on which you can install
multiple applications.) Display a list of installed applications
and their version.
Bundled Provisioning View
Use the Bundled Provisioning View to see the list of provisioning bundles
available to dynamically managed HDX andRealPresence Group Series
systems.
Endpoint List in the Bundled Provisioning View
By default, the Bundled Provisioning View displays the list of provisioning
bundles available for use by dynamically-managed HDX or RealPresence
Group Series systems.
The bundle list in the Bundled Provisioning View has the following
information.
Field
Description
Filter
The filter choices for provisioning bundles that have been
downloaded to the system. Possible values include:
•
•
•
Name—Filters by the name of the provisioning bundle.
Model—Filters by the endpoint type.
Creation Date—Filters by the date the provisioning bundle was
downloaded and created on the system.
•
Description—Filters by the description of the provisioning
bundle.
Name
Model
The name assigned to the provisioning bundle when it was
downloaded and created on the system.
The exact type of endpoint to which the provisioning bundle applies
as defined when it was downloaded and created on the system.
Creation
Date
The date the provisioning bundle was downloaded and created on
the system.
Description
The description assigned to the provisioning bundle when it was
downloaded and created on the system.
Polycom, Inc.
95
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Actions in the Bundled Provisioning View
The Actions section of the Bundled Provisioning View may include these
context-sensitive commands.
Action
Use this action to...
Download
Create a new provisioning bundle by downloading the
bundle from an HDX or RealPresence Group Series system
on the network.
Delete
Delete the selected bundled from the bundle list.
Automatic Provisioning View
Use the Automatic Provisioning View to see the list of endpoints that are
registered to the system for automatic provisioning.
Endpoint List in the Automatic Provisioning View
By default the endpoint list in the Automatic Provisioning View displays the
list of Polycom HDX and RealPresence Group Series system endpoints
registered to the CMA system for automatic provisioning.
The endpoint list in the Automatic Provisioning View has the following
information.
Field
Description
Filter
The filter choice for endpoint types that can be automatically
provisioned. Possible values include:
•
•
•
All—Displays all dynamically managed endpoint systems
registered to the system.
HDX Series—Displays just the HDX endpoints registered to the
system and deployed in dynamic management mode.
CMA Desktop—Displays just the CMA Desktop clients
registered to the system.
•
•
VVX—Displays just the VVX systems registered to the system.
RealPresence Mobile-—Displays just the RealPresence
Mobile clients registered to the system.
•
•
RealPresence Group Series -—Displays just the
RealPresence Group Series endpoints registered to the system.
RealPresence Desktop-—Displays just the registered
RealPresence Desktop clients registered to the system.
96
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
Description
Status
The status of the endpoint’s last provisioning process. Possible
values include:
•
•
•
Success
Failed
Clear
Name
Type
The assigned name of the endpoint.
Note
The system assigns Polycom CMA Desktop systems a user name
of LastName_Firstname_CMADesktop
.
The type of endpoint. Automatic provisioning is only available for
the endpoint types listed in this table as Filter selections.
IP Address
Area
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.
The assigned Area associated with the endpoint, if any.
The date and time of the endpoint’s last provisioning.
Last
Note
CMA Desktop clients are provisioned at the start of each session.
Actions in the Automatic Provisioning View
Because automatic provisioning is managed by the endpoint, there are no
context-sensitive commands available in the Automatic Provisioning View.
Scheduled Provisioning View
Use the Scheduled Provisioning View to:
•
•
•
View the list of endpoints that are eligible for scheduled provisioning
Schedule one or more endpoints for provisioning
Cancel a scheduled provisioning
Endpoint List in the Scheduled Provisioning View
By default, the endpoint list in the Scheduled Provisioning View displays the
list of Polycom HDX system endpoints registered to the CMA system that are
eligible for scheduled provisioning.
The Endpoint list in this view has the following information.
Polycom, Inc.
97
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Filter
The filter choice for endpoint types that can be
scheduled for provisioning. Possible values include:
•
HDX Series—Displays the Polycom HDX systems
operating in standard management mode.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
LifeSize®
QDX Series
TANDBERG T150
TANDBERG C-Series
TANDBERG MXP
V and VSX Series
Viewstation
Viewstation FX & EX
Status
The status of the endpoint’s last provisioning process.
Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
Success
Pending
Failed
Clear
Name
Type
The system name of the endpoint.
The type of endpoint. Scheduled provisioning is only
available for the endpoints types listed in this table as
Filter selections.
IP Address
Last
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.
The date and time of the endpoint’s last provisioning,
unless its status has been cleared.
Pending
When the endpoint is scheduled for provisioning, this
field shows the provisioning profile to be used for the
scheduled provisioning process.
Scheduled
When the endpoint is scheduled for provisioning, this
field shows the date and time for the next scheduled
provisioning process.
Actions in the Scheduled Provisioning View
Besides providing access to the endpoint views, the Actions section of the
Scheduled Provisioning View also includes these commands:
98
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Action
Use this action to...
Provision
Schedule provisioning for the selected endpoint(s).
Cancel a previously scheduled provisioning operation.
Cancel Provision
Clear Status
Change the status column for a endpoint to the Clear
state.
You can perform these operations on multiple endpoints at the same time. To
select multiple endpoints, hold the control key while you select the endpoints.
For information about these endpoint actions, see “Endpoint Provisioning
Automatic Software Update View
Use the Automatic Software Update View, available from the Endpoint
menu, to view the list of endpoints that have registered to the system for
automatic software updates.
Endpoint List in the Automatic Software Update View
By default, the Endpoint list in the Automatic Software Update View
displays all endpoints eligible for automatic software update. It has the
following information.
Field
Description
Filter
Filter choices for this view include:
•
•
Type—Filters the list by endpoint type.
Name—Searches the list by the endpoint’s system
name.
•
•
•
•
IP Address—Searches the endpoint list by IP
address.
ISDN Video Number—Searches the endpoint list
by ISDN video number.
Dial String— Searches the endpoint list by dial
string (SIP, H.323, or ISDN).
Site—Searches the endpoint list by site location.
Status
Name
The status of the endpoint’s last software update.
Possible values include:
•
•
•
Success
Failed
Clear
The system name of the endpoint.
Polycom, Inc.
99
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Type
The type of endpoint. Automatic software update is only
available for these endpoint types:
•
•
•
All—Displays all dynamically managed endpoints
together.
CMA Desktop—Displays just the Polycom CMA
Desktop clients.
HDX Series—Displays just the Polycom HDX
endpoints deployed in dynamic management mode.
•
•
VVX—Displays just the Polycom VVX systems.
Group Series—Displays just the Polycom
RealPresence Group Series endpoints.
IP Address
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.
Current Version
The version of software installed during the last
successful software update procedure.
Actions in the Automatic Software Update View
Because automatic (pull) software update is managed by the endpoint, there
are no actions available in the Automatic Software Update View.
100
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Scheduled Software Update View
Use the Scheduled Software Update View, available from the Endpoint
menu, to:
•
•
•
View the list of endpoints that are eligible for a scheduled software update
Schedule one or more endpoints for a software update
Cancel a software update.
Endpoint List in the Scheduled Software Update View
By default, the Endpoint list in the Scheduled Software Update View
displays all endpoints eligible for scheduled software update.
The Endpoint list in the Scheduled Software Update View has the following
information.
Field
Description
Filter
Filter choices for this view include:
•
•
Type—Filters the list by endpoint type.
Name—Searches the list by the endpoint’s system
name.
•
•
IP Address—Searches the list by endpoint’s IP
address.
ISDN Video Number—Searches the list by
endpoint’s ISDN video number.
•
•
Alias—Searches the list by endpoint’s alias.
Site—Searches the list by site location.
Status
Name
The status of the endpoint’s last scheduled software
update. Possible values include:
•
•
•
Success
Failed
Clear
The system name of the endpoint.
Polycom, Inc.
101
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Model
The type of endpoint. Scheduled software update is only
available for these endpoint types:
•
HDX Series—Displays the Polycom HDX endpoints
operating in standard management mode.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
LifeSize®
QDX Series
TANDBERG T150
TANDBERG C-Series
TANDBERG MXP
V and VSX Series
Viewstation
Viewstation FX & EX
IP Address
The IP address assigned to the endpoint.
Current Version
The version of software installed during the last
successful software update procedure.
Scheduled
When the endpoint is scheduled for software update,
this field shows the date and time for the scheduled
software update process.
Scheduled Software Update View Actions
Besides providing access to the endpoint views, the Action section for the
Scheduled Software Update View will also include these actions:
Action
Use this action to...
Software
Update
Schedule software update for the selected endpoints.
Cancel Update
Cancel a scheduled or in progress software update
operation.
Clear Status
Change the status column for an endpoint to the Clear state.
For information about these endpoint actions, see “Endpoint Software Update
102
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Endpoint Types
The following tables describe the CMA system support for endpoints based on
endpoint type and category of support. See the Polycom CMA System Release
Notes for more information on tested and supported endpoint versions.
Polycom Endpoint
Types
CMA Desktop
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
HDX Series (dynamic
management mode)
HDX Series (standard
management mode)
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
VVX Series
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
ViewStation Series
ViewStation FX and EX
Series
V and VSX Series
QDX Series
PVX
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
RealPresence Group
Series
RealPresence Desktop
RealPresence Mobile
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
a. Dynamic Management and Standard Management are mutually exclusive functionality.
b. Scheduling (Dial In Only) and Scheduling (Dial In and Dial Out) are presented as mutually
exclusive functionality. Some endpoints, such as Polycom VVX systems do not have
interfaces that can be ask to perform dialing. Some endpoints, such as CMA Desktop
clients and VVX systems require external MCU resources for dial-in conferences.
c. Standard CMA monitoring does not involve using SNMP. It includes endpoint monitoring
(online/offline status) and alerts.
d. Command and Control means the CMA system can send a command like Send Message
and Reboot, and the endpoint can receive and act on the command.
Polycom, Inc.
103
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
e. Reports for IP Calls are generated as part of standard gatekeeper functionality. Reports
for ISDN Calls are additional system functionality. Endpoints that aren't registered with
the gatekeeper or ISDN calls send an alert to the device management function to record
CDR information. Some legacy endpoints do not send this alert so the CDRs are not
written.
f. Supported behind a Polycom VBP device with Access Proxy enabled.
Endpoint Type
TANDBERG 150 MXP
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
TANDBERG
990/880/770 MXP
TANDBERG C Series
and Other TANDBERG
Models
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
LifeSize Team and
Express 200
Other LifeSize Models
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
Other third-party
endpoints:
•
•
•
Sony PCS
Aertha Maia Starr
VCON
(Galaxy and Vigo)
•
VTEL
a. Dynamic Management and Standard Management are mutually exclusive
functionality.
b. Scheduling (Dial In Only) and Scheduling (Dial In and Dial Out) are presented as
mutually exclusive functionality.
c. Standard CMA monitoring does not involve using SNMP. It includes endpoint
monitoring (online/offline status) and alerts.
d. Command and Control means the CMA system can send a Reboot command, and
the endpoint can receive and act on the command.
e. Reports for IP Calls are generated as part of standard gatekeeper functionality.
104
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Some notes about the TANDBERG connection to the Global Address Book:
•
TANDBERG endpoints do not need to register with the CMA system
gatekeeper to access the Global Address Book.
•
Even if the Global Address Book is password protected, TANDBERG
endpoints are not required to provide a password. They have unrestricted
access to the Global Address Book.
•
Any third-party endpoint, including TANDBERG endpoints, that are
registered to the CMA system gatekeeper are displayed in the Global
Address Book. In this case, endpoints are not filtered out based on
capability.
A CMA system may also list an endpoint type of Other. The CMA system
cannot manage endpoints with a type of Other and cannot direct these
endpoints to initiate point-to-point calls. A scheduled point-to-point call
between two endpoint systems with an endpoint type of Other requires the
use of an MCU.
Note
The Polycom RealPresence Mobility and Telepresence M100 systems register as
endpoint type of Other. As such, the CMA can schedule and perform limited
monitoring of these systems.
Endpoint Configuration/Provisioning
Polycom endpoint systems can be configured in three ways:
•
•
•
In the room by using the system’s remote control to navigate the screens
and enter information.
From a remote location by using the system’s web interface to navigate the
screens and enter information.
From a remote location by using a management system’s web interface to
provision configuration settings to the endpoint system. The CMA system
is a management system that provisions configuration settings.
The CMA system can provision several types of endpoints. Endpoint
provisioning, which requires provisioning profiles, allows an administrator to
remotely configure multiple endpoints of the same type with a standard set of
settings. This eliminates the need to configure each endpoint individually
either through the hand-held remote or the endpoint’s web interface.
The CMA system supports three types of endpoint provisioning: bundled,
automatic, and scheduled. Enable endpoints for only one type of provisioning.
Note
Polycom recommends that all endpoints in a region (that is, a gatekeeper zone) be
managed by a single management system.
Polycom, Inc.
105
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
For more information, see:
•
•
•
Provisioning Best Practices
To use the available provisioning options most effectively, we recommend the
following:
1
For each site in the CMA system, configure the site provisioning details as
2
On each HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoint, configure the
system settings that are available in bundled provisioning for that model.
Then download the provisioning bundle for each HDX and RealPresence
Group Series endpoint to the CMA system. See “Bundled Provisioning”
3
If you need unique provisioning settings for one or more groups of users,
create automatic provisioning profiles with those settings and apply them
For example, you may want to set a higher bit rate for the executives of
your organization or for conference rooms used for large video
conferences. You can create a group for these users/rooms and give that
group an automatic provisioning profile with a higher bit rate.
Bundled Provisioning
The CMA system supports a Bundled Provisioning model for dynamically
managed HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoints. With Bundled
Provisioning, a CMA system administrator can download a provisioning
bundle from any already configured HDX and RealPresence Group Series
endpoints. Any dynamically-managed HDX and RealPresence Group Series
endpoints of the same model will receive the provisioning bundle when it next
polls the CMA system for new provisioning information.
Note
Some configuration settings on dynamically managed endpoints that the CMA
system provisions are associated with the site where the endpoint system is
located. Site provisioning takes precedence.
Bundled provisioning provides businesses with an efficient and effective way
to provision HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoints consistently
across each model. HDX and RealPresence Group Series endpoint users with
106
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
administrative rights can still change the settings on an HDX and RealPresence
Group Series endpoint after the provisioning bundle is applied. However, if a
newer bundle is sent by the CMA system, it will overwrite the user’s changes.
The HDX and RealPresence Group Series system parameters that may be
provisioned in a bundle are limited to the following types:
•
•
•
•
•
Camera configuration settings
Monitor configuration settings
Microphone configuration settings
Security settings
Home screen settings
How Bundled Provisioning Works
In dynamic management mode, when an HDX and a RealPresence Group
Series system starts up and at designated intervals thereafter, it automatically
polls for new provisioning information from the CMA system. If a
provisioning bundle exists on the CMA system that matches the model of the
polling HDX or RealPresence Group Series endpoint, the provisioning bundle
is sent over a secure HTTPS connection.
Endpoints do not poll for provisioning information if they are in a call. They
restart polling after the call ends.
Provisioning information is applied in the following order:
1
2
Bundled provisioning, if a bundle exists for the same model.
Automatic provisioning profile, if the endpoint is part of a group
assigned a profile.
3
Site provisioning, which takes precedence.
For information about how to download a provisioning profile, see
Automatic Provisioning
The CMA system is a gatekeeper; it manages video and audio endpoints.
However, the system also manages users, because endpoints are only useful
when they provide access to users.
Automatic provisioning, which controls the automatic configuration of
dynamically managed endpoints and the management of its video resources,
is also tied to users and groups. That’s because some users and groups may
require significantly more video resources than others.
Polycom, Inc.
107
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Note
Some settings on dynamically managed endpoints that the CMA system provisions
are associated with the site where the endpoint system is located. Site provisioning
takes precedence.
Currently, automatic provisioning is available for:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Polycom VVX systems deployed in dynamic management mode
Polycom HDX systems deployed in dynamic management mode
Polycom RealPresence Group Series systems
RealPresence Desktop clients
RealPresence Mobile clients
Polycom CMA Desktop clients
Note
Polycom CMA Desktop provisioning occurs on a session by session basis.
How Automatic Provisioning Works
In dynamic management mode, when an endpoint starts up and at designated
intervals thereafter, it automatically polls for new provisioning information
from the CMA system. The provisioning information is sent in XML format
over a secure HTTPS connection.
Endpoints do not poll for provisioning information if they are in a call. They
restart polling after the call ends.
When you add an automatic provisioning profile, the CMA system
immediately rolls it out. If it rolls it out first thing in the morning, people who
need to attend a “start the day” conference will have to first wait for their
endpoint to be provisioned. Better to implement profiles in the middle of the
work day and then let the provisioning occur at the designated polling
interval.
Provisioning information is applied in the following order:
1
2
Bundled provisioning, if one exists for the same model.
Automatic provisioning profile, if the endpoint is part of a group
assigned a profile.
3
Site provisioning, which takes precedence.
108
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Automatic Provisioning Profiles
Automatic provisioning is enabled at the endpoint, but the CMA system must
have automatic provisioning profiles for both the endpoint and the site at
which the endpoint resides. So to ensure out-of-box usability, the CMA system
comes with Default Provisioning Profiles for both. However, you can edit
these default profiles to meet your needs or add additional provisioning
profiles to assign different video resources to different groups of users.
Notes
•
If an automatic provisioning profile provisions a setting that the endpoint is not
capable of fulfilling, the endpoint will ignore those settings.
•
The name of the Default Provisioning Profile is stored in the system database
and is not localized into other languages. If you wish to localized it into your
language, edit the profile and give it a new profile name.
The following table shows the fields you can configure when adding a new
automatic provisioning profile. You may find more implementation details
about these fields in the endpoint system documentation.
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
System Settings
Language
Specifies the language for the video endpoint system’s
user interface. Possible values include: English,
German, Spanish, French, and Chinese (Simplified
Chinese only).
Allow Access to User
Setup
Specifies whether the User Settings screen is
accessible to users via the System screen. Select this
option to allow endpoint system users to change limited
environmental settings.
Allow Directory
Changes
Specifies whether endpoint system users can save
changes they make to the directory on contacts/favorites
list.
Call Detail Report
Specifies whether to collect call data for the Call Detail
Report and Recent Calls list. When selected,
information about calls can be viewed through the
endpoint system’s web interface and downloaded as a
.csvfile.
Note
If this setting is disabled, applications such as the CMA
system or the Polycom Global Management System™
will not be able to retrieve Call Detail Report (CDR)
records.
Polycom, Inc.
109
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Maximum Time in Call
(minutes)
Specifies the maximum number of minutes allowed for a
call. Enter 0 to remove any limit.
Recent Calls
Specifies whether to display the Recent Calls button on
the home screen. The Recent Calls screen lists the site
number or name, the date and time, and whether the
call was incoming or outgoing.
Note
If the Call Detail Report option is not selected, the
Recent Calls option is not available.
Screen Saver Wait
Time
Specifies how long the system remains awake during
periods of inactivity. The default is 3 minutes. If the
system requires users to log in, the screen saver timeout
also logs out the current user.
Setting this option to Off prevents the system from going
to sleep. To prevent image burn-in, specify 3 minutes or
less.
Directory Search Mode
Specifies how endpoint directory searches are initiated
by the endpoint user. Possible values are:
•
Automatic—The search is executed after the user
stops entering characters.
•
Manual—The search is executed only when the user
explicitly clicks the Search button.
Home Screen Settings
Display Contact List as
Home Screen
Specifies whether or not to display the contact list as the
entry screen.
Display H.323
Extension
Lets users placing a gateway call enter the H.323
extension separately from the gateway ID.
If you do not select this setting, endpoint system users
make gateway calls by entering the call information in
this format:
gateway ID + ## + extension
Enable Availability
Control
When enabled, lets users set their availability in the
endpoint system’s local user interface.
H.323 Settings
Maximum Speed for
Receiving Calls (kbps)
Allows you to restrict the bandwidth used when
receiving calls.
If the far site attempts to call the endpoint system at a
higher speed than selected here, the call is
re-negotiated at the speed specified in this field.
110
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Preferred Speed for
Placing Calls (kbps)
Determines the speeds that will be used for calls from
this endpoint system when:
•
The Call Quality selection is either unavailable or
set to Auto on the Place a Call screen
•
The call is placed from the directory
If the far-site endpoint system does not support the
selected speed, the endpoint system automatically
negotiates a lower speed.
Call Settings
Preferred Dialing
Method
Specifies the preferred method for dialing various call
types.
•
•
If set to Auto, calls use the configured dialing order.
If set to Manual, the endpoint systems will prompt
the user to select the call type from a list when
placing a call.
Audio Settings
Mute Auto Answer
Calls
Specifies whether or not to automatically mute incoming
calls.
CMA Desktop Settings
Allow IM/Chat
When enabled, specifies that the Polycom CMA
Desktop client can initiate instant messaging.
Enable Screen Saver
When in Call
Calendaring Settings
Enable Calendaring
When enabled, specifies that the CMA system will
provision the endpoint for Polycom Conferencing for
Outlook. This includes provisioning the Microsoft
Exchange server and calendaring settings for the
endpoint system.
Alert Tone
When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will
play a sound along with the meeting reminder. In this
case, the endpoint will only play a sound when the
system is not in a call.
Display Private Meeting When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will
display details about meetings marked private.
Meeting Reminder
Time
Specifies the number of minutes before the meeting an
endpoint system provisioned for Polycom Conferencing
for Outlook will display a reminder.
Polycom, Inc.
111
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Microsoft Lync Settings
Select method to find
Server
Specifies how the CMA system will locate the Lync
server that it will provision to endpoints. Possible values
are:
•
Disable Integration—The CMA system will not
provision a Lync or Office Communication Server.
•
DNS SRV Record—The CMA system will issue a
DNS query to locate the Lync or Office
Communication Server and provision that
information to endpoints.
•
Server Name—The CMA system will use the
specified Server Address. Enter the Lync or Office
Communication Server address or DNS name.
Transport Protocol
Specifies the transport protocol for communications with
the Office Communications Server. Possible values are:
Auto—The communication protocol will be
auto-negotiated.
TCP—This protocol has error-recovery services,
message delivery is assured, and messages are
delivered in the order they were sent.
UDP—This protocol does not provide error-recovery
services, message delivery is not assured, and
messages are not necessarily delivered in the order
they were sent.
TLS—This protocol transfers communications over an
encrypted Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) or Transport
Layer Security (TLS) connection.
Group Name
Specifies the group name for which the endpoint system
should be provisioned.
VVX Settings
Configuration Server
URL
Specifies the IP address for the system that will provide
provisioning service. All addresses can be followed by
an optional directory and optional filename.
Logging Server URL
Configuration Data
Specifies the directory to use for log files, if required.
A URL can also be specified. This field is blank by
default.
Enter XML data for a custom configuration. Allows the
CMA system administrators to provision settings that the
CMA system does not normally provide.
112
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Profile Order and Priority
Automatic provisioning profiles are associated with groups, but what about
those users who belong to more than one group—what determines their
experience? When you add new profiles, you assign a Profile Order. The
Profile Order determines which provisioning profile takes priority.
Consider the following example:
•
Jason Smith is part of the Support group and also part of the Executive
group.
•
The Support group is assigned an automatic provisioning profile named
Low-Bandwidth, which allows a maximum speed for receiving calls of
128kbps.
•
•
The Executive group is assigned an automatic provisioning profile called
High-Bandwidth, which allows a maximum speed for receiving calls of
1920kbps
The Low-Bandwidth profile is assigned a profile order of 1, while the
High-Bandwith profile is assigned a profile order of 2.
In this example, Jason’s endpoint is provisioned with the Low-Bandwidth
provisioning profile, because it has the higher priority.
So when you add provisioning profiles, you may want to assign provisioning
profiles with more robust privileges a higher priority than those providing less
privileges.
Scheduled Provisioning
Scheduled provisioning is enabled at the CMA system. To schedule an
endpoint for provisioning, the CMA system must already have a scheduled
provisioning profile created for the endpoint.
How Scheduled Provisioning Works
In this standard management mode, administrators with System Setup
permissions can schedule provisioning for one endpoint or a group of
endpoints; and they can schedule provisioning to occur immediately or for a
date and time in the future. The provisioning data is sent in XML format over
a secure HTTPS connection.
Scheduled provisioning is available for these endpoint types:
•
•
•
•
ViewStation endpoints
ViewStation FX & EX endpoints
V and VSX Series endpoints
Selected TANDBERG endpoints—TANDBERG 150, 990, 880, and 770
endpoints
Polycom, Inc.
113
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
HDX Series--Polycom HDX systems deployed in standard management
mode
Scheduled Provisioning Profiles
The CMA system does not include a default profile for scheduled
provisioning. You must create a profile before you can schedule a endpoint for
provisioning. Create a different profile for each endpoint type (Polycom HDX
system or Polycom CMA Desktop) and group of users.
Some examples of when to use scheduled provisioning profiles follow.
•
To apply a standard set of options to each new endpoint
By creating templates of standard settings for different types of endpoints,
or for the needs of different users, you can have the CMA system apply all
the settings at once. After the endpoint is connected and registered with
the CMA system, you can use a provisioning profile that defines a range
of other options.
•
•
To update the password for all endpoints of a particular type
For security purposes, you can create a provisioning profile to update the
password for endpoints on a regular basis and reuse the same profile
quarterly. You might have several profiles, one for each type of endpoint
to update.
To change the IP address of the CMA system gatekeeper when the CMA
system is moved
For information about how to add a scheduled provisioning profile, see “Add
Scheduled Provisioning of Polycom Endpoints
The following table show the fields you can provision when adding a new
scheduled provisioning profile for the supported Polycom endpoints.
.
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
General Settings > System Settings > System Settings 1
Maximum Time in Call
(minutes)
Specifies the maximum number of minutes allowed for a
call. Enter 0 to remove any limit.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Allow Mixed IP and
ISDN calls
Specifies whether users can make multipoint calls that
include both IP and H.320 sites.
—
Y
—
Y
—
Y
Auto Answer
Point-to-Point Calls
Specifies whether to set the endpoint system to answer
incoming point-to-point calls automatically.
114
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Auto Answer Multipoint
Calls
Specifies whether to set the endpoint system to answer
incoming multipoint calls automatically.
Y
Y
Y
—
Y
—
Allow Dialing
Allow users to place calls. You can still place calls from
the web interface.
—
Y
—
Y
Y
Allow Directory
Changes
Specifies whether users can save changes to the
directory or contacts/favorites list.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Confirm Directory
Additions Upon Call
Disconnect
Specifies whether users are prompted to confirm
deletions of directory entries.
Y
Y
—
—
Confirm Directory
Deletions
Specifies whether users are prompted to confirm new
directory entries when saving the information for the last
site called.
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
Y
—
Y
Y
Y
Allow Access to User
Setup
Specifies whether the User Settings screen is accessible
to users via the System screen.
Select this option to allow users to change limited
environmental settings.
General Settings > System Settings > System Settings 2
Far Site Name Display
Specifies how long the far site name to appear on the
Y
Y
—
—
Y
screen when the call is first connected.
Display Time in Call
Displays time that the current call has been connected
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
Y
—
Y
Y
Y
Keypad Audio
Confirmation
Allows the user to hear a voice confirmation of the
numbers selected with the remote control.
Call Detail Report
Recent Calls
Collects call data.
Y
Y
—
—
Y
—
—
Y
Y
Y
Provides navigational tool for call history.
Y
Y
Display IP and ISDN
Information
•
•
•
•
Both – Displays both number types on the system’s
Home screen.
—
—
IP only – Display the system IP number on the Home
screen.
ISDN only – Displays the system ISDN number on the
Home screen.
None – The system will not display contact numbers
on the Home screen.
Show Speed Dial
Color Scheme
Allow the user to disable the Speed Dial page and go
directly to the Address Book.
—
—
Y
Y
Y
Enables the customization of the look of the system with
five different color schemes.
—
—
Polycom, Inc.
115
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Screen Saver Wait
Time
The time the system will delay before going into standby
mode after nonuse
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
General Settings > Home Screen Settings > Home Screen Settings 1
Dialing Display
Dialing entry field - Includes the dialing entry field on the
Home screen.
Y
Y
—
—
—
Display Marquee - Allows the addition of text to the dialing
entry field of the Home screen.
Enter Marquee Text
Call Quality
Enter the Marquee text that will appear in the “Dialing
entry field” when Display Marquee is selected.
Y
—
Y
Allow users to select the speed/bandwidth of the call.
Displays the IP dialing extension on the main call screen
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Display H.323
Extension
Directory
System
Includes the Directory button on the Home screen.
Includes the System button on the Home screen.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Multipoint
Includes the Multipoint navigational item on the Home
screen.
General Settings > Home Screen Settings > Home Screen Settings 2
System Name
Enable when the system name is to be displayed on the
Home Screen.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
IP or ISDN Information
•
•
•
•
Both – Displays both number types on the system’s
Home screen.
IP only – Display the system IP number on the Home
screen.
ISDN only – Displays the system ISDN number on the
Home screen.
None – The system will not display contact numbers
on the Home screen.
Local Date and Time
Displays the local time on the Home screen.
Displays availability icons on the Home screen.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Enable Availability
Control
Sites
Displays icons created for frequently called sites on the
Home screen.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Last Number Dialed
Displays the last number dialed on the Home screen.
116
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
General Settings > Security
Remote Access
Password
Specifies the password for administrator access when
logging in to the system remotely.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
When the remote access password is set, users must
enter it to manage the system from a computer. The
remote access password must not contain spaces.
Meeting Password
Specifies the password users must supply to join
multipoint calls on this system if the call uses the internal
multipoint option, rather than a bridge.
The meeting password must not contain spaces.
Do not set a meeting password if multipoint calls will
include audio-only endpoints. Audio-only endpoints
cannot participate in password-protected calls.
Software Update
Password
Specifies the password users must enter to update the
software on their endpoint system.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Enable FTP Access
Enable Web Access
Enable Telnet Access
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via
an FTP session.
Y
Y
Y
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access
Port to disable the port.
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via
its web interface.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access
Port to disable the port.
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via a
telnet session.
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access
Port to disable the port.
Polycom, Inc.
117
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
AES Encryption
Specifies how to encrypt calls with other sites that support
AES encryption.
Y
Y
Y
•
•
Off—AES Encryption is disabled.
When Available—AES Encryption is used with any
endpoint that supports it, even if the other endpoints in
the call don’t support it.
•
Required for Video Calls Only—AES Encryption is
used for all video endpoints in the call. Analog phone
and voice over ISDN connections are allowed. Video
endpoints must support AES Encryption to participate
in the call.
•
Required for All Calls—AES Encryption is used for all
video endpoints in the call. Analog phone and voice
over ISDN connections are not allowed. All endpoints
must support AES Encryption to participate in the call.
Enable SNMP Access
Specifies that the endpoint system can be accessed via
an SNMP monitoring system.
Y
Y
Note: The system restarts if you change the remote
access settings. This setting does not deactivate the
associated port, only the application. Use Web Access
Port to disable the port.
General Settings > Date and Time 1
Date Format
Time Format
Month
Specifies the preferred format preference for the date and
time display and lets you enter your local date and time.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Day
Year
Hour
Minute
AM/PM
Primary Time Server
Address
Auto Adjust for Daylight
Saving Time
Specifies the daylight savings time setting. When this
setting is enabled, the system clock automatically
changes for daylight saving time.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Time Difference from
GMT
Specifies the time difference between GMT (Greenwich
Mean Time) and the endpoint system’s location.
118
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Time Server
Specifies connection to a time server for automatic
system time settings.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Primary Time Server
Address
Specifies the address of the time server to use when Time
Server is set to Manual.
Video Network > IP Network > Call Preferences
Enable IP H.323
Enable H.239
Allows the system to make IP calls
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
—
Y
Y
Specifies standards-based People+Content data
collaboration. Enable this option if you know that H.239 is
supported by the far sites you will call. If callers
experience issues when sharing content with other
Polycom systems, disable this setting.
Enable Transcoding
Specifies whether the system allows each far-site system
to connect at the best possible call rate and audio/video
algorithm. If transcoding is disabled, the Polycom HDX
system down-speeds all connections to the same call
rate.
Y
Y
—
ISDN Gateway
IP Gateway
Allows users to place IP-to-ISDN calls through a gateway.
Y
Y
Y
—
—
Y
Y
Allows users to place ISDN-to-IP or IP-to-IP calls through
a gateway.
—
Video Network > IP Network > Gatekeeper
Use Gatekeeper Specifies whether to use a gatekeeper. Gateways and
Y
Y
Y
Y
gatekeepers are required for calls between IP and ISDN.
•
•
Off — Calls do not use a gatekeeper.
Auto — System attempts to automatically find an
available gatekeeper.
•
Specify — Calls use the specified gatekeeper. Enter
the gatekeeper’s IP address or name (for example,
gatekeeper.companyname.usa.com, or 10.11.12.13).
Gatekeeper IP Address If you chose to use an automatically selected gatekeeper,
this area displays the gatekeeper’s IP address.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
If you chose to specify a gatekeeper, enter the IP
address.
Outbound Call Route
Choices:
—
—
•
•
Gateway
ISDN
Polycom, Inc.
119
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Use Gatekeeper for
Multipoint Calls
Specify whether multipoint calls use the system’s internal
multipoint capability or the Conference on Demand
feature.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Send Preferred Alias
Only to Gatekeeper
—
—
Video Network > IP Network > Gateway Number
Country Code
Specifies the country code for the system’s location
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
—
—
Y
Area Code
Specifies the area or city code for the system’s location
Specifies the gateway’s number
Gateway Number
Gateway Number Type
Specifies the number type users enter to call this system:
Y
•
Direct Inward Dial — Users enter an internal
extension to call this system directly.
Note
If you choose this setting, you must also register the
number with the gatekeeper as an E.164 alias.
•
Number + Extension — Users enter the gateway
number and the system’s extension to call this
system.
Number of digits in DID
Number
Specifies the number of digits in the DID number.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
The national or regional dialing plan for your location
determines the standard number of digits. For instance,
the US standard is 7 digits.
Number of digits in
Extension
Specifies the number of digits in the extension used when
Direct Inward Dial is selected.
Your organization’s dial plan determines this number.
Video Network > IP Network > Quality of Service Settings
Type of Service Field Specifies the service type and the priority of IP packets
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
sent to the system for video, audio, and far-end camera
control:
•
IP Precedence — Represents the priority of IP
packets sent to the system. The value can be between
0 and 7.
•
DiffServ — Represents a priority level between 0 and
63. If this setting is selected, enter the value in the
Type of Service Value field.
120
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Video Type of Service
Value
Specifies the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for video
packets. This value does not apply to the CMA Desktop
system. Its value is set by the client’s operating system.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Audio Type of Service
Value
Specifies the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for audio
packets.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
FECC Type of Service
Value
Specifies the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for Far End
Camera Control packets.
Enable Dynamic
Bandwidth
Specifies whether to let the system automatically find the
optimum line speed for a call
Enable PVEC
Allows the system to use PVEC (Polycom Video
ErrorConcealment) if packet loss occurs.
Y
Y
Video Network > IP Network > Firewall Settings
Use Fixed Ports
Specifies whether to define the TCP and UDP ports.
Y
Y
Y
Y
•
If the firewall is H.323 compatible or the endpoint
systems are not behind a firewall, disable this setting.
•
If the firewall is not H.323 compatible, enable this
setting. The endpoint systems will assign a range of
ports starting with the TCP and UDP ports you specify.
The endpoint system defaults to a range beginning
with port 3230 for both TCP and UDP.
Note
You must open the corresponding ports in the firewall.
You must also open the firewall’s TCP port 1720 to allow
H.323 traffic.
Start TCP Port
Allows you to specify the beginning value for the range of
TCP ports used by the endpoint systems. The endpoint
systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting
with the port you specify.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Note
You must also open the firewall’s TCP port 1720 to allow
H.323 traffic.
Start UDP Port
Allows you to specify the beginning value for the range of
TCP ports used by the endpoint systems. The endpoint
systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting
with the port you specify.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
System is Behind a
NAT
Specifies whether the endpoint systems are behind a NAT
firewall.
—
—
Polycom, Inc.
121
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
NAT Configuration
Specifies whether the endpoint systems should determine
the NAT Public WAN Address automatically.
Y
Y
Y
•
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that allows
HTTP traffic, select Auto.
•
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that does
not allow HTTP traffic, select Manual. Then specify a
NAT Public (WAN) Address.
•
If the endpoint systems are not behind a NAT or are
connected to the IP network through a virtual private
network (VPN), select Off.
NAT Public (WAN)
Address
When NAT Configuration is set to Manual, specifies the
address that callers from outside the LAN should use to
call the endpoint systems.
Y
Y
Y
Y
NAT is H.323
Compatible
Specifies that the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that
is capable of translating H.323 traffic.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Auto Discover NAT
Address
Specifies whether to allow the system to automatically
discover the NAT firewall address through the domain
name server.
—
—
Y
Address Displayed in
Global Directory
Specifies whether or not to include the endpoint system’s
information in the global directory
Y
Y
—
Y
Video Network > ISDN BRI Protocol
Enable ISDN H.320
Allows this system to make H.320 (ISDN) calls.
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
—
Number of ISDN
Channels to Dial in
Parallel
Specifies how many channels to dial at one time. You can
specify up to eight channels. If you experience network
problems, decrease the number.
Set this value to 1 for serial dialing. Serial dialing is not
recommended unless you have trouble connecting calls
using parallel dialing.
ISDN Switch Protocols
Specifies the protocol used by your network’s switch.
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
—
Outside Line Dialing
Prefix
Specifies the ISDN dialing prefix used to call outside the
network.
122
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Video Network > Preferred Speeds
Preferred Speed for
Placing Calls (Kbps)
Determines the speeds that will be used for IP, ISDN, or
International ISDN calls from this endpoint system when:
Y
Y
—
Y
Y
•
The Call Quality selection is either unavailable or set
IP Calls
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
—
to Auto on the Place a Call screen
ISDN Video Call
(H.320)
•
The call is placed from the directory
If the far-site endpoint system does not support the
selected speed, the endpoint system automatically
negotiates a lower speed.
International ISDN calls
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
—
Maximum Speed for
Receiving Calls (Kbps)
Allows you to restrict the bandwidth used when receiving
IP or ISDN calls.
Y
Y
If the far site attempts to call the system at a higher speed
than selected here, the call is re-negotiated at the speed
specified in this field.
IP Calls
Y
Y
Y
Y
—
—
ISDN Video Call
(H.320)
Monitors > Monitors 1
Number of Monitors
Monitor 1 Options
Monitor 1
Y
Y
Specifies the monitor’s aspect ratio.
—
—
•
4:3 — Select if you are using a regular TV monitor.
Video Format
Specifies the monitor’s format:
Y
Y
•
•
•
DVI — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI
connector using a DVI or HDMI cable.
VGA — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI
connector using a VGA cable.
Component YPbPr — Select if the monitor is
connected to the DVI connector using component
cables. Polycom HDX 8000 series and Polycom HDX
7000 series systems do not support 720p Component
format for 50 Hz monitors.
•
•
S-Video (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select if
the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors using
an S-Video cable.
Composite (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select
if the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors
using a composite video cable.
Display Icons in Call
Specifies whether to display all on-screen graphics,
including icons and help text, during calls.
Y
Y
—
Y
Polycom, Inc.
123
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Snapshot Timeout
Lets you choose whether to have slides and snapshots
time out after a period of four minutes.
—
Y
Y
Y
—
—
—
Dual Monitor Emulation Specifies whether the system can show multiple views on
a single display.
Output Upon Screen
Saver Activation
Specifies whether black video or no signal is sent to the
monitor when the system goes to sleep and the screen
saver activates.
Y
Y
•
Select Black to display black video. This is the
recommended setting to prevent burn-in for TV
monitors.
•
Select No Signal to have the display react as if it is
not connected when the system goes to sleep. This is
the recommended setting for VGA monitors and
projectors.
VGA Resolution
Monitor 2 Options
Monitor 2
—
Y
Y
—
—
—
Applies to:
—
—
Y
Y
Specifies the second monitor’s aspect ratio:
Y
•
•
Off — Select if you do not have a second monitor.
4:3 — Select if you are using a regular TV monitor as
the second monitor.
Video Format
Specifies the monitor’s format:
Y
—
—
Y
•
•
•
DVI — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI
connector using a DVI or HDMI cable.
VGA — Select if the monitor is connected to the DVI
connector using a VGA cable.
Component YPbPr — Select if the monitor is
connected to the DVI connector using component
cables. Polycom HDX 8000 series and Polycom HDX
7000 series systems do not support 720p Component
format for 50 Hz monitors.
•
•
S-Video (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select if
the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors using
an S-Video cable.
Composite (Polycom HDX 9000 series only) — Select
if the monitor is connected to the BNC connectors
using a composite video cable.
124
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Output Upon Screen
Saver Activation
Specifies whether black video or no signal is sent to the
monitor when the system goes to sleep and the screen
saver activates.
Y
—
—
Y
•
Select Black to display black video. This is the
recommended setting to prevent burn-in for TV
monitors.
•
Select No Signal to have the display react as if it is
not connected when the system goes to sleep. This is
the recommended setting for VGA monitors and
projectors.
People Display Mode
Content Display Mode
Color System
Y
Y
Y
Monitor 3 Options
Monitor 3
Specifies the aspect ratio for recording.
Y
—
—
•
•
•
Off — Select if you do not have a VCR or DVD player
connected to record video conferences.
4:3 — Select to record for playback on a standard
monitor.
16:9—Select to record for playback on a wide-screen
monitor, if your recording device has this capability.
See the endpoint product documentation for more
information about these selections.
Video Format
Specifies the VCR or DVD player’s format:
Y
—
—
•
•
S-Video — Select if the VCR or DVD player is
connected to a Polycom HDX system using an
S-Video cable.
Composite — Select if the VCR or DVD player is
connected to a Polycom HDX system using a
composite video cable and S-Video to RCA adapter.
Output Upon Screen
Saver Activation
Specifies whether black video or no signal is sent to the
VCR or DVD player when the system goes to sleep and
the screen saver activates.
Y
—
—
•
•
Select Black to send black video.
Select No Signal to have the VCR or DVD player
react as if it is not connected when the system goes to
sleep.
Polycom, Inc.
125
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
VCR/DVD Record
Source
Specifies the video source to be recorded to videotape or
DVD.
Y
—
—
•
If Far is enabled, the recorded video will switch to the
current far site speaker.
Near
Y
Y
Y
—
—
—
—
—
—
Far
•
•
If both Near and Far are enabled, the recorded video
will switch between near and far sites depending on
the current speaker.
Content
If Content is enabled, any content sent during the call
is recorded.
Screen Saver Wait
Time
The time the system will delay before going into standby
mode after nonuse
Y
Cameras > Cameras 1
Camera 1 Name
Camera 1 Icon
Specifies a name for camera 1.
Specifies an icon for camera 1.
Specifies a name for camera 2.
Specifies an icon for camera 2.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Camera 2 Name
Camera 2 Icon
Cameras > Camera Settings
Camera 1 Name
Camera 1 Icon
Camera 2 Name
Camera 2 Icon
Camera 3 Name
Camera 3 Icon
Cameras > Video Quality
Camera 1
Specifies a name for camera 1.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies an icon for camera 1.
Specifies a name for camera 2.
Specifies an icon for camera 2.
Specifies a name for camera 3.
Specifies an icon for camera 3.
Specifies Motion or Sharpness for the video input. The
default is Sharpness.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Camera 2
•
Motion — This setting is for showing people or other
video with motion.
Camera 3
•
Sharpness — The picture will be sharp and clear, but
moderate to heavy motion at low call rates can cause
some frames to be dropped. Sharpness is available in
point-to-point H.263 and H.264 calls only. It is
recommended for HD calls between 1 Mbps and 2
Mbps.
126
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Video/Camera > Cameras 1
Snapshot Camera
Far Control of Near
Camera
Specifies whether the far site can pan, tilt, or zoom the
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
near-site camera. When this option is selected, a user at
the far site can control the framing and angle of the
camera for the best view of the near site.
Backlight
Compensation
Specifies whether the camera should automatically adjust
for a bright background. Backlight compensation is best
used in situations where the subject appears darker than
the background.
Primary Camera
Camera Direction
Specifies which camera is the main camera.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies the direction the camera moves when using the
arrow buttons on the remote control.
Y
Y
Y
Video/Camera > Monitor Setup
Snapshot Timeout Lets you choose whether to have slides and snapshots
—
Y
—
Y
Y
Y
time out after a period of four minutes.
Audio Settings > Audio Settings 1
Sound Effects Volume
Sets the volume level of the ring tone and user alert
Y
tones.
Incoming Video Call
User Alert Tones
Specifies the ring tone used for incoming calls.
Specifies the tone used for user alerts.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Mute Auto Answer
Calls
Specifies whether to mute incoming calls.
Y
Y
Incoming calls are muted by default until you press the
mute on the microphone or on the remote control.
Input Type Level
Sets the volume level for audio input 1.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Content Input Level
Specifies the volume level for audio input 4 of a Polycom
HDX 9000 series or Polycom HDX 8000 series system.
Specifies the volume level for audio input 3 of a Polycom
HDX 7000 series system. Specifies the volume level for
the PC audio input of a Polycom HDX 6000 series or
Polycom HDX 4000 series.
Line Output Level
Sets the volume level for audio output.
Y
Y
Audio Settings > Audio Settings 2
Polycom, Inc.
127
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Master Audio Volume
Midrange Speakers
Sets the volume level for audio from the far site.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies whether to use the system’s built-in midrange
speaker. You may prefer to turn off the midrange speaker
if you connect the audio output to Monitor 1 or if you
connect an external speaker system.
—
Bass
Sets the volume level for the low frequencies without
changing the master audio volume.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Treble
Sets the volume level for the high frequencies without
changing the master audio volume.
LAN Properties > LAN Properties 1
Connect to My LAN
IP Address
Enables connection to the local area network
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies how the system obtains an IP address.
Y
•
•
Obtain IP Address Automatically — Select if the
system gets an IP address from the DHCP server on
the LAN.
Enter IP Address Manually — Select if the IP
address will not be assigned automatically.
Use the Following IP
Address
If you selected Enter IP Address Manually, enter the IP
address here.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
LAN Properties > LAN Properties 2
DNS Servers
Displays the DNS servers currently assigned to the
system.
If the system does not automatically obtain a DNS server
address, enter up to four DNS servers here.
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.
Default Gateway
Subnet Mask
Displays the gateway currently assigned to the system.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
If the system does not automatically obtain a gateway IP
address, enter one here.
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.
Displays the subnet mask currently assigned to the
system.
If the system does not automatically obtain a subnet
mask, enter one here.
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.
WINS Server
Displays the server running the Windows Internet Name
Service
—
Y
128
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
WINS Resolution
Enables connection to the WINS Server for URL
resolution
—
Y
Y
Y
LAN Speed
Specify the LAN speed to use. Note that the setting you
choose must be supported by the switch.
Y
Choose Auto to have the network switch negotiate the
speed automatically. In this case, the switch must also be
set to Auto. Choosing Auto automatically sets Duplex
Mode to Auto.
If you choose 10 Mbps, 100 Mbps, or 1000 Mbps you
must set Duplex Mode to Half or Full.
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.
Note
Mismatches with the network switch settings may lead to
unexpected behaviors.
Duplex Mode
Specify the duplex mode to use. Note that the Duplex
mode you choose must be supported by the switch.
Y
Y
Y
Choose Auto to have the network switch negotiate the
Duplex mode automatically. In this case, the switch must
also be set to Auto. Choosing Auto automatically sets
LAN Speed to Auto.
Changing this setting causes the system to restart.
Global Services > Directory Servers
Global Directory (GDS)
Specifies the IP address or DNS address of the Global
Directory Server.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Password
Lets you enter the global directory password, if there is
one.
Y
Display Name in Global
Directory
Specifies whether to display the system’s name in the
global directories of other registered systems. Global
Address
—
Display Global
Addresses
Displays other registered systems in the global directory.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Register
Registers this system with the Global Directory Server.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Save Global Directory
to System
Copies the global directory to this local system. When this
setting is disabled, the system can display no more than
1,000 global directory entries. When this setting is
enabled, the system can display up to 4,000 global
directory entries.
—
Polycom, Inc.
129
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
LAN/H.323 > Global Directory (GDS) > Preferences
Show Addresses in
Address Book
—
—
—
—
—
—
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Preferred Speed for
Placing Calls (Kbps)
Determines the speeds that will be used for IP, ISDN, or
International ISDN calls from this endpoint system when:
•
The Call Quality selection is either unavailable or set
ISDN Video Call
(H.320)
to Auto on the Place a Call screen
•
The call is placed from the directory
International ISDN calls
IP Calls
—
—
—
—
Y
Y
Y
Y
If the far-site endpoint system does not support the
selected speed, the endpoint system automatically
negotiates a lower speed.
LAN/H.323 > Global Directory (GDS) > Preferred Alias
Preferred Alias Possible values include:
—
—
Y
Y
•
•
•
•
Gateway Number
ISDN Number
Called Party Line Identifier
Extension
Global Services > Dialing Rules 1
Number of digits in
Extension
Specifies the number of digits in the extension. Your
organization’s dial plan determines this number.
—
Y
—
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
International Dialing
Prefix
Specifies the dialing prefix needed for international calls
Public Network Access
Specifies if calls can be made to the public network
—
—
—
—
Y
Y
Y
Y
Public Network Dialing
Prefix
Specifies the dialing prefix used to call out to endpoints on
the public network when the endpoint is not in the same
area code as the system
Public Network (same
area code) Prefix
Specifies the dialing prefix used to call out to endpoints on
the public network when the endpoint is in the same area
code as the system
—
—
Y
Y
Private Network Access Specifies if calls can be made to the private network
—
—
—
—
Y
Y
Y
Y
Private Network Dialing
Prefix
Specifies the dialing prefix used to call outside the
network
Always Dial Area Code
Specify whether the phone number must always include
an area code
Y
Y
—
130
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Field
For the endpoint systems being provisioned...
Dial 1+ for all USA
Calls
Specify whether to preface calls within the United States
with 1
Y
Y
—
Y
Global Services > Dialing Rules 2
If Area Code Equals/
Dial Prefix Pairs
Create additional dialing rules and routing based on area
code
—
—
Y
Global Services > Account Validation
Require Account
Number to Dial
Specify whether to require an account number for placing
calls and whether that number should be validated by the
system.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Validate Account
Number
Specify whether to require an account number for placing
calls and whether that number should be validated by the
system.
Global Services > My Information
Contact Person
Contact Number
Contact Email
Contact Fax
Specifies the name of the person responsible for this
system
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Specifies the phone number of the person responsible for
this system
Specifies the email address of the person responsible for
this system
Specifies the Fax number of the person responsible for
this system
Tech Support
Specifies the contact information for Technical Support for
this system
City
Specifies the location of the person responsible for this
system
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
State/Province
Country
Video Network > IP Network > Gateway Setup
Speed
Prefix
Suffix
Enter a prefix or suffix for each bandwidth allowed for
gateway calls.
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Associating prefixes and suffixes with particular
bandwidths on your gateway can optimize the use of
bandwidth by your organization. Be sure the gateway is
configured to use the same prefixes and suffixes you
define for the system.
Polycom, Inc.
131
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Scheduled Provisioning Notes
Some notes about scheduled provisioning profiles and the scheduled
provisioning of endpoints:
•
Each page in the scheduled Provisioning Fields dialog box has a
Provision This Page option. When this option is selected, the system
provisions all of the values on that page. When this option is not selected,
the system does not provision any of the values on that page. At least one
page must be provisioned, or the system returns an error stating, “No data
to save in profile. Either press Cancel or add pages.”
•
Until the CMA system successfully provisions an endpoint scheduled for
provisioning, provisioning remains in the Pending state and the system
attempts to provision the endpoint until it succeeds or until the
provisioning is cancelled.
•
•
If an endpoint scheduled for provisioning is In a Call, the system waits
until the call ends before provisioning the endpoint. The system checks the
endpoint at 15 minute intervals.
If an endpoint scheduled for provisioning is Offline, the system attempts
to connect to it at 60 minute intervals until the endpoint is Online.
•
•
Provisioning may reboot the endpoint
You can schedule provisioning for an unlimited number of endpoints, but
the system may limit the number of active provisioning processes
Endpoint Gatekeeper Registration Policies
If the CMA system gatekeeper registration policy allows endpoints to register
automatically (that is, a primary gatekeeper setting of Allow Registration of
All Endpoints, Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites, or Allow
Registration of Endpoints with Defined E.164 Prefixes), those registered
endpoints are automatically added to the endpoint list.
If the CMA gatekeeper registration policy does not allow endpoints to register
automatically (that is, a gatekeeper setting of Allow Registration of
Predefined Endpoints Only), you must manually add all endpoints to the
CMA system.
No matter what the gatekeeper registration policy, any endpoint that is
automatically provisioned, any endpoint that is registered with the Global
Address Book, and any endpoint that is added manually to the CMA system
can automatically register with the gatekeeper. For more information, see
Note
You can manually add endpoints to the CMA system for monitoring purposes only.
132
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Endpoint Software Updates
The CMA system software update feature, which requires a software update
profile for the endpoint type and model, allows an administrator to upgrade
the software on one or more endpoints with a standard software package. This
eliminates the need to upgrade each endpoint individually.
The CMA system supports two exclusive software update processes:
automatic and scheduled. Automatic and scheduled software update are
exclusive endpoint management scenarios. Endpoints enabled for automatic
software update should not be scheduled for software updates through the
system.
Note
Polycom recommends that all endpoints in a region (that is, a gatekeeper zone) be
managed by a single management system.
For more information, see:
•
•
Automatic Software Updates
Automatic software update, which controls the endpoint’s software version
level, is tied to the endpoint type. Currently, the automatic software update
feature is only available for these endpoint types.
•
•
•
Polycom HDX system endpoints deployed in dynamic management mode
Polycom RealPresence Group Series
Polycom CMA Desktop systems
How Automatic Software Update Works
In dynamic management mode, when a endpoint starts up and at designated
intervals thereafter, it automatically polls the CMA system for a newer
software update package. If a software update is necessary, the package is sent
in XML format over a secure HTTPS connection.
Endpoints do not poll for software update packages if they are in a call. They
restart polling after the call ends.
Automatic Software Update Profiles
Automatic software update is enabled at the endpoint, but the CMA system
must have an automatic software update profile for the endpoint type to fulfill
the process. A default automatic software update profile—with the
Polycom, Inc.
133
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
description CMA Desktop - shipped version—is available for the Polycom
CMA Desktop client. Default automatic software update profiles are not
available for other endpoint systems. To create an automatic software update
profile, you upload the software package and create a profile for the update.
Automatic Software Update Versions
After creating an automatic software update profile, you can use the Version
to use and Allow this version or newer selections to manage the roll out of
software update packages. These selections also allow you to manage the
release of multiple software packages for the same endpoint type.
Here’s how it works: All endpoints have a current version of software. To
automatically overwrite that current software with a different software
version on all dynamically managed endpoint systems:
1
You first create a new automatic software update profile that includes the
new software update package.
2
Then to activate the roll out, you change the Version to use selection
from the current value (None by default) to the new version number and
Update the page.
The next time a dynamically managed endpoint polls the CMA system, it will
detect that it has a different software version than the Version to use selection,
so it will automatically download and install the identified software update
package. Use this method to force users to use a specific software version.
Note
Until the Version to use selection is enabled, the automatic software update is not
activated.
If you also enable the Allow this version or newer selection, anytime you
package a newer version of software into an automatic software profile that
package will be automatically installed on all dynamically managed endpoint
systems.
Some important things to note about software versions
•
Newer software is identified by the version number. If the Allow this
version or newer selection is enabled, when a dynamically managed
endpoint polls the CMA system, the system will compare the current
software version number with the packaged software version numbers.
The CMA system will send the software package with the highest version
number to the endpoint.
•
You can also use the Version to use selection to roll endpoints back to
older software versions. If you change the Version to use selection to an
older software version and clear the Allow this version or newer
selection, the CMA system will send the specifically identified software
package to the endpoint even if it is an older version.
134
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Note
Currently to roll back a Polycom CMA Desktop client to an older version, you must
first remove the existing Polycom CMA Desktop client via the Windows Add or
Remove Software selection. Then you can install the older software package.
Peripheral Software Updates
You can update the platform (operating system) and applications (if
applicable) for peripherals connected to endpoints. Peripheral software
updates can be in any of the following states:
•
•
•
Production - The software update is configured for one or more groups
that are using the software in production.
Trial - The software update is configured for one or more groups that are
trialing the software.
Both - The software update is configured for one or more groups that are
trialing the software and for one or groups are using the software in
production.
Note
When doing peripheral upgrades on redundant systems running Microsoft SQL
Server 2005 or 2008 R1, you may receive an SQL server exception. To resolve this
exception, upload the peripheral upgrade package to the secondary server as well.
Scheduled Software Updates
The scheduled software update feature is enabled at the CMA system. An
administrator with System Setup permissions can schedule software updates
for one endpoint or a group of endpoints to occur immediately or for a date
and time in the future.
Scheduled software updates are available for these endpoint types.
•
•
•
•
•
ViewStation
ViewStation FX & EX
V and VSX Series
TANDBERG MXP series
HDX Series--Polycom HDX systems operating in standard management
mode
Some notes about scheduled software updates:
•
Until the CMA system successfully updates an endpoint scheduled for
updating, the update remains in the Pending or In Progress state and the
CMA system attempts to update the endpoint until it succeeds or until the
update is cancelled.
Polycom, Inc.
135
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
If an endpoint scheduled for update is In a Call, the CMA system waits
until the call ends before updating the endpoint. The system checks the
endpoint at 15 minute intervals.
•
•
If an endpoint scheduled for update is Offline, the CMA system attempts
to connect to the endpoint every hour until the endpoint is Online.
A software update may reboot the endpoint.
Endpoint Passwords
A CMA system can manage Polycom endpoints only when the password in
the device record matches the password in the endpoint. Matching passwords
are required to:
•
•
•
Schedule provisioning of an endpoint through a CMA system.
Use the Scheduled Software Update feature.
Monitor the endpoint from the Endpoint > Monitor View.
You can update the password for certain endpoint systems through scheduled
provisioning only after you have entered the matching password in the CMA
system. In this case, you must instruct end-users not to change the password.
Note
Some companies select an administrative password that is used for all endpoints
and regularly updated through provisioning.
For third-party endpoints, passwords may be required to access the endpoint
management software.
For information about restrictions in changing passwords for a specific
endpoint, see the documentation for the endpoint.
Considerations for Third-Party Endpoints
The CMA system includes additional command and control for select
TANDBERG C Series, TANDBERG Edge, and LifeSize Team and Express
endpoints. The CMA system can send a Reboot command to these endpoints,
and the endpoints can receive and act on the command. In addition, the CMA
system can:
•
Discover these endpoints by searching for them within a range of IP
addresses.
•
•
Complete the initial configuration of these endpoints.
Schedule and launch point-to-point conferences on these endpoints.
136
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
•
Launch the management interface for these endpoints.
In the following sections, some additional considerations for supporting
third-party endpoints are discussed, including
•
•
•
•
•
•
Enable TANDBERG Endpoints Global Address Book Access
With CMA system, users of the TANDBERG 150, 990, 880, 770 MXP,
TANDBERG C Series, and TANDBERG Edge can access the Polycom Global
Address Book, so they can see the endpoints in the Global Address Book.
(Note that any third-party endpoint that is registered to the CMA system
gatekeeper is displayed in the Global Address Book.)
The timing of the endpoint’s connection with the Global Address Book can
affect the success of its connection. We recommend the following process:
1
At the endpoint, enter the information required for directory set up
including the Polycom Global Address Book/CMA system IP address
and the path. To do this, on the endpoint, go to Endpoint Configuration
> General > External Phone Book Settings.
2
3
Wait for the connections to take effect.
At the CMA system, go to Endpoint > Monitor View and verify the
endpoint’s Global Address Book connection status is green.
Considerations for LifeSize Endpoints
Consider the following when you must support LifeSize endpoints:
•
•
•
Enabling Management of LifeSize Endpoints
To facilitate management of LifeSize endpoints, a CMA system administrator
must enable the Default Passwords for LifeSize Endpoint Management
option and enter the SSH and web UI passwords for the LifeSize endpoints.
Polycom, Inc.
137
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To enable LifeSize endpoint management
1
On the CMA system, go to Admin > Management and Security >
Endpoint Management Settings.
2
In the Default Passwords for LifeSize Endpoint Management section of
the Endpoint Management Settings page, enable Use Default
Passwords.
3
4
Enter the Password for SSH User and confirm the password. Refer to the
LifeSize system documentation for information on using SSH to connect
to the endpoint, then enter the same SSH password here.
Enter the Password for Web UI User and confirm the password. Refer to
the LifeSize system documentation for information on using a web
browser to connect to the endpoint, then enter the same web UI password
here.
5
Click Update.
Note
For the CMA system to successfully manage a LifeSize endpoint, SSH must
be enabled on the endpoint. SSH can be enabled on the endpoint through
device provisioning.
Monitoring
The CMA system can monitor select TANDBERG C Series, TANDBERG Edge,
and LifeSize Team and Express endpoints, so when properly configured, the
CMA system can provide online/offline status and alerts, display call status,
and provide image support including near and far end images for these
endpoints.
Scheduled Provisioning of Selected TANDBERG Endpoints
The following table identifies the fields that the CMA system can provision for
TANDBERG 150, 990, 880, 770 MXP, and TANDBERG C Series endpoints.
See the appropriate TANDBERG product documentation for more
information about these fields and their acceptable values. See “Scheduled
scheduled provisioning of endpoints.
138
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
AdditionalCamera Type
AlertSpeaker Mode
AlertTone Telephony
AlertTone VideoTelephony
AlertTone Volume
AllowLatency
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Audio AGC
Audio AGC AUX
Audio AGC Microphones
Audio AGC Received
Audio AGC VCR
Audio AudioModule
Audio AutoMute
Audio Delay AUX
Audio Delay VCR
Audio EchoControl
Audio EchoControl 1 through 4
Audio Feedback Mode
Audio Inputs Line 1 through 3
Level
Mode
Audio Inputs Microphone 1 through 3
Level
Mode
Audio KeyTones
Audio LocalDetection Mode
Audio Loudspeaker
Polycom, Inc.
139
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
Audio MicrophoneMixer Mode
Audio Microphones Mode
Audio Outputs Line 1 through 3
Level
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Mode
Type
Audio Stereo
Audio StereoSpeakers
Audio VCRDucking
Audio Volume
AutoAnswer Delay
AutoAnswer Device
AutoAnswer Mode
AutoLayout Mode
AutoPIP Mode
AutoPIP TimeOut
Bonding Rebonding
Bonding Timer
CallManager Address
CallVideoSource
Cameras 1 through 13
Backlight
Brightness Level
Brightness Mode
DualVisca
Focus Mode
Gamma Level
Gamma Mode
140
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
IR
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Mirror
Whitebalance Level
Whitebalance Mode
CameraDVI Mode
CameraSleep Mode
CameraSwUpgrade
CameraTracking Speed
Conference AAC-LD
Conference AAC-LD-128-Mono
Conference AAC-LD-128-Threshold
Conference AIM
Conference AllowIncomingCallInCall
Conference AllowIncomingMSCall
Conference AllowIncomingTlphCall
Conference BillingCode
Conference DefaultCall CallRate
Conference DefaultCall NetProfile
Conference DefaultCall Restrict
Conference Downspeed
Conference Encryption Mode
Conference Encryption Type
Conference FallbackToTelephony
Conference FarTlphEchoSupression
Conference FloorToFull
Conference G722
Conference G722.1
Conference G728
Polycom, Inc.
141
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
Conference H239
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Conference H263
Conference H264
Conference H264RCDO
Conference H331
Conference IPDualstreamRate
Conference IPLR Transmit
Conference MailBox URI
Conference MaxCallLength
Conference NaturalVideo
Conference PeriodicIntra
Conference PictureMode
Conference SIP URI
Conference VideoQualityCP
Conference VideoText
Conference VideoTextTimeout
Conference WebSnapshots
CorporateDirectory Address
CorporateDirectory Mode
CorporateDirectory Path
CorporateDirectory Protocol
DefaultPIPPosition
Directory CallLog
Directory SmartSearch
DoNotDisturb Mode
DualMonitor Mode
DuoVideoSource
DynamicResolution Mode
142
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
E1 Interface CRC4
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Ethernet 1 Speed
Ethernet 2 Speed
ExternalNetwork Callcontroll
ExternalNetwork Clocking
ExternalNetwork DTRPulse
ExternalServices Address
ExternalServices Mode
ExternalServices Path
ExternalServices Protocol
FECC Mode
FeedbackFilter Call
FeedbackFilter Conference
FTP Mode
G703 Callcontrol
G703 Interface MaxChannels
G703 Interface StartChannel
G703 Linecoding
G703 PhysicalLayer
H320 NetType
H323 Mode
H323CallSetup Mode
H323Gatekeeper Address
H323Gatekeeper Authentication ID
H323Gatekeeper Authentication Mode
H323Gatekeeper Authentication
Password
H323Gatekeeper Avaya AnnexH
Y
Y
N
Polycom, Inc.
143
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
H323Gatekeeper Avaya Mode
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
H323Gatekeeper Avaya
MultipointCount
H323Gatekeeper Avaya Password
H323Gatekeeper Discovery
H323Gatekeeper MultipleAlias
H323Prefix
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
HTTP Mode
HTTPS Mode
HTTPS VerifyServerCertificate
IdReport H323
IEEE802.1x AnonymousIdentity
IEEE802.1x EAP-MD5
IEEE802.1x EAP-PEAP
IEEE802.1x EAP-TTLS
IEEE802.1x Identity
IEEE802.1x Mode
IEEE802.1x Password
IMUX Custom bw1152 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw1152 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw1152R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw1152R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw128 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw128 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw128R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw128R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw1472 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw1472 Suffix
144
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
IMUX Custom bw1472R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw1472R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw192 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw192 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw1920 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw1920 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw1920R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw1920R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw192R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw192R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw256 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw256 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw256R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw256R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw320 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw320 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw320R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw320R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw384 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw384 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw384R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw384R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw512 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw512 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw512R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw512R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw64 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw64 Suffix
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Polycom, Inc.
145
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
IMUX Custom bw64R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw64R Suffix
IMUX Custom bw768 Prefix
IMUX Custom bw768 Suffix
IMUX Custom bw768R Prefix
IMUX Custom bw768R Suffix
Integrator AMXBeacon Mode
Integrator Telepresence Mode
IP Assignment
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
IP DNS Domain Name
IP DNS Server 1 through 5 Address
IP Gateway
IP SubnetMask
IPMedia MaxVideoTXRate
IPProtocol
IRControl Mode
IRControl NumberKeyMode
ISDN BRI Alert
ISDN BRI AutoActivation
ISDN BRI ChanId
ISDN BRI Interface 1 through 6
DirectoryNumber 1
DirectoryNumber 2
Mode
SPID 1
SPID 2
ISDN BRI MaxDeactiveTime
ISDN BRI SwitchType
146
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
ISDN CliNumbPlan
ISDN CliNumbSpec
ISDN CliNumbType
ISDN HLC
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
ISDN MSN
ISDN ParallelDial
ISDN PRI Alert
ISDN PRI ChanId
ISDN PRI InitialRestart
ISDN PRI Interface HighChannel
ISDN PRI Interface LowChannel
ISDN PRI Interface MaxChannels
ISDN PRI Interface
NumberRangeStart
ISDN PRI Interface NumberRangeStop
ISDN PRI Interface Search
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
ISDN PRI L2WindowSize
ISDN PRI NSFTelephony Mode
ISDN PRI NSFTelephony Number
ISDN PRI NSFVideoTelephony Mode
ISDN PRI NSFVideoTelephony
Number
ISDN PRI SwitchType
ISDN SendComplete
ISDN SendNumber
ISDN SpeechTimers
ISDN SubAddress
Key AUX
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Polycom, Inc.
147
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
Key Brightness
Key Cabinet
Key CallRegister
Key Cancel
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Key Connect
Key Disconnect
Key DocCam
Key Down
Key FarEnd
Key Grab
Key Headset
Key Help
Key Layout
Key Left
Key MainCam
Key MicOff
Key Number0 through Number9
Key Ok
Key PC
Key Phonebook
Key PIP
Key Presentation
Key Presets
Key Right
Key Selfview
Key Services
Key Settings
Key Softkey1
148
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
Key Softkey2
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Key Softkey3
Key Softkey4
Key Softkey5
Key Speaker
Key Square
Key Star
Key Up
Key VideoOff
Key VCR
Key VolumeDown
Key VolumeUp
Key ZoomIn
Key ZoomOut
Keyboard Layout
Kiosk AllowIRControl
Kiosk AutoDial
Kiosk LanguageMenu English
Kiosk LanguageMenu French
Kiosk LanguageMenu German
Kiosk LanguageMenu Italian
Kiosk LanguageMenu Mode
Kiosk LanguageMenu Norwegian
Kiosk LanguageMenu Spanish
Kiosk LanguageMenu Swedish
Kiosk Menu
Kiosk Mode
Kiosk OneClickConnect
Polycom, Inc.
149
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
Kiosk Phonebook
LocalLayout Mode
LocalLayout Toggle
Logo
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
LoS Duration Exponent
LoS Duration Offset
LoS Inhibit
LoS Initial
LoS Polarity
LoS Retry
MainVideoSource
MaxBandwidth
Multipoint Mode
Multipoint MultiwayMultiprotocol
Multipoint MultiwayStartupPeriod
Multipoint MultiwayURI
NAT Address
NAT Mode
NetProfile 1 through 7
CallPrefix
CallSuffix
Name
NTP Address
NTP Mode
OneClickConnect Mode
OSD CallDuration Mode
OSD Icon BadNetwork
OSD Icon CameraTracking
150
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
OSD Icon DuoVideo
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
OSD Icon Encryption
OSD Icon Headset
OSD Icon MicOff
OSD Icon OnAir
OSD Icon Telephone
OSD Icon VolumeOff
OSD MCUStatusLine Mode
OSD Menu BalloonHelp
OSD Menu CodecLabel
OSD Menu DisableH323IdCalling
OSD Menu DisableTimeout
OSD Menu DisplayWelcomeText
OSD Menu DisplayWelcomeTime
OSD Menu IconPlacement
OSD Menu InputEditor Language
OSD Menu Language
OSD Menu Mode
OSD Menu Password
OSD Menu Simple
OSD Menu WelcomeMenu
OSD Menu WelcomeText
OSD Mode
OSD Offset Mode
PacketlossDownSpeed Mode
PCPort Mode
PictureProgram 1 Layout
Polycom, Inc.
151
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
PictureProgram 1 Window 1 through 6
Call
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 1 Window 1 through 6
Picture
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 2 Layout
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
PictureProgram 2 Window 1 through 6
Call
PictureProgram 2 Window 1 through 6
Picture
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 3 Layout
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
PictureProgram 3 Window 1 through 6
Call
PictureProgram 3 Window 1 through 6
Picture
Y
N
N
PictureProgram 4 Layout
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
PictureProgram 4 Window 1 through 6
Call
PictureProgram 4 Window 1 through 6
Picture
Y
N
N
PresentationStart
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Preset 1 through 15 Name
QoS Diffserv Telephony Audio
QoS Diffserv Telephony Signalling
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony Audio
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony Data
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony
Signalling
QoS Diffserv VideoTelephony Video
QoS Mode
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
QoS Precedence Telephony Audio
QoS Precedence Telephony Signalling
152
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony
Audio
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony
Data
Y
Y
Y
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony
Signalling
QoS Precedence VideoTelephony
Video
QoS RSVP
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
QoS ToS
RemoteSwUpgrade Mode
RemoteSwUpgrade Password
RTP MTU
RTP Ports
Screensaver Delay
Screensaver LED
Screensaver Mode
SecurityLog Mode
SelfViewOnStartup
SerialPort 1 BaudRate
SerialPort 1 DataBits
SerialPort 1 Mode
SerialPort 1 Parity
SerialPort 1 StopBits
SerialPort 2 BaudRate
SerialPort 2 DataBits
SerialPort 2 Mode
SerialPort 2 Parity
SerialPort 2 StopBits
Polycom, Inc.
153
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
SerialPort Direct Buffer
SIP Authentication Password
SIP Authentication UserName
SIP Legacy Mask
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
SIP Mode
SIP ReplyTo URI
SIP Server Address
SIP Server Discovery
SIP Server Type
SIP TLS Verify
SIP Transport Default
SNMP CommunityName
SNMP HostIPAddr 1
SNMP HostIPAddr 2
SNMP HostIPAddr 3
SNMP Mode
SNMP SystemContact
SNMP SystemLocation
SSH Mode
StartupVideoSource
StillImageSource
Streaming Address
Streaming AllowRemoteStart
Streaming Announcements
Streaming Hops
Streaming Password
Streaming Port
Streaming Quality
154
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
Streaming Source
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Streaming VideoRate
StrictPassword
Switch Configuration Primary
Switch Configuration Secondary
Switch LogicalInput 1 Map
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 1
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 2
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 3
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 4
Switch LogicalInput 1 Mode 5
Switch LogicalInput 2 Map
Switch LogicalInput 2 Mode 1
Switch LogicalInput 3 Map
Switch LogicalInput 3 Mode 1
Switch LogicalInput 4 Map
Switch LogicalInput 4 Mode 1
Switch LogicalInput 5 Map
Switch LogicalInput 5 Mode 1
Switch Source
SystemUnit Multiway
SystemUnit Password
T1 Interface CableLength
Telnet Modea
TelnetChallenge Mode
TelnetChallenge Port
Time DateFormat
Time DaylightSavings
Polycom, Inc.
155
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
C Series
Time TimeFormat
Time Zone
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
UseAsLocalPCMonitor
Video 1 Outputs Animation
Video 1 Outputs Testpattern
Video Inputs Source 1 through 6
Name
Quality
Video Outputs DVI 1 and 2
Mode
OSD
VirtualMonitor
Video Outputs DVIResolution
Video Outputs Letterbox
Video Outputs ScreenFormatPC
Video Outputs ScreenFormatTV
Video Outputs TV 1 and 2
Mode
OSD
VirtualMonitor
VNC DisplayNumber
VNC IPAddress
VNC Password
WLAN Community
WLAN Enable
WLAN Encryption
WLAN Key 1
WLAN Key 2
156
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for supported Tandberg
models?
MXP
MXP
Models
990/880/770
Model
T150
Field Name
WLAN Key 3
WLAN Key 4
WLAN Mode
WLAN SSID
WLAN UseKey
C Series
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
N
N
N
N
N
N
N
Y
N
N
a. The CMA system always provisions Telnet Mode to ON, because provisioning Telnet Mode
to OFF would make the endpoints unmanageable.
Scheduled Provisioning of LifeSize Endpoints
The CMA system can provision many fields for LifeSize Team and Express
endpoints. The following table identifies the fields that the CMA system can
provision for LifeSize Team 200 endpoints. See the “Endpoint
scheduled provisioning of endpoints.
Provisioned for
selected LifeSize
Models?
Field Name
Calls
Team 200
Outgoing Max BandWidth
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Incoming Max BandWidth
Auto Bandwidth
Maximum Call Time
Maximum Redial Entries
Auto Answer
Auto Answer Mute
Audio
Audio Codecs
Y
Y
Y
Active Microphone
Active Microphone Volume
Polycom, Inc.
157
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for
selected LifeSize
Models?
Field Name
Primary Audio Output Test
Team 200
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Audio Mute
Muted Device(s)
Video Call Audio Output
Audio Call Audio Output
Line Out Treble
Line Out Bass
Ring Tone Volume
DMF Tone Volume
Status Tone Volume
Telepresence
Telepresence
Y
Y
Y
HD Camera 1 Moment
HD Camera 2 Moment
Video Settings > Video Control
Far Ctrl of Near Camera
Far Set of Camera Presets
Far Move to Camera Presets
Camera Presets Lock
Camera Pan Direction
Default Primary Input
Video Snapshots
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
HD Camera 1 Name
HD Input 1 Name
Stretch Video
Video Settings > Video Quality
Video Bandwidth Balance
Primary Video Motion
Presentation Video Sharpness
Y
Y
Y
158
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for
selected LifeSize
Models?
Field Name
Video Encoder Quality
Team 200
Y
Y
Y
H.241 MaxStaticMBPS
Video MTU
Security > General
Telnet
Y
Y
SNMP
Security > Passwords
SSH Password
UI Admin Password
UI User Password
Network > General
DHCP
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
IP Address
Subnet Mask
Gateway
Host Name
DNS Server
Name Search Domains
Network Speed
VLAN Tag
NTP Server Host Name
802.1x Authentication
IPv6 Configuration
IPv6 Address
IPv6 Router
Network > NAT
Static NAT
Y
Y
NAT Public IP Address
Polycom, Inc.
159
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for
selected LifeSize
Models?
Field Name
Team 200
Network > Reserved Ports
UDP Lowest Value
UDP Highest Value
TCP Highest Value
TCP Lowest Value
Network > Network Qos
Network QoS
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
DiffServ Audio Priority
DiffServ Video Priority
DiffServ Data Priority
InServ Audio Priority
InServ Video Priority
InServ Data Priority
InServ ToS
Network > LifeSize® Transit
LifeSize® Transit
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Transit Hostname
Transit Username
Transit Password
Transit ICE
Transit Signaling
Web Proxy URL
Web Proxy Username
Web Proxy Password
Communications > General
Auto Answer Multiway Calls
Video Dialing
Y
Y
Y
Y
Voice Dialing
Presentations
160
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for
selected LifeSize
Models?
Field Name
Auto Start Presentations
Team 200
Y
Communications > H.323
H.323
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
H.323 Name
H.323 Extension
Gatekeeper ID
Gatekeeper Mode
Primary Gatekeeper IP and Port
Alternate Gatekeeper IP and Port
H.460
Communications > SIP
SIP
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
SIP Username
SIP Authorization
SIP Server Type
SIP Registration
SIP Proxy
SIP Proxy Host Name
SIP Proxy Port
SIP Registrar
SIP Registrar Host Name
SIP Registrar Port
UDP Signaling
UDP Signaling Port
TCP Signaling
TCP Signaling Port
TLS Signaling
TLS Signaling Port
Polycom, Inc.
161
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioned for
selected LifeSize
Models?
Field Name
Team 200
System > General
Auto Reboot
Y
N
Y
Y
Y
System > Identification
System Name
Video Number
Voice Number
System > Identification
Timezone
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Month
Day
Year
Hour
Minute
Second
Directory > Auto Discovery
Auto Discovery
Auto Discovery Subnets
Auto Discovery Ignored Subnets
Directory > LDAP
LDAP
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
LDAP Hostname
LDAP Password
LDAP Base
LDAP Filter
LDAP Refresh
Appearance > General
Language
Y
Y
Y
Fade Out Timeout
Company Logo
162
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Management Overview
Provisioned for
selected LifeSize
Models?
Field Name
LCD Contrast
Team 200
Y
Y
Y
Y
Screen Saver
Screen Saver Timeout
Sleep Timeout
Appearance > Layout
Picture in Picture
Y
Y
Display 2 Layout
Appearance > Display
Display 1 Resolution
Y
Y
Y
Y
Display 1 Energy Saver
Display 2 Energy Saver
Display 2 Resolution
Diagnostics > Cameras
Camera Anti-Flicker
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
HD Camera 1 Brightness
HD Camera 1 White Balance
HD Camera 2 White Balance
HD Camera 2 Brightness
Diagnostics > DVD-I Input
DVI-I Input Horizontal Position
DVI-I Input Vertical Position
DVI-I Input Coarse Tuning
DVI-I Input Fine Tuning
DVI-I Input Brightness
DVI_I Input Contrast
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
DVI-I Input Scaling
Polycom, Inc.
163
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provisioning of LifeSize Passwords
Take note of the following when provisioning passwords to LifeSize
endpoints:
•
The Auto password must be provisioned to meet the LifeSize and
SSH/telnet rules for passwords.
•
You cannot provision the Auto password to be blank. If you attempt to
provision a blank value, the existing value of the password will not be
overwritten. It will remain valid.
•
•
The Web UI or User password can be provisioned to include the numbers
0-9 and/or the symbols * and #. The system will silently truncate these
passwords to a maximum of 16 characters.
You can provision the Web UI or User password to be blank.
Refer to the LifeSize documentation for more information about the
requirements for these password.
Reporting
The CMA system includes standard reporting for select TANDBERG C Series,
TANDBERG Edge, and LifeSize Team and Express endpoints.
164
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
10
Endpoint and Peripheral
Management Operations
This chapter describes how to perform the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system endpoint management tasks. It includes these
topics:
•
•
Endpoint Management Operations
The follow topics describe the actions available in Endpoint > Monitor View:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Polycom, Inc.
165
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
View Device Details
To view detailed information about a managed endpoint
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest and click View Details.
The Device Details dialog box displays the following information:
Field
Description
Identification
System Name
The name of the endpoint.
•
•
Endpoint names must be unique.
The name must be in ASCII only and may have an
unlimited number of characters. Spaces, dashes,
and underscores are valid.
•
When retrieved from a video endpoint system, the
name is taken from the H.323 ID if the endpoint
registered with the gatekeeper and it is a third-party
system. In other cases, it is the system name, which
might be different than the H.323 ID.
Device Type
The type of endpoint. For valid types, see “Endpoint
IP Address
Owner
Site
The assigned IP address of the endpoint.
The person to whom the endpoint is assigned.
The network site for the endpoint. By default, endpoints
are added to the Primary Site.
Product ID
Description
The product model.
A free-form text field (extended ASCII only) in which
information about the endpoint can be added.
Serial Number
The serial number (ASCII only) of the endpoint.The
endpoint provides the serial number if it registered
successfully or is managed.
Software Version
The version of the software installed on the endpoint
(ASCII only). The endpoint provides the version number
if it registered successfully or is managed.
166
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations
Field
Description
HTTP URL
The management URL for the endpoint, if available
(ASCII only). This URL allows the CMA system to start
the endpoint‘s management system using the Manage
function.
All Polycom endpoints allow management through a
browser. For these endpoints, this field is completed
when the endpoint registers with the CMA system.
HTTP Port
The HTTP port number for the endpoint. The endpoint
provides the port number if it registered successfully and
is managed.
Addresses
SIP URI
A SIP URI is the address used to call another person via
SIP. In effect it’s a user’s SIP phone number. The SIP
URI will be of the following format:
<username>@host(domain or IP):Port
Aliases
The aliases that allow you to connect to the endpoint.
The CMA system converts the aliases to the IP address
associated with the endpoint.
•
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and
Unknown.
•
•
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.
The value for the H.323 ID is the endpoint name if the
endpoint registered with the gatekeeper and it is a
third-party system. In other cases, the endpoint
name is the system name, which might be different
from the H323 ID.
•
The value of the E.164 alias is the extension dialed
to reach this endpoint.
Notes
•
To add aliases for the endpoint, edit the endpoint.
•
The following Alias Values are ASCII only: H323 ID,
URL, Transport Address, and Unknown.
ISDN Video
Number
For ISDN endpoints only, the country code + city/area
code + phone number for the endpoint.
When you add an endpoint without native ISDN, the
ISDN gateway, country code, and area code are not
captured. The CMA system only supports native ISDN.
LAN Host Name
The host name of the endpoint on the LAN. This can be
different from the system name of the endpoint. It is an
ASCII only name.
Call Signaling
Address
The port on which the CMA system gatekeeper sends
call signaling information.
Polycom, Inc.
167
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
RAS Address
The port on which the CMA system gatekeeper sends
RAS addressing information.
Capabilities
Supported
Protocols
The communications protocols that the endpoint can
support. Possible values include:
•
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols
used for multimedia communications on
packet-based H.323 networks.
•
•
IP (SIP) - A standard that defines the protocols used
for multimedia communications on SIP networks.
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols
used for multimedia communications on switched
networks, such as ISDN.
For endpoints with the type Unknown, select H.323.
The endpoint automatically provides the protocols if it
registered successfully or is managed.
Required MCU
Service
The MCU service selected for the endpoint to use.
Capabilities
Enabled
Capabilities enabled on this endpoint. Options are:
•
•
MCU - The endpoint can act as a control unit for
multipoint conferences
Gateway - The endpoint can act as a gateway for
call management
The MCU provides the capability if it registered
successfully or is managed.
Monitoring Level
The monitoring level for the endpoint. Possible values
include:
•
•
Standard. This endpoint is monitored.
VIP. This endpoint is monitored closely. The VIP
identifier and filters are available to operators to
monitor and manage conferences.
Available to
Schedule
Identifies if the endpoint is available when users are
scheduling conferences
Call Info > Sites
Far Site Name
The H.323ID of the far site endpoint to which the
selected endpoint is connected. When multiple endpoints
are connected through the endpoint's embedded MCU,
this field displays a concatenation of each endpoint's
H.323ID separated by ' | ', for example 'ISDN-CO1-7-1 |
Vsfx-9-1'.
168
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations
Field
Description
Far Site Number
The address of the far site endpoint to which the
selected endpoint is connected. The address value for
the calling endpoint appears to be the dialed address.
The address value for the called endpoint appears to be
the IP Address.
Encryption
Cause Code
Error
The type of encryption the far site uses.
The cause code showing how the call ended.
Video FEC Errors
The number of Forward Error Correction (FEC) errors
that have been corrected in the current call.
Sync
Call Type
Type of call, such as, H.323, SIP, ISDN, or POTS.
Call Info > Call Details
Video Protocol The video connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using. Possible
values include:
•
•
•
H.261—H.261 is an ITU standard designed for
two-way communication over ISDN lines and
supports data rates which are multiples of 64Kbit/s.
H.261 supports CIF and QCIF resolutions.
H.263—H.263 is based on H.261 with
enhancements that improve video quality over
modems. It supports CIF, QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and
16CIF resolutions.
H.264
Video Format
The video format, both transmission (Tx) and reception
(Rx), the endpoint is using.
Video Rate
The video bandwidth negotiated with the far site.
Video Rate Used
The actual video bandwidth used in the call to the far
site.
Video Frame Rate
Audio Protocol
Specifies the frame rate the endpoint is using.
The audio connection protocol, both transmission (Tx)
and reception (Rx), the endpoint is using. Possible
values include:
•
•
•
G.711
G.722
G.728
Audio Rate
The audio bandwidth negotiated with the far site
Call Info > Quality of Service (Not reported by all endpoint types)
Polycom, Inc.
169
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Total Packet Loss
Specifies the total packet loss for the currently active call
that is, the total percentage of packet loss for all currently
active calls divided by the number of active calls.
% Packet Loss
Specifies the average percentage of packet loss for the
currently active call that is, the total percentage of packet
loss for all currently active calls divided by the number of
active calls.
Audio Packet Loss Specifies the audio packet loss for the currently active
call.
Video Packet Loss Specifies the video packet loss for the currently active
call.
Audio Jitter
Video Jitter
Specifies the audio jitter for the currently active call.
Specifies the video jitter for the currently active call.
Call Info > Video Feed
Near Site
Far Site
The video feed from the endpoint.
The video feed from the endpoint to which the endpoint
is connected.
System Alerts
Errors
Endpoint error message, for example, GK Registration
error.
Warnings
Endpoint warning message, for example, Low Battery.
Add an Endpoint or Find an Endpoint on the Network
This topic describes how to manually add endpoints and how to find
endpoints on the same network as the CMA system.
For most endpoints, you enter basic information. The CMA system then
locates the endpoint and retrieves its information.
To add an endpoint to a CMA system or find an endpoint on the network
1
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View and click Add
.
170
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations
2
In the Add New Device dialog box, select the Device Type. For valid
the list, select a Device Type of Other. This dialog is meant for adding
endpoints that are managed in Standard Management mode.
Note
All dynamically-managed endpoints automatically register with the CMA system
and cannot be added using the Add option.
3
4
Enter the IP Address of the endpoint.
Click Find Device.
— If the CMA system can find the endpoint on the network, the Add
New Device dialog box is populated with information retrieved from
the endpoint. Review any information retrieved from the endpoint.
— If the CMA system cannot find the endpoint on the network, a Device
Not Found dialog box appears.
Notes
If you enter an invalid Admin ID or Password for an endpoint that requires that
information, the CMA system may still find the endpoint. It depends upon the
endpoint type.
•
V-Series, VSX-Series, and Viewstation endpoints allow the CMA system to
detect the endpoint type and complete the registration. The endpoint appears in
the Endpoint list with an alert indicating Incorrect Password.
•
Polycom HDX systems and ViewStation FX systems won’t allow the CMA
system to detect the endpoint type and complete the registration. You can
manually add the endpoint, but the CMA system cannot communicate with it
until you’ve entered a valid Admin ID or Password for the endpoint. In this
case, the CMA system records an error message in an error log.
•
The Find Device function only works for endpoints with a specified Device
Type. If you selected a Device Type of Other, the CMA system will report an
error.
5
Assign the endpoint a System Name.
Endpoint names must be unique, must be in ASCII only, and may have an
unlimited number of characters. Spaces, dashes, and underscores are
valid.
6
7
If necessary, enter the Admin ID and Password for the endpoint. Some
endpoints may not require this information. Other endpoints may require
only a password.
Complete the Identification, Addresses, and Capabilities sections of the
Add New Device dialog box.
Pay particular attention to the Capabilities options, because the settings
on it determine how the endpoint is used throughout the CMA system.
Polycom, Inc.
171
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
For example, you can select it as a VIP endpoint and determine whether it
will be Available to Schedule through the scheduling interface.
Note that many fields in this dialog box are ASCII only. Depending on the
selected type, some of these fields may not be displayed or may not be
editable.
Field
Description
Identification
Description
A free-form text field (extended ASCII only) in which
information about the endpoint can be added.
GAB Display
Name
Enter a name for the endpoint as it will appear in the
Global Address Book.
Site
The network site for the endpoint.The system determines
the site based upon IP address.
Serial Number
The serial number (ASCII only) of the endpoint.The
endpoint provides the serial number if it registered
successfully or is managed.
Software Version
HTTP URL
The version of the software installed on the endpoint
(ASCII only). The endpoint provides the version number
if it registered successfully or is managed.
The management URL for the endpoint, if available
(ASCII only). This URL allows the CMA system to start
the endpoint ‘s management system using the Manage
function.
All Polycom endpoints allow management through a
browser. For these endpoints, this field is completed
when the endpoint registers with the CMA system.
HTTP Port
The HTTP port number for the endpoint. The endpoint
provides the port number if it registered successfully and
is managed.
Addresses
DNS Name
The name for the endpoint as entered on the domain
name server.
SIP URI
The address used to call the endpoint via SIP.
<username>@host(domain or IP):Port
172
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations
Field
Description
Aliases
The aliases that allow you to connect to the endpoint.
The CMA system converts the aliases to the IP address
associated with the endpoint.
•
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and
Unknown.
•
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.
Notes
•
The following Alias Values are ASCII only: H323 ID,
URL, Transport Address, and Unknown.
•
The value for the H.323 ID is the endpoint name if the
endpoint registered with the gatekeeper and it is a
third-party system. In other cases, the endpoint
name is the system name, which might be different
from the H323 ID.
•
The value of the E.164 alias is the extension dialed
to reach this endpoint.
ISDN Video
Number
For ISDN endpoints only, the country code + city/area
code + local phone number for the endpoint.
When you add an endpoint without native ISDN, the
ISDN gateway, country code, and area code are not
captured. The CMA system only supports native ISDN.
Capabilities
Supported
Protocols
The communications protocols that the endpoint can
support. Possible values include:
•
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols
used for multimedia communications on
packet-based H.323 networks.
•
•
IP (SIP) - A standard that defines the protocols used
for multimedia communications on SIP networks.
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols
used for multimedia communications on switched
networks, such as ISDN.
For endpoints with the type Unknown, select H.323.
The endpoint automatically provides the protocols if it
registered successfully or is managed.
Required MCU
Service
The MCU service selected for the endpoint to use.
Polycom, Inc.
173
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Capabilities
Enabled
Capabilities enabled on this endpoint. Options are:
•
MCU - The endpoint can act as a control unit for
multipoint conferences
•
Gateway - The endpoint can act as a gateway for
call management
The MCU provides the capability if it registered
successfully or is managed.
Monitoring Level
The monitoring level for the endpoint. Possible values
include:
•
•
Standard. This endpoint is monitored.
VIP. This endpoint is monitored closely. The VIP
identifier and filters are available to operators to
monitor and manage conferences.
Available to
Schedule
Identifies if the endpoint is available when users are
scheduling conferences
8
Click Add.
The endpoint appears in the Endpoint list. By default, the system may
also:
— Add the endpoint to the applicable site.
— Set the HTTP Port to 80
— Add an Alias for the endpoint.
— Make the endpoint Available to Schedule
— Set the Monitoring Level to Standard
Note
For third-party endpoints, the HTTP URL, serial number, and DNS name are not
captured during endpoint registration.
Once you’ve added an endpoint, you can associate it with a user. See “Assign
Edit an Endpoint
The CMA system automatically detects IP address changes and updates its
database with the new information for Polycom and third-party endpoints
that are registered with the CMA system.
174
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations
To edit an endpoint in the CMA system
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest and click Edit
.
As required, edit the Identification, Addresses, and Capabilities
Note that many fields in this dialog box are ASCII only.
5
Click Update.
Note
Editing information for an endpoint on the CMA system does not change the
information in the endpoint. To make changes in the endpoint information, use
Provisioning or change it at the endpoint interface. Note that for managed
endpoints, the endpoint may overwrite settings entered manually.
Delete an Endpoint
To delete an endpoint from the CMA system
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest and click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The Endpoint list is updated.
Note
If your gatekeeper registration policy allows endpoints to register automatically with
the CMA system (that is, a gatekeeper setting of Allow Registration of All
Endpoints or Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites or Allow
Registration of Predefined Prefixes Only) an endpoint that you delete may
re-appear in the Endpoint list.
Polycom, Inc.
175
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
View an Endpoint’s Video Feed
Note
This procedure is available on the following endpoint types:
•
•
•
•
Polycom HDX system
TANDBERG
V-Series and VSX-Series
ViewStation
To view the video feed for an endpoint (near site or far site)
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest and click View Details.
The Device Details dialog box appears. For information about these
4
Click Call Info to expand the Call Info options and select Video Feed.
The Endpoint Video section shows the video feed from the near and far
site.
Clear an Endpoint Help Request
To clear an endpoint help request from the CMA system
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest and click Clear Help.
The Confirm Endpoint Help Clear dialog box appears.
4
To send a message to the endpoint as well as clear the help request, check
Also send message to endpoint.
5
6
Click Clear.
If you selected the Also send message to endpoint check box, enter the
text message to send the endpoint in the Send Message to Endpoint
dialog box and click Send.
The Endpoint list is updated and alerts for the endpoint are cleared.
Note
If the reason for the original alert still exists on the endpoint, the alert will likely
reappear in the Endpoint list.
176
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations
Send a Message to an Endpoint
In some situations, such as in response to a help request, you can send a
message to some types of endpoints.
To send a message to an endpoint from the CMA system
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest.
If the endpoint can receive text messages, a Send Message option appears
in the Action menu.
4
5
Click Send Message.
In the Send Message to Endpoint dialog box, enter a text message and
click Send.
The message is sent to the endpoint.
Reboot an Endpoint
In some situations, for example when a remote endpoint is unresponsive, you
may need to reboot an endpoint remotely through the CMA system.
To reboot an endpoint from the CMA system
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest.
Click Reboot Device.
To confirm the request, click Reboot.
Associate a User with an Endpoint
To associate an endpoint to a user within the CMA system
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest.
Click Associate User.
Polycom, Inc.
177
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
5
In the Last Name field of the Associate User dialog box, enter all or part
of the user’s last name and click Search.
The system displays the list of users who meet your search criteria.
6
Select the user of interest and click Close.
Search for Endpoints in a Range of IP Addresses
To search for a set of endpoints within a range of IP addresses
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View and click Search Devices.
In the Search Devices dialog box, enter the starting IP address and
ending IP address for the search range and click Search.
The system begins searching for endpoints. A progress bar displays the
status of the search and a results message displays the number of
endpoints searched and the number of endpoints found within the IP
range.
View Peripherals
If an endpoint has one or more peripherals connected, you can view
information about the peripherals.
1
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View and select an endpoint that has
peripherals connected.
2
3
Click View Peripherals.
From the Peripherals dialog box, select the peripheral of interest to see
the following information.
Field
Description
Status
The status shows if a paired peripheral is one of the
following connection states:
Connected
Disconnected
Paired Endpoint
Name of the HDX or RealPresence Group Series
endpoint that the peripheral is connected to.
Serial Number
IP Address
The serial number of the peripheral.
IP address of the peripheral, if applicable.
Version of the peripheral hardware.
Version of the peripheral software.
Hardware Version
Software Version
178
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint and Peripheral Management Operations
Peripheral View Operations
The following topics describe the actions available in the Endpoint >
Peripherals View:
•
•
Delete Peripheral
You can delete peripherals from the Peripherals View list when the peripheral
is no longer connected to an endpoint.
1
Go to Endpoint > Peripherals View and select a peripheral that is listed
as Not Paired.
2
3
Click Delete Peripheral.
In the Confirm Delete dialog box, click Yes.
Display Applications
For peripherals on which you can install multiple applications, you can
display a list of installed applications and their version.
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Peripherals View and select a peripheral.
Click Display Applications.
The Applications Installed on dialog box for the selected peripheral
appears.
Field
Description
Application Name
Version
Name of the peripheral application.
Version of the peripheral application.
3
Click Close.
Polycom, Inc.
179
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
180
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
11
Endpoint Provisioning Operations
This chapter discusses Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) system automatic and scheduled endpoint provisioning operations.
It includes these topics:
•
•
•
Bundled Provisioning Operations
This topic describes the bundled provisioning operations a user assigned the
Device Administrator role can perform. These are:
•
•
•
Bundled provisioning is not available when Maximum Security is enabled.
View the Provisioning Bundle List
To view the provisioning bundle list
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Bundled Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the list of provisioning bundles.
Polycom, Inc.
181
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Download a Provisioning Bundle
After you download a provisioning bundle for a specific HDX or RealPresence
Group Series model, any dynamically managed HDX or RealPresence Group
Series system of the same model will receive the provisioning bundle when an
HDX or RealPresence Group Series system next polls the CMA system for new
provisioning information.
If a provisioning bundle already exists for the model you select, the existing
bundle is overwritten with the new one.
For more information about provisioning bundles, see “Bundled
To download a provisioning bundle
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Bundled Provisioning.
Click Download.
The Download Provisioning Bundle From an Endpoint dialog lists all of
the HDX and RealPresence Group Series systems registered with the CMA
system.
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select an HDX or a RealPresence Group Series system that is configured
the way you want for the provisioning bundle.
5
6
Complete the Bundle Name and Description fields.
Click Download.
The system confirms that the bundle downloaded successfully.
Click OK.
7
Delete a Provisioning Bundle
When you no longer need a provisioning bundle for an HDX or a RealPresence
Group Series model, you can delete it. An existing provisioning bundle is also
removed when you download a bundle for the same HDX or RealPresence
Group Series model. The newly downloaded bundle overwrites the existing
one.
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Endpoint > Bundled Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the list of provisioning bundles.
Select the bundle you want to delete.
Click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The system confirms that the bundle was deleted.
182
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Provisioning Operations
Automatic Provisioning Operations
This topic describes the automatic provisioning operations a user assigned the
Device Administrator role can perform. These are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
View the Automatic Provisioning List and Details
To view the automatic provisioning list and details about an automatic
provisioning operation
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Automatic Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest.
Expand the Provisioning Details tab in the Device Details section.
Add an Automatic Provisioning Profile
This topic describes how to add automatic provisioning profiles.
TIP
Add provisioning profiles in the middle of the work day, not first thing in the morning.
When you add an automatic provisioning profile, the CMA system
immediately rolls it out. If it rolls it out first thing in the morning, people who
need to attend a “start the day” conference will have to first wait for their
endpoint to be provisioned. Better to implement profiles in the middle of the
work day and then let the provisioning occur at the designated polling
interval.
To add an automatic provisioning profile
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning
Profiles.
Polycom, Inc.
183
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
3
4
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, click Add
.
In the Add Profile dialog box, enter a name for the profile and click Next.
Complete the System Settings, Home Screen Settings, H.323 Settings,
Call Settings, Audio Settings, and (if applicable) CMA Desktop Settings
sections of the Provisioning Fields dialog box.
page 107. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type
selected.
5
6
Click OK.
The provisioning profile appears at the bottom of the Automatic
Provisioning Profiles list.
To change the priority order of the automatic provisioning profiles:
a
Click in the Profile Order text box preceding the provisioning profile
of interest and enter the priority for the profile.
b
Click Update Profile Order.
The system assigns the provisioning profile the selected priority and
shuffles and reassigns priorities to the other provisioning profiles.
Edit an Automatic Provisioning Profile
To edit an automatic provisioning profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning
Profiles.
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest
and click Edit
.
Edit the System Settings, Home Screen Settings, H.323 Settings, Call
Settings, Audio Settings, and (if applicable) CMA Desktop Settings
sections of the Provisioning Fields dialog box.
page 107. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type
selected.
4
Click OK.
The provisioning profile is updated.
184
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Provisioning Operations
Edit the Profile Order for an Automatic Provisioning Profile
To edit the profile order for an automatic provisioning profile
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning
Profiles.
2
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest,
click in the Profile Order text box preceding the provisioning profile of
interest, and enter the priority for the profile.
3
Click Update Profile Order.
The system assigns the provisioning profile the selected priority and
shuffles and reassigns priorities to the other provisioning profiles.
Clone an Automatic Provisioning Profile
To clone an automatic provisioning profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning
Profiles.
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest
and click Clone
.
In the Clone Profile dialog box, enter a name for the new profile and click
Save.
The provisioning profile appears last in the Automatic Provisioning
Profiles list.
4
As needed, edit the profile. See “Edit an Automatic Provisioning Profile”
Delete an Automatic Provisioning Profile
To delete an automatic provisioning profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning
Profiles.
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest
and click Delete
.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The profile is deleted from the CMA system.
Polycom, Inc.
185
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Scheduled Provisioning Operations
This topic describes the scheduled provisioning operations a user assigned the
Device Administrator role can perform. These are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
View the Scheduled Provisioning List and Details
To view the automatic provisioning list and details about a scheduled
provisioning operation
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest.
Expand the Provisioning Details tab in the Device Details section.
Add a Scheduled Provisioning Profile
To add a scheduled provisioning profile
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning
Profiles.
2
3
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, click Add
.
In the Add Profile dialog box, select the Endpoint Type for the
provisioning profile, enter a name for the profile, and click Next.
186
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Provisioning Operations
4
5
As needed, select Provision This Page and complete the General
Settings, Video Network, Monitors, Cameras, Audio Settings, LAN
Properties, and Global Services sections of the Provisioning Fields
dialog box.
page 113. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type
selected.
Click OK.
The provisioning profile appears in the updated Scheduled Provisioning
Profiles list.
Edit a Scheduled Provisioning Profile
To edit a scheduled provisioning profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning
Profiles.
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles list, select the profile of interest
and click Edit Profile.
As needed, select Provision This Page and complete the General
Settings, Video Network, Monitors, Cameras, Audio Settings, LAN
Properties, and Global Services sections of the Provisioning Fields
dialog box.
page 113. The sections may differ depending on the endpoint type
selected.
4
Click OK.
The provisioning profile is updated.
Clone a Scheduled Provisioning Profile
To clone a scheduled provisioning profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning
Profiles.
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest
and click Clone Profile.
In the Clone Profile dialog box, enter a name for the new profile and click
Save.
The provisioning profile appears first in the updated Scheduled
Provisioning Profiles list.
Polycom, Inc.
187
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
4
Edit the sections of the Provisioning Fields dialog box. The sections and
fields differ depending on the endpoint type selected. For more
information on these fields, see the product documentation for the
selected endpoint.
5
6
Review each page of the scheduled provisioning profile and determine if
you want the parameters on the page provisioned. If you do want the
parameters on the page provisioned, select Provision This Page.
Click OK.
The provisioning profile is updated.
Delete a Scheduled Provisioning Profile
To delete a scheduled provisioning profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning
Profiles.
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest
and click Delete Profile.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The profile is deleted from the CMA system.
Schedule an Endpoint for Provisioning
To schedule an endpoint for provisioning
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoints of interest.
Click Provision.
In the Schedule Endpoint Provisioning dialog box, select the
appropriate provisioning profile.
6
7
8
In the Schedule field, select Now or Later.
If you select Later, enter a Date and Time for the provisioning.
Select either Use Server Date/Time or Use Endpoint Date/Time as these
may differ.
9
Click Schedule.
The Scheduled Provisioning View reappears.
188
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Provisioning Operations
10 Click Refresh
and check the Pending column for the provisioning
status.
For each endpoint you selected, the name of the profile appears in the
Pending column, and the date and time you entered appears in the
Scheduled column.
Check the Status of a Scheduled Provisioning
To check the status of a scheduled provisioning
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoint of interest.
Expand the Provisioning Details tab in the Device Details section.
For information about the fields in this section, see “View the Scheduled
Clear the Status of Scheduled Provisioning
To clear the status of a scheduled provisioning
1
2
3
4
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoints of interest.
Click Clear Status.
The endpoint provisioning status returns to Clear.
Cancel a Scheduled Provisioning
You can only cancel provisioning of a Pending process. You cannot cancel the
provisioning of an endpoint while it is In Progress.
To cancel a pending scheduled provisioning
1
2
3
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Provisioning.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoints of interest.
Polycom, Inc.
189
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
4
Click Cancel Provision.
The provisioning operation is cancelled and the provisioning status
returns to Clear.
190
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
12
Endpoint Software Update
Operations
This chapter describeshow to use Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system to update the software on Polycom endpoints
when a new software package is available. It includes these sections:
•
•
Automatic Software Update Operations
For automatic software update, it includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
View Automatic Software Update Information
To view information for endpoints that are eligible for automatic software
updates
1
Go to Endpoint > Automatic Software Update.
The Automatic Software Update page appears.
2
3
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list. Filter choices
include Type, Name, IP Address, ISDN Video Number, Alias, and Site.
Select the endpoint of interest.
Polycom, Inc.
191
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
4
In the Device Details section, expand the Software Update Details tab.
View Automatic Software Update Packages
To view the list of automatic software update packages
1
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
The Automatic Software Updates page appears and the Polycom HDX
Series automatic software update packages are displayed. The Automatic
Software Updates page includes this information.
Field
Description
Version to use
Displays the default automatic software update
profile to be used for the endpoint type and
model.
Allow this version or newer When checked, indicates that when a newer
automatic software update package for the
endpoint type and model is added, that package
should be used as the default package.
Endpoint Type
The type of endpoint system. For valid endpoint
system types, see “Endpoint
Version
The version of the software package associated
with the automatic software update package.
Description
Uploaded
Trial Group
The meaningful name given to the automatic
software update package when it was created.
The date and time when the automatic software
update package was created.
The trial group assigned to the software update
package, if applicable.
2
To view the Polycom CMA Desktop automatic software update
packages, click the CMA Desktop tab.
192
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
Set Maintenance Window for Automatic Software Updates
You can restrict automatic software updates of dynamically-managed
endpoint systems to a scheduled maintenance window.
Typically, automatic software updates occur as specified by the Software
Update Polling Interval (Admin > Site > Edit Site Provisioning Details >
Provisioning Settings). Enabling the maintenance window feature in the
CMA system overrides the Software Update Polling Interval. The CMA
system provisions the maintenance window to the endpoints, and the
endpoints hold their automatic software update requests until the
maintenance window starts.
Some notes about this feature:
•
It applies to dynamically-managed HDX and RealPresence Group Series
systems only.
•
To avoid automatically updating the software on all HDX or RealPresence
Group Series systems at the start of the maintenance window, the systems
randomize their automatic software update requests.
To restrict automatic software updates to a scheduled maintenance window
1
Go to Admin > Software Update > Automatic Software Update >
Maintenance Window.
2
In the Maintenance Window dialog box, click Enable Maintenance
Window and set a maintenance window Start Time and either an End
Time or Duration.
Set the maintenance window start time to the endpoint’s system local
time, not the CMA system local time. For example, if you set the
maintenance window start time to 3am, the maintenance window for each
HDX system will start at 3am local time. Therefore, the maintenance
window for HDX systems in Buffalo, NY will start at 3am EST; the
maintenance window for HDX systems in Denver, CO will start at 3am
MST; and the maintenance window for HDX systems in San Francisco, CA
will start at 3am PST.
3
Click Save.
Implement Automatic Software Updates for Endpoints
To implement automatic software updates, complete the following tasks:
1
2
3
Polycom, Inc.
193
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
4
on page 196. For more information on software update packages, see
5
List the Serial Numbers for the Endpoints to be Updated
To list the serial numbers for the endpoints to be updated
1
2
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Click Get Serial Numbers
.
The Endpoint Serial Number List appears listing the endpoints eligible
for automatic software update. Endpoints without serial numbers and
endpoints that are not actively managed by the system are excluded.
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the specific endpoints to be updated. To select all endpoints in the
list, click the check box in the column header.
5
6
Click Get Serial Numbers.
The serial number(s) appear in the text box on the page.
When updating a single endpoint:
a
b
Record the serial number:____________________________________
Click Close.
The Automatic Software Updates list reappears.
c
7
When updating multiple endpoints:
a
Create a .txtfile that you can submit to the Polycom Product
Activation site. Put each License Number - Serial Number
combination on a separate line as shown in the following example.
X1006-3202-3027-0101
X1009-0453-6027-0202
X1009-1624-6027-0303
VR207071500x
VR207071500x
VR207071500x
b
c
Return to the Endpoint Serial Number List and click Close.
The Automatic Software Updates list reappears.
updated. You may include all of the serial numbers for all of the
different endpoint types in the same .txtfile.
d
Save the .txt file.
194
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
e
Download the Required Software Package
To download the software package required to update the endpoint
1
On your local system, create a directory to which to save the software
package (if one does not already exist).
2
For Polycom endpoints:
a
b
Open a web browser and go to http://support.polycom.com.
In the Documents and Downloads section, select the Product Type
for the required software package (Telepresence and Video for video
endpoints such as Polycom HDX systems or Voice for endpoints such
as Polycom VVX systems).
c
On the product listing page, click the link to the product page of
interest.
d
e
Select the software package and save it to the directory created in
that the software package may contain the software for different
models of the same endpoint type.
3
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended
procedure for downloading a software package. Save it to the directory
Request Update Activation Keys
Note
In general, you need an activation key when updating to a major release (for
example, 3.x to 4.x) or minor release (for example, 3.1 to 3.2). You do not need an
activation key when updating a point release (for example, 3.1.1 to 3.1.2). However,
you should read the product release notes for specific information about whether or
not you’ll need an activation key.
To request upgrade activation keys
1
2
3
For Polycom endpoints, open a web browser and go to
http://support.polycom.com
.
In the Licensing & Product Registration section, select the
Activation/Upgrade.
Log in or Register for An Account.
Polycom, Inc.
195
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
4
5
Select Product Activation.
To activate a single license:
a
b
c
Click SITE & Single Activation/Upgrade.
Enter the Serial Number and click Next.
Read and click Accept Agreement to continue.
d
Enter the License Numbers you received for the upgrade and click
Upgrade.
e
f
The key code is returned on the screen.
Record the key code and create a .txtfile with the Serial Number -
Key Code combination to be updated.
6
To activate a batch of licenses:
a
b
Click Batch Activation.
Click Browse and browse to the location of the .txt file you created
in step 7 on page 194.
c
Click Upload.
A file containing the Serial Number - Key Code combinations will be
E-mailed to the specified E-mail account.
d
When you receive the .txtfile, save it to your local system.
7
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended
procedure for requesting an upgrade activation key.
Upload the Software Package and Create a Software Update
Package
After you receive notification about a new software package for a Polycom
endpoint, upload the software update to the CMA system and create a
software update profile to use for the update.
Note
When uploading a software package, log into the CMA system web interface using
its fully qualified domain name (for example, CMAsystem.domain.com) rather than
its IP address. As long as your browser did not display any certificate errors when
logging in, you should be able to upload the software package successfully.
To upload the software package and create an automatic software update
profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for the endpoint type of interest.
Click Upload Software Update.
196
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
4
5
In the Upload Software Update dialog box, verify the endpoint type and
model.
If an activation key code is required to activate the software update, click
the Update Requires Key check box and in the Software Update Key
Note
The key is generated from the endpoint serial number and version number, and
Polycom sends it as a text (.txt) file to the customer when new software is
available. Customers can review their key history at
http://support.polycom.com
.
6
7
Enter a meaningful description that will help other users to understand
the purpose of the software update.
Click OK.
An automatic software update profile for the endpoint type and model
type appears in the Automatic Software Updates list.
If you receive a message that indicates “This version is the first for its
endpoint type, so it will be assumed to be the policy for this endpoint
type,” the software update profile also appears in the Version to use field.
Set an Automatic Software Update Policy
To set an automatic software update policy for an endpoint type
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for the endpoint type of interest.
Choose one of these policies:
— To specify a minimum version of automatic software update package,
make that version the Version to use and select Allow this version or
newer.
— To require a specific version of automatic software update package,
make that version the Version to use and clear Allow this version or
newer.
— To turn automatic software update off for an endpoint type, change
the Version to use value to (none).
4
Click Update.
Polycom, Inc.
197
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Trial a Software Update Package
To trial a software update package:
1
Get the things you need to create the package. Complete these tasks:
a
b
c
2
Set up testing. Complete these tasks:
a
b
3
Once your testing of the trial software package is complete, do one of
these tasks:
Create a Local Trial Group
To trial a software update with a specific group of local and/or enterprise
users, create a local group that includes these users, as described in “Add a
software update package when their endpoint goes through its normal,
automated software update process.
Notes
•
You can use an existing enterprise group as a trial group, but you will not be
allowed to change the enterprise group in any way.
•
If the trial software group is a parent group with children, all of its children will
inherit trial permissions.
198
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
Upload the Software Package and Create a Trial Software Update
Package
To upload the software package and create a trial automatic software update
package
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for the endpoint type of interest.
Click Upload Software Update.
In the Upload Software Update dialog box, verify the endpoint type and
model.
5
If an activation key code is required to activate the software update, click
the Update Requires Key check box and in the Software Update Key
Note
The key is generated from the endpoint serial number and version number, and
Polycom sends it as a text (.txt) file to the customer when new software is
available. Customers can review their key history at
http://support.polycom.com
.
6
7
Enter a meaningful description that will help other users to understand
the purpose of the software update.
To trial the software with the group created previously, select Trial
Software and from the Select Trial Group menu, select the trial group
8
Click OK.
A trial automatic software update package for the endpoint type and
model type appears in the Automatic Software Update list. You can tell it
is a trial package, because the Trial Group column includes your entry.
The next time members of the trial group log into the system, their systems
will be upgraded with the trial software package.
Promote the Trial Software Update Package to Production
If you determine that the trial software update package is acceptable for
production, you can then promote it to production.
To promote a trial software update package to production
1
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Polycom, Inc.
199
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
3
Select the tab for product to update.
Select the software update package of interest and click Promote to
Production.
4
Click Yes to confirm the promotion.
The package becomes a production automatic software update package.
Delete the Trial Software Update Package
If you determine that the trial software update package is unacceptable for
production, you can delete it.
To delete a trial software update package
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for product to update.
Select the software update package of interest and click Delete Software
Update.
4
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The package is removed from the Automatic Software Updates list.
5
6
To return your trial group to the last production version of software, clear
the Allow this version or newer option and click Update.
When all endpoints are back to the last production version of software,
reset your automatic software update policy. See “Set an Automatic
View and Implement Software Updates for Peripherals
For peripherals that permit software updates from the CMA system, you can
download the updates from http://support.polycom.comand make them
available from the CMA system web server. You also configure which updates
are for trial or production use. The following topics describe software updates
for peripherals:
•
•
•
•
Note
When doing peripheral upgrades on redundant systems running Microsoft SQL
Server 2005 or 2008 R1, you may receive an SQL server exception. To resolve this
exception, upload the peripheral upgrade package to the secondary server as well.
200
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
View Software Updates for Peripherals
To view software updates for peripherals
1
2
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for a peripheral.
The tab includes this information.
Field
Description
Production URL
URL where the peripheral can access software
updates configured for production use. The URL
consists of the IP dress of the CMA system plus
/repo.
Trial URL
URL where the peripheral can access software
updates configured for trial use. The URL
consists of the IP dress of the CMA system plus
/repotrial.
Package Name
Displays the name of the software update
package. Updates listed as platform are
updates to the peripheral’s operating system.
Other updates are for specific applications.
Description
The meaningful name given to the software
update package when it was created
Version
Status
The version of the software package
The status of the software update. Possible
values are:
•
None - The software update has not been
configured for production or trial.
•
Production - The software update is
configured for production. It is available only
from the Production URL.
•
•
Trial - The software update is configured for
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.
Both - The software update is configured for
both production and trial. It is available from
both the Production URL and the Trial
URL.
Uploaded
The date and time when the software update
package was uploaded
Polycom, Inc.
201
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Upload Peripheral Software Updates to the CMA Web Server
After you download the software updates from
http://support.polycom.comand save them on your hard drive, you can
upload them to the CMA system web server.
To upload software updates to the CMA system web server
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for the peripheral.
Click Upload Software Update.
In the Select File to Upload dialog box, navigate to and select the
software update that you saved to your hard drive.
5
Click Open.
The update is added to the list on the peripheral tab.
Note
If this is the first update for the platform or an application, the update is
automatically configured for production.
Configure Peripheral Updates for Production
To configure software updates for production
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for the peripheral.
Click Configure Production.
The Configure Production dialog box includes the following information.
Field
Description
Configure Platform
Platform Description
The meaningful name given to the platform
software update package when it was created
202
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
Field
Description
Status
The current status of the platform software
update. Possible values are:
•
None - The software update has not been
configured as production or trial.
•
Production - The software update is
configured as production. It is available only
from the Production URL.
•
•
Trial - The software update is configured as
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.
Both - The software update is configured as
both production and trial. It is available from
both the Production URL and the Trial URL.
Configure Application
Application Description
The meaningful name given to the application
software update package when it was created
Platform Compatible
Status
Column title shows the version of the currently
selected platform. Use the drop-down list to
select available application versions that match
the platform version.
The current status of the application software
update. Possible values are:
•
None - The software update has not been
configured as production or trial.
•
Production - The software update is
configured as production. It is available only
from the Production URL.
•
•
Trial - The software update is configured as
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.
Both - The software update is configured as
both production and trial. It is available from
both the Production URL and the Trial URL.
4
From the Configure Platform section, select the platform version to
configure for production.
You can select only one platform version for production.
5
6
Click Configure Application.
For each application, select the version to configure for production from
the Platform Compatible drop-down list.
The version selected must be compatible with the platform version listed
in the column heading. If the application is not selected (no check mark),
the application will not be configured for production.
Polycom, Inc.
203
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
7
Click OK.
From the peripheral itself, the configured software updates are now
available using the Production URL.
Configure Peripheral Updates for Trial
To configure software updates for trial
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Automatic Software Updates.
Select the tab for the peripheral.
Click Configure Trial.
The Configure Trial dialog box includes the following information.
Field
Description
Configure Platform
Platform Description
The meaningful name given to the platform
software update package when it was created
Status
The current status of the platform software
update. Possible values are:
•
None - The software update has not been
configured as production or trial.
•
Production - The software update is
configured as production. It is available only
from the Production URL.
•
•
Trial - The software update is configured as
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.
Both - The software update is configured as
both production and trial. It is available from
both the Production URL and the Trial
URL.
Configure Application
Application Description
The meaningful name given to the application
software update package when it was created
Platform Compatible
Column title shows the version of the currently
selected platform. Use the drop-down list to
select available application versions that match
the platform version.
204
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
Field
Description
Status
The current status of the application software
update. Possible values are:
•
None - The software update has not been
configured as production or trial.
•
Production - The software update is
configured as production. It is available only
from the Production URL.
•
•
Trial - The software update is configured as
trial. It is available only from the Trial URL.
Both - The software update is configured as
both production and trial. It is available from
both the Production URL and the Trial
URL.
4
From the Configure Platform section, select the platform version to
configure for trial.
You can select only one platform version for trial.
5
6
Click Configure Application.
For each application, select the version to configure for trial from the
Platform Compatible drop-down list.
The version selected must be compatible with the platform version listed
in the column heading. If the application is not selected (no check mark),
the application will not be configured for trial.
7
Click OK.
From the peripheral itself, the configured software updates are now
available using the Trial URL.
Scheduled Software Update Operations
For scheduled software update, it includes these topics:
•
•
•
Polycom, Inc.
205
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
View Scheduled Software Update Information
To view information about software updates that are scheduled or for endpoints
that are eligible for scheduled software updates
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Software Update.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list. Filter choices
include Type, Name, IP Address, ISDN Video Number, Alias, and Site.
3
4
Select the endpoint of interest.
In the Device Details section, expand the Software Update Details tab.
View List of Software Update Packages
To view the list of scheduled software update packages
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Scheduled Software Updates.
The Scheduled Software Updates page appears listing all of the endpoint
types and models for which the CMA system can perform a scheduled
software update. It includes this information. If a software update package
has been uploaded to the system, the Description and Uploaded fields are
populated for the endpoint.
Implement Scheduled Software Updates for Endpoints
To implement a scheduled software update, you must perform this series of
tasks.
1
2
3
4
on page 196. For more information on software update profiles, see
5
List the Serial Numbers for the Endpoints to be Updated
To list the serial numbers for the endpoints to be updated
1
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Scheduled Software Updates.
206
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
2
3
Select the appropriate Endpoint Type and Endpoint Model combination
for the endpoint to update.
Click Get Serial Numbers
.
The Endpoint Serial Number List appears listing the endpoints of the
selected type and model that are eligible for scheduled software updates.
4
5
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the specific endpoints to be updated. To select all endpoints in the
list, click the check box in the column header.
6
7
Click Get Serial Numbers.
The serial number(s) appear in the text box on the page.
When updating a single endpoint:
a
b
Record the serial number:_____________________________________
Click Close.
The Scheduled Software Updates list reappears.
8
When updating multiple endpoints:
a
Copy and paste the serial numbers from the endpoint serial number
list to a .txtfile that you can submit to the Polycom Product
Activation site. Put one serial number per line as shown in the
following example.
82071007E1DACD
82070407E010CD
820418048078B2
82040903E00FB0
b
c
Return to the endpoint serial number list and click Close.
The Scheduled Software Updates list reappears.
be updated. You may include all of the serial numbers for all of the
different endpoint types in the same .txtfile.
d
Save the .txt file.
Download the Required Software Package
To download the software package required to update the endpoints
1
On your local system, create a directory to which to save the software
package (if one does not already exist).
2
For Polycom endpoints:
a
Open a web browser and go to http://support.polycom.com.
Polycom, Inc.
207
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
b
c
In the Downloads section, select the Product and Category for the
required software package.
Select the software package and save it to the directory created in
d
that the software package may contain the software for different
models of the same endpoint type.
3
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended
procedure for downloading a software package. Save it to the directory
Request Update Activation Keys
To request upgrade activation keys
1
For Polycom products
a
b
c
Go to http://support.polycom.com
Log in or Register for An Account.
Select Product Activation.
.
d
In the Software Upgrade KeyCode section, click Retrieve Software
KeyCode.
e
When upgrading a single endpoint:
»
Enter the serial number of the endpoint to be updated into the
Serial Number field of the Single Upgrade Key Code section.
»
Enter the version number to which you are upgrading and click
Retrieve.
»
»
The key code is returned on the screen.
Record the key code and create a .txtfile with the Serial Number
- Key Code combination to be updated.
»
Close the Product Activation screens.
f
When updating multiple endpoints from a prepared .txtfile (step 7
on page 194):
»
»
»
»
In the Multiple Upgrade KeyCode section, click Add
Attachment.
Browse to the location of the .txt file you created in step 7 on
page 194 and click Upload.
A file containing the Serial Number - Key Code combinations will
be E-mailed to the specified E-mail account.
When you receive the .txtfile, save it to your local system.
208
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
»
Close the Product Activation screens.
2
For third-party endpoints, follow the company’s recommended
procedure for requesting an upgrade activation key.
Upload the Software Package and Create a Software Update
Profile
To upload the software package and create an automatic software update
profile
1
2
Go to Admin > Software Updates > Scheduled Software Updates.
On the Software Update Profiles list, click the check box to select the
appropriate Endpoint Type and Endpoint Model combination for the
endpoints to be updated. To select all endpoints in the list, click the check
box in the column header.
3
4
In the Upload Software Update dialog box, verify the endpoint type and
model.
If an activation key code is required to activate the software update, click
Update Requires Key and in the Software Update Key File field browse
Note
The key is generated from the endpoint serial number and version number, and
Polycom sends it as a text (.txt) file to the customer when new software is
available. Customers can review their key history at
http://support.polycom.com.
5
6
Enter a meaningful description that will help other users to understand
the purpose of the software update.
Click OK.
A scheduled software update profile for the endpoint type and model type
is created.
7
server.
Schedule the Software Update for Endpoints
To schedule one or more endpoints for software update
1
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Software Update.
Polycom, Inc.
209
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoints of interest and click Software Update.
In the Schedule Software Update dialog box, specify when the update
should occur.
a
b
c
In the Schedule field, select Now or Later.
If you select Later, enter a Date and Time for the update.
Select either Use Server Date/Time or Use Endpoint Date/Time as
these may differ.
5
Select from these options.
Fields
Description
Remove address
book entries
Select this check box to have all local address book
entries removed after the update.
Remove system files
Select this check box to have all endpoint settings
removed after the update. You must then reconfigure
the endpoint.
Allow endpoint to be
a DHCP server
Select this check box to allow the endpoint to be a
DHCP server.
Applies to V-Series, VSX-Series, and ViewStation
endpoints only. For more information, see the
endpoint’s user guide.
Note
You may apply a single software update request to multiple endpoint models. If the
request includes one or more scheduling options that are not valid for a selected
endpoint model, the system applies only the options that are valid.
6
Click Schedule.
For each endpoint selected, the status changes to Pending and the date
and time for the software update appears in the Scheduled column.
Cancel Software Updates
You can cancel scheduled software updates for an endpoint. You cannot
explicitly cancel automatic software updates for an endpoint. You must do
that at the endpoint.
To cancel scheduled software updates
1
Go to Endpoint > Scheduled Software Update.
210
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Endpoint Software Update Operations
2
3
As needed, use the Filter to customize the endpoint list.
Select the endpoint or endpoints of interest and click Cancel Update.
A confirmation dialog box appears. The dialog box may indicate that one
or more of the selected endpoints had a software update in progress.
4
Click Ok to cancel in progress and future software updates for the
selected endpoints and clear their status.
You can cancel software update operations that are in progress, but you
may wish to check the endpoint afterward to verify it was left in a
operational state.
Polycom, Inc.
211
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
212
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
13
Device Details
This chapter lists the fields found in the Device Detail section of the Polycom®
Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system interface. It includes
these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Device Summary Information
The Device Summary information in the Device Details section includes the
following fields.
Field
Name
Type
Description
The name of the device.
The type of device. For valid device types, see “Endpoint
ID
The system-generated ID for the device.
(Endpoints only) The user associated with the device.
The assigned IP address of the device.
Owner
IP Address
Area
Area with which the device is associated.
Polycom, Inc.
213
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
ISDN Video
Number
For ISDN devices only, the country code + city/area code +
phone number for the device.
When you add an endpoint without native ISDN, the ISDN
gateway, country code, and area code are not captured.
The CMA system only supports native ISDN.
Site
The network site for the device. By default, devices are
added to the Primary Site.
Software Version
The version of the software installed on the device (ASCII
only). The device provides the version number if it
registered successfully or is managed.
Serial Number
The serial number (ASCII only) of the device.The device
provides the serial number if it registered successfully or is
managed.
Available to
Schedule
Select this option to make the device available when users
are scheduling conferences.
Note
The Available to schedule field is disabled for MGC and
RMX devices.
Monitoring Level
(Endpoints only—grayed out for MCU devices.)
The monitoring level for the device. Possible values include:
•
•
Standard. This device is monitored.
VIP. This device is monitored closely. The VIP identifier
and filters are available to operators to monitor and
manage conferences.
Supported
Protocols
The communications protocols that the device can support.
Possible values include:
•
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols used
for multimedia communications on packet-based
networks, such as IP.
•
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols
used for multimedia communications on switched
networks, such as ISDN.
For devices with the type Unknown, select H.323.
The device automatically provides the protocols if it
registered successfully or is managed.
Notes
•
If an endpoint is configured as a gateway (ISDN), only
the H.323 check box is selected. If the endpoint
supports true ISDN, the H.323 and ISDN check boxes
are selected.
•
RMX MCUs support only the H.323 protocol.
214
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Device Details
Field
Description
Capabilities to enable on this device. Options are:
Capabilities
Enabled
•
MCU - The device can act as a control unit for multipoint
conferences
•
Gateway - The device can act as a gateway for call
management
The MCU provides the capability if it registered successfully
or is managed.
Note
Currently, RMX MCUs cannot be Gateway devices.
Alias (type)
The alias to connect to the device. The CMA system
converts the aliases to the IP address associated with the
device.
•
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and
Unknown.
•
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.
Device Status Information
The Device Status information in the Device Details section includes the
following fields.
Field
Description
Gatekeeper
Registration
The status of the device’s registration with the gatekeeper
service. Possible values include:
•
•
Registered
Unregistered
Directory
Registration
The status of the device’s registration with the Global
Directory Service. Possible values include:
•
•
Registered
Unregistered
Presence
Registration
The status of the device’s registration with the presence
service. Possible values include:
•
•
Registered
Unregistered
Exchange
Registration
The status of the device’s registration with the Microsoft
Exchange service.
SIP Registration
The status of the device’s registration with the SIP service.
Polycom, Inc.
215
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Device Managed
Indicates whether or not the CMA system is managing the
device.
Last GK
The date and time of the device’s last gatekeeper
Registration
registration in a default format of mm-dd-yyyy hh:mm:ss
AM | PMwith adjustment to the client-machine GMT offset
Device Local Time
The local time as set within the device in a default format of
hh:mm:ss AM | PM. This field is blank for the following
device types: MGC, RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and
TANDBERG.
ISDN Line Status
Type
The status of the ISDN line. Possible values include:
•
•
Operational
Non-operations
This field is blank for the following device types: PVX, MGC,
RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.
ISDN Assignment
Type
How the ISDN type was assigned to the device. Possible
values include:
•
•
•
Administrator, when the ISDN type was assigned
manually by an administrator
Endpoint, when the ISDN type was natively assigned in
the endpoint
Auto-Assigned, when the ISDN type was automatically
assigned by the CMA system based on the site
configuration
•
•
From Network, when the ISDN type was derived from
the gateway and extension
Undefined, when the CMA system cannot identify the
source for the ISDN type assignment
This field is blank for the following device types: PVX, MGC,
RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.
Device ISDN Type
The ISDN network interface type installed in the device.
Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
ISDN_QUAD_BRI
ISDN_PRI_T1
ISDN_BRI
ISDN_UNKNOWN
This field is blank for the following device types: PVX, MGC,
RMX, GW/MCU, Other, and TANDBERG.
216
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Device Details
Call Information
The Call Info in the Device Details section includes the following fields.
Field
Description
Call Type
The connection protocol for the call in which the device is
participating. Possible values include: H.323, H.320, and
S.IP
Video Protocol
The video connection protocol, both transmission (Tx) and
reception (Rx), the device is using. Possible values include:
•
H.261—H.261 is an ITU standard designed for two-way
communication over ISDN lines and supports data rates
which are multiples of 64Kbit/s. H.261 supports CIF and
QCIF resolutions.
•
•
H.263—H.263 is based on H.261 with enhancements
that improve video quality over modems. It supports
CIF, QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and 16CIF resolutions.
H.264
Video Format
Audio Protocol
The video format, both transmission (Tx) and reception
(Rx), the device is using.
The audio connection protocol, both transmission (Tx) and
reception (Rx), the device is using. Possible values include:
•
•
•
G.711
G.722
G.728
Far Site Name
The H.323ID of the far site device to which the selected
endpoint is connected. When multiple endpoints are
connected through the device's embedded MCU, this field
displays a concatenation of each endpoint's H.323ID
separated by ' | ', for example 'ISDN-CO1-7-1 | Vsfx-9-1'.
Far Site Number
The address of the far site device to which the selected
endpoint is connected. The address value for the calling
device appears to be the dialed address. The address value
for the called device appears to be the IP Address.
Cause Code
Encryption
Standard H.323 cause code that reflects normal call
termination or the nature of an internal failure, for example,
'16' or '211'.
The status of encryption for the call. Possible values
include: Off, Disabled, AES, and DH-1024
Polycom, Inc.
217
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Device Alerts Information
The Device Alerts information in the Device Details section includes the
following fields.
Field
Description
Errors
Device error message text, for example, GK Registration
error
Warnings
Device warning message text, for example, Low Battery
Provisioning Details
The Provisioning Details information in the Device Details section includes
the following fields.
Field
Description
Last Profile Applied
The name of the last provisioning profile that was or was not
successfully applied to the device. The Provisioning
Status will be either Success or Failed.
Provisioning Status
The device’s current provisioning status. Possible values
include:
•
•
•
•
Clear. No provisioning has been done.
Pending. Provisioning is scheduled for this device.
In Progress. The device is currently being provisioned.
Success. Provisioning has been completed
successfully on this device.
•
Failed. Provisioning was not completed on this device.
Some endpoint systems expect all configuration fields to be
provisioned. If any of the fields are not provisioned, the
status will indicate failed. However, the endpoint will often
function successfully.
Pending Profile
Scheduled
The name of the provisioning profile that is scheduled to be
applied to the device. In this case, the Provisioning Status
will be either Pending or In Progress.
This field is blank if the device is not scheduled for
provisioning.
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd
hh:mm, when the device is scheduled to be provisioned.
This field is blank if the device is not scheduled for
provisioning.
218
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Device Details
Field
Description
Last Attempt
Date/Time
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd
hh:mm:ss, of the last provisioning message exchanged with
the device.
Failure Reason
A text description of the reason the provisioning failed.
Causes for failure include:
•
•
The provisioning profile does not exist
The provisioning profile does not include provisioning
information
•
•
The CMA system no longer manages the device
A password for the device is set in the video endpoint
system, and you must enter it in the CMA system
•
•
•
The device is busy
A network error occurred
An incomplete transfer of provisioning information
occurred
•
•
Provisioning has timed out
An internal error occurred on the device, and you must
reboot it
•
An unknown error occurred. Reboot the device.
Log Message
A read-only text box that contains messages related to the
device provisioning status
Software Update Details
The Software Update Details information in the Device Details section
includes the following fields.
Field
Description
Software Update
Status
The device’s software update status. Possible values
include:
•
•
Clear. A software update has not been done.
Pending. A software update has been scheduled and is
pending. The device may be offline or in a call.
•
•
In Progress. The software update is in progress.
Success. A software update has completed
successfully.
•
Failed. A software update could not be performed.
Polycom, Inc.
219
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Scheduled
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd
hh:mm, when the device software is scheduled to be
updated.
This field is blank if the device is not scheduled for
provisioning.
Last Attempt
Date/Time
The date and time, in the default format of yyyy-mm-dd
hh:mm:ss, of the last software update message exchanged
with the device.
Failure Reason
A text description of the reason the software update failed.
Causes for failure may include:
•
•
The software update file location does not exist.
A password for the device is set in the video endpoint
system, and you must enter it in CMA.
•
•
•
A network error has occurred.
The update has timed out.
An internal error occurred on the device, and you must
reboot it.
•
•
•
•
A profile has not been configured.
An endpoint is offline.
An incorrect activation key is in the key file.
An unknown error has occurred. Reboot the device
Log Message
A read-only text box that contains the log message text
recorded during the execution of the software update.
Note that there are no log messages displayed for
dynamically-managed endpoints.
220
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
14
Network Device Management
Overview
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system’s network device management functions. It
includes these topics:
•
•
Network Device Types
A CMA system supports these network device types:
•
•
•
•
Polycom MGC conferencing bridges
Polycom RMX conferencing bridges
Polycom Distributed Management Application™ (DMA®) systems
Polycom Video Border Proxy (VBP) systems
Network Device Menu, Views, and Lists
The CMA system Network Device menu provides these views of the network
device list:
•
•
Monitor View—Displays the list of all manageable and registered
network devices. Use this view to manage network devices.
VBPs (Video Border Proxy systems)—Displays the list of Polycom VBP
systems registered to the CMA system. Use this view to add, edit, or delete
VBP systems.
Polycom, Inc.
221
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
MCUs (Microprocessing Control Units)—Displays the list of Polycom
MCUs (Polycom RMX or MGC conferencing platforms) registered to the
CMA system. Use this view to add, edit, or delete MCUs.
•
DMAs (Distributed Management Application systems)—Displays the list
of Polycom DMA systems) registered to the CMA system. Use this view to
add, edit, or delete DMA systems.
All of the Network Device views have the following information:
Section
Views
Description
The views you can access from the page
The set of available commands. The constant command in
Actions
the Network Device views is Refresh
, which updates
the display with current information.
Network Device List The context-sensitive Network Device list for the selected
view
Device Details
Information about the network device selected in the
network device list including:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Monitor View
Use the Network Device > Monitor View to monitor the network devices.
Network Device List in the Monitor View
By default, the Network Device list in the Monitor View displays a list of
network devices the CMA system monitors, including those devices that
registered automatically with the CMA system and those devices that were
added manually for management and monitoring purposes.
The Network Device list in the Monitor View includes MCUs and Polycom
DMA nodes. It does not include Polycom VBP devices.
The Network Device list in the Monitor View displays MCUs as two separate
Device Types, the MCU type and a GW/MCU device. If automatic registration
is allowed, individual H.323 cards and/or IP blades in Polycom MCUs are
assigned the device type of GW/MCU during registration. This device type
represents the cards’ network interface. If automatic registration is not
allowed, you must add a GW/MCU device record for each H.323 card and IP
blade.
222
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Network Device Management Overview
The Network Device list has these fields.
Field
Description
Filter
Use the filter choices to display other views of the Network
Device list, which include:
•
•
•
Type- Filters the list by device type. For more
Alerts- Filters the list by alert type: Help, Error, or
Warning
Connection Status- Filters the list by connection
status: In a Call, Online, or Offline
•
•
•
•
•
Name - Filters the list by system name entered
IP Address - Filters the list by IP address entered
Alias - Filters the list by the alias entered
Site - Filters the list by site location entered
Area - Available only when Areas are enabled. Filters
the list by the area with which the device is associated.
Status
The state of the network device. Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Online
Offline
In a call
Unknown
Device alert
Gatekeeper registration error
Name
Type
The system name of the network device
The type of network device. For valid device types, see
IP Address
Site
The IP address assigned to the network device
The site to which the network device belongs
The alias assigned to the network device
Alias
Area
Available only when Areas are enabled. The area with
which the network device is associated.
Polycom, Inc.
223
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Actions in the Monitor View
Besides providing access to the network device views, the Actions section of
the Monitor View may also include these context-sensitive commands
depending on the selected device type.
Action
Use this action to...
Available for all device types
Add
Manually add a network device to the CMA system or find a
network device on the network
View
Display all of the Device Details for the selected network
Details
device
Edit
Change connection settings for the selected network
device. Note that if this is a managed device, the device
may overwrite settings entered manually.
Delete
Delete the selected network devices
Associate Area
Available only when Areas are enabled. Associate the
selected network device to an area so that only specified
users can manage it.
Available for only selected network device types
Manage Open the selected network device’s management interface
in a separate browser window. This command is not
available for the following device types: MGC, GW/MCU,
and Other.
VBP View
Use the VBP View to manage Polycom Video Border Proxy™ (VBP™) firewall
devices on the network.
Polycom VBP devices, when installed at the edge of the operations center,
secures critical voice, video, and data infrastructure components including
VoIP softswitches, video gatekeepers, gateways, media servers, and
endpoints.
The VBP list has the following information.
Field
Description
Name
A unique name to identify the Polycom VBP device.
The model of Polycom VBP device.
Model
Provider-side IP
The private network IP address for the Polycom VBP
device.
224
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Network Device Management Overview
Field
Description
Subscriber-side IP
The public network IP address for the Polycom VBP
device.
MCU View
DMA View
Use the MCU View to manage Polycom MCU conferencing platforms on the
network.
The MCU list has the same fields as the Network Device > Monitor view. For
The Polycom® Distributed Media Application (DMA) system is a multipoint
conferencing manager that uses advanced routing policies to distribute voice
and video calls among multiple media servers (Multipoint Control Units, or
MCUs), creating a single virtual resource pool. This greatly simplifies video
conferencing resource management and uses MCU resources more efficiently.
Use the DMA View to manage DMA systems v2.3 or earlier. These earlier
versions of the DMA system register with the CMA system as a
Gateway/MCU and can be displayed in the DMA list.
The DMA list has the following information.
Field
Description
Name
A unique name for the DMA system.
The virtual IP address for the DMA system.
Virtual IP Address
Dial Prefix
E.164 dial string prefix for calling the system. Must be
unique among the gatekeeper’s devices and services.
For more information, see the Polycom DMA 7000
System Operations Guide.
Description
A useful description for the DMA system.
IMPORTANT
Newer versions of the DMA system (v3.0 or greater) include call server functionality
(H.323 gatekeeper and SIP proxy/registrar). For that reason, these DMA systems
do not register with the CMA system as a Gateway/MCU and should not be added
to the CMA system as a network device. Instead, these DMA system should be
added to the CMA system as a trusted neighbor.
Polycom, Inc.
225
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
226
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
15
MCU Bridge Management
Operations
This chapter describes how to perform the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system MCU bridge management tasks. It includes
these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
View Device Details
To view detailed information about a managed MCU bridge
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
Select the MCU of interest and click View Details
.
Polycom, Inc.
227
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The Device Details dialog box for the selected MCU appears.
Field
Description
Identification
System Name
The name of the MCU.
•
•
MCU names must be unique.
The name must be in ASCII only and may have an
unlimited number of characters. Spaces, dashes,
and underscores are valid.
•
When retrieved from the MCU, the name is taken
from the H.323 ID if the MCU registered with the
gatekeeper and it is a third-party system. In other
cases, it is the system name, which might be
different than the H.323 ID.
Device Type
The type of MCU. For valid types, see “Network Device
IP Address
Site
The assigned IP address of the MCU
The network site for the MCU. By default, MCUs are
added to the Primary Site.
Product ID
Description
A free-form text field (Extended ASCII only) in which
information about the MCU can be added
Serial Number
Software Version
HTTP URL
The serial number (ASCII only) of the MCU.The MCU
provides the serial number if it registered successfully or
is managed.
The version of the software installed on the MCU (ASCII
only). The MCU provides the version number if it
registered successfully or is managed.
(RMX MCUs only) The management URL for the
endpoint, if available (ASCII only). This URL allows the
CMA system to start the endpoint ‘s management
system using the Manage function.
All Polycom endpoints allow device management
through a browser. For these endpoints, this field is
completed when the endpoint registers with the CMA
system.
For third-party endpoints that do not register using an IP
address, you must enter the URL.
HTTP Port
(RMX MCUs only) The HTTP port number for the MCU
communications. The MCU provides the port number if it
registered successfully and is managed.
By default, in non-secure (HTTP) mode, the RMX uses
port 80 and in secure (HTTPS) mode, the RMX uses port
443.
228
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MCU Bridge Management Operations
Field
Description
Addresses
DNS Name
Aliases
The DNS name for the MCU.
The aliases that allow you to connect to the MCU. The
CMA system converts the aliases to the IP address
associated with the MCU.
•
Alias Type. Possible types include E.164, H.323 ID,
URL, Transport Address, E-mail, Party Number, and
Unknown.
•
•
Alias Value. Value for the alias type shown.
The value for the H.323 ID is the MCU name if the
MCU registered with the gatekeeper and it is a
third-party system. In other cases, the MCU name is
the system name, which might be different from the
H323 ID.
Notes
•
To add aliases for the MCU, edit the MCU.
•
The following Alias Values are ASCII only: H323 ID,
URL, Transport Address, and Unknown.
ISDN Video
Number
The country code + city/area code + phone number for
the MCU.
Capabilities
Supported
Protocols
The communications protocols that the MCU can
support. Possible values include:
•
IP (H.323) - A standard that defines the protocols
used for multimedia communications on
packet-based networks, such as IP.
•
ISDN (H.320) - A standard that defines the protocols
used for multimedia communications on switched
networks, such as ISDN.
The MCU automatically provides the protocols if it
registered successfully or is managed.
Capabilities
Enabled
Capabilities to enable on this MCU. Options are:
•
MCU - The device can act as a control unit for
multipoint conferences
•
Gateway - (MGC MCUs only) The device can act as
a gateway for call management
The MCU provides the capability if it registered
successfully or is managed.
Available to
Schedule
Select this option to make the MCU available to users
who are scheduling conferences
Monitoring Level
Not applicable to MCU devices.
Polycom, Inc.
229
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
MCU (Network) Services
Service Type
The available network services may include:
•
•
•
H.323 Service—Indicates a connection to an IP
network using the H.323 protocol.
H.320 Service—Indicates a connection to an ISDN
phone line using the H.320 protocol.
Gateway Service—(MGC MCUs only) Indicates a
connection to both IP and ISDN to enable conversion
from one protocol to the other.
•
Direct Service—Indicates a direct connection
between an MCU and a video endpoint system,
using a serial cable.
Service Name
Priority
A descriptive name for the network service.
The priority set for the network service as compared to
other services when it was created.
MCU Resources
Max Total
Conferences
Maximum number of total conferences allowed at once
on this MCU.
Max CP
Conferences
Maximum number of continuous presence (CP)
conferences allowed, based on the number of licenses
available.
Max Video Ports
(RMX MCUs only)
Max Total
Participants
Maximum number of total MCU participants allowed at
once on this MCU.
Max Transcoding
Ports
(MGC MCUs only) Maximum number of transcoding
ports on which both ISDN and IP participants can be
connected.
Use Entry Queue
Indicates whether the MGC device supports an IVR.
Entry Queue
Number ID
The IP number that conference participants dial to
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.
Max Bandwidth
Capacity (Kbps)
The maximum bandwidth supported by the Polycom
RMX MCU.
230
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MCU Bridge Management Operations
Field
Description
Alerts (RMX MCUs only)
Category
Lists the type of error. The following categories may be
listed:
•
File – indicates a problem in one of the files stored on
the MCU’s hard disk.
•
•
•
•
Card – indicates problems with a card.
Exception – indicates software errors.
General – indicates a general error.
Assert – indicates internal software errors that are
reported by the software program.
•
Startup – indicates errors that occurred during
system startup.
•
•
Unit – indicates problems with a unit.
MPL - indicates an error related to a Shelf
Management component (MPL component) other
than an MPM, RTM or switch board.
Level
Code
Indicates the severity of the problem, or the type of
event. There are three fault level indicators:
•
•
•
Major Error
System Message
Startup Event
Indicates the problem, as identified by the error category
Card Alerts (MGC MCUs only)
Slot
Displays an icon according to the HW component type
and the slot number. The icon displays the hardware
status as follows:
•
•
•
An exclamation point (!) indicates errors in the HW
component.
Card icon with the reset button () indicates that the
HW component is currently resetting.
Card icon with diagnostic tools () indicates that the
HW component is in diagnostic mode.
Type
The type of hardware card
Polycom, Inc.
231
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Add an MCU Manually
This topic describes how to add an MCU to a CMA system.
Note
Back-end communication with the RMX control units and IP service blades must be
enabled.
When you add an MCU device, MCU network services are added
automatically at the time the IP card registers with the CMA system.
When you add a gateway device, use the Services page to specify the network
services available for the device.
Notes
•
Polycom RMX devices may only have H.323 service.
•
Once an MCU registers with the CMA system, if you change an MCU service on
the MCU, the update does not automatically get sent to the CMA system. To
update the system, you must delete and read the MCU to the system.
•
These network services are not the same as the Dial Plan Services such as
Simplified Dialing and Conference on Demand. Network services describe
the physical connection that the device supports. Dial plan services provide
access to specific features used for routing calls by dialing a prefix.
When you enter network service information manually, remember that the
CMA system does not create the service at the device. The service must have
already been defined at the device. Enter information in the CMA system that
matches the information in the device.
If you do not define network services, you may not use an MCU or gateway in
a conference. For example, if you do not define the H.323 service on the MCU,
when the CMA system tries to schedule a video conference that requires this
service, it will look for another MCU with this service. If another MCU with
this service is not available, the conference will not be scheduled.
To add an MCU bridge to a CMA system or find an MCU on the network
1
2
Go to Network Device > MCUs and click Add
.
In the Add New Device dialog box, select the Device Type of interest.
3
4
Enter the IP Address of the MCU.
Enter the Admin ID and Password for the MCU.
232
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MCU Bridge Management Operations
5
Click Find Device.
— If the CMA system can find the MCU on the network, the Add New
Device dialog box is populated with information retrieved from the
MCU. Review any information retrieved from the MCU.
— If the CMA system cannot find the MCU on the network, a Device Not
Found dialog box appears.
6
7
Click OK.
Complete the Identification, Addresses, Capabilities, MCU Services,
MCU Resources, and MCU Cascading sections of the Add New Device
Note
When naming an RMX system, use lowercase letters to specify the FQDN in the
System Name field.
Pay particular attention to the Capabilities options, because the settings
on it determine how the MCU is used throughout the CMA system.
8
Click Add.
The MCU appears in the Network Device list. By default, the system:
— Adds the MCU to the applicable site
— Sets the HTTP Port to 80
— Adds an Alias for the endpoint
— Makes the endpoint Available to Schedule
— Sets the Monitoring Level to Standard
Notes
•
In the Device List, a CMA system displays a single MCU as two separate
Device Types (an RMX or MGC device and a GW/MCU device). The GW/MCU
designation represents the network interface.
•
For third-party endpoints, the HTTP URL, serial number, and DNS name are not
captured during endpoint registration.
Edit an MCU Bridge
To edit an MCU from the CMA system
1
2
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
Polycom, Inc.
233
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
4
Select the MCU of interest and click Edit
.
Complete the Identification, Addresses, Capabilities, MCU Services,
MCU Resources, and MCU Cascading sections of the Edit Device dialog
minimum, assign the MCU a System Name.
5
Click Update.
Enable Cascading Conferences on Polycom MCUs
To enable multi-bridge conferences, you must complete the following steps:
1
Configure entry queues on the participating MCUs. Only bridges with
entry queues are displayed in the list of available bridges to schedule on
the people-to-bridge or bridge-to-bridge scheduling page.
To configure cascading using a Polycom RMX MCU, you must create two
cascading entry queues—one for which the Master option on the Cascade
menu is selected and one for which the Slave option on the Cascade menu
is selected. Also, enable the Use Entry Queue selection.
The primary purpose for the Master and Slave designation is to determine
which Polycom RMX MCU is responsible for managing People + Content
for the conference.
2
Configure MCU Cascading for each MCU on the CMA system by editing
each MCU and referencing the appropriate entry queue ID and ISDN
numbers.
Some notes about cascading MCUs:
•
•
A Polycom RMX 1000 MCU cannot be used for cascading.
All devices (MCUs and endpoints) in a cascaded conference must be
registered to the same CMA system gatekeeper.
•
•
All systems (the CMA system, MCUs, and endpoints) must be time
synchronized.
Since ISDN cascade links on Polycom RMX MCUs are not supported, do
not select Enable ISDN/PSTN Access. The CMA system only supports
cascaded IP links on Polycom RMX MCUs. It does not support cascaded
ISDN links on Polycom RMX MCUs.
•
Polycom RMX systems enforce a 1x1 layout for the cascaded link between
bridges, so only one participant on each bridge is displayed at any time.
To change this on a Polycom RMX system, go to Setup > System
Configuration and on the MCMS_PARAMETERS_USER page add a
new flag called FORCE_1X1_LAYOUT_ON_CASCADED_LINK_CONNECTION
with a Value of NO
.
234
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MCU Bridge Management Operations
To enable cascading conferences
1
On the MCUs, configure entry queues as required and record the entry
queue number(s). For more information, see the product documentation
for the MCU.
2
3
4
5
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
Select the MCU of interest and click Edit
.
Go to the MCU Resources section of the Edit Device dialog box and
select Use Entry Queue.
6
7
Go to the MCU Cascading section of the Edit Device dialog box.
For a Polycom RMX MCU:
a
Enter the Master Entry Queue Number ID and Slave Entry Queue
Number ID.
b
(Optional) Enter the Master Entry Queue ISDN Number and Slave
Entry Queue ISDN Number.
8
9
For a Polycom MGC MCU:
a
b
Enter the Cascade Entry Queue Number ID.
(Optional) Enter the Cascade Entry Queue ISDN Number.
Click Update.
Delete an MCU Bridge
To delete an MCU from the CMA system
1
2
3
4
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
Select the MCU of interest and click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The MCU list is updated.
View Bridge Hardware
To view the hardware configuration of a bridge
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
1
Polycom, Inc.
235
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
3
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Hardware.
A Hardware pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the hardware for
the selected bridge and displays the Slot number, Card Type, Status,
Temperature, and Voltage for each piece of hardware.
View Bridge Services
To view the network services available on the bridge
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Services.
A Services pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the network services
for the selected bridge and identifies the Service Type, Service Name, and
the default setting for the network service.
View Bridge Conferences
To view information about the conferences resident on the bridge
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Conferences.
A Conferences pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the conferences
for the selected bridge and identifies the conference Status, Type, Name,
Start Time, Bridge, and Owner.
View Bridge Ports
To view information about the bridge ports
1
2
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
236
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MCU Bridge Management Operations
3
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Ports.
A Ports pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the ports for the selected
bridge and identifies the Audio Ports Available, Video Ports Available,
Audio Ports in Use, and Video Ports in Use.
View Bridge Meeting Rooms
To view information about meeting rooms on a bridge
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Meeting
Rooms.
A Meeting Rooms pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the meeting
rooms for the selected bridge and identifies the meeting room by Name,
ID, Duration, Conference, Chairperson, Profile.
View Bridge Entry Queues
To view information about entry queues on a bridge
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Entry
Queues.
An Entry Queues pane appears below the bridge list. It lists the entry
queues for the selected bridge and identifies the entry queue by Name, ID,
Profile, and Dial-In Number.
View Bridge Gateway Conferences
To view information about gateway conferences on a bridge
Go to Network Device > MCUs.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the MCU list.
1
2
Polycom, Inc.
237
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
In the MCU list, select the bridge of interest and click View Gateway
Conferences.
If the feature is available on the bridge, a Gateway Conferences pane
appears below the bridge list. It lists the gateway conferences for the
selected bridge.
238
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
16
Management Operations for Other
Network Devices
This chapter describes how to perform the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system network device management tasks. It includes:
•
•
Polycom VBP Management Operations
The Polycom Video Border Proxy (VBP) device management operations
include these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
Polycom, Inc.
239
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Add a Polycom VBP Device
IMPORTANT
When you add a new Polycom VBP device, the CMA system will restart the user
interface web service. This will interrupt others using the CMA system user
interface.
To add a Polycom VBP device to a CMA system
1
2
Go to Network Device > VBPs and click Add
.
Configure these settings in the Add VBP dialog box.
Column
Description
Name
A unique name to identify the Polycom VBP device.
Provider-side IP
The Private Network IP address for the Polycom
VBP device.
Subscriber-side IP
The Public Network IP address for the Polycom VBP
device.
3
4
Click OK.
A system dialog box appears indicating that you must restart Apache for
the settings to take affect. You also have the opportunity to add another
Polycom VBP device.
Click Restart Apache.
The Polycom VBP device is added to the CMA system. However, more
configuration may be necessary for the device to operate in your network.
For example, you will probably need to “Copy the CMA System
Certificate to a Polycom VBP Device” as described in the next topic.
Copy the CMA System Certificate to a Polycom VBP Device
To copy the CMA system certificate to a Polycom VBP device
1
2
Go to Network Device > VBPs
Select the Polycom VBP device of interest and click Copy Certificate to
VBP.
In the Copy Certificate to VBP dialog box, the system automatically
populates the Filename field with the filename of the CMA system
certificate and the Username field with root.
240
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management Operations for Other Network Devices
3
Enter the SSH or console Password for the root user and click OK.
The Polycom VBP device appears in the Network Device list.
Edit a Polycom VBP Device
To edit a Polycom VBP device
1
2
3
4
Go to Network Device > VBPs
Select the Polycom VBP device of interest and click Edit
.
Configure these settings as needed in the Edit VBP dialog box.
Click OK.
Delete a Polycom VBP Device
To delete a Polycom VBP device from a CMA system
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > VBPs.
Select the Polycom VBP device of interest and click Delete
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
.
Identify Endpoints Using the Polycom VBP Device
Note
This procedure identifies only Polycom HDX, Polycom RealPresence Group Series,
and CMA Desktop systems that are:
•
•
•
Registered to the CMA system
Using the Polycom VBP firewall
Operating in dynamic-management mode.
One Polycom HDX or legacy endpoint system operating in standard management
mode, registered to the CMA system, and using the Polycom VBP firewall may also
be displayed in the Endpoint list. This entry may represent multiple endpoints,
since all Polycom HDX or legacy endpoint system operating in standard
management mode register with the same information.
To identify which endpoints are using the Polycom VBP firewall
1
2
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View.
Click Select Filter and select IP Address.
Polycom, Inc.
241
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
Enter the provider-side IP address of the Polycom VBP device and press
Enter.
The Endpoint list displays the dynamically-managed endpoints that are
registered to the CMA system and using the Polycom VBP firewall. All of
the endpoints display the same IP address, which is the Provider-side IP
address of the Polycom VBP device. However, the endpoints will have
different aliases and owners.
Polycom DMA Management Operations
The Polycom DMA device management operations includes these topics:
•
•
•
Add a Polycom DMA System
IMPORTANT
Newer versions of the DMA system (v3.0 or greater) should not be added to the
CMA system in this way. They include call server functionality (H.323 gatekeeper
and SIP proxy/registrar), so they do not register with the CMA system as a
Gateway/MCU. Instead, these DMA system should be added to the CMA system as
a trusted neighbor.
To add DMA system
1
2
Go to Network Device > DMAs and click Add
.
In the Add DMA dialog box, enter a unique and identifying Name and
Description for the DMA system.
3
4
Enter the E.164 dial string prefix for calling the system.
Click Add.
The DMA system appears in the Network Device list.
Edit a Polycom DMA System
To edit a DMA system
1
2
Go to Network Device > DMAs.
Select the DMA system of interest and click Edit
.
242
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management Operations for Other Network Devices
3
4
In the Edit DMA dialog box, edit the Name, Description or Dial Prefix
for the DMA system.
Click OK.
Delete a Polycom DMA System
To delete a DMA system from a CMA system
1
2
3
Go to Network Device > DMAs.
Select the DMA system of interest and click Delete
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
.
View Registered DMA Nodes
Logically, the Polycom DMA system is a cooperative two-node cluster. When
the CMA system is the gatekeeper for a DMA system (v2.3 and earlier) both
nodes register with the CMA system and can accept and process calls.
The CMA system routes calls destined for the Polycom DMA system to the
first node that it finds available. If the first node isn’t available, it automatically
routes the call to the second node.
To view the registered DMA nodes
1
2
Go to Network Device > DMAs.
Click View DMA Nodes.
The DMA Node List appears on the DMA page. It includes these columns
Field
Description
Name
The name of the DMA system node as sent at
registration.
IP Address
Serial Number
Site
The IP address of the DMA system node as sent at
registration.
The serial number of the DMA system node as sent
at registration.
The location of the DMA system node as sent at
registration.
Gatekeeper Status
The status of the DMA system node.
Polycom, Inc.
243
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
244
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
17
MCU Bridge Device Details
This chapter lists the fields found in the MCU Device Detail section of the
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system interface.
It includes:
•
•
•
•
•
MCU H.320 Services
Field
Description
MCU H.32O Service
Service Name
Channels
Name of the H.320 ISDN service
Number of 64K channels dedicated to the MCU
Number Range
Dial-in number range of service. These ISDN numbers are
available on an MCU for all endpoints to use. Also called
direct inward dialing (DID).
LCR Table
The least-cost routing table for calls made through this
gateway
Local Prefix
The prefix required to place a call to a local number outside
the enterprise. For example, if you dial 9 to reach an
outside line, the Local Prefix is 9.
Non-Local Prefix
The prefix required to dial long distance. For example, in
certain states in the United States, you must dial 1 before
you can dial a non-local number.
Polycom, Inc.
245
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
International Prefix
The prefix required to dial an international number. For
example, in many countries, the international prefix is 00.
Local Area Code
Priority
A list of local area codes, separated by commas
The priority order for this service
MCU H.323 Services
Field
Description
Service Name
The name of the H.323 service (ASCII only) defined in
the MCU.
Dialing Prefix
Prefix to select this service.
The prefix for the MGC is located in the H.323 Service
Properties dialog box of the MGC Manager.
Service IP Address
Alias
IP address associated with this network service and
with this H.323 card in the MCU.
Alias for the service defined in the MCU.
Note
Polycom recommends using E.164 as the alias for this
service.
The number is dialed if the endpoints are registered
with the same gatekeeper. If the endpoints are not
registered with the same gatekeeper, they use their
assigned IP address to connect.
Port
Number of IP connections available.
The priority order for this service.
Priority
246
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MCU Bridge Device Details
MCU Gateway Services
Field
Description
Service Name
Dialing Prefix
The name of the H.323 service defined in the MCU.
Prefix to select this service.
The prefix for the MGC is located in the H.323 Service
Properties dialog box of the MGC Manager.
H320 Service Name
Select a defined H320 service.
Channels
Priority
Number of 64K channels dedicated to the MCU.
The priority order for this service.
MCU Resources—Polycom MGC Platform
Field
Description
Max Total Conferences
Maximum number of total conferences allowed at
once on this MCU.
Max CP Conferences
Maximum number of continuous presence (CP)
conferences allowed, based on the number of
licenses available.
Max Total Participants
Max Transcoding Ports
Maximum number of total MCU participants
allowed at once on this MCU.
Maximum number of transcoding ports on which
both ISDN and IP participants can be connected.
Total IP Parties
(Embedded MCU devices)
Maximum number of IP calls that can be made
from this endpoint.
Total ISDN Parties
(Embedded MCU devices)
Maximum number of ISDN calls that can be made
from this endpoint.
Total Transcoded Parties
(Embedded MCU devices)
Maximum number of transcoded calls (IP and ISDN
calls combined) that can be made from this
endpoint.
Use Entry Queue
Indicates whether the MGC device supports an
IVR.
Entry Queue Number ID
Entry Queue ISDN Number
The IP number that conference participants dial to
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.
The ISDN-allocated phone number of the IVR.
ISDN devices only.
Polycom, Inc.
247
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
MCU Resources—Polycom RMX Platform
Field
Description
Max Total Conferences
Maximum number of total conferences allowed at
once on this MCU.
Max CP Conferences
Maximum number of continuous presence (CP)
conferences allowed, based on the number of
licenses available.
Max Video Ports
Maximum number of video ports on which
participants can be connected.
Max Total Participants
Use Entry Queue
Maximum number of total video participants
allowed at once on this MCU.
Indicates whether the RMX device supports an
IVR.
Entry Queue Number ID
Entry Queue ISDN Number
The number that conference participants dial to
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.
The number that conference participants dial to
access the IVR prompt to join a conference.
Audio & Video Settings: The following parameters must be set manually to
synchronize with the RMX device. See the RMX documentation for more
information about these settings.
Max Voice Ports
Set this to the maximum number of audio ports
configured on the RMX device.
Refer to the RMX 2000/4000 Administrator’s Guide
for more information about this field.
Note
Up to 10 blocks of RMX video ports can be
converted to 50 audio-only ports, up to a maximum
of 200 audio-only ports.
Max CP Resolution
Set this to the highest available video format.
Choices are: HD1080, CIF, SD15, SD30, and
HD720.
Refer to the RMX 2000/4000 Administrator’s Guide
for more information about this field.
Max Bandwidth Capacity
(Kbps)
The maximum bandwidth to the Polycom RMX
system.
248
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
18
Users and Groups Overview
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system users and groups management structure. It
includes these topics:
•
•
•
Overview of Groups, Users, and User Roles
The CMA system allows users assigned the Administrator role to manage
users, groups, user roles, permissions, and areas (if applicable).
Most often, a CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory from
which users are imported. However, the CMA system also allows
administrators to add local users (that is, users added manually to the system)
and associate them with endpoints, groups, and roles.
Users
Local Users
When you manually add local users, the CMA system manages all user
information and associations.
At a minimum, when you manually add users, you must enter a user’s First
Name or Last Name, User ID, and Password. When you enter the minimum
information, the CMA system automatically assigns local users the basic
Scheduler role, unless you remove that assignment. They can then schedule
conferences, be scheduled into conferences, and call into conferences.
However, the system cannot call out to them until they are associated with
endpoints.
Polycom, Inc.
249
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
You should associate local users with one or more roles and associate them
with one or more endpoints. Alternatively, you can associate local users with
roles by associating them with local groups.
If your company has implemented the Areas feature, you can also associate
local users with areas for which you are an administrator. For more
Enterprise Users
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, the CMA
system manages only the following pieces of an enterprise users’ information:
the endpoints, roles, alert profiles, and areas assigned to them. The remaining
information is pulled from the enterprise directory.
Notes
•
Currently, the CMA system supports only a Microsoft Active Directory
implementation of an LDAP directory.
•
The CMA system displays a user’s City, Title, and Department to help
distinguish between users with the same name.
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, users
imported into the system through the enterprise directory are by default
added to the system without a role. This default set up allows users to log into
the CMA system with their enterprise user IDs and passwords. They can then
be scheduled into conferences and call into conferences. However, the system
cannot call out to them until they are associated with endpoints.
To be fully functional, you must associate enterprise users with one or more
roles to control their access to system functions and associate them with one or
more endpoints. Alternatively, you can associate enterprise users with roles by
associating them with local or enterprise groups.
If your company has implemented the Areas feature, you can also associate
enterprise users with areas for which you are an administrator. For more
If you want the CMA system to, by default, automatically assign enterprise
users the basic Scheduler role, you must change the appropriate system
Groups
Groups provide a more efficient and consistent use of the CMA system,
because they allow you to assign roles and provisioning profiles to sets of
users rather than to individual users.
250
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Users and Groups Overview
Local Groups
The CMA system allows you to add local groups (that is, groups added
manually to the system) and associate them with provisioning profiles and
roles.
For local groups, the CMA system manages all group information and
associations.
Enterprise Groups
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, groups
defined to the enterprise directory are not automatically added to the CMA
system, but you can import them into the system.
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, the system
manages only three pieces of group information: the provisioning profile
assigned to the group, the roles assigned to the group, and whether or not the
group is Directory Viewable (that is, displayed in endpoint directories). The
remaining group information is pulled from the enterprise directory.
To take full advantage of the CMA system, the enterprise Microsoft Active
Directory must:
•
Have Global Catalog turned ON. The Global Catalog enables searching for
Active Directory objects in any domain without the need for subordinate
referrals, and users can find objects of interest quickly without having to
know what domain holds the object.
•
•
Use universal groups. The Global Catalog stores the member attributes of
universal groups only. It does not store local or global group attributes.
Have a login account that has read access to all domains in the Active
Directory that the CMA system can use. We recommend an account with
a administrative username and a non-expiring password.
•
Have the Active Directory Domain Name Service correctly configured.
For more information about Active Directory design and deployment, see
the Microsoft best practices guides at http://technet.microsoft.com.
For system and endpoint directory performance purposes, two best practices
in regards to enterprise groups are:
•
•
Do not import more than 500 enterprise groups into a CMA system.
Do not mark more than 200 enterprise groups as Directory Viewable.
Polycom, Inc.
251
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Roles and Permissions
The CMA system is a role and permissions based system.
•
Users are assigned one or more user roles either directly or through their
group associations.
•
•
User roles are assigned a set of permissions.
Users see only the pages and functions available to their roles and
associated permissions. Permissions are cumulative, so users see all of the
pages and functions assigned to all of their roles and associated
permissions.
Notes
•
Users inherit roles from their parent groups—local or enterprise. They cannot
inherit roles from groups more distantly removed—for example, from their
grandparent groups.
•
The role names Administrator, Operator, and Scheduler are stored in the
system database and are not localized into other languages. If you wish to
localize their names into your language, edit the roles and enter new names for
them.
•
If your company has implemented the Areas feature, users only see
endpoints assigned to their areas.
An administrator has several options when implementing user roles.
1
Implement only the default user roles and keep the standard permissions
assigned to these roles.
2
Implement only the default user roles but change the permissions
assigned to these roles.
Note
To ensure CMA system access and stability, the default Administrator role cannot
be deleted or edited.
3
Implement either option 1 or 2, but also create additional unique,
workflow-driven user roles and determine which permissions to assign
to those user roles.
While the CMA system allows businesses almost unlimited flexibility in
defining roles, for simplicity and clarity, we recommend keeping the default
roles with their default permissions and responsibilities. Because users can be
assigned multiple roles, and permissions are cumulative, your business can
combine roles as needed to reflect the workload your people undertake to
manage and use the system.
252
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Users and Groups Overview
Some important notes about user roles and permissions:
•
Users (local and enterprise) may be assigned more than one role. In this
case, the permissions associated with those roles are cumulative; a user
has all of the permissions assigned to all of his roles.
•
Users (local and enterprise) may be assigned roles as an individual and as
part of a group. Again, the permissions associated with those roles are
cumulative; a user has all of the permissions assigned to all of his roles no
matter how that role is assigned.
•
Users assigned a role with any one of the Administrator Permissions are
generally referred to as administrators. Users assigned a role with any one
of the Operator Permissions and none of the Administrator Permissions
are referred to as Operators. Users assigned a user role with Scheduler
Permissions and none of the Administrator or Operator Permissions are
referred to as Schedulers.
Default CMA System Roles and Permissions
The CMA system includes a default set of roles. Roles are associated with a set
of permissions. Roles and permissions define the menus, pages, and functions
that the system displays. So users see only the menus, pages, and functions
associated with their roles.
The following table identifies the default roles. Each of these roles is discussed
in more detail in the following sections.
Note
The role names are stored in the system database and are not localized into other
languages. If you wish to localized the role names into your language, edit the roles
and enter new names for them.
Role
Permissions
Comment
Scheduler
Schedule Conferences
Scheduling Level = Basic
Advanced Scheduler
View-Only Scheduler
Schedule Conferences
Scheduling Level = Advanced
Schedule Conferences
Users with this role cannot schedule
conferences; they can only see
conferences scheduled
Scheduling Level = View-Only
Operator
Conference Operator
Reports
Troubleshooting
Polycom, Inc.
253
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Role
Permissions
Comment
Device Administrator
Administrator
Monitoring
Directory Setup
Dial Plan Setup
Conferencing Setup
System Setup
This role cannot be deleted or edited.
Assign Users to Areas (when activated)
Associate Devices to Areas
(when activated)
System Maintenance/Troubleshooting
Provision Profiles
Auditor
Auditor
Except when operating in maximum security mode, most users will also see
these menu items:
Description
Settings. Click here to display a Settings dialog box with the following information:
•
•
•
•
User Name
Remote Server
Software Version
Font Size
In this dialog box, you can also:
•
Change the font size used in your display of the CMA system web client
interface.
•
Change your password, if you are a local system user.
Downloads. Click here to display the Downloads dialog box with the
downloadable applications that are compatible with the CMA system.
Downloadable applications include:
•
•
•
•
CMA Desktop client for PC or MAC (including the path to the application)
Polycom Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft Outlook
Polycom Scheduling Plugin for IBM Lotus Notes
Polycom File Verification Utility
Log Out. Click here to log out of the CMA system.
Note
The CMA system has an inactivity timer. If you are logged into the system but do
not use the interface for a specified period of time (10 minutes by default), the
system automatically logs you out.
Help. Links to the CMA system online help.
254
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Users and Groups Overview
Scheduler Roles, Responsibilities, and Menus
The CMA system offers three different default Scheduler roles.
,
Role
Responsibilities
Scheduler
For the areas to which they belong (areas are optional),
users assigned the Scheduler (sometimes called basic
scheduler) role can schedule conferences. They do so
using the conference templates defined for them. But
basic schedulers cannot change any of the conference
settings defined in the templates they choose when
scheduling their conferences.
Advanced Scheduler
View-Only Scheduler
For the areas to which they belong (areas are optional),
users assigned the Advanced Scheduler role can also
schedule conferences. And again they do so using the
conference templates defined for them. But advanced
schedulers can change selected conference settings
defined in the template they use when scheduling their
conferences.
For the areas to which they belong (areas are optional),
users assigned the View-only Scheduler role cannot
schedule conferences; they can only see conferences
that have been scheduled.
When basic or advanced schedulers log into the CMA system, the system
displays the Future conference page and they have access to the following
menu items:
When view-only schedulers log into the CMA system, the system displays the
Ongoing conference page and it is the only menu item to which they have
access.
Operator Role, Responsibilities, and Menus
The Operator role allows businesses to offer high-touch customer service for
video conferencing. For the areas to which they belong, users assigned the
Operator role can:
•
•
•
Schedule conferences.
Monitor and manage ongoing conferences.
Monitor endpoints.
Polycom, Inc.
255
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
•
•
•
Monitor network devices such as MCUs.
Add, edit, and delete entries in the system Guest Book.
Create favorites.
View some system reports.
When operators log into the CMA system, the system displays the Ongoing
conference page and they have access to the following menu items:
Device Administrator Role, Responsibilities, and Menus
The Device Administrator role is for those users who administrate endpoints,
bridges, and other network devices. For the areas to which they belong, users
assigned the Device Administrator role can:
•
•
•
•
•
Monitor endpoints, peripherals, and network devices.
Add, edit, and delete endpoints and network devices.
Provision endpoints.
Update endpoints.
Add, edit, and delete rooms.
256
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Users and Groups Overview
When device administrators log into the CMA system, the system displays the
system Dashboard and they have access to the following menu items:
Auditor Role, Responsibilities, and Menus
The Auditor role allows security-conscious companies to separate system
administration functions from system auditing functions. This provides an
added level of system checks and balances. This role must be explicitly
assigned by an administrator.
For the areas to which they belong, users assigned the Auditor role can:
• View audit logs.
• Backup and delete audit logs.
• Change the audit log file alert level.
• Generate online Endpoint Usage Reports.
• Download CDRs.
• View and download system log files.
• Download Windows event logs.
• Respond to audit log alerts.
When auditors log into the CMA system, the system displays the Audit Log
Files page and they have access to the following menu items:
Polycom, Inc.
257
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Administrator Role, Responsibilities, and Menus
The Administrator role is for those users who administrate the CMA system
itself. Users assigned the Administrator role can generally do almost all
system functions, however they cannot schedule conferences, monitor
conferences, or manage endpoints or other network devices.
When administrators log into the CMA system, the system displays the system
Dashboard and they have access to the following menu items:
Customized Roles and Responsibilities
The CMA system allows you almost unlimited flexibility in defining and
redefining roles, but for simplicity and clarity, we recommend keeping the
default roles with their default permissions and responsibilities.
Users can be assigned multiple roles and permissions are cumulative, so your
business can combine roles as needed to reflect the workload your people
undertake to manage and use the system.
258
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Users and Groups Overview
Device Associations and Presence
The CMA system assumes that users will be associated with endpoints. You
can associate a user with more than one endpoint, but one endpoint is
designated as the primary endpoint.
When scheduling a user in a conference, the CMA system will, by default,
schedule the user’s primary endpoint. The scheduler can choose to change the
request to schedule one of the user’s other endpoints.
The CMA system is also a presence service, which is the part of the system that
maintains online status information for the users of dynamically managed
endpoints. The presence service allows users to access information about the
online status of other users. This is important, because when you make a video
call or start a chat, that action only takes you to an endpoint. It doesn’t ensure
that you will reach the person you want to reach. The presence service
provides information about the user’s availability, which improves your
chances of getting the person.
Polycom, Inc.
259
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
260
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
19
User Management Operations
This chapter includes information on managing users and groups within the
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It
includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
Manage Users
In the CMA system, only users assigned the Administrator role can manage a
user. Some of these tasks include:
•
•
•
•
•
Search for a User
To search for a user
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the
user of interest.
Polycom, Inc.
261
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Note
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First
Name, and Last Name fields.
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only
check box and then press Enter.
Note
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for
enterprise users.
The first 500 users in the database that match your search criteria are
displayed in the Users list.
4
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.
View User Information
You can view information about a user, local or enterprise.
To view the address book a user is assigned to
1
2
3
Go to User > Users.
Select the user you want.
Click View Details.
Column
Description
General Info
First Name
Last Name
User ID
The user’s first name.
The user’s last name.
The user’s unique login name. This user ID must be
unique across all rooms and users and across all
domains.
Email Address
The user’s E-mail address. (The E-mail address is
an ASCII-only field.)
Note
The CMA system identifies plugin users and their
associated endpoints by E-mail address, so this is
required information for the plugin to work.
262
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
Column
Description
Title
The user’s professional title.
Department
City
The user’s department within the enterprise.
The city in which the user’s office is located.
The contact phone number for the user.
Phone Number
Associated Permissions
Permission
The set of permissions the user is assigned. For
Granted Through
The role through which the permissions are
assigned.
Associated Roles
Assigned Roles
The roles assigned to the user. For more information,
Groups
Type
The type of group to which the user belongs.
Possible values are local and enterprise.
Name
The name of the group to which the user belongs.
Inherited Group Info
Address Book
The Address Book(s) the user sees based upon the
groups to which the user is assigned.
Add a Local User
To add a local user
1
Go to User > Users and click Add.
The Add New User dialog box appears. The Enable User option is
selected by default.
2
Enter the following user information.
Column
Description
First Name
Last Name
The user’s first name
The user’s last name
Polycom, Inc.
263
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Column
Description
User ID
The user’s unique login name. This user ID must be
unique across all rooms and users and across all
domains.
Password
The user’s assigned password. This password must
be a minimum of eight characters in length.
Email Address
The user’s E-mail address. (The E-mail address is
an ASCII-only field.)
Note
The CMA system identifies plugin users and their
associated endpoints by E-mail address, so this is
required information for the plugin to work.
Title
The user’s professional title
Department
City
The user’s department within the enterprise
The city in which the user’s office is located
The contact phone number for the user
Phone Number
3
4
In the Associated Endpoints section, select and move the required
endpoints(s) to Selected Endpoints list. Move the unwanted endpoints(s)
to the Available Endpoints list. Press Shift-click or Ctrl-click to select
multiple items in the list.
In the Associated Roles section, select and move the required role(s) to
Selected Roles list. Move the unwanted role(s) to the Available Roles
list. Press Shift-click or Ctrl-click to select multiple items in the list.
Note
If the user has multiple endpoints, list the endpoints in order of priority, with the
primary endpoint first.
5
If Areas are enabled, in the Associated Areas section, select one of the
following options to associate the user with an area.
— None—Does not allow access to any endpoints.
— All Areas—Gives the user access to all endpoints, regardless of the
area the endpoints are assigned to.
— Specific Areas—Give the user access to only endpoints assigned to
the areas selected below. Select one or more areas in the list below and
click the right arrow.
6
In the Associated Alert Profile section, select a Remote Alert
Notification Profile as appropriate.
264
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
7
8
In the Dial String Reservations section, select the user’s endpoint and
enter the appropriate dial strings for SIP URI, E164, and H323 ID, then
click Apply.
The dial strings appear in the list below.
If the user has multiple endpoints, enter the dial strings for one endpoint
type at a time and click Apply each time.
Click OK.
If the Phone Number you entered is exactly the same as an existing user
or endpoint, the Phone Number Conflict dialog box appears and lists the
names of the other users or endpoints with the same number.
— To keep the duplicate number, click Continue.
— To change the phone number, click Cancel.
Edit a User
For local users added manually to the CMA system, you can edit all user
information. If you change the user ID, the user must log into the associated
endpoints with the new ID.
For users added through the enterprise directory, you can edit their roles
(unless the role is inherited from a group) and associate them to endpoints, but
you cannot change user names, user IDs, or passwords.
To edit a user
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the
user of interest.
Note
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First
Name, and Last Name fields.
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only
check box and then press Enter.
Note
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for
enterprise users.
4
5
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.
Select the user of interest and click Edit.
Polycom, Inc.
265
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
6
As required, edit the General Info, Associated Devices, Associated
Roles, Associated Areas, Associated Alert Profile, and Dial String
Reservations sections of the Edit User dialog box.
7
Click OK.
View Permissions for a User
A user with the Administrator role can view permissions for a user.
To view permissions for a user
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the
user of interest.
Note
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First
Name, and Last Name fields.
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only
check box and then press Enter.
Note
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for
enterprise users.
4
5
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.
Select the user of interest and click View Permissions.
The View Permissions dialog box displays the permissions information.
— Permission—Lists the permissions assigned to the user.
— Granted Through—Role assigned to the user that grants the listed
permissions.
6
Click Close.
Delete a User
You can only delete local users from the CMA system. You cannot delete users
added through integration with an enterprise directory.
266
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
To delete a user
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the
user of interest.
Note
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First
Name, and Last Name fields.
2
3
To search for a local user, press Enter.
To search both local and enterprise users, first clear the Local Users Only
check box and then press Enter.
Note
If you are not in an enterprise domain, you will not have the option of searching for
enterprise users.
4
5
6
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.
Select the user of interest and click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The user is deleted from the CMA system.
Unlock a User Account
When a local user reaches the Failed login threshold, the system will not allow
the user to log in until an administrator unlocks the user’s account. When a
user’s account is locked, the system will display an error message.
To unlock a user account
1
Go to User > Users and in the Search Users field, enter the name of the
user of interest and press Enter.
2
3
Select the user of interest and click Edit.
Enable the Unlock User option and click OK.
The system should allow the user to log in.
Polycom, Inc.
267
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Manage Groups
In the CMA system, only users assigned the Administrator role can:
•
•
•
•
Add a Local Group
To add a local group
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.
In the Groups page, click Add Local Group.
Complete the General Info section of the Add Local Group dialog box.
Column
Description
General Info
Group Name
A meaningful and unique group name assigned
when creating the group.
Description
A more complete description of the group’s purpose
Directory Viewable
Whether or not the group is displayed in the endpoint
directory
Provisioning Profile
The automatic provisioning profile assigned when
creating the group
Address Book
Associated Roles
Available Roles
Selected Roles
The list of roles defined to the CMA system
The list of roles that you assign users when adding
them to the system. Users have all of the
permissions associated with all of the roles assigned
to them (that is, permissions are cumulative).
268
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
Column
Description
Group Members (Local Users Only)
Search Available
Members
Search field for finding users
Search Results
The users and groups identified to the system that
you can add to the local group. This list can include
both local and enterprise users and groups.
Group Members
The users and groups selected as part of the group
4
5
In the Search Available Members field of the Group Members dialog
box, search for the users and groups to add to this local group.
In the Search Results section, select and move the users and groups of
interest to the Group Members list. To select all users and groups listed,
click the check box in the column header.
6
Click OK.
The group appears in the Groups list. It is identified as a LOCAL group.
Import Enterprise Groups
To import one or more enterprise groups
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.
In the Groups page, click Import Enterprise Group.
In the Search Available Groups field of the Import Enterprise Group
dialog box, type all or part of the group name (with wildcards) and press
ENTER.
Note
Searches for a group are case-insensitive, exact-match searches of the Group
Name field. Use wildcard characters to perform substring searches.
4
5
6
In the Search Results list, select the enterprise groups to add. To select all
enterprise groups, click the check box in the column header.
Click the right arrow to add the enterprise groups to the Groups to
Import list.
Click OK.
The enterprise group appears in the Groups list. Now you can edit the
group and associate it with an automatic provisioning profile, user roles,
and specify whether or not the group directory is viewable. You can also
search for enterprise users.
Polycom, Inc.
269
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Edit a Group
To edit a local or enterprise group
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.
In the Groups page, select the group of interest and click Edit.
As required, edit the General Info, Associated Roles, and Group
Members sections of the Edit Local Groups dialog box.
Notes
•
The Group Members section is only available for Local groups.
•
If you remove a user from a group or a role from a group, the user no longer has
the roles associated with the group.
4
Click OK.
Delete a Group
To delete a local or enterprise group
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.
In the Groups page, select the group of interest and click Delete Group.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The group is deleted from the CMA system.
Note
An enterprise group is only deleted from the CMA system, not the enterprise
directory, so it can be reimported.
Manage User Roles
In the CMA system, only users assigned the Administrator role can:
•
•
•
•
•
270
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
•
Polycom, Inc.
271
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Assign Users Roles and Endpoints
You can assign roles to both local and enterprise users and associate them with
endpoints.
To assign a role and endpoint to a user
1
2
Go to User > Users.
To search for a user:
a
In the Search field of the Users page, type a search string.
Note
Searches for a user on the CMA system Users page are case-insensitive, prefix
searches of the Username, First Name, and Last Name fields.
b
To search both local and enterprise users, clear the Local Users Only
check box and press Enter.
The first 500 users in the database that match your search criteria are
displayed in the Users list.
c
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.
3
4
Select the user of interest and click Edit.
In the Devices section of the Edit User dialog box, select the endpoint to
associate with the user and move it to the Selected Devices column. If a
user has multiple endpoints, the first endpoint listed is the user’s default
endpoint.
5
Click Finish.
View the List of User Roles
To view the list of User Roles
Go to User > User Roles.
The User Roles list appears. It can be filtered by Name and Description.
Column
Name
Description
The unique name of the user role
An optional description of the role
Description
272
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
Add a User Role
When you add a user role, you also specify permissions for the role.
To add a new user role
1
2
3
Go to User > User Roles.
On the User Roles page, click Add.
Complete the Name and Description fields of the Add Role dialog box
and assign permissions to the new role.
The following table describes the fields of the Add Role dialog box.
Field
Description
Name
The unique name (ASCII only) of the user role
(Optional) A useful description (ASCII only) of the user role
Description
Administrator
Permissions
Identifies which CMA system administrator pages and
functions are available to the user role.
Operator
Permissions
Identifies which CMA system operator pages and functions
are available to the user role.
Scheduler
Permissions
Identifies which CMA system scheduling pages and
functions are available to the user role.
Scheduling Level. This setting determines the level of
scheduling available through this role. Possible values are:
•
Basic. Users can schedule conferences using the
conference templates defined for them. They cannot
access or edit the advanced Conference Settings.
•
Advanced. Users can schedule conferences using the
conference templates defined for them. They can also
access and edit the advanced Conference Settings.
4
Click Save.
The new user role appears in the CMA system.
Edit Permissions for a User Role
You can change permissions for the default Operator and Scheduler roles, as
well as for other user roles that were created manually. You cannot change
permissions for the default Administrator role.
To edit the permissions for a user role
1
Go to User > User Roles.
Polycom, Inc.
273
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
3
4
As needed, use the Filter to customize the User Roles list.
In the User Roles list, select the role of interest and click Edit.
Edit the Description field of the Edit Role dialog box and edit
permissions for the role.
5
Click Save.
Delete a User Role
You can delete a user role from the CMA system, provided no users are
currently assigned to it.
To delete a user role
1
2
3
4
Go to User > User Roles.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the User Roles list.
In the User Roles list, select the role of interest and click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The user role is deleted from the CMA system.
View the Groups and Users Associated with a User Role
To view which groups and users are associated with a specific user role
Go to User > User Roles.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the User Roles list.
1
2
3
In the User Roles list, select the role of interest and click View Associated
Groups and Users.
The View Associated Groups and Users dialog box appears.
274
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
Manage System Guest Book
This section includes some general information you should know about the
Conference menu and views. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
User Menu and Guest Book
By default, schedulers, operator, and administrators have access to the User
Menu and Guest Book.
The Guest Book is a local system directory that includes guest participants
who were either:
•
•
Explicitly added to the Guest Book.
Saved to the Guest Book while being added as conference participants.
They are referred to as static entries because they are not imported through the
dynamically updated enterprise directory or included in the system Global
Address Book. The Guest Book is limited to 500 entries. The Guest Book has
these fields.
Field
Name
Email
Description
The guest’s first and last name.
The guest’s E-mail address. The system validates the
E-mail structure only.
Location
Number
The location of the guest’s endpoint system. This is a
free-form entry field that the system does not validate.
(Optional) The ISDN phone number for the user. This
number is constructed from the Country code + Area/City
code + phone number or entered as the modified dial
number.
Join Mode
Dial Options
Dial Type
Indicates whether the guest will use an audio endpoint or
video endpoint to join conferences.
Indicates whether the guest will dial into conferences or that
the system should dial out to the guest.
Indicates whether the guest has an H.323 (IP), SIP (IP), or
H.320 (ISDN) endpoint.
Polycom, Inc.
275
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Context-Sensitive Guest Book Actions
The Actions section of the Guest Book page may include these
context-sensitive actions depending on what is selected.
Actions
Description
Add Guest
Edit Guest
Delete Guest
Use this command to add a new guest user.
Use this command to change information for a guest user.
Use this command to delete a guest from the Guest Book.
Deleting a guest is a permanent operation.
Add a Guest to the System Guest Book
To add a guest to the system Guest Book
1
2
Go to User > Guest Book and click Add Guest.
Configure the Guest Information section of the Add New Guest dialog
box.
Field
Description
First Name
Last Name
Email
The guest’s first name.
The guest’s last name.
The guest’s E-mail address. The system only
validates the structure of the E-mail address.
Location
The location of the guest’s endpoint system. This is a
free-form field that the system does not validate.
Dial Type
Specify the protocol that the guest’s endpoint
supports: H.323 (IP), SIP (IP), or H.320 (ISDN).
This selection will determine what other sections of
the Add New Guest dialog box you will need to
complete.
Join Mode
Specify whether the guest’s endpoint is an audio or
video endpoint.
Note
A guest may have multiple endpoints. Create a
separate Guest Book entry for each endpoint.
276
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
Field
Description
Dial Options
Specify whether the guest will dial into conferences,
or require that the system dial out to the guest.
Note
To support both options, create a separate Guest
Book entry for each.
3
If the guest has an H.323 (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Number and
Number Type
The specific dial string for the guest, and the format
of the number that the MCU must resolve to contact
the guest. This may be an IP address, E.164
address, H.323, or Annex-O.
For Annex-O dialing, in the Number field enter the
H.323.alias@IP, for example:
Notes
•
Polycom endpoints must register with a
gatekeeper before they will attempt an Annex-O
call.
•
You can enter a dial string for another MCU as a
guest. If so, you may need to specify the
conference ID in the Extension field also.
Extension
Use this field to connect the conference to another
conference on another MCU. In this field, specify the
conference ID or passcode for the conference on the
other MCU.
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on the
MCUs with which the CMA system is registered.
Leave this at Any Available Service unless you
have specific knowledge of MCU services.
4
If the guest has a SIP (IP) endpoint, configure these settings:
Polycom, Inc.
277
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Sip URI
The SPI URI the MCU must resolve to contact the
guest.
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on the
MCUs with which the CMA system is registered.
Leave this at Any Available Service unless you
have specific knowledge of MCU services.
5
If the guest has an H.320 (ISDN) endpoint, configure these settings:
Field
Description
Use Modified Dial
Number
Select this option first (as needed) as it will
determine the other fields you must configure.
Country
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number is
selected.) The country to which the system will dial
out to the guest. Click Select to view a list of country
codes.
Area/City Code
(Not available when Use Modified Dial Number is
selected.) The area code to which the system will
dial out to the guest.
Number
The participant’s phone number.
Cannot be configured.
Extension
MCU Service
Choose from the list of MCU services defined on the
MCUs with which the CMA system has registered.
Leave this at Any Available Service unless you
have specific knowledge of MCU services.
6
Click OK.
Edit a Guest in the System Guest Book
To edit a guest in the system Guest Book
1
2
3
Go to User > Guest Book and select the guest of interest.
Click Edit Guest.
Change the Guest Information section and endpoint information
sections of the Add New Guest dialog box, as needed. For more
information about these fields, see “Add a Guest to the System Guest
4
Click OK.
278
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
User Management Operations
Delete a Guest from the System Guest Book
To delete a guest from the system Guest Book
1
2
3
Go to User > Guest Book and select the guest of interest.
Click Delete Guest.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Manage Favorites
The CMA system allows operators with Monitoring permissions to create one
or more Favorites list, which they can use to quickly select participants to
participate in conferences.
The operations associated with managing favorites include:
•
•
•
In the CMA system, only operators with Monitoring permissions can view,
add, edit, delete, or use Favorites lists and these Favorites lists cannot be
shared with other operators.
Add a Favorites List
To add a Favorites list
1
2
3
Go to User > Favorites.
On the Favorites page, click Add.
Complete the Favorites List Name and Description fields of the Add
Favorites List dialog box.
Note
The Favorites List Name must be unique within the system.
4
In the Search Available Members field enter all or part of the person’s
last name or first name and click Search.
The system searches the Users list (local and domain) for users who are
associated with endpoints and who meet your search criteria. The results
appear in the Search Results column.
Polycom, Inc.
279
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Notes
•
Depending on the search domain, the search function may return different
•
The search results only include users associated with endpoints.
5
6
Select the user(s) of interest from the list and move them to the Favorite
List Members column.
Repeat step 4 and 5 until you’ve added the users of interest to your
Favorites list and then click OK.
The new list appears in the Favorites page.
Edit a Favorites List
To edit a Favorites list
1
2
3
Go to User > Favorites.
On the Favorites page, select the Favorites list of interest and click Edit.
In the Edit Favorites List dialog box, edit the Favorites List Name and
Description fields as needed.
4
Remove or add users to the Favorite List Members column as needed
and then click OK.
Delete a Favorites List
To delete a Favorites list
1
Go to User > Favorites.
2
On the Favorites page, select the Favorites list of interest and click
Delete.
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The list is deleted from the CMA system.
280
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
20
System Reports
This chapter describes the reports available through the Polycom® Converged
Management Application™ (CMA®) system and how to view and export
them. Use these reports to identify return on investment, troubleshoot
problems, provide information about network traffic, and ensure accurate
billing for Polycom video calls.
The topics include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Site Statistics Report
Use the Site Statistics report to check call rate and call quality statistics for the
sites. You can view the data in a grid or graphically.
Polycom, Inc.
281
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To view Site Statistics
1
Go to Reports > Site Statistics.
The Site Statistics appear with the statistics displayed in a grid. The grid
shows a snapshot of the current statistics. The data is updated
automatically every 15 seconds.
Column
Description
Site Name
Specifies the site to which the statistics apply.
Specifies the number of currently active calls for the site.
Num of Calls
% Bandwidth Used
Specifies the cumulative bandwidth used by the
currently active calls.
Bandwidth
Avg Bit Rate
Specifies the average bit rate for the currently active
calls that is, the total bit rate for all currently active calls
divided by the number of active calls.
% Packet Loss
Specifies the average percentage of packet loss for the
currently active calls that is, the total percentage of
packet loss for all currently active calls divided by the
number of active calls.
Avg Jitter
Avg Delay
Specifies the average jitter for the currently active calls
that is, the total jitter for all currently active calls divided
by the number of active calls.
Specifies the average delay for the currently active calls
that is, the total delay for all currently active calls divided
by the number of active calls.
2
To view the Site Statistics graphically and over a selected period of time:
a
b
c
Click View Chart.
In the Site Name list, select the site(s) to chart.
In the Y-Axis list, select the statistic(s) to chart.
d
In the Data Limit field, enter the time frame in minutes for which to
chart the data. The default is 60 minutes.
The charts are dynamically updated for your selections.
282
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Site Link Statistics Report
Use the Site Link Statistics report to check call rate and call quality statistics
for all site links. You can view the data in a grid or graphically.
To view Site Link Statistics
1
Go to Reports > Site Link Statistics.
The SiteLink Statistics appear with the statistics displayed in a grid. The
grid shows a snapshot of the current statistics. The data is updated
automatically every 15 seconds
Column
Description
Site Link Name
Specifies the two linked sites for which the statistics
apply.
Num of Calls
Specifies the number of currently active calls for the site
link.
% Bandwidth Used
Specifies the percentage of bandwidth used by the
currently active calls, that is, the bandwidth used by the
currently active calls divided by the total available
bandwidth for the link expressed as a percentage.
Bandwidth
Specifies the total bandwidth of the link.
Avg Bit Rate
Specifies the average bit rate for the currently active
calls, that is, the total bit rate for all currently active calls
divided by the number of active calls.
% Packet Loss
Specifies the average percentage of packet loss for the
currently active calls that is, the total percentage of
packet loss for all currently active calls divided by the
number of active calls.
Avg Jitter
Avg Delay
Specifies the average jitter for the currently active calls
that is, the total jitter for all currently active calls divided
by the number of active calls.
Specifies the average delay for the currently active calls
that is, the total delay for all currently active calls divided
by the number of active calls.
2
To view the Site Link Statistics graphically:
a
b
c
Click View Chart.
In the Site Name list, select the site(s) to chart.
In the Y-Axis list, select the statistic(s) to chart.
Polycom, Inc.
283
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
d
In the Data Limit field, enter the time frame in minutes for which to
chart the data. The default is 60 minutes.
The charts are dynamically updated for your selections. The site-links
are displayed in the same order as the site-link grid.
H.323 Call Detail Records Report
The H.323 Call Detail Record (CDR) report includes CDRs for Polycom and
non-Polycom endpoints. Use data from the H.323 Call Detail Record (CDR)
report to troubleshoot problems, provide information about network traffic,
and ensure accurate billing for video calls.
Notes
•
Endpoints that access the CMA system through a Polycom VBP device do not
have CDRs.
•
•
•
Only calls that go through the gatekeeper are included in this report.
A Call Detail Record is recorded for each IP call into a conference.
CDR reports may not include data for calls made in the last 24 hours, depending
upon when the data in the localcdr.csvfile was last updated.
To work with the H.323 Call Detail Records report data, extract the report from
the Logger.dbo.callsdatabase. See your Microsoft SQL Server
documentation for information about extracting data.
To view the H.323 Call Detail Records report
1
Go to Reports > H.323 Call Detail Records.
The H.323 Call Detail Records report appears. It lists the CDRs for the
5,000 most recent IP calls made to or from system-managed endpoints. It
includes the following information.
Column
Call ID
Description
Specifies the ID automatically generated for the call.
Conf ID
Specifies the GUID (global unique identifier) for the
conference to which the call was made.
Date/Time
Source
Specifies the date and time the call started, provided in
local time for the server.
Specifies the name, IP, or alias of the endpoint that
originated the call.
Source Address
Specifies the IP address of the endpoint that originated
the call.
284
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Column
Description
Destination
Specifies the name, IP address, or alias of the endpoint
that received the call. For point-to-point calls this is
another endpoint. For multipoint calls using an MCU,
this is the MCU.
Destination
Address
Specifies the IP address of the endpoint that received
the call.
Call Type
Specifies the type of call: scheduled or unscheduled.
Specifies the bit rate that was used for the call.
Bandwidth (Kbps)
Duration (min)
Specifies how long the call lasted in minutes, up to a
maximum of 999.
Q.850 Code
Specifies the standard cause code for call termination.
2
Use the Filter to customize the report by Date, IP Address, Endpoint
Type, Call Type, and Duration.
Call Detail Record Report Administration
By default, the CMA system stores the conference and endpoint call detail
records (CDRs) for 30 days. You can modify the CDR retention period and you
can schedule a weekly archive of the CDRs. These procedures are described in
the following topics.
Modify the CDR Retention Period
By default, the conference and endpoint CDRs are purged after 30 days.
To change how long CDR information is retained
1
2
Go to Admin > Report Administration.
In the Report Administration page, enter the number of Days to keep
Conference and Endpoint CDRs.
3
Click Save Settings.
Schedule Weekly Archives of the CDR Report
To schedule weekly archives of CDR information
1
2
Go to Admin > Report Administration.
In the Report Administration page, select Enable Weekly FTP
Archiving of CDR Records.
Polycom, Inc.
285
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
Configure these settings:
Field
Description
First day of weekly
archive
Specifies the day on which the system will transfer
archives. By default, this is Sunday. As needed,
you can select a different day for the transfers.
Use Secure FTP
(SSL/TLS)
Specifies whether or not the archives will be
transferred over an encrypted Secure Sockets
Layer (SSL) or Transport Layer Security (TLS)
connection. By default, the system does not secure
the transfers.
Host name or IP
Address of FTP server
Specifies the server to which the archives will be
transferred. By default, the system transfers the
archives to a location on its local server. You can
change this to an external server.
FTP Port
Specifies the port through which the archives will
be transferred. By default, this is system port 21.
FTP User Name/
FTP Password/
Confirm FTP Password
Specifies a user name and password combination
for accessing the FTP server. This must be a valid
user account on the FTP server.
FTP Directory
Specifies the directory on the server to which the
archives will be transferred.
4
5
To verify that the FTP settings are functional, click Test Archive Settings.
When the settings are correct, click Save Settings.
Endpoint Usage Report
The Endpoint Usage Report is based on the CDRs extracted from selected
endpoints and includes entries for ISDN and IP calls. (Currently, the CMA
system reports CDRs for the Polycom dynamically managed, Polycom
non-dynamically managed, HDX Series, RealPresence Group Series, V and
VSX Series, VVX, and CMA Desktop endpoints as well as supported
TANDBERG and LifeSize endpoint models.)
Use data from the Endpoint Usage Report to troubleshoot problems, provide
information about network traffic, and ensure accurate billing for Polycom
video calls.
286
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
To view the Endpoint Usage Report
1
Go to Reports > Endpoint Usage Report.
The Endpoint Usage Report page appears displaying the following
information for the endpoints for which CDRs are available.
Field
Description
Serial Number
Endpoint Name
Site
The registered serial number of the endpoint.
The registered name of the endpoint.
The location at which the endpoint resides.
The person or room to whom the endpoint is registered.
Owner/Room
The CDRs are displayed in alphabetical order for the default Start Date
and End Date. By default, the CDRs for the last week are reported.
2
3
4
To restrict the report to a different time period, change the Start Date and
End Date. The report is dynamically updated.
Use the Filter to customize the report by endpoint Type, Name, IP
Address, ISDN Video Number, Alias, Site, or VIP status.
To generate the Endpoint Usage report, select one or more endpoints to
include in the report and click Generate Report. Use the CTRL key, to
select multiple endpoints.
The Generate Report page displays the Summary usage report for the
selected endpoints. It includes the following information for the calls.
Field
Description
Number of calls
Specifies the number of calls the selected endpoints
joined for the selected date range. Click Details to get
more information about these calls.
Total call time
Specifies the total amount of time the selected endpoints
spent in conference during the selected date range.
Average time per
call
Specifies the average amount of time the selected
endpoints spent in conference during the selected date
range, that is, the total call time divided by the number of
calls.
Average rate per
call
Specifies the average bit rate for the selected calls.
5
6
To select a different group of endpoints, click Change Selection, select
the endpoints, and click Generate Report again.
Click Call Times to see a chart that identifies the number of calls versus
the start time for the calls.
Polycom, Inc.
287
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
7
8
9
Click Inbound to see a chart that identifies the endpoints from which the
inbound calls to the selected endpoints originated.
Click Outbound to see a chart that identifies the endpoints to which the
selected endpoints called.
Click Summary CDR Report to see a grid that displays information for
each of the selected endpoints that participated in calls.
Field
Description
Serial Number
Endpoint Name
The registered serial number of the endpoint.
Identifies the endpoint by name.
Total Time in Call Specifies the total amount of time the endpoint spent in
conference during the selected time period.
Average Time in
Call
Specifies the average amount of time the endpoint spent
per call during the selected time period, that is, the Total
Time in Call divided by the Total Calls.
Average Speed
All Calls
Specifies the average bit rate for all of the calls in which
the endpoint participated during the selected time period,
that is, total bit rate divided by the Total Calls.
Calls Out
Calls In
Specifies the number of calls in which the endpoint
participated during the selected time period that originated
from the endpoint.
Specifies the number of calls in which the endpoint
participated during the selected time period that did not
originate from the endpoint.
Total Calls
Specifies the total number of calls in which the endpoint
participated for the selected time period.
If any of the selected endpoints did not participate in calls during the
selected time period, it is not included in the Summary CDR Report.
10 To export the information in the Summary CDR Report, click Export as
Excel File and either Open or Save the file as needed. Note that only the
first 1000 lines of the report are exported to the Excel file.
11 Click Detail CDR Report to see information for each of the endpoints
that participated in calls.
The Generate Report page displays System Information and CDR
information for the first endpoint in the list. For the selected endpoint, the
System Information section includes the following data.
288
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Field
Description
System Information
Model
Specifies the name of the selected endpoint.
Specifies the model number of the selected
endpoint.
IP Address
Specifies the IP address of the selected endpoint.
Specifies the ISDN number or V.35 number.
ISDN or V.35 Number
Serial Number
Specifies the serial number of the selected endpoint.
For each call from the selected endpoint, the CDR information includes the
following data.
Field
Description
Start Date Time
End Date Time
Specifies the start date and time for the conference.
Specifies the end date for the report. This also
defaults to the current date.
Call Duration
Specifies how long the call lasted in hours, minutes,
and seconds.
Account Number
If Require Account Number to Dial is enabled on the
system, the value entered by the user is displayed
in this field.
Remote System Name
Specifies the endpoint to which the endpoint was
connected for the call.
Call Number 1
Call Number 2
Specifies the IP or ISDN numbers for the endpoints
to which the endpoint was connected for the call.
Transport Type
The type of call — Either H.320 (ISDN), H.323 (IP),
or SIP.
Call Rate
The bandwidth negotiated with the far site.
System Manufacturer
The name of the system manufacturer, model, and
software version, if they can be determined.
Call Direction
Conference ID
In — For calls received.
Out — For calls placed from the system.
A number given to each conference. A conference
can include more than one far site, so there may be
more than one row with the same conference ID.
Call ID
Identifies individual calls within the same
conference.
Polycom, Inc.
289
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
H.320 Channels
The total number of ISDN B channels used in the
call. For example, a 384K call would use six B
channels.
Endpoint Alias
The alias of the far site.
Endpoint Additional
Alias
An additional alias of the far site.
Endpoint Type
Terminal, gateway, or MCU.
Endpoint Transport
Address
The actual address of the far site (not necessarily
the address dialed).
Audio Protocol Tx
Audio Protocol Rx
Video Protocol Tx
Video Protocol Rx
Video Format Tx
Video Format Rx
Disconnect Info
The audio protocol transmitted to the far site, such
as G.728 or G.722.1.
The audio protocol received from the far site, such
as G.728 or G.722.
The video protocol transmitted to the far site, such
as H.263 or H.264.
The video protocol received from the far site, such
as H.261 or H.263.
The video format transmitted to the far site, such as
CIF or SIF.
The video format received from the far site, such as
CIF or SIF.
The description of the Q.850 (ISDN) cause code
showing how the call ended.
Q850 Cause Code
Total H.320 Errors
Avg % Packet Loss Tx
The Q.850 cause code showing how the call ended.
The number of errors during an H.320 call.
The combined average of the percentage of both
audio and video packets transmitted that were lost
during the 5 seconds preceding the moment at
which a sample was taken. This value does not
report a cumulative average for the entire H.323
call. However, it does report an average of the
sampled values.
Avg % Packet Loss Rx
The combined average of the percentage of both
audio and video packets received that were lost
during the 5 seconds preceding the moment at
which a sample was taken. This value does not
report a cumulative average for the entire H.323
call. However, it does report an average of the
sampled values.
290
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Field
Description
Avg Packet Loss Tx
The number of packets transmitted that were lost
during an H.323 call.
Avg Packet Loss Rx
Avg Latency Tx
The number of packets from the far site that were
lost during an H.323 call.
The average latency of packets transmitted during
an H.323 call based on round-trip delay, calculated
from sample tests done once per minute.
Avg Latency Rx
Max Latency Tx
Max Latency Rx
Avg Jitter Tx
The average latency of packets received during an
H.323 call based on round-trip delay, calculated
from sample tests done once per minute.
The maximum latency for packets transmitted
during an H.323 call based on round-trip delay,
calculated from sample tests done once per minute.
The maximum latency for packets received during
an H.323 call based on round-trip delay, calculated
from sample tests done once per minute.
The average jitter of packets transmitted during an
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once
per minute.
Avg Jitter Rx
The average jitter of packets received during an
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once
per minute.
Max Jitter Tx
Max Jitter Rx
The maximum jitter of packets transmitted during an
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once
per minute.
The maximum jitter of packets received during an
H.323 call, calculated from sample tests done once
per minute.
12 To export the information, click Download Report and either Open or
Save the CDR report in Microsoft Excel format for the selected endpoint
or in CSV format For All Selected Endpoints. Note that only the first
1000 lines of the report are exported to the Excel file.
13 Click Change Selection to return to the Endpoint Usage Report page to
select a different endpoint.
Polycom, Inc.
291
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Conference Type Report
Use the Conference Type Report option to review monthly summary
information about past CMA system conferences.
To create a Conference Type Report
1
Go to Reports > Conference Type Report.
An empty Conference Type Report grid appears.
2
As needed, change the From: and To: dates to select the date range for the
report, and click View.
The Conference Type Report for the selected date range appears. It
includes the following information.
Column
Description
Date
Information is displayed on a month-by-month basis and
an average for the selected months.
Scheduled Confs
Ad hoc Confs
The number of conferences scheduled via one of the
CMA system scheduling interfaces (that is, the CMA
system application, the Polycom Scheduling Plugin for
Microsoft Outlook, or the Polycom Scheduling Plugin for
IBM Lotus Notes).
The number of conferences that used one or more
endpoints for which the CMA system was the
gatekeeper, but that weren’t scheduled via one of the
CMA system scheduling interfaces.
MP Confs
The number of multipoint conferences scheduled using
one of the CMA system scheduling interfaces.
P2P Confs
The number of point-to-point conferences scheduled
using one of the CMA system scheduling interfaces.
Gateway Confs
The number of scheduled conferences that used a
gateway to reach one or more endpoints.
Embedded MP
Confs
The number of scheduled multipoint conferences that
used the MCU embedded in a V-Series, VSX-Series, or
Polycom HDX-Series endpoint rather than an external
MCU such as an MGC or RMX MCU.
Two Person
Conferences on
MCU
The number of scheduled point-to-point conferences
that used an external MCU such as an MGC or RMX
MCU even through point-to-point conferences do not
usually require MCU resources.
Short Confs
The number of scheduled conferences that were
scheduled to last 30 minutes or more, but which actually
lasted less than 30 minutes.
292
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Column
Description
Scheduled Minutes The sum of the scheduled minutes for all CMA system
scheduled conferences.
Executed Minutes
The sum of the actual minutes for all CMA system
scheduled conferences.
Total Parts
The sum of the participants that joined CMA system
scheduled conferences.
Avg Parts in MP
Confs
The average number of participants that joined
scheduled CMA system multipoint conferences.
3
To create one of the conference type report charts, click the appropriate
chart name below the grid. Chart choices include:
Column
Description
Scheduled vs.
Ad hoc
A chart that compares the number of scheduled
conferences to the number of ad hoc conferences for
each month
Scheduled Types
A chart that compares the number of point-to-point,
multipoint, gateway, and embedded multipoint
conferences for each month
Scheduled vs.
Executed Mins
A chart that compares the number of scheduled minutes
to the number of executed minutes for each month
Avg Parts in MP
Confs
A chart that displays the average number of participants
in multipoint conferences for each month
Point-to-Point
A chart that displays the number of point-to-point
Confs on MCUs
conferences hosted on an external MCU for each month
The selected chart dynamically appears below the grid.
To export the report:
4
a
b
c
Click Export.
In the File Download dialog box, click Save.
In the Save As dialog box, browse to the location to which to save the
report and click Save.
Polycom, Inc.
293
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Gatekeeper Message Log
Use the Gatekeeper Message Log page to:
•
•
•
•
•
View messages that endpoints send to the gatekeeper
Define which messages are logged
Pause and restart message logging
Clear the log
Export the log to another file
Logging starts when you define the Log Settings. Logging stops only when
you clear all of the Log Settings. Logging can include these types of messages:
•
Warnings/Errors. Messages displayed for all warnings or errors that occur
on registered Polycom endpoints
•
•
Rogues. Messages displayed for all calls from unregistered endpoints
Events. Messages display about these events:
— Registration
— Call detail
— Neighboring gatekeeper
While you can pause logging, the CMA system always logs errors and
warnings.
You can also:
•
•
Clear events from the log, which removes data from the database
Export the log to a a comma-separated value (CSV) file. You can export
only the data that displays on-screen, and exporting the log may take a
long time depending on the number of entries in the log.
View and Export the Gatekeeper Message Log
To see more details about a log message
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.
Enter a Filter String to customize the list.
Select the message of interest.
The Gatekeeper Message Log report appears. It has these fields:
294
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Column
Description
Type
These types of messages display:
•
•
•
Information, which indicates normal
communications between the CMA system and
the endpoint.
Warning, which indicates an unscheduled call
and the inability to assign E.164 and ISDN
numbers to an endpoint.
Error, which indicates the registration of an
endpoint or a call failed, or a lack of resources for
this gateway or MCU exists.
Date/Time
Category
Date and time of the event.
Specifies whether an event is a registration, call, or
neighboring gatekeeper request.
Description
Displays the message sent to or received from the
endpoint, identified by the IP address.
4
To export a message:
a
b
Select the message of interest and click Export Log.
In the Export Log dialog box, click Yes.
GKexport fileappears in your default text editor.
Save the file.
A
c
Define Log Settings
To define which messages should be logged
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.
When the Gatekeeper Message Log page appears, click Log Settings.
In the Gatekeeper Log Settings dialog box, select the events to log.
Field
Description
Registration
RRQ
Registration requests
GRQ
Gatekeeper requests
IRR/IRQ
LWRRQ
Information response or information sent
Light-weight registration request
Polycom, Inc.
295
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
URQ
Unregistration request
Non Standard
Message
Neighbors
LRQ
Location request
Call Details
ARQ
Admission request
Disengage request
Bandwidth request
DRQ
BRQ
Setup
4
Click OK
The CMA system begins logging the types of messages you selected.
Clear Events from the Log
To clear all events from the log
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.
When the Gatekeeper Message Log page appears, click Clear Log.
Click Yes to confirm the action.
The Gatekeeper Message Log is cleared.
Pause and Restart Logging
To pause logging
1
2
3
Go to Reports > Gatekeeper Message Log.
When the Gatekeeper Message Log page appears, click Pause Log.
In the Stop Logging dialog box, click Yes.
The Start Log button is available and the system stops logging messages
to the Gatekeeper Message Log.
4
Click Start Log to restart logging.
296
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Many of the CMA system components can write a System Log File when
they experience an error or issue. Whether or not they do write a system
log file depends upon the system log level.
The following table lists some of the logs the CMA system saves.
Log Name
Description
Log Files Related to Basic System Functionality
SE200MasterService.txt
Log file that shows when individual
services are started and stopped, and
displays a memory usage summary for
some of those services (mqm, sitetopo,
plcmgk, gab) every 30 minutes.
ESINSTALL-<timestamp>.txt
Log file that shows the output of the CMA
system install script. Shows what steps
were done when installing the CMA
system software.
ESUPGRADE-<timestamp>.txt
Log file that shows the output of the CMA
system upgrade script (not applicable
unless an upgrade was performed).
Log File Related to Dial Plan Functionality
DialRule_Log.txt
General log file used by the dial rule
process. This process generates dial out
strings to endpoints, controls the dialing
rules set up in the user interface.
SiteTopo_Log.txt
When in debug mode, this log file
contains messages about site topology
entry and usage.
Log File Related to External Database Functionality
ServiceMonitor_Log.txt Log file for the redundancy service that
shows when a redundant CMA system
goes into active or standby mode.
Log Files Related to Scheduling Functionality
AdapterLog_SCH.txt .NET remoting log file that shows
low-level communication errors between
internal system components--in this case,
the scheduling component.
Log Files Related to Global Address Book Functionality
AdapterLog_GAB.txt .NET remoting log file that shows
low-level communication errors from the
GAB communications with the integration
layer.
Polycom, Inc.
297
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Log Name
Description
ComponentLog_GAB.txt
.NET remoting log file that shows
low-level communication errors from the
GAB communications with endpoints.
EXXX_LOG
x
.txt
Log files for web services, device
manager, and conference monitoring.
This file includes information about
successful and failed system logins and
all logouts, as well as system errors,
major system events, and general system
information.
Log Files Related to Device Management Functionality
AdapterLog_GMS.txt
.NET remoting log file that shows
low-level communication errors between
internal system components--in this case,
the management component.
<DeviceType>Device.txt
Log file that captures device specific
message.
<DeviceType>DeviceCollection.txt Log file that captures device specific
message.
<DeviceType>PasswdErrs.log
Log file that captures device specific
messages related to potential password
mismatches.
DeviceManager.txt
DeviceManagerService.txt
softwareUpdate
Log file for the device management
process.
Log file for the device management
process.
Log file that shows when a endpoint is
updated with a new software package via
a scheduled software update.
Log Files Related to Gatekeeper Functionality
AdapterLog_PN.txt
.NET remoting log file that shows
low-level communication errors between
internal system components--in this case,
the gatekeeper component.
PLCMGK.log
MQM_Log.txt
General gatekeeper log file.
General media quality monitor log file that
will show any errors when writing CDRs
or media quality data to the database.
298
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
Log Name
Description
Log Files Related to Call Management Functionality
Messages.txt
Conference launching log used
exclusively by CodecMngr process. This
log contains information about the
conference start up process, that is,
information that the system sends to
endpoints at the start of a conference.
CS_<conf_name>.html
Conference scheduling log used by the
conference scheduling process. This log
contains debug information on how a
conference is created. A log file is
created for each scheduled conference,
with the log file name format:
CS_<conf_name>.txt
CS-<conf_name>.txt, where
<conf_name>is the name of the
scheduled conference. This is always on,
and there is no logging level.
Log Files Related to Web Services Functionality
apache_access.log.<xxxx>
Apache web server access log that
shows when and what URL was
requested.
apache_error.log
mod_jk.log
Log file that captures error messages
from the Apache web server.
Log file that shows which web requests
were forwarded from Apache web server
to the Tomcat servlet engine.
Log Files Related to Presence Functionality
Jserver.log.<n>
Log file that shows errors related to the
internal LDAP, SNMP, DM, Openfire, Site
Topology and dynamically-managed
endpoint login and provisioning
functionality. This circular log has a six
month limit. The timestamp is the local
server time.
boot.log
JBoss startup log. JBoss is the container
service for the Jserver service.
Polycom, Inc.
299
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
View and Export System Log Files
Many of the CMA system components can write a System Log File when they
experience an error or issue.
Whether or not they do write a system log file depends upon the system log
To view System Log Files
1
Go to Reports > System Logs.
The System Log Files list appears listing the logs for the given time period.
To view a log file:
2
a
b
Select the log file of interest.
Click Open.
3
To export a .zipof all log files:
a
b
Click Download All.
To open the .zipfile, in the File Download dialog box, click Open
with, and browse to the program you use to open.zipfiles.
c
To save the .zipfile to your local computer, in the File Download
dialog box, click Save.
Change the System Log Level
To edit the current system log level
1
Go to Reports > System Logs.
The System Log Files list appears listing the logs for the given time period.
The Current Log Level indicates which log files are being saved.
2
3
4
Select the report you want.
Click Change Settings.
From the Current Log Level menu, select a new value. Choices include:
— Debug
— Info
— Warn
— Error
— Fatal
— Off
300
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
5
In a redundant configuration, repeat steps 1 and 4 on the redundant
server.
Download Windows Event Log Files
You can download a .zip file that includes the Windows Event Log Files for the
CMA system. The Windows Event Log Files include the operating system
level application, security, and system logs. These logs store events logged by
Windows system components.
To download the Windows Event Logs
1
2
3
Go to Reports > System Log Files.
Click Download All Event Logs.
In the File Download dialog box, click Save to save the log file to your
local system.
View and Download Audit Log Files
You can view and download audit log files.
To view and download audit log files
1
Go to Reports > Audit Log Files.
The Audit Log Files page appears listing the logs being stored on the
system. The following table identifies the CMA system audit log files.
Log Name
Description
apache_access.log.<timestamp>
Log file that shows every web request
that was made from client systems. The
system may have more than one such
log.
apache_error.log
Log file that captures all of the failed
web requests as well as any internal
Apache error messages.
cma_audit_ComponentLog_Apach
eCert1.log
Log file that captures security-related
authentication issues.
cma_audit_EXXX_LOG1.log
Log file that captures significant .NET
application events.
Polycom, Inc.
301
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Log Name
Description
cma_audit_jserver.log
Log file that captures significant Java
Server application events.
cma_audit_os_patches_hotfixes1.l
og
Log file that is created when the system
first starts up. It displays the operating
system updates and hotfixes applied to
the CMA system.
ntp.log
Log file that captures time server
related events.
opends-access-log.txt
opends-audit-log.txt
opends-replication-log.txt
Log file that captures activity queries
sent to OpenDS.
Log file that captures OpenDS
configuration events.
Log file that captures redundancy and
DMA system integration events. Not
available because redundancy and
DMA integration are not supported.
2
3
Select the audit log of interest and click Open.
In the File Download dialog box, click Open to view the file or click Save
to save the log file to your local system.
Backup and Delete Audit Log Files
You can backup and delete audit log files.
To backup and delete audit log files
1
Go to Reports > Audit Log Files.
The Audit Log Files page appears listing the logs being stored on the
system.
2
3
Click Backup and Delete.
In the Backup and Delete dialog box, select the checkboxes of the log files
to backup.
4
5
6
Click Backup to begin backing up the log files into a zip folder.
Click Save.
In the Backup and Delete dialog, click on Download Verification
Utility, if it is not installed already.
302
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
7
To enter the verification code, leave the dialog open, until you get the
verification code from the File Verification Utility.
8
9
Run the File Verification Utility.
In the File Verification Utility dialog box, browse to the location of the
backed-up file and select it, the utility will run when the file is selected.
After the utility runs, a verification code will be visible in the Verification
Value field.
10 In the File Verification Utility dialog, click Copy.
11 In the Backup and Delete dialog, click in the Verification Code field and
press CTRL-V to paste in the Verification code into the field.
12 Click on Verify and Delete. The backed-up file will be checksum verified
and the backed-up log files will be deleted.
Note
It is important for the user to log into the CMA system with the proper roles to be
able to view and access the Backup and Delete option, otherwise only the Open
option will be visible.
The alerting threshold may be modified through the Change Settings option.
CMA System Report
The CMA System Report is not available from the Reports menu, but it can be
a useful report. It produces a SystemInfo.txtfile that describes the system
configuration.
To view CMA System Report
1
2
Go to Admin > Troubleshooting Utilities.
In the CMA System Report section of the Troubleshooting Utilities
page, click Download Report in the CMA System Report section.
3
When the File Download dialog box appears, either Open or Save the
SystemInfo.txtfile:
The report includes this information.
CMA VERSION
Software version : 6.00.00.ER012
Hardware version : REVISION_B
LDAP Integration : true
SECURITY SETTINGS
Polycom, Inc.
303
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
System under Secure Mode: false
NETWORK CONFIGURATION
System name
: POLYCOM-Dell150
System IPv4 Address
System IPv6 Address
: 10.47.10.150
: N/A
System IPv6 Link local: N/A
System subnet mask
: 255.255.255.0
System default gateway: 10.47.10.10
System DNS domain
: pe.com
System DNS server 1: 10.47.10.189
System DNS server 2: N/A
LICENSE INFO
Total number of licenses : 100
Number of licenses in used: 10
CONFERENCE SETTINGS
Conference Time Warning
: true
Include Conference Owner in new Conference: false
Allow Overbooking of dial-In participants : false
Conference PIN Length
: 15
SESSION MANAGEMENT SETTINGS
Remote Desktop Connection is allowed
CMA User Interface timeout (in sec)
Max number of sessions per user
: true
: 60
: 5
Max number of sessions per user enabled : false
Max number of sessions per system : 50
Max number of sessions per system enabled: false
LOCAL USER ACCOUNT CONFIGURATION
Failed login threshold
: 3
Failed login windows (hours)
Lockout duration (minutes)
: 1
: Indefinite
Account Inactivity threshold (days): 30
LOCAL PASSWORD REQUIREMENTS
Maximum password age (days)
: 180
Password warning interval (days): 7
Number of lowercase letters
Number of uppercase letters
Minimum length (characters)
Minimum password age (days)
Number of numbers
: 1
: 1
: 8
: 1
: 1
: 8
: 1
Reject previous passwords
Number of special characters
Minimum number of changed characters : 1
Maximum consecutive repeated characters: 1
304
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Reports
CERTIFICATE INFO
Certificate Common Name
: CMA Self-Signed Certificate
Certificate CRL Version
Certificate CRL Expired
Certificate Alias
: 0
: false
:
1.2.840.113549.1.9.1=#1613737570706f727440706f6c79636f6d2e636f6d,c
n=cma self-signed
certificate,ou=vsg,o=polycom,l=pleasanton,st=california,c=us
Certificate Issuer
: CMA Self-Signed Certificate
PRIMARY GATEKEEPER INFORMATION
GateKeeper Id
: PN:PLCM
GateKeeper description
: ReadiManager
GateKeeper Registration mode : ALL_ENDPOINTS
GateKeeper deny rogue calls : false
GateKeeper log rogue calls
: true
GateKeeper Statistics enabled: false
GateKeeper Registration timeout (days)
: 30
GateKeeper Registration refresh (seconds): 300
REDUNDANCY INFORMATION
Server 1 IP address: 10.47.10.150
Server 1 is PRIMARY: true
Server 1 is ON
: true
Server 2 IP address: N/A
Server 2 is PRIMARY: false
Server 2 is ON
: false
Virtual IP address : N/A
DATABASE CONFIGURATION
Use external DB
: false
Polycom, Inc.
305
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
306
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
21
System Administration Overview
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) system Dashboard, menu, and actions. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
Polycom CMA System Dashboard
When you log into the CMA system with Administrator role and permissions,
the system first displays the system Dashboard. Use the system Dashboard to
view information about system health and activity levels.
Note
We recommend that you use a minimum monitor display of 1280 x 1024 pixels to
view the system Dashboard.
The system Dashboard displays data in an array of charts, forms, data grids,
and other graphical displays. It is supremely customizable. You can modify
your system Dashboard layout by moving (select the pane title, hold, drag and
drop), minimizing, maximizing, closing, and restoring panes. Also note that
your changes to the system Dashboard are persistent not just for a session but
between logouts and logins.
Polycom, Inc.
307
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Dashboard Buttons
In general, the system Dashboard displays information only. However, the
following buttons are available from the Dashboard view.
Button
Use this button to....
Add Panes
Add additional display panes to the system Dashboard. See
Refresh
Update the page with current information. To change the
frequency of automatic screen refreshes from the default of 5
seconds, click the down arrow and select another option: 15, 30
45, or 60 seconds.
The Refresh button flashes when the system refreshes the
Dashboard or when you click Refresh.
Restart
Shutdown
Shuts down the CMA system. See “Restart or Shut Down a
Dashboard Panes
By default the system Dashboard displays the following informational panes:
•
•
•
•
•
•
But you can add or remove panes to customize the system Dashboard.
Additional panes that you can add include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Endpoints (multiple, configurable panes)
MCU Status (multiple, configurable panes)
308
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Administration Overview
These panes are described in more detail in the following topics.
Users Logged In
The Users Logged In pane displays the type and number of users that are
currently logged into the system. A sparkline presents the number of logins
over time (30 minutes total; updated every 5 minutes so there are 6 data points
on the sparkline) for each user type.
The system identifies three user types by their permissions: Administrators,
Operators, and Schedulers.
Note that these three user types are not necessarily the same as user roles. For
example, users assigned the default Administrator and default Device
Administrator roles appear in this pane as Administrators. And users
assigned the default View Only Scheduler, default Scheduler, and default
Advanced Scheduler roles appear in this pane as Schedulers.
CMA Configuration
The CMA Configuration pane displays information about the configuration
of the CMA system, including:
Field
Description
Software
Version
Displays the current version of CMA system software running on
the system.
Hardware
Version
The hardware of the CMA system.
CMAD
Shipped
Version
Displays the version of CMA Desktop for PC that shipped with
the version of CMA system software running on the system.
Users can download this version of the Polycom CMA Desktop
software from the Downloads page.
CMAD Mac
Shipped
Version
Displays the version of CMA Desktop for Macintosh that shipped
with the version of CMA system software running on the system.
Users can download this version of the Polycom CMA Desktop
software from the Downloads page.
Enterprise
Directory
Displays the enterprise directory configuration. Possible values
include:
•
Auto—If the system is configured to auto-discover the
enterprise directory server.
•
DNS name or IP address of the enterprise directory
server—If an enterprise directory server is specified on the
system configuration page.
•
None—If the system is not integrated with an enterprise
directory server.
Database
Displays the database source (Internal or External) and the
DNS name or IP address of the database server.
Polycom, Inc.
309
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Time Source
Displays the time server source (Internal or External) and the IP
address of the time server.
Redundancy
Displays whether or not the system is configured for redundancy.
The Redundancy field may also show two configuration errors:
Need Virtual IP or Secondary Is Down.
Remote Alerts
Displays whether or not the system is configured to send remote
alert notifications.
Enterprise
Directory DC
If the system is integrated with a domain controller for single sign
on authentication, displays the domain name for that domain
controller. If the system is not integrated with a single sign on
domain controller, this field displays Disabled.
Remote
Desktop
Displays whether or not Remote Desktop Connection is enabled.
CMA Info
The CMA Info pane displays general information about the CMA system,
including:
Field
Description
CPU
Utilization
Displays two views of the CMA system control processor unit
(CPU) usage:
•
A sparkline that presents the CPU usage over time (10
minutes total; updated every 1 minute so there are 10 data
points on the sparkline)
•
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage
Paging File
Displays two views of the CMA system paging file usage:
•
A sparkline that presents the paging file usage over time (10
minutes total; updated every 1 minute so there are 10 data
points on the sparkline)
•
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage
Last Hard
Displays the date and time of the last complete system start.
Start/Reboot
Provisioning in
Progress
Displays the number of scheduled endpoint provisioning
processes that are currently underway.
Software
Updates in
Progress
Displays the number of scheduled endpoint software update
processes that are currently underway.
Hardware
Alarms
The number of hardware components in the CMA system
reporting a warning state.
Threshold
Alarms
The number of hardware components in the CMA system
reporting an error state
310
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Administration Overview
Field
Description
Total Memory
Free Memory
The total amount of RAM on the CMA system.
The amount of free RAM space on the CMA system.
Partition [C:]
Memory
The amount of used and unused capacity on the CMA system
partition C.
Partition [D:]
Memory
The amount of used and unused capacity on the CMA system
partition D.
Partition [E:]
Memory
The amount of used and unused capacity on the CMA system
partition E.
Temperature
Temperature status information provided by the
Polycom-branded Dell server agent through its MIB
Power Supply
Status
Power supply status information provided by the
Polycom-branded Dell server agent thought its MIB
Battery Status
Battery status information provided by the Polycom-branded Dell
server agent thought its MIB
Cooling Fan
Fan status information provided by the Polycom-branded Dell
server agent thought its MIB
Services
The Services pane displays information about the CMA system services,
including:
•
•
•
How many services are running
How many services are stopped
A list of the services and a graphical indicator for each service indicating
its state: Running
or Stopped
. If a service is stopped, select the
service and a dialog box appears that describes the error, possible reasons
for the error, and suggestions to correct the error. Click the start service
icon to restart the service.
The following table lists the services, their purpose, and whether or not
they are essential to the health of the system.
Service
Manages the system’s...
Web processes
Comment
Essential
Essential
Apache2
MSSQLSERVER
OpenDS
Database processes
Site topology database
Required for site
topology functionality
Polycom Cascader
Cascaded conferencing
processes
Required for
cascading conferences
Polycom, Inc.
311
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Service
Manages the system’s...
Comment
Polycom Conference
Scheduling Service
Conference scheduling
processes
Essential
Polycom Device Manager Device management
processes
Essential
Essential
Polycom DialRuleService Dial rule management
processes
Polycom Gatekeeper
Polycom JServer
Gatekeeper processes
Essential
Essential
Java processes including
LDAP, SNMP, device
management, Site
Topology, and
dynamically-managed
device logins and
provisioning.
Polycom Master Service
Polycom Serial COM
Basic operation processes
Essential
Essential
Serial port management
processes
Polycom Service Monitor
Redundancy monitoring
processes
Required for
redundancy
When users log into a CMA system, the system first checks to make sure all
essential services are running before allowing users to access the system. The
following situations may occur.
•
•
If all essential services are running, users are allowed to access the system.
If one or more essential services is down, and the Apache service has been
running for less than seven minutes, users receive an error message
saying, “The CMA system is not ready. Please try again in a few minutes.”
•
If one or more essential services is down, but the Apache service has been
running for at least seven minutes, users are allowed to access the system.
In this case, specific system functions may be unavailable to users.
Gatekeepers
The Gatekeepers pane displays information about the CMA system as a
gatekeeper, including:
Field
Description
Gatekeeper
Statue
Displays the status of the CMA system gatekeeper. Possible
values are Up or Down.
312
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Administration Overview
Field
Description
Call Model
Describes how the CMA system routes selected H.225 call
signaling messages. Possible values include: Routed or Direct.
Neighbors
Displays the number of neighboring gatekeepers identified for the
CMA system.
Alternate
Configured
Displays whether or not the CMA system has an alternate
gatekeeper identified.
Registered
Devices
Displays the number of devices currently registered to the CMA
system gatekeeper.
Active Calls
Displays two views of the current CMA system active calls:
•
•
A number field that shows the current number of active calls
A graph that presents the percentage of active calls over time
Maximum
Allowed
The maximum number of active calls. This value is dependent on
the call model (routed or direct) and the total number of licenses
•
In routed mode, the maximum number of active calls is 30%
of the total number of licenses.
•
In direct mode, the maximum number of active calls is 60% of
the total number of licenses.
CMA Licenses
The CMA Licenses pane displays information about how the CMA system is
licensed, including:
•
•
The Total Number of Licenses available on the system
The Licenses in Use, which displays two views of the CMA system active
calls:
— A sparkline that presents the license usage over time (60 minutes total;
updated every 5 minutes so there are 12 data points on the sparkline).
— A percentage indicator that shows the current usage.
Pre-call Status
The Pre-call Status pane displays information about the next conference or
conferences that are scheduled to launch including:
Field
Description
Time to
Conference
Displays the system-defined pre-call status reporting time of 10
minutes. In other words, the Pre-call Status pane always reports
on conferences that are scheduled to start in the next 10 minutes.
Scheduled to
Launch
Displays the number of conferences scheduled to start in the
next 10 minutes.
Polycom, Inc.
313
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Ready to
Launch
Displays the subset of conferences that are scheduled to start in
the next 10 minutes and that have passed the resource tests that
the system executes before launching a conference.
Ready to
Launch with
Device in Call
Displays the subset of conferences that are scheduled to start in
the next 10 minutes and that have passed the resource tests but
that still have one or more devices in another call.
NOT Ready to
Launch
Displays the subset of conferences that are scheduled to start in
the next 10 minutes but that have not yet passed the resource
tests.
Also displays the conferences that are not ready to launch.
Today’s Adhoc Conferences
The Today’s Adhoc Conferences pane displays information about the ad hoc
conferences started by video endpoints registered to the CMA system. For the
current day (starting at 0:00 and ending at 24:00), it displays:
•
The number of ad hoc conferences that were Completed for the current
day
•
•
The number of ad hoc conferences that are Active at the current time
A bar chart that displays the number of ad hoc conferences (vertical axis)
plotted against time of day (horizontal axis)
Today’s Scheduled Conferences
The Today’s Scheduled Conferences pane displays information about the
scheduled conferences managed by the CMA system. For the current day
(starting at 0:00 and ending at 24:00), it displays:
•
•
•
•
The number of scheduled conferences that were Completed that day
The number of scheduled conferences that are Active at the current time
The number of scheduled conferences that are yet to occur (Future)
A bar chart that displays time on the linear axis plotted against the number
of scheduled conferences on the horizontal axis
Endpoints
The system allows you to add multiple Endpoints panes so you can create
your own scheme for grouping and monitoring endpoints. When you add an
Endpoints pane, you can give the pane a meaningful name and select which
endpoints to monitor. You can save the pane, create others as needed. You can
also reconfigure an Endpoints pane using the configuration tool.
Endpoints panes display the following information:
•
•
The number of endpoints being monitored
The number of monitored endpoints that are In a Call
314
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Administration Overview
•
•
The number of monitored endpoints that are Online
The number of monitored endpoints that are Offline
In addition, the Endpoints pane identifies any monitored endpoints that are
experiencing alert conditions. If you click on an endpoint in the list, the system
displays the Endpoint > Monitor View.
Finally, click View Endpoint to see the Status, Name, Alias, IP Address,
Owner, and Site for the monitored endpoints. This status information is sent
by the endpoints to the CMA system.
Systems
The Systems pane displays summary information about the devices registered
with the CMA system, including:
Field
Description
Endpoints
VVXs
The number of endpoints registered with the CMA system.
The number of VVX systems registered with the CMA system.
The number of MCUs registered with the CMA system.
MCUs
Gatekeepers
The number of neighbored gatekeepers identified to the CMA
system plus the CMA system itself.
Gateways
The number of individual H.323 cards and/or IP blades in
Polycom MCUs are assigned the device type of GW/MCU during
registration. For more information, see “Network Device Types”
Rooms
VBPs
The number of rooms defined with the CMA system.
The number of VBPs defined with the CMA system.
The number of DMAs defined with the CMA system.
DMAs
Touch Controls The number of Touch Controls defined with registered endpoints.
If any of the devices registered with the CMA system experience a fault, the
Systems pane also displays an alert icon. Click the alert icon to see the
Endpoint or Network Device view and get more information about the alert.
Conference Status
The Conference Status pane displays the list of active conferences, plus 2 of 6
participants online.
Click on conference title to go to conference monitor view for that conference.
Polycom, Inc.
315
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Failed Enterprise Directory Login Attempts
The Failed AD Login Attempts pane displays:
•
The total number of Failed Logins for Active Directory users in the last 24
hour period.
•
The domain\username for the Active Directory users whose login
attempts failed and how many times they failed. Click the
domain\username to view the date and time for the failed attempts.
Redundancy Status
The Redundancy Status pane displays information about the CMA system
redundancy configuration, including:
•
Whether or not the system is configured for redundancy. Possible values
for Status are Configured or Not Configured.
•
•
•
The Virtual IP Address for the redundant system
The IP address of the Active Server
The IP address of the Backup Server
MCU Status
The system allows you to add multiple MCU Status panes so you can create a
pane for all or individual MCUs registered with the CMA system. When you
add an MCU Status pane, you can give the pane a meaningful name and either
select an MCU to monitor or select All MCUs. You can save the pane, create
others as needed. You can also reconfigure an MCU Status pane using the
configuration tool.
The MCU Status pane for All MCUs displays the following information:
:
Note
Areas may affect an administrator’s ability to View Details for an MCU. The
administrator and MCU must be assigned to a common area.
Field
Description
Errors
Displays the cumulative number of alarms for all of the registered
MCUs.
Warnings
Displays the cumulative number of warnings for all of the
registered MCUs.
Active
Conferences
Displays the total number of active conferences being hosted by
all of the registered MCUs.
The MCU Status pane for All MCUs also lists all of the registered MCUs and
displays the Errors and Warnings for the MCUs.
316
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Administration Overview
The MCU Status pane for an individual MCU displays the following
information:
Field
Description
Errors
Displays the number of alarms on the MCU.
Warnings
Displays the number of conferences that are active on the MCU
at the current time.
Active
Conferences
Displays the number of active conferences currently being
hosted by the MCU.
Number of
Audio Ports
Displays the number of dedicated audio ports configured on the
MCU.
Audio Ports
Utilization
Displays two views of the MCU audio port usage:
•
•
A sparkline that presents the audio port usage over time
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage
Number of
Displays the number of video ports configured on the MCU.
Video Ports
Video Ports
Utilization
Displays two views of the MCU video port usage:
•
•
A sparkline that presents the video port usage over time
A percentage indicator that shows the current usage
Expected Port
Utilization
A timeline that shows how many ports are scheduled for
conferences within the next 45 minutes.
This status information is sent by the MCU to the CMA system.
In addition, the MCU Status pane identifies when the monitored MCU is
experiencing alert conditions.
System Administration Menu
The system Admin menu gives users with administrative permissions access
to the day-to-day management tasks they need to monitor, maintain, and
troubleshoot the CMA system. Besides the Dashboard, it lists these selections:
Selection
Use this selection to...
Conference
Templates
Manage (add, edit, and delete) conference templates. See
Conference Settings Enable or disable Conference Auto-launch and Conference
Provisioning Profiles Manage (add, edit, and delete) automatic or scheduled
provisioning profiles.
Polycom, Inc.
317
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Selection
Use this selection to...
Software Updates
Manage (add, edit, and delete) automatic or scheduled
software update packages.
Rooms
Manage (add, edit, and delete) rooms in the CMA system
directory.
Areas
Manage Areas for a CMA system.
Directories
Manage the directories available to the CMA system
including the enterprise directory, address books, or Global
Address Book.
Server Settings
Configure the basic CMA system, which includes the
network, system time, database, directory, licensing,
redundancy, branding, GAB, remote alert, and E-mail set
up.
SNMP Settings
Manage SNMP messaging for the CMA system.
Gatekeeper Settings By default the CMA system is made the default gatekeeper
during the First Time Setup process. Use the Gatekeeper
Settings option to modify this setting or to add an alternate
gatekeeper or neighboring gatekeepers.
Gatekeeper Settings affect how devices register and calls
are made in your video communications network. These
settings allow you to:
•
Identify the gatekeeper with an identifier and
description.
•
Specify registration-related settings, including the
default gatekeeper, which endpoints register, the
registration refresh period, and the offline timeout.
•
•
Set the maximum number of neighboring gatekeeper
hop counts.
Specify how to handle calls to and from unregistered
endpoints.
Management and
Security
Upgrade the CMA system and configure the certificate,
security, and endpoint management set up.
Dial Plan and Sites
Edit the default CMA system Dial Plan and Site settings
(which includes the definition of sites, site links, dial rules,
services, and least-cost routing tables) to support your
network topology and video call routing.
Alert Settings
Configure the CMA system to send E-mail alerts for
specified system or endpoint events.
Backup System
Settings
Download a .zip archive file containing all configuration
information necessary to restore the system.
Database Backup
FIles
View or backup the CMA system internal database backup
file.
318
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Administration Overview
Selection
Use this selection to...
Uploads
Upload SIP URI data to the CMA system.
Troubleshooting
Utilities
Access all of the troubleshooting information and utilities
the CMA system has available.
Report
Administration
Configure report administration settings including retention
periods, etc.
Polycom, Inc.
319
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
320
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
22
Conference Setup Overview
This chapter describes information about conference templates, options, and
settings within the Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) system. Two types of configuration settings relate to scheduled
conferences:
•
Conference Templates define most of the settings that become the defaults
for a conference.
•
Conference Settings are global system-wide settings that apply to all
scheduled conferences.
Conference Templates
Conference templates allow you to create various combinations of settings to
apply to scheduled conferences.
•
•
For scheduled conferences that end on MGC devices, the conference
template explicitly identifies the settings the MGC should use to control
the conference.
For scheduled conferences that end on RMX devices, the conference
template explicitly identifies the RMX profile which identifies the settings
the RMX should use to control the conference.
Users assigned the Administrator role can add or edit Conference Templates.
They can also identify (by user role) which users have access to which
Conference Templates and which users have the Advanced Scheduler role.
Then users select from the different templates available to them to switch
between different combinations of conference settings.
If using an existing profile on the RMX system, the CMA system administrator
must manually synchronize the settings in the CMA system conference
template and its associated RMX profile.
Alternatively, you can configure the RMX profile settings in the CMA system
conference template, which is used by all RMX systems in the conference. For
more information about the RMX profile settings, see the Polycom® RMX®
1500/2000/4000 Administrator’s Guide.
Polycom, Inc.
321
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
General Settings
Name
Enter a unique and meaningful name for the template,
which can be up to 32 characters long.
Description
Enter a meaningful description (ASCII only) of the
conference settings template.
Audio-Only
Template
Select this option to designate the template as an
audio-only template. Selecting this option disables many
settings.
Supported MCUs
Specify the supported MCU type. Possible values include:
•
•
MGC
RMX
Always Use MCU
Dial Options
When selected, an MCU is used for the scheduled
conference, regardless of the number of participants. When
not selected, an MCU is used only when necessary.
These settings apply only to video conferences. The video
dial options are:
•
•
•
Dial-In Only (all participants dial into the conference)
Dial-Out Only (all participants are called by the system)
Dial-In + Dial-Out (The person setting up the
conference can specify which participants must dial into
the conference and which participants are called by the
system.)
Template will be
available to users
with the selected
roles...
Select the roles to which users must be assigned for them
to see this template when scheduling conferences.
Available Roles
Selected Roles
The list of roles defined to the CMA system.
The list of roles that can use the conference template being
defined.
Common Settings
Meet Me Per
Conference
When selected, only one dial-in number is assigned to the
conference. When cleared, each dial-in participant is
assigned a different dial-in number.
322
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Overview
Field
Description
Sets the video layout for the conference. The default is
Video Mode
Video Switching Mode. To change to a Continuous
Presence layout or mode, click the switching icon and
select a layout option.
The video mode determines the initial layout on an
endpoint’s display during a multipoint conference. This
option requires an MCU.
This option is not available for RMX devices if you select
any of the following:
•
•
•
Auto layout option (RMX Video Settings)
Video switching option (RMX General Settings)
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)
Note
Make sure you have defined video endpoint systems and
boards so that they are available for selection in continuous
presence layouts.
Presentation Mode
•
Select to enable Presentation Mode. In this mode, the
system uses the selected layout to display all
participants. When a participant’s speech exceeds a
predefined time (30 seconds), the system identifies the
participant as the lecturer and changes to Lecture
Mode. The video mode for the other participant’s
automatically changes to full screen, displaying the
lecturer, while the lecturer’s endpoint displays
participants in the video mode defined previously. When
another participant starts talking, the system changes
back to Presentation Mode and the conference returns
to its predefined video layout.
•
Clear this option do disable Presentation Mode. All
participants see the conference in the video mode
defined elsewhere.
This option is not available if you select any of the following:
•
•
•
Video switching option (RMX General Settings)
Same layout option (RMX Video Settings)
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)
Notes
RMX 1000 systems do not support Lecture Mode,
Presentation Mode, or Lecture View Switching.
•
Polycom, Inc.
323
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Speed (Kbps)
Sets the speed for the conference, which applies to both
point-to-point and multipoint calls. Possible values for
Polycom MGC systems are between 96 to 1920 Kbps and
Bridged Audio. The default is 384 Kbps.
Note
If you use an RMX profile for conferences that land on an
RMX system, the speed designated here is used to reserve
bandwidth and must match the line rate defined in the RMX
profile that is identified in the Profile Name field.
Lecturer View
Switching
Select this option to enable automatic switching of
participants on the Lecturer’s screen when Lecture Mode
is set to Presentation Mode and the number of participants
exceeds the number of windows identified by the video
mode defined elsewhere.
This option is not available if you select any of the following:
•
•
Same layout option (RMX Video Settings)
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)
Note
RMX 1000 systems do not support Lecture Mode,
Presentation Mode, or Lecture View Switching.
MGC Settings
Entry Tone
Sets an entry tone sound when a participant enters a
conference.
Exit Tone
Sets an exit tone sound when a participant leaves a
conference.
End Time Alert Tone
Sets an alert tone to play into MCU-hosted conferences
indicating that the conference is scheduled to end soon.
Set the End Time Alert (minutes) field to configure when the
tone should be played into the conference.
Note
This feature is not related to the system-based Conference
Time Warning feature.
End Time Alert
(mins)
Specifies the number of minutes before the conference end
that the End Time Alert Tone should sound.
324
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Overview
Field
Description
Video Algorithm
Sets the compression algorithm that the MCU uses to
process video. Possible values include:
•
•
Auto
H261. An ITU standard designed for two-way
communication over ISDN lines and supports data rates
which are multiples of 64Kbit/s. H.261 supports CIF and
QCIF resolutions.
•
•
H263. Based on H.261 with enhancements that
improve video quality over modems. It supports CIF,
QCIF, SQCIF, 4CIF and 16CIF resolutions.
H264
The default is Auto.
Note
Selecting a video algorithm doesn't guarantee that it will be
chosen for a conference since the MCU device may
negotiate a different algorithm with the endpoints,
depending on the endpoint’s capabilities.
People + Content
Enable this setting when you have equipment that supports
the display of people and content. Sets the format type of
the content. Possible values include:
•
•
•
None
People+Content (H.239)
People and Content V0. To show both the presenter
and the content on a single display using HDX-Series
products.
•
•
•
Polycom Visual Concert PC. To show live PC content
using standard ViewStation® systems
Polycom Visual Concert FX. To integrate a laptop with
graphics into a video call using ViewStation® products
DuoVideo
None is the default.
Note
The MGC requires that conferences with People+Content
use a minimum speed of 192 K.
Talk Hold Time
(secs)
Indicates the minimum period that a participant has to
speak to become the main speaker. During this period, no
other participant may become the main speaker. The range
is from 1.5 seconds to 10 seconds, in increments of 0.01
seconds.
Polycom, Inc.
325
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
T120 Rate
Determines whether T.120 is enabled, and if so, the default
transfer rate. Enable this setting when you have equipment
that supports T.120 display of data. Options are: 6.4, 14.4,
16, 22.4, 24, 30.4, 32, 38.4, 40, 46.4, 54.4, and 62.4.
Note
Because this setting uses resources on the MCU device, it
is recommended that you select None.
Audio Algorithm
Sets the compression algorithm that the MGC uses to
process audio.
The default is Auto.
Note
Selecting a certain video/audio algorithm doesn't guarantee
that it will be chosen for a conference since an MGC device
may negotiate a different algorithm with the endpoints,
depending on the endpoint’s capabilities.
Audio Mix Depth
(sites)
Sets the number of participants with the loudest voices who
can speak at once during a conference. If additional
participants speak, their comments are not heard.
Conference on Port
When selected, this option conserves bandwidth and ports
by putting all participants on a single port. When
Conference on Port is enabled, the Video Mode must be
set to one of the Continuous Presence layouts.
RMX General Settings > RMX Profile Settings
Use existing profile Select to use an existing RMX profile.
Clear to set all of the RMX profile settings here in the
conference template. This method ensures that the RMX
profile settings are the way you want them and avoids
maintaining identical profiles on all RMX systems.
Note
With this option selected, conferences fail if they land on an
RMX device and a valid RMX profile is not specified below.
RMX profile name
Identifies the RMX profile for the conference, if the
conference is hosted on an RMX system.
Enter the RMX profile routing name, which is generally (but
not always) the same as the profile name as specified in the
RMX platform.
326
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Overview
Field
Description
RMX General Settings > Conference Settings
Video switching
(VSW)
In Video Switching mode, all participants see the same
video picture (full screen). The current speaker is displayed
in full screen on all the participants’ endpoints, while the
speaker sees the previous speaker. Switching between
participants is voice-activated; whenever a participant starts
to speak, he or she becomes the conference speaker and is
viewed on all screens.
When selected, the conference is of ultra-high quality video
resolution, in a special conferencing mode which implies
that all participants must connect at the same line rate and
use HD video.
This feature utilizes the resources more wisely and
efficiently by:
•
Saving utilization of video ports (1 port per participant as
opposed to 4 ports in CP mode).
•
Video display is in full screen mode only.
Drawbacks of this feature are that all participants must
connect at the same line rate, (for example, HD), and all
participants with endpoints not supporting HD will connect
as secondary (audio only).
Video layout changes are not enabled during a conference.
If HD 1080p is selected, endpoints that do not support HD
1080p resolution are connected as secondary (audio only)
participants.
Note:
•
This option is not available if MGC is selected as a
Supported MCU (General Settings).
•
Video Switching conferencing mode is unavailable to
ISDN participants.
Resolution
Possible values include:
•
•
•
•
H.264 SD 30(v7 with MPM+ or MPMx)
H.264 720p60(v7 with MPM+ or MPMx)
H.264 720p30
H.264 1080p30(MPM+ or MPMx)
RMX General Settings > Advanced Settings
Auto redialing Instructs the Polycom RMX to automatically redial IP and
SIP participants that have been abnormally disconnected
from the conference.
•
The RMX will not redial an endpoint that has been
disconnected from the conference by the participant.
•
The RMX will not redial an endpoint that has been
disconnected or deleted from the conference by an
operator or administrator.
Polycom, Inc.
327
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Encryption
LPR
Activate encryption for the conference
Activate lost packet recovery (LPR) for the conference.
Note:
LPR can be enabled for VSW conferences, but H.320 and
SIP participants will not be able to connect.
Auto terminate
When selected (default), the conference automatically ends
when the termination conditions are met:
•
Before first joins — No participant has connected to a
conference during the n minutes after it started. Default
idle time is 10 minutes.
•
At the end - After last participant quits — All the
participants have disconnected from the conference
and the conference is idle (empty) for the predefined
time period. Default idle time is 1 minute.
•
At the end - When last participant remains — Only
one participant is still connected to the conference for
the predefined time period (excluding the recording link
which is not considered a participant when this option is
selected). This option should be selected when defining
a profile that will be used for Gateway Calls and you
want to ensure that the call is automatically terminated
when only one participant is connected. Default idle
time is 1 minute.
RMX Video Quality > People Video Definition
Video quality
Optimizes the video quality based on the amount of
movement contained in the conference video. Possible
values include:
•
Motion—Provides a higher frame rate without
increased resolution.
•
Sharpness—Provides a higher video resolution and
requires more system resources.
Max resolution (v7)
Depending on whether MPM+ or MPMx cards are installed,
the possible values include:
•
•
•
•
•
Auto
CIF
HD 1080
HD 720
SD
328
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Overview
Field
Description
Video clarity (MPM+
and MPMx only)
Applies video enhancing algorithms to incoming video
streams of resolutions up to and including SD. Clearer
images with sharper edges and higher contrast are sent
back to all endpoints at the highest possible resolution
supported by each endpoint.
This option is not available if you select any of the following:
•
•
Motion option for Video quality
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General
Settings)
Auto brightness (v7) Detects and automatically adjusts the brightness of video
windows that are dimmer than other video windows in the
conference layout.
This option is not available if you set Telepresence mode
to On (RMX Video Settings).
RMX Video Quality > Content Video Definition
Content settings
Select the transmission mode for the content channel:
•
•
Graphics — Basic mode, intended for normal graphics.
Hi-resolution graphics — Higher bit rate intended for
high resolution graphic display.
•
Live video — Content channel displays live video.
Selection of a higher bit rate for the content results in a
lower bit rate for the people channel.
Content protocol
The possible values are:
•
H.263 – Content is shared using H.263 even if some
endpoints have H.264 capability.
•
Up to H.264 – H.264 is the default content sharing
algorithm. When selected:
Content is shared using H.264 if all endpoints have
H.264 capability.
Content is shared using H.263 if all endpoints do not
have H.264 capability.
Endpoints that do not have at least H.263 capability
can connect to the conference but cannot share
content.
Polycom, Inc.
329
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
RMX Video Settings
Send content to
legacy endpoints
(MPM+ and MPMx
only)
Content can be sent to H.323/ SIP/ISDN endpoints that do
not support H.239 content (legacy endpoints) over the video
(people) channel.
This option is not available if you select any of any of the
following:
•
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General
Settings)
•
Same layout option
Notes:
When enabled, additional video resources are allocated to
the conference.
Same layout
Select this option to force the selected layout on all
participants in a conference. Displays the same video
stream to all participants and personal selection of the
video layout is disabled. If participants are forced to a video
layout window, they can see themselves.
This option is not available if you select any of the following:
•
•
MGC as a Supported MCU (General Settings)
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General
Settings)
•
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)
Auto layout
Select this option to have the system automatically select
the conference layout based on the number of participants
currently connected to the conference. When a new video
participant connects or disconnects, the conference layout
automatically changes to reflect the new number of video
participants.
Clear this option to manually select a layout for the
conference using the Video Mode options.
This option is not available if you select any of any of the
following:
•
•
MGC as a Supported MCU (General Settings)
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General
Settings)
•
•
Lecture View Switching option (Common Settings)
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)
330
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Overview
Field
Description
Telepresence mode
(v6)
The possible values are:
•
Auto (Default) - If any ITP (Immersive Telepresence)
endpoints are detected, ITP features are applied to the
conference video for all participants.The ITP features
are dynamic. If all ITP endpoints disconnect from the
conference, normal conference video resumes for all
participants. ITP features resume for all participants if
an ITP endpoint reconnects to the conference.
•
•
On - ITP features are applied to the conference video
for all participants regardless of whether there are ITP
endpoints connected.
Off - Normal conference video.
Note:
•
This field is enabled only if the RMX system is licensed
for Telepresence Mode.
•
This option is not available if MGC is selected as a
Supported MCU (General Settings).
Telepresence layout
mode (v6)
Enables VNOC operators and Polycom Multi Layout
Applications to retrieve Telepresence Layout Mode
information from the RMX.
The possible values include:
•
Manual
•
Continuous Presence - Room continuous presence
(default)
•
Room Switch - Voice activated room switching
This option is not available if MGC is selected as a
Supported MCU (General Settings).
RMX Audio Settings
Echo suppression
(Supported only with MPM+ or MPMx cards.) Enables an
algorithm to search for and detect sounds outside the
normal range of human speech (such as echo) and
automatically mute them when detected.
Keyboard noise
suppression
(Supported only with MPM+ or MPMx cards.) Enables an
algorithm to search for and detect keyboard noises and
automatically mute them when detected.
Audio clarity (v7)
(Supported only with MPM+ or MPMx cards.) Improves
received audio from participants connected via low audio
bandwidth connections, by stretching the fidelity of the
narrowband telephone connection to improve call clarity.
The enhancement is applied to the following low bandwidth
(8kHz) audio algorithms: G.729a and G.711.
Polycom, Inc.
331
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
RMX Skins
Select the skin you want. Skins modify the background and
frames. With the top two skin options, the frames fill the
screen with their borders touching.
These options are not available if you select any of the
following:
•
Video switching (VSW) option (RMX General
Settings)
•
Telepresence mode is On (RMX Video Settings)
RMX Conference IVR
Override default
conference IVR
service
Select to override the default conference Interactive Voice
Response (IVR).
Conference IVR
service
If you selected the override option above, enter the name of
the conference IVR service you want to use. All RMX
systems that could be used must have the same
conference IVR service set up.
Conferencerequires Select this option to require that a video chairperson control
chairperson
the conference from his or her video endpoint system.
When this option is implemented, the system will assign a
15-digit password that the conference chairperson must
enter to control the conference. The conference scheduler
can change this system-assigned password to any 15-digit
number.
In this case:
•
The video chairperson must have a video endpoint
system.
•
•
The conference requires an MCU.
All conference participants remain in the waiting room
and cannot join the conference until the conference
chairperson enters the conference.
H.243 chair control allows an endpoint to control the
conference using the H.243 chair control feature. The
chairperson can disconnect participants, force the use of a
continuous presence video layout, and terminate the
conference.
H.243 cascade control allows the MGC-50 or MGC-100 to
support a cascading configuration of conferences with the
capabilities of H.243.
Note
•
Set in the RMX profile for RMX 2000/4000 devices
•
The RMX 1000 system does not support the
Chairperson feature.
332
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Overview
Field
Description
RMX Recording
Enable recording
Enables the recording settings. If no Recording links are
found, an error message is displayed.
Record conference
Recording link (v7)
The possible values are:
•
Immediately – Conference recording is automatically
started upon connection of the first participant.
•
Upon request – The operator or chairperson must
initiate the recording (manual).
Enter the name of the Recording link you want to use. The
recording link defines the connection between the
conference and the recording system to be used for
conference recording.
Recording links defined on the RMX can be given a
descriptive name and can be associated with a Virtual
Recording Room (VRR) saved on the Polycom® RSS™
4000 Version 6.0 Recording and Streaming Server (RSS).
All RMX systems that could be used must have the same
recording link set up.
Audio only
Records only the audio channel of the conference.
Indication of
recording
Displays a recording icon to all conference participants
informing them that the conference is being recorded. The
recording icon is replaced by a paused icon when
conference recording is paused.
Polycom CMA system has a Default Template. Administrators with
Conference Setup permissions can edit the Default Template and create
additional templates with different settings.
When scheduling a conference, the Default Template, which is available to all
users, is selected by default. Schedulers can select a different conference
template from the list of templates an administrator has made available to
them. Users with advanced scheduling permissions can edit the template
settings for a specific scheduled conference. These changes apply only to the
specified conference.
Use these best practices when working with conference templates.
•
For the Default Template, select settings that are the lowest common
values for all device types. This ensures that all conferences scheduled
with the Default Template can successfully launch on whatever devices
the system has available at the time.
•
The template names Default Template and Default Audio Templates are
stored in the system database and their names are not localized into other
languages. If you wish to localized their names into your language, edit
the templates and enter new names for them.
Polycom, Inc.
333
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
When creating new templates, give them meaningful purposes and names
so that your users can easily identify the differences between template
choices. For example, identify templates according to maximum bit rate,
specific features implemented by the template (for example, Lecture Mode
or Chairperson Control), and/or supported MCU type (MGC or RMX).
•
•
In a mixed-MCU environment, consider the advantages and
disadvantages of creating one or more conference templates for each MCU
type. This ensures that the system can select a specific type of MCU and
can implement the chosen conference settings.
Remember that using an existing RMX profile will override settings
specified when scheduling a conference through the Polycom CMA
system. To ensure consistent and expected behavior, make sure to
synchronize and lock down RMX profiles and Polycom CMA system
conference templates.
Note
Polycom CMA systems do not support scheduling of third-party MCUs. Template
settings apply only to the MGC or RMX devices.
Conference Settings
Conference settings apply to all conferences scheduled using the Polycom
CMA system. These settings include:
Field
Description
Conference Time
Warning
Specifies whether or not the Polycom CMA system sends a
message to video endpoints in a conference to warn the
endpoint users that their conference is scheduled to end
soon. The system sends the message 15 minutes and 5
minutes before the conference is scheduled to end.
To support this feature, the video endpoint system must be
capable of receiving a system Send Message action.
By default, Conference Time Warning is enabled.
Note
This feature is not related to the MCU-based End Time
Alert Tone feature.
Automatically
Include Conference
Owner (Scheduler)
Select this option when you wish the system to always
include the person scheduling the conference as a
conference participant. Do not select this option if your
in New Conferences organization has assistants or operators schedule
conferences for others.
334
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Overview
Field
Description
Allow overbooking
of dial-in
participants
Select this option to allow schedulers to schedule dial-in
participants to dial into multiple conferences, but the system
reserves resources for the participant for only the first
scheduled conference
Conference and
chairperson
passcode length
Designate the required length of the system-generated
conference and chairperson passcodes. The acceptable
length for both of these passcodes is 9 to 16 characters. By
default, the required length for both of these passcodes is
set to 15 characters.
Note
•
Depending on the system settings, the scheduler may
be allowed to change the conference or chairperson
passcode. However, the passcode length requirement
still applies.
•
If an administrator changes the passcode length here at
the same time a scheduler edits the passcode settings
for a scheduled conference, the scheduling operation
may use either the old or the new length, depending on
the exact timing.
Polycom, Inc.
335
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
336
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
23
Conference Setup Operations
This chapter includes information about conference options and tasks within
the Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It
includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
View the Conference Templates List
To view the Conference Template list
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.
The Conference Templates list appears.
Polycom, Inc.
337
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Add a Conference Template
To add a conference template
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.
On the Conference Templates list, click Add
.
Complete the General Info and MCU Settings sections of the Add
Conference Template dialog box first. Your selection for MCU Settings
affect your choices in the Video Settings section. For more information
on the Add Conference Template dialog box, see “Conference Templates”
4
5
Complete the Video Settings and Conf Settings sections of the Add
Conference Template dialog box.
Click OK.
The new template appears in the Conference Template list.
Note
The CMA system does not validate the Conference Template settings. When you
create a new conference template, you must make certain that the settings match
the capabilities of the MCUs (MGC or RMX device) or endpoints.
Edit a Conference Template
To edit a conference template
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.
On the Conference Templates list, select the template of interest and
click Edit
.
3
Edit the General Info, Video Settings, MCU Settings, and Conf Settings
sections of the Edit Conference Template dialog box as required.
Note
If you change the conference template Speed setting and there are scheduled
conferences using that template, all endpoints in the scheduled conferences are
reset to whichever is less: the new template Speed or the maximum speed that the
endpoint supports.
4
Click OK.
338
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Operations
Delete a Conference Template
To delete a conference template
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Templates.
On the Conference Templates list, select the template of interest and
click Delete
.
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Set Conference Settings
To specify conference settings
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.
On the Conference Settings page, make the required selections.
3
Click Update.
Disable Conference Auto-Launch
To disable conference auto-launch
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.
In the Conference Auto-Launch section of the Conference Settings page,
check the Disabled check box.
3
Click Update.
Disable Conference Time Warning
To disable the conference time warning
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.
In the Conference Time Warning section of the Conference Settings
page, clear the Enabled check box.
3
Click Update.
Polycom, Inc.
339
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Overbooking Dial-in Participants
In the CMA system, an administrator can configure the system to allow
schedulers to overbook dial-in participants. In this case, dial-in participants
can be scheduled to dial into multiple conferences, but the system reserves
resources for the participant for only the first scheduled conference. Dial-out
participants cannot be scheduled into multiple conferences.
Note
Schedulers can only overbook dial-in participants if they select a conference
template that has the Video Dial Option set to Dial-In Only. A conference template
that has the Video Dial Option set to Dial In+Dial Out will not work for this
purpose.
To allow schedulers to overbook dial-in participants
1
2
Go to Admin > Conference Settings.
In the Allow Overbooking of dial-in participants section of the
Conference Settings page, check the Enabled check box.
3
Click Update.
Add Customized Text to E-mail Notifications
To add customized text to all conferencing E-mail notifications
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.
In the Text at the Beginning of the Reminder E-mail section of the
E-mail page, type in the introductory text you want to appear at the start
of all conferencing E-mail notifications.
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will
appear in plain text just as you typed it.
3
4
In the Text at the End of the Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page,
type in the closing text you want to appear at the end of all conferencing
E-mail notifications.
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will
appear in plain text just as you typed it.
Click Update.
340
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Conference Setup Operations
Edit Customized Text in E-mail Notifications
To edit the customized text in all conferencing E-mail notifications
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.
To change the introductory text, replace the text in the Text at the
1
2
Beginning of the Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page with the
new text you want to appear at the start of all conferencing E-mail
notifications.
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will
appear in plain text just as you typed it.
3
4
To change the closing text, replace the text in the Text at the End of the
Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page with the new text you want
to appear at the end of all conferencing E-mail notifications.
This text field is limited to 650 characters. The text you type here will
appear in plain text just as you typed it.
Click Update.
Delete Customized Text in E-mail Notifications
To delete the customized text in all conferencing E-mail notifications
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.
To delete the introductory text, select the text in the Text at the
Beginning of the Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page and press
DELETE.
3
4
To delete the closing text, select the text in the Text at the End of the
Reminder E-mail section of the E-mail page and press DELETE.
Click Update.
Polycom, Inc.
341
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
342
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
24
Room Overview and Operations
This chapter describes how to set up rooms in the Polycom® Converged
Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
Local and Enterprise Meeting Rooms
The CMA system allows a user assigned the default Administrator role to
manage local and enterprise meeting rooms and the endpoints associated with
those meeting rooms.
Most often a CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory to which
rooms have been added. However, the CMA system also allows you to add
local rooms (that is, rooms added manually to the system) and associate them
with endpoints.
For dynamically managed endpoints associated with a room, you must also
associate each room in the CMA system with a machine account. The machine
account allows the room’s endpoint to connect and authenticate with the CMA
system for directory and dynamic management purposes without using the
endpoint user’s account. After you add a room, you can create the machine
account and associate the room with the machine account. For more
Polycom, Inc.
343
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
View the Rooms List
To view the Rooms list
Go to Admin > Rooms.
The Rooms list appears. It can be filtered by Site.
Column
Room Name
Description
Site
Description
The unique and required name of the room.
The optional description of the room.
The location of the room as identified in the site
topology.
Associated
Endpoints
The primary endpoint associated with this room. A set of
ellipses (...) indicates the room has more than one
associated endpoint.
Add a Local Room
When you add a local room to a CMA system, you specify settings for it and
associate one or more endpoints with it.
To add a local room
1
2
Go to Admin > Rooms.
On the Rooms page, click Add
.
The Add New Room dialog box appears.
3
4
If you are logged into a domain other than the Local domain, click
Manually Define.
Complete the General Info and Associated Devices sections of the Add
New Room dialog box. The following table shows the room information
in the CMA system records.
Field
Description
General Info
Room Name
The name of the room, which appears in the address
book for associated endpoints.
Description
(Optional) A useful description (ASCII only) of the room.
344
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Room Overview and Operations
Field
Description
Site
The site in which the room is located.
Note
Rooms and the endpoint associated with them must be
assigned to the same site.
Email
(Optional) The E-mail address of the room administrator.
Associated Endpoints
Available
Endpoints
The list of unassigned endpoints that are managed by the
CMA system.
Selected
Endpoints
The list of endpoints assigned to the room. The endpoint
at the top of the list is the primary endpoint. You can
change the order of endpoint priority by selecting an
endpoint and clicking Move Up or Move Down.
5
6
In the Dial String Reservations section, select the user’s Device and enter
the appropriate dial strings for SIP URI, E164, and H323 ID, then click
Apply.
The dial strings appear in the list below.
If the user has multiple endpoints, enter the dial strings for one endpoint
type at a time and click Apply each time.
Click OK.
The room is added to the CMA system. Note that the system does not
distinguish between enterprise rooms and local rooms once they’ve been
added to the system.
Add an Enterprise Room
If your CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, you can add a
room from the enterprise directory to the CMA system.
To add an enterprise room
1
2
Go to Admin > Rooms.
On the Rooms list, click Add Room
.
The Add New Room dialog box appears.
Polycom, Inc.
345
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
To find a room in the enterprise directory:
a
In the Search Value field, type in the first few characters of the room
name.
The system does a prefix search of the appropriate fields.
b
Click Search.
A list of the enterprise users and rooms that meet the search criteria
appears. If the search found more than 500 matching entries, only the
first 500 are displayed.
c
Select the room of interest and click Define Details.
4
5
Complete the General Info, Associated Devices, and Dial String
Reservations sections of the Add New Room dialog box. For information
Click OK.
The room is added to the CMA system. Note that the system does not
distinguish between enterprise rooms and local rooms once they’ve been
added to the system.
Edit a Room
To edit a room
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Rooms.
In the Rooms list, select the room of interest and click Edit
.
Edit the General Info, Associated Devices, and Dial String Reservations
sections of the Edit Room dialog box. For information on these fields, see
4
Click OK.
Delete a Room
To delete a room
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Rooms
.
In the Rooms list, select the room of interest and click Delete.
In the Delete Room dialog box, click Yes.
The room is deleted from the CMA system.
346
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
25
Area Overview and Operations
This chapter describes how to set up areas in the Polycom® Converged
Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Areas Overview
Because the CMA system is a role-based system, users see only the pages and
functions available to their roles and the permissions assigned to their user
roles. However, users can perform those functions on any endpoint or
network device defined to the system unless the Areas feature is implemented.
By implementing areas, the CMA system administrator with System Setup
permissions can limit access to endpoints and network devices to a specific set
of administrators, operators, and schedulers.
How Areas Work
Areas add another dimension of permissions to scheduling, monitoring, and
administration of endpoints and network devices. Besides the permissions
enabled and disabled by roles and groups, the system now has a set of
permissions enabled and disabled by areas.
Polycom, Inc.
347
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Areas also limit access to directory entries. For example, a user associated with
Area1 will not see a user associated with Area2 in the directory. However, the
Area1 user can call the Area2 user with the correct H.323 address.
To implement areas, complete the following tasks
1
As a best practice, create an Area Administrator role. Assign that role to
the people you want to administer devices in areas but not the CMA
system itself.
2
A CMA system user with System Setup permissions can configure areas.
When configuring areas, you can also change the term (both singular and
plural) used to describe areas. For example, if you plan to limit users’
access to devices based on their department, you may want to label this
function Departments. If you plan to limit users’ access to devices based
on their line of business, you may want to label this function Line of
Business.
3
4
A CMA system user with System Setup permissions can add areas.
Adding areas includes naming the area, assigning devices to the area, and
associating users with the area.
A CMA system user with Associate Devices to Areas permissions can
assign an area when adding or editing an endpoint or network device. To
assign multiple devices to an area, you can use the Assign Area action on
the Monitor View page. A device can only be assigned to one area. Only
administrators associated with All Areas can assign a device with no area
assignment to an area.
5
A CMA system user with Assign CMA Users to Areas permissions can
associate users with one or more areas when adding or editing users. To
associate multiple users with areas, you can use the Assign Areas action
on the User > Users page. Users can be associated with multiple areas.
Note that only users that have a CMA system role can be associated with
areas.
Area Best Practices
Plan your area strategy with the following in mind:
•
After you start assigning endpoints to areas, you must associate users with
areas. The setting of None does not let users see endpoints assigned to an
area.
348
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Area Overview and Operations
•
•
•
Endpoints and network devices can be assigned to only one area.
Users can be associated with more than one area.
Schedulers can only schedule endpoints assigned to the same area the
scheduler is associated with.
•
If you set up areas to correspond to sites, you must also set up site links
between each site to permit calls between sites.
View Areas
You can view the list of existing areas from Admin > Areas. The following
information is available.
Field
Description
Areas list
Name
Meaningful name for the area.
Description of the area.
Description
Associated Devices
Members
Summary
Name
Number of devices assigned to the area.
Number of users assigned to the area.
Name of the selected area.
Description
Members
User ID
Description of the selected area.
List of users associated with the selected area
Member’s CMA system user ID.
Member’s first name.
First Name
Last Name
Member’s last name.
List of endpoints and network devices assigned to the
selected area.
Associated Devices
Device ID
Device ID of the associated device.
Device name of the associated device.
Site of the associated device.
Device Name
Site
You may not see all areas that exist in the system. Only administrators that are
associated with All Areas can see all the of areas in the system.
Polycom, Inc.
349
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Create Area Administrator Role
As a best practice, create an area administrator role to separate CMA system
administration from area administration.
To create an area administrator role
1
2
3
Go to User > User Roles.
On the User Roles page, click Add.
Complete the Name and Description fields of the Add Role dialog box
and assign the desired permissions to the new role. At a minimum, add
Associate Devices to Area permission to this role.
4
Click Save.
The new user role appears in the CMA system.
Enable, Configure, and Customize Areas
Before you can use areas, you must enable areas for endpoints and network
devices. You can also change the term Area used in the CMA system interface
to fit your use of areas.
To enable, configure, and customize the Areas function
1
2
Go to Admin > Areas and on the Areas page click Configure Areas.
In the Configure Areas dialog box, click Enable Areas for endpoints and
network devices.
3
(Optional) To use a different term for the Areas function that is more
meaningful to your business, enter the Singular and Plural term in the
appropriate field. For example, Agency or Department.
Note
This configuration change will not take place until you restart the CMA system.
4
5
Click Save Configuration.
If you changed the Area term, go to Admin > Dashboard and click
Restart to restart the CMA system.
After the system restarts, the Areas function will be renamed and enabled.
By default, the CMA system maintains an All area, to which you, as the
enabler of the function are assigned.
350
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Area Overview and Operations
Add Areas
When you add areas, you can assign devices and users to the area.
Note
If the Areas option on your CMA system has been customized and renamed, the
CMA system user interface will use that custom terminology.
To add areas
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Go to Admin > Areas and click Add.
In the Add an Area dialog box, enter the Area Name and Description.
To associate devices with the area, click Associate Devices.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the device list.
Select the devices to be assign to the area and click the right arrow.
To assign users to the area, click Assign Area Members.
In the Search Users field, enter the name for the user of interest and press
Enter.
Note
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First
Name, and Last Name fields.
8
9
Select the users to assign to the area and click the right arrow.
When complete, click OK.
Assign Devices to Areas
You can assign one or more unassociated devices to an existing area. Devices
can only be associated with one area.
Notes
•
After you assign devices with an area, only users associated with the same area
or to All Areas can see the devices in the CMA system.
•
The user setting of None does not let users see endpoints assigned to an area.
To assign devices to areas
Go to Endpoint > Monitor View or Network Device > Monitor View.
1
Polycom, Inc.
351
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
Click Associate Area.
The Assign Area to Endpoints or Assign Area to Network Devices dialog
box appears with a list of endpoints or network devices.
3
4
5
Select the devices to assign to an area.
From the Assign Area drop-down, select the area to assign.
Click Assign Area.
Associate Users with Areas
You can associate one or more users with an existing area. A user can be
assigned to as many areas as needed.
Note
After you associate users with an area, they can only see devices assigned to the
same area in the CMA system.
To associate users with areas
1
2
Go to Admin > Areas and click Manage Members.
In the Manage Area Members dialog box, enter the name for the user of
interest in the Search Users field and press Enter.
Note
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First
Name, and Last Name fields.
3
4
5
Select the users to assign to an area and click the right arrow.
Click Assign Areas.
Select one of the following options and click the right arrow.
— All Areas—Gives the users access to all devices, regardless of the area
the devices are assigned to.
— Specific Areas—Give the users access to only devices assigned to the
areas selected below. Select one or more areas in the list below.
6
Click OK.
352
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Area Overview and Operations
Change Area Association for Users
To remove area associations from users
1
2
Go to Admin > Areas and click Manage Members.
In the Manage Members dialog box, enter the name for the user of
interest in the Search Users field and press Enter.
Note
Searches for a user are case-insensitive, prefix searches of the Username, First
Name, and Last Name fields.
3
4
5
6
Select the user of interest and click the right arrow.
Click Unassign Areas.
Select the areas to unassign and click the right arrow.
Click OK.
Delete an Area
You can only delete areas that are not associated with devices or assigned
members.
To delete an Area from the the Polycom CMA System
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Areas and on the Areas page select the area of interest.
Click Edit
.
Click Associate Devices and move any devices out of the Selected
Devices list.
4
Click Assign Area Members and move any devices out of the Selected
Area Members list.
5
6
7
Click OK.
When the Areas page reappears, click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Polycom, Inc.
353
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
354
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
26
Directory Operations
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) enterprise directory integration and operations. It includes these
topics:
•
•
•
•
Directory Management Overview
In a large organization, integrating your CMA system with Microsoft Active
Directory greatly simplifies the task of managing conference system security.
Directory management provides the following features.
•
•
•
Single sign-on capability. Users get the benefits of pass-through
authentication, allowing them to leverage their Active Directory user
name and password to login to the Polycom CMA Desktop system. This
happens without the user having to enter their credentials, creating
seamless integration for logins.
Single management environment. After the initial setup of the CMA
system, adding groups into CMA system is no more complex than adding
a group to a file share or database. Continue to manage your group
memberships through Active Directory, then grant those groups rights
within the CMA system.
Allows you to continue leveraging the existing role-based security model
that you have in place, though the CMA system only uses Universal
groups.
Polycom, Inc.
355
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Directory Management Supported Configurations
There are many possible configurations available within Microsoft Active
Directory, some of which are not fully supported by the CMA system. This
section describes the implications of different Microsoft Active Directory
configurations for integrating with the CMA system.
Multiple Forests
Microsoft Active Directory may be set up in either a single-forest or
multi-forest configuration. However, the CMA system requires that user
accounts reside in a single forest.
Multiple Domains
Microsoft Active Directory forests may contain one or more domains. In either
configuration, the directory must have a Global Catalog service. The CMA
system can integrate to either single or multiple domains, so long as they
reside in the same forest structure.
Microsoft Active Directory domains are organized into trees, each tree being a
group of domains which share a consistent DNS namespace (ex: polycom.com
and na.polycom.com would be in the same tree, while polycom.com and
CMADevelopment.net would be separate trees, if they were in the same
forest). The CMA system will integrate to all domains in a multi-tree forest.
Viable options:
1
2
Integrate to all domains of a multi-domain forest configuration.
Restrict to a single domain tree in a multi-domain forest through the use
of LDAP Search baseDN criteria.
Groups
Microsoft Active Directory provides three group scopes: Universal, Global,
and Domain Local. Both Global groups and Universal Groups are held on all
Global Catalog servers in the forest. The CMA system supports only the
Universal groups.
Microsoft Active Directory provides two group types: Security and
Distribution. The CMA system supports either of these group types.
356
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Directory Operations
Note
An Active Directory forest with a functional level of Windows 2000 Mixed mode only
supports Universal Distribution groups. Windows 2000 Native mode, Windows
2003 Mixed, and Windows 2003 forest functional levels support Universal Security
and Distribution groups.
In addition to leveraging Active Directory Universal groups, the CMA system
also has Local groups, which you can use to grant a standard set of rights to
multiple users or groups. These CMA system Local groups can have as
members, CMA system Local users, Active Directory users or Active Directory
Universal groups. In this fashion, you can nest a variety of users and groups
into a CMA system Local group and assign those users rights through their
CMA system Local group membership, simplifying management of rights on
the CMA system.
Users
The CMA system supports both local and enterprise user accounts. Local user
accounts exist entirely on the CMA system. They can be created and managed
whether or not the system is integrated to an enterprise directory. Enterprise
user accounts exist in your enterprise Active Directory. The CMA system
cannot create or manage Active Directory accounts, except to modify their
privileges on the CMA system itself.
If simultaneously using local and enterprise accounts, it is important to avoid
duplication of account data. For example, if your Active Directory has a user
named John Doe with a username of jdoe, a local account for this user must
possess a unique name, such as localjdoe or johndoetest. If duplicate user
accounts exist in the same domain or across domains, the user associated with
these accounts will not be able to log into a dynamically-managed endpoint.
The CMA system accesses the enterprise directory in a read-only mode. It does
not create, modify, or delete Active Directory users or groups in any way.
Once you integrate with an enterprise directory, it's best to minimize your
dependency on local users. A single local administrative user account must
exist, and it should be used only when there is a problem connecting to the
enterprise directory.
This configuration provides flexibility and varying security levels as follows:
•
Restricted access: For security reasons, local user accounts do not have
access to any data in Active Directory, though they can see the Active
Directory users and groups as defined in the CMA system's security.
•
Administration: Active Directory users and their Active Directory group
memberships are managed through your Active Directory. CMA system
local users are managed through the CMA system's web interface.
Polycom, Inc.
357
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
Security: Local accounts have their own passwords, which are stored on
the CMA system. Active Directory user accounts maintain the same users'
Active Directory credentials and password complexity policies, which are
validated by the domain controllers.
How Global Catalog Searches Work
When you integrate the CMA system with Active Directory, you can configure
it to integrate in one of two ways:
•
It can access a specific global catalog server by host name or IP address
(not recommended, due to a lack of redundancy).
If you select this option, the domain name that you specify for the CMA
system must match the DNS name suffix of the Global Catalog server
(example: dc1.polycom.com configured as the Global Catalog, then you
must enter polycom.com as the domain name of the CMA system server).
•
It can auto-discover the server by querying the DNS for the closest Global
Catalog server (strongly recommended).
If you select this option, you can specify any domain in the Active
Directory forest in the Domain Name criteria for the CMA system server.
The DNS server must contain Active Directory-specific entries.
It is recommended that you enter the forest root DNS domain name.
When configured to auto-discover the server, every time the CMA system
needs to bind to a Global Catalog server for LDAP queries, the CMA system
performs the following.
•
•
•
Uses Microsoft's LDAP Ping mechanism to determine the site in which the
system is located.
Uses a DNS SRV record query to find a Global Catalog server within the
same site.
Connects to the Global Catalog on the domain controller and queries for
the object in question and any relevant information (such as GUID, userID,
name, phone number).
You can secure the connection between the CMA system and the Active
Directory server's Global Catalog using LDAP-S (via outbound TCP/UDP
port 3269) or Start TLS (via outbound 3268 TCP/UDP). To implement the
secure connection, the appropriate ports must be open on any network
equipment between the Global Catalog and the CMA system.
358
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Directory Operations
Accounts Required for the CMA System
CMA System Service Account
Before integrating the CMA system with an Active Directory forest, you must
create a service account for it in Active Directory. This service account is a
read-only user account that the CMA system uses to perform LDAP queries
against your Active Directory Global Catalog.
CMA System Computer Account
The CMA system requires a computer account to enable secure channel
communications with the Active Directory forest that is being leveraged for
authentication. This account must be pre-created and the password set by an
administrator from a Domain Controller.
Note
When setting up a redundant CMA system, the redundant servers use the same
computer account to create their secure channel connection. The computer
account name does not have to match the host name of your CMA system server.
Understanding Base DN
When the CMA system is integrated with an enterprise directory, the system
uses the baseDN to determine domains and manage directory searches.
The Base DN field is where you specify the distinguished name (DN) of a subset
of the Active Directory hierarchy (a domain, subset of domains, or
organizational unit) to which you want to restrict the CMA system search. It
acts like a filter.
By default, the Base DN field is empty. The first time you tell the system to
connect to the enterprise directory server, leave the Base DN field empty.
Once you have established a working connection with your Active Directory,
then you enter a Base DN.
The following table illustrates some basic examples of Base DN filter
expressions.
Search baseDN expression
Description
(ou=CMAGroups,dc=example,dc=com)
Include only groups and users which
reside within the CMAGroups OU in the
example.com domain.
(dc=example,dc=com)
Include only groups and users which
reside within the example.com domain
or domain tree.
Polycom, Inc.
359
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Expressions in the Base DN and exclusion filter fields must be formatted
according to RFC-4514, section 2.4.
Some special characters are allowed in the BaseDN field. They include:
Character
“ % ”
“ ”
Character Name
Percent
Space
“ " ”
Double quote
Question mark
Open brace
Close brace
Caret
“ ? ”
“ { ”
“ } ”
“ ^ ”
“ ~ ”
“ [ ”
Tilde
Open bracket
Close bracket
Single quote
Ampersand
Pipe or bar
“ ] ”
“ ‘ ”
“ & ”
“ | ”
The special characters that are not allowed in the Base DN field without the
special escape character (backslash, \) are:
Character
“ \ ”
Character Name
Backslash
Equal
“ = ”
“ , ”
Comma
“ # ”
“ + ”
“ ; ”
Pound
Plus
Semicolon
Less than
Greater than
“ < ”
“ > ”
360
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Directory Operations
Therefore, to use these character as part of a name, they must be preceded in
the Base DN field by a backslash. For example, the baseDN of an ou named
"
tom,ann,bob" in the "myteam.example.com" domain must be entered as:
ou=tom\,ann\,bob\ dc=my team,dc=example,dc=com
Or the baseDN of an ou named "#+,=<>\ " in the "mydomain.example.com"
domain must be entered as
ou=\#\+\,\=\<\>\\\ ,dc=mydomain,dc=example,dc=com
Note that this applies only to attribute values, not the ou=or dc=structure.
Understanding Exclusion Filters
Using LDAP exclusion filters, you can exclude objects in your directory based
on a wide variety of criteria within your Active Directory environment. Any
LDAP filters that you create must follow the LDAP standard and reference the
LDAP display name of the attributes against which you are filtering.
The following table illustrates some basic examples of exclusion filter
expressions.
Search baseDN expression
Description
Memberof=cn=Restricted Group,OU=users,dc=example,dc=com Excludes all users who are members of
"Restricted Group" within the Users OU in the
example.com domain.
!(Memberof=cn=Video Users,OU=Users,dc=example,dc=com)
Includes only groups and users within the
Video Users group in the Users OU in the
example.com domain.
Creating exclusion filters can impact the performance of your LDAP queries.
As a best practice, use indexed attributes and do not use medial searches when
implementing exclusion filters. For more information, see Creating More
Polycom, Inc.
361
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The following table illustrates some more advanced examples of exclusion
filter expressions.
Search baseDN expression
Description
!(| (memberof=CN=Sales,DC=europe,DC=example,DC=com)
(memberof=CN=IT,DC=europe,DC=example,DC=com))
Includes only users that are members of the
‘Sales’ or ‘IT’ Groups in the domain
europe.example.com.
Notes:
•
The expression should be in continuous
line with no carriage returns or extra
spaces (not possible in this document’s
format).
•
By excluding an entity, we implicitly mean
to include all other entities. Conversely, by
including an entity, we are implicitly
excluding all other entities. Hence, this
exclusion filter will suffice for a case where,
for example, the administrator wants to
include Sales and IT but exclude Human
Resources, Engineering, etc., within the
specified domain.
&(objectCategory=person)(objectClass=user)(userAccountContr
ol:1.2.840.113556.1.4.803:=2)
Excludes all users who are disabled. Note this
is using a different but valid notation.
Polycom CMA System and Windows Authentication
To allow Microsoft Active Directory users with dynamically-managed
endpoints to securely log into their endpoint without typing in their network
credentials, the CMA system must be integrated with an Active Directory
server and trusted by Active Directory.
When the CMA system starts up, it performs the following actions.
•
Uses Microsoft's LDAP ping mechanism to determine the site in which the
system is located.
•
Uses a DNS SRV record query to find a domain controller within the same
site.
When an Active Directory user attempts to log into the CMA system, it
authenticates the user by connecting to the domain controller that it is
connected to and passes the user's credentials using NTLMv2. The credentials
are seamlessly passed to the CMA system utilizing a secure channel
connection from the user's workstation, using the credentials with which they
logged into the workstation.
362
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Directory Operations
Note
Because the CMA system uses NTLMv2, the password is not stored within and the
CMA system never receives the user's password.
Some important notes about the CMA system Active Directory integration:
•
The CMA system is not joined to the domain. Other computers on the
network cannot browse its file system and it cannot be managed remotely
by existing IT mechanisms such as SMS.
•
•
The CMA system does not modify the Active Directory in any way.
The CMA system can auto-discover the closest logical domain controller
and Active Directory servers, but to do this the network DNS server must
have a DNS SRV record for these servers. Once the domain controller’s
hostname and IP address have a record on the DNS, the CMA system can
auto-discover the IP address of the domain controller. If your Active
Directory does not publish the domain controller’s hostname and IP
address to the network DNS, you must edit the file to include it.
•
The CMA system requires that you enable Digitally sign
communications on the Active Directory server.
Directory Management Operations
This section describes the directory management operations. It includes these
topics:
•
•
•
Integrate with Enterprise Directory Server Option
The process of integrating with an enterprise directory server, involves these
steps:
•
•
•
Enabling the Integrate with Enterprise Directory Server option allows CMA
system users who are included in the Active Directory to log into the CMA
system interface using their network credentials.
Polycom, Inc.
363
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Enabling the Integrate with Enterprise Directory Server option also allows
endpoint users to select conference participants and rooms from the enterprise
directory. Because endpoint connections to LDAP use the endpoint user’s
credentials, the Active Directory access control lists identify which endpoint
users and rooms each user can see.
Note
The CMA system supports only the Microsoft Active Directory for its enterprise
directory.
In addition, administrative users can:
•
•
•
•
View some enterprise user and group information
Import enterprise groups into the CMA system
Assign roles to users in different enterprise groups
Identify enterprise resources, such as rooms, so that they can be treated as
resources in the CMA system
Note
To allow endpoint users to use NTLM Single Sign On technology to connect to the
CMA system and access services such as automatic provisioning, automatic
software update, and presence, see “Allow Delegated Authentication to Enterprise
For more information about Active Directory and LDAP, see MS Strategy for
Create the Polycom CMA System Service Account
To create the CMA system service account
1
On the Active Directory server, open the Active Directory Users and
Computers module (Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Active
Directory Users and Computers).
2
3
Click the node for your domain and then right-click the OU folder in
which you want to add a user account and select New > User.
At a minimum, in the First name, Full name, and User logon name
fields, type cmaserviceor an appropriate name for your environment
and click Next.
4
In the Password and Confirm Password fields, type a password for the
service account to use during initial integration. This is the password you
must enter on the CMA system Enterprise Server page.
364
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Directory Operations
5
Select the Password never expires option, unselect the User cannot
change password option, click Next and then Finish.
Notes
•
You can reset the password for this account manually, but to do so you must
change it in Active Directory first and then update the CMA system LDAP Server
page.
•
The service account requires the rights to read all properties on all users and
groups that will be used in the CMA system. Without these permissions, it may
not function properly.
Create the Polycom CMA System Computer Account
To create the CMA System computer account
1
On the Microsoft Active Directory system, open the Active Directory
Users and Computers module (Start > Programs > Administrative Tools
> Active Directory Users and Computers.
2
3
Select the node for your domain, right-click the OU folder in which to
add the computer account and then select New > Computer.
In the Computer name field, type PolycomCMAor an appropriate name
for your environment and then click Next and Finish (or simply click OK
depending on your version of Active Directory).
4
Ensure that the Active Directory Users and Computers console will
show all available computer options necessary for the remaining steps by
enabling View > Advanced Features.
5
6
7
8
Right-click the computer account, select Properties, and then select the
Security tab.
In the Group or user names section of the Security tab, select the SELF
object.
In the Permissions for SELF section, select Change password, and then
click OK.
Login to the domain controller where the computer account was created
and set the password using the following command:
net user <computername>$ <password>
For example: net user polycomcma$ p@ssw0rd
Polycom, Inc.
365
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Notes
•
Performing the net user command on any machine other than a domain
controller will not assign the computer account password for the CMA system
computer account.
•
At initial integration, the CMA System will change its Computer Account
password to a random 120 character string including special characters. This
password will also be changed, to a new randomly generated password, every
time the CMA System is rebooted, or every week if no reboots are performed.
Because this is a Computer account, resetting the password to a known value
requires use of net user commands on an Active Directory Domain Controller.
Enable Integration with the Enterprise Directory Server
To integrate the CMA system to an enterprise directory server
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Enterprise Directory.
On the Enterprise Directory page, select Integrate with Enterprise
Directory Server.
3
4
To have the system auto-discover the server by querying DNS, enable
Auto-discover in the Enterprise Directory Server DNS Name section;
otherwise, enter the DNS Name for the enterprise directory server.
As needed, configure these settings.
Setting
Description
Domain\Enterprise
Directory User ID
Domain and Enterprise Directory User ID for an
account that the CMA system can use to access the
enterprise directory server and retrieve group, user,
and room information. This is the account created
This User ID must have read permissions so it can
search the entire forest on the enterprise directory
server.
This User ID is automatically associated with the
CMA system administrator role - by default it is the
ONLY enterprise directory User ID with this role.
Enterprise Directory
User Password
The password for the enterprise directory user
account
366
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Directory Operations
Setting
Description
Security Level
The level of security on the connection between the
CMA system and the enterprise directory server.
Possible values include:
•
•
Plain—No security on the connection
LDAPS—The connection is secured over
outbound port 3269 using LDAP-S in a manner
similar to https
.
If the “Domain Controller: LDAP Server signing
requirements” setting on the Active Directory
server is set to “Require Signing”, then you must
use LDAPS to secure the connection.
•
StartTLS—The connection is secured over
outbound port 3268 (the same port as Plain), but
it then negotiates security once the socket is
opened. Some LDAP servers reject any
unsecured transactions, so the first command is
the StartTLSnegotiation command.
Ignore Disabled
Enterprise Directory
Users
Check this field to have the CMA system ignore
disabled enterprise users in its queries.
Enterprise Directory
Exclusion Filter
If necessary and you understand the filter syntax,
specify other types of user accounts to exclude.
Don’t edit these expressions unless you understand
LDAP filter syntax.
For more information, see “Understanding Exclusion
Enterprise Directory
Search BaseDN
If necessary and you understand the filter syntax,
specify the top level of the enterprise directory tree
(referred to as the base DN) to search. Don’t edit
these expressions unless you understand the filter
syntax.
For more information, see “Understanding Base DN”
5
If you also wish to implement single sign-on, see the following section
Otherwise, click Update.
Allow Delegated Authentication to Enterprise Directory Server
The CMA system Use Single Sign on (Integrated Windows Authentication)
option, allows endpoint users who are included in the enterprise directory to
securely log into their dynamically-managed endpoint without typing in
credentials.
Polycom, Inc.
367
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Note
To allow CMA system users who enter their network usernames and passwords to
log into the CMA system and select conference participants from your company’s
To delegate authentication to the enterprise directory server
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Enterprise Directory.
On the Enterprise Directory page, select Allow delegated authentication
to enterprise directory server.
3
To have the system auto-discover the closest logical domain controller
and enterprise directory servers, in the Domain controller name section
enable Auto-discover; otherwise, enter the fully qualified hostname of
the domain controller (for example, dc1.mydomain.com).
Note
To auto discover the domain controller and enterprise directory server, the network
DNS server must have a DNS SRV record for these servers.
4
Enter the Username (domain\<computer name>) and Password and click
Update.
Remove or Include Dynamically-Managed Endpoints in the Global Address
Book
By default the CMA system includes dynamically-managed endpoints in the
Global Address Book. However, you may not want to take advantage of this
feature if you have legacy endpoints such as VSX, ViewStation, and FX
endpoints. These endpoints may not be able to handle the increased size of the
Global Address Book.
To remove enterprise users from the CMA system Global Address Book
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.
In the Directory page, clear Include dynamically-managed devices in
the Global Address Book.
3
Click Update.
To include enterprise users in the CMA system Global Address Book
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.
1
368
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Directory Operations
2
3
In the Directory page, select Include dynamically-managed devices in
the Global Address Book.
Click Update.
Remove or Include Guest Book Entries in the Directory
By default the CMA system includes Guest Book entries in the endpoint
directory, regardless of whether the endpoint directory is the Global Address
Book or the enterprise directory.
To remove Guest Book entries from the endpoint directory
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.
In the Directory page, clear Show Guest Book entries in the Directory.
Click Update.
To include Guest Book entries in the endpoint directory
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.
In the Directory page, select Show Guest Book entries in the Directory.
Click Update.
Support LifeSize Endpoints in Directories
You can include LifeSize endpoints in the endpoint directory by configuring
your directory setup. When you do this, you also need to ensure that your
LifeSize endpoint is configured to use the correct LDAP settings.
Complete the following steps:
•
•
Modify Directory Listings
You need to allow your directory listings to include support for LifeSize
endpoints.
To modify directory listings for LifeSize endpoint support
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Directory Setup.
In the Directory Setup page, mark the Modify directory listings for
LifeSize endpoint support check box.
Polycom, Inc.
369
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
Click Update.
Configure LDAP Settings
In addition to configuring directory listing support in the directory set up, you
need to also ensure that the LifeSize endpoint is configured to use the
RealPresence CMA system’s LDAP settings. You can provision these through
a scheduled provisioning profile or configure them manually on the endpoint.
To add LDAP settings to a scheduled provisioning profile
1
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Scheduled Provisioning
Profiles.
2
3
In the Scheduled Provisioning Profiles page, click Add.
In the Add Profile dialog box, select the Endpoint Type for the
provisioning profile, enter a name for the profile, and click Next.
4
As needed, complete the various settings that you would like to provision
for your LifeSize endpoint.
For more information about these fields, see “Scheduled Provisioning of
5
6
For Directory support, select the Directory > LDAP page.
On the Directory > LDAP page:
a
b
Mark the Provision This Page check box.
In the LDAP field, select Enabled from the drop-down list.
»
»
In the LDAP Username field, enter uid=ldapgab,ou=system
In the LDAP Password field, enter the password for the Polycom
Global Address Book if you have one. If not, leave this field blank.
»
In the LDAP Base field, enter DC=Polycom,dc=com
7
Click OK.
If you manually enter the LDAP settings on the LifeSize endpoint, the value for
the LDAP Base field needs to be the following:
OU=Endpoints,DC=Polycom,dc=com
.
370
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
27
Directory Setup Operations
This chapter describes how to manage the Global Address Book in the
Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It
includes these topics:
•
•
View the Global Address Book
The Polycom Global Address Book is a system managed endpoint directory
that allows users with video endpoints to look up and call other users with
video endpoints in their video communications network.
From a video endpoint system, users can locate other user’s endpoints by
name in the Global Address Book and initiate a call without knowledge of the
other user’s equipment. The CMA system will filter incompatible endpoints
out of the Global Address Book (GAB) results so that the GAB presented to
H.323-only endpoints will not include ISDN-only endpoints and the GAB
presented to ISDN-only endpoints will not include H.323-only endpoints.
Note
GAB filtering applies only to Polycom endpoints. The GAB is not filtered on
third-party endpoints.
For more information on the Global Address Book, see “Endpoint Directory
To view the Global Address Book
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Global Address Book.
As needed, use the Filter to customize the Global Address Book. It can
be filtered by Endpoint Name or IP Address.
Polycom, Inc.
371
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The user information found in the Global Address Book includes:
Column
Description
Owner
The associated user or resource ID.
The name of the registered endpoint.
Name
GAB Display Name
The name of the registered endpoint as it will be
displayed to other endpoint users. This display name
is an ASCII only field.
Type
The type of endpoint.
IP Address
Phone Number
Alias
The IP address of the endpoint.
The phone number of the endpoint.
The alias associated with the endpoint.
Set or Change the GAB Password
You can require that endpoints be provisioned with a password in order to
access the Global Address Book on the CMA system. To do so, set a Global
Address Book password as described here. Use the same procedure to change
the Global Address Book password.
Note that even if the Global Address Book is password protected, some
third-party endpoints may not be required to provide a password because
they are not directory-password aware. They have unrestricted access to the
Global Address Book.
To provision this password to endpoints, see “Add a Scheduled Provisioning
To set or change the password for the Global Address Book
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Global Address Book.
In the Global Address Book, click Set GAB Password
.
In the Set Client Password dialog box, enter the Old Password and the
New Password. (Note that the password fields are ASCII only.)
4
Confirm the new password and click Save.
Once you set this password, endpoints that are not provisioned with this
password cannot access the Global Address Book on the CMA system.
372
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
28
Multiple Address Books
This chapter describes how to set up multiple address books in the Polycom®
Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these
topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Multiple Address Books Overview
Users assigned the Administrator role can create multiple address books in
the CMA system. Multiple address books are subsets of the Global Address
Book (GAB) and let you manage which users (local and enterprise), endpoints,
rooms, groups, and guests appear in each address book.
Multiple address books support both the GAB and LDAP protocols. Endpoints
requesting directory information using either protocol receive either the
default address book or the address book assigned to the user’s group.
If you do not want to use multiple address books, you can leave the default
address book set to All Entries. Using this default, all users will see all entries
in the directory. Be sure that all groups are assigned either the System Default
or All Entries option. System Default is the default group setting.
Polycom, Inc.
373
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Notes
•
Multiple Address Book functionality works in Maximum Security Mode based
upon LDAP only.
•
An endpoint must be associated with a User and the User must be in a Group
in order to specify an address book.
How Multiple Address Books Work
Use address books to limit access to people and endpoints. For example, you
can set up separate address books for each department in your organization.
Each address book would include only CMA users in that department and
only rooms in that department’s location.
If the CMA system has the Areas feature enabled, you can only associate users
and endpoints in the same Areas as you are in to address books.
Users not assigned the Administrator role will not be aware of address books.
They will see only those users (local and enterprise directory), endpoints,
rooms, groups, and guests in the same address book that the user is assigned
to.
To implement multiple address books, complete the following tasks
1
CMA system users assigned the Administrator role can create address
books and associate users (local and enterprise directory), endpoints,
rooms, groups, and guests with one or more address books. This process
controls where each entity appears as an address book entry.
2
3
CMA system users assigned the Administrator role can assign an address
book to a group. A group can be assigned to only one address book. This
process controls the address book that users and endpoints have access to.
CMA system users assigned the Administrator role can set the priority of
address books. The priority affects which address book a user has access
to. For example, if a user is a member of two different groups and each
group is assigned a different address book, the user can access the address
book that is higher in priority.
374
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Multiple Address Books
View the Address Book List and Details
To view the address book list and details
1
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.
The Address Book list appears, with details of the selected address book
in the right pane.
Column
Description
Priority
The priority affects which address book a user sees. For
example, if a user is a member of two different groups and
each group is assigned a different address book, the user
will see the address book that is higher in priority.
Address Books
Description
Name of the address book.
A brief description of the address book.
2
In the Address Book Details in the right pane, expand the tree to view
the tiers along with users, endpoints, rooms, groups, and guests
associated with the address book.
Add an Address Book
You can add many address books to the CMA system, and each address book
can have up to 100 tiers.
Tiers are only meant to allow you to organize the address book contents. They
will not be visible to endpoint users when they access the directory. Each tier
can have up to three subtiers., and you can have address book entries at any
tier level.
Associating users, endpoints, rooms, groups, and guests with an address book
controls where these entities appear. For example, if you associate user A with
address book A, the user will appear as an entry in address book A. You can
associate any of these entities with more than one address book, and the entity
will appear as entry in each address book.
Groups in the CMA system control the address book users, endpoints, and
rooms have access to. To set which address book an entity has access to, see
To add an address book
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.
Click Add.
Polycom, Inc.
375
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
Complete the fields in the Add an Address Book dialog box.
Field
Description
Address Book Information
Name
A meaningful name to identify this address book.
Description
Address Book Tiers
New Tier
A brief description of the address book.
Select where you want to add a tier and click to add a
new tier to the address book.
Edit Tier Name
Delete
Select a tier and click to change a tier name.
Select a tier and click to delete a tier.
4
To associate users with this address book, click Associate Users.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the users
appear in.
a
Search for the users you want to associate. Use the Filter to customize
the list.
b
c
Select the users you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the users and click OK.
5
To associate endpoints with this address book, click Associate
Endpoints.
Only endpoints that are not associated with a CMA system user appear in
the list.
a
Use the Filter to customize the list.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the
endpoints appear in.
b
c
Select the endpoints you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the endpoints and click OK.
6
To associate rooms with this address book, click Associate Rooms.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the rooms
appear in.
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.
Select the rooms you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the rooms and click OK.
376
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Multiple Address Books
7
8
9
To associate groups with this address book, click Associate Groups.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the groups
appear in.
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.
Select the groups you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the groups and click OK.
To associate guests with this address book, click Associate Guests.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the guests
appear in.
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.
Select the guests you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the guests and click OK.
Click OK.
Edit an Address Book
You can edit an address book to add or remove users, endpoints, rooms,
groups, and guests.
You can find any of these entities that are not currently associated with an
address book by selecting Current Association from any Filter, then selecting
Not Associated With An Address Book.
If a group is set up with the Enterprise Directory Viewable option not
selected, you can still add that group to an address book. The group itself will
not appear as an entry in the address book, but the members of the group will.
To edit an address book
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.
Select an address book.
Click Edit.
Edit the fields in the Edit an Address Book dialog box.
Field
Description
Address Book Information
Name
A meaningful name to identify this address book.
A brief description of the address book.
Description
Polycom, Inc.
377
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Address Book Tiers
New Tier
Select where you want to add a tier and click to add a new
tier to the address book.
Edit Tier Name
Delete
Select a tier and click to change a tier name.
Select a tier and click to delete a tier.
5
To associate users with this address book, click Associate Users.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the users
appear in.
a
Search for the users you want to associate. Use the Filter to customize
the list.
b
c
Select the users you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the users and click OK.
d
To delete a user from the address book, select the user and click
Delete.
The user is removed from the address book, but remains in the CMA
system.
6
To associate endpoints with this address book, click Associate
Endpoints.
Only endpoints that are not associated with a CMA system user appear in
the list.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the
endpoints appear in.
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.
Select the endpoints you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the endpoints and click OK.
d
To delete an endpoint from the address book, select the endpoint and
click Delete.
The endpoint is removed from the address book, but remains in the
CMA system.
7
To associate rooms with this address book, click Associate Rooms.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the rooms
appear in.
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.
Select the rooms you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the rooms and click OK.
378
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Multiple Address Books
d
To delete a room from the address book, select the room and click
Delete.
The room is removed from the address book, but remains in the CMA
system.
8
To associate groups with this address book, click Associate Groups.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the groups
appear in.
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.
Select the groups you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the groups and click OK.
d
To delete a group from the address book, select the group and click
Delete.
The group is removed from the address book, but remains in the
CMA system.
9
To associate guests with this address book, click Associate Guests.
The Address Book/Tier column shows all of the address books the guests
appear in.
a
b
c
Use the Filter to customize the list.
Select the guests you want and click Specify Tier.
Select the tier you want for the guests and click OK.
d
To delete a guest from the address book, select the guest and click
Delete.
The guest is removed from the address book, but remains in the CMA
system.
10 Click OK.
Assign Address Books to Groups
You can assign an address book to a group, but you cannot assign address
books directly to users. Group assignment controls to which address book
users and endpoints have access. Each group can have just one address book
assigned to it, but users can be in more than one group.
Address book priority affects which address book users and endpoints can
access. For example, if a user is a member of two different groups and each
group is assigned a different address book, the user will see the address book
that is higher in priority. To change priority, see “Change Address Book
Polycom, Inc.
379
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To assign an address book to a group
1
2
3
Go to User > Groups.
Select the group you want to assign.
In the Edit Local Group dialog box, select address book you want from
the Assign Address Book drop-down list.
4
Click OK.
Viewing the Address Book a User is Assigned To
You can see which address book a user is assigned to. The address book
assignment controls the address book entries a user or endpoint can access.
To view the address book a user is assigned to
1
2
3
4
5
Go to User > Users.
Select the user you want.
Click View Details.
In the View User dialog box, click Inherited Group Info.
Click OK.
Delete an Address Book
You can delete an address book when it is no longer needed. Deleting an
address book does not delete the users, endpoints, rooms, groups, or guests
that were in the address from the CMA system.
Any entity that was assigned the deleted address book will have access to one
of the following:
•
Another address book if the entity is a member of another group that is
assigned to an existing address book.
•
The default address book.
To delete an address book
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.
Select the address book you want to delete.
380
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Multiple Address Books
3
4
Click Delete.
A confirmation message appears.
Click Yes.
Change Address Book Priority
You can change the priority of address books. The priority determines which
address book a user sees. For example, if a user is a member of two different
groups and each group is associated with a different address book, the user
will see the address book that is higher in priority.
The All Entries address book always has the highest priority and None always
has the lowest priority. If the address book for one of the groups the user
belongs to is changed to All Entries, the user will see all entries regardless of
the priority of the address book for the other group.
To change address book priority
1
2
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.
In the Priority column of an address book, enter the priority you want.
Use only whole numbers and only numbers that fall within the total count
of address books. For example, if you have four address books, only 1
through 4 are valid priority values.
3
Click Update Priority.
The system changes the order of the address book list.
Set the Default Address Book
You can set the default address book. The default address book sets the
address book all new users have access to if no address book is assigned
through a group.
If you do not want to use multiple address books in the CMA system, leave the
default address book set to All Entries (the default). Using this default, all
users will be able to see all entries in the directory. Be sure that all groups are
assigned either the System Default or All Entries option. System Default is
the default group setting.
If you create multiple address books, you can change the default address book
to one of the address books you created.
Polycom, Inc.
381
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To set the default address book
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.
Click Set Default.
In the Default Address Book dialog box, select the option you want:
— All Entries—Default setting. All users, endpoints, groups, rooms, and
guests are in one address book and all have access to all address book
entries.
— None— No directory entries will be available.
— Specify—Select the address book you want as the default.
Click OK.
4
Copy an Address Book
You can copy an existing address book as a shortcut to creating a new address
book. The copy process can copy the entire address book or just the tier
structure.
To copy an address book
1
2
3
4
Go to Admin > Directories > Address Books.
Select the address book you want to copy.
Click Copy.
In the Copy AddressBook dialog box, select the option you want:
— Entire AddressBook—This option copies all of the tiers and the users,
endpoints, rooms, groups, and guests that are associated with the
address book to the new address book.
— Tiers only—This option copies only the tier structure to the new
address book.
5
6
Enter a meaningful Name and Description.
Click OK.
You can now edit the new address book to add or delete entries.
382
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
29
Polycom CMA System Setup
Overview
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) System Setup menu. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Server Settings
Most of the selections in the Server Settings menu are entered during the
CMA system First Time Setup process and do not change frequently. Use the
Server Settings menu, when you do need to change them.
The Server Settings menu allows users with Administrator permissions to
implement the CMA system configuration best suited for their corporate
environment as identified in the solution design, site survey, and/or network
design.
The Server Settings menu includes these items:
Selection
Description
Network
The basic network setting for the CMA system on your
network.
Polycom, Inc.
383
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Selection
Description
Gatekeeper Settings By default the CMA system is made the primary
gatekeeper during the First Time Setup process. Use the
Gatekeeper Settings option to modify the primary
gatekeeper behavior or to add an alternate gatekeeper or
neighboring gatekeepers.
Gatekeeper Settings affect how devices register and calls
are made in your video communications network. These
settings allow you to:
•
Identify the gatekeeper with an identifier and
description.
•
Specify registration-related settings, including the
default gatekeeper, which endpoints register, the
registration refresh period, and the offline timeout.
•
•
Set the maximum number of neighboring gatekeeper
hop counts.
Specify how to handle calls to and from unregistered
endpoints.
Management and
Security Settings
Management Settings allow you to upgrade the CMA
system software and enable auto discovery of endpoints.
Security Settings allow you to implement HTTPS for the
CMA system.
Dial Plan Settings
Edit the default CMA system Dial Plan and Site settings
(which includes the definition of sites, site links, dial rules,
services, and least-cost routing tables) to support your
network topology and video call routing.
Polycom CMA System Licensing
The seat capacity for a CMA 5000 system with the Maximum Security feature
not enabled scales from 500 to 5,000 devices. The entry-level CMA 5000 system
has a baseline capacity of 500 client access licenses. Additional licensing is
offered in 100, 500, and 1000 license pack sizes.
The seat capacity for a CMA 4000 system with the Maximum Security feature
not enabled scales from 200 to 400 devices. The entry-level CMA 4000 system
has a baseline capacity of 200 client access licenses. Additional device licensing
is offered in 100 license pack size.
The seat capacity for a CMA 5000 system with the Maximum Security feature
enabled is fixed at 500 devices with no expansion available. A CMA 4000
cannot operate in Maximum Security mode.
Your system comes with a Default Trial key that is valid for 60 days after
activating your system. With your system order, you will receive one License
Certificate. You must activate the License Certificate to receive an activation
key, which you then enter in the CMA system. When you enter this activation
384
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
key into the system, it overwrites the Default Trial key.
When applied to the system, an expansion license pack augments the device
license count. For example, applying a 1000-device expansion license pack to
a baseline CMA 5000 system will yield a total license count of 1500 concurrent
licenses.
Where applicable, the number of concurrent calls supported by a CMA system
is derived from the number of device licenses at a 3/10 ratio (calls/devices).
For example, a system licensed for 5000 devices supports up to 1500
concurrent calls in routed mode and 3000 calls in direct mode.
Device licenses are consumed based on a 1:1 basis for any managed device
(endpoints, MCU, GK, GW— including personal endpoints, IP blades, and
more) that can be added to the system by any means, including the user
interface, registration for management services, or registration for Global
Address Book services.
Note
Device licenses are consumed by managed devices, not by users. You may add
any number of local or enterprise users to the CMA system.
The CMA system has the following licensing packages:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Base system license
Base system license with Microsoft Outlook
Base system license with IBM Lotus Notes
Base system license with Microsoft Outlook and IBM Lotus Notes
Redundant system licenses (primary and redundant licenses)
Redundant system licenses with Microsoft Outlook
Redundant system licenses with IBM Lotus Notes
Redundant system licenses with Microsoft Outlook and IBM Lotus Notes
Licensing for the Polycom CMA Desktop client is included with the CMA
system. When a Polycom CMA Desktop client is provisioned by the CMA
system, it automatically consumes a license. That license is then reserved for
that Polycom CMA Desktop client. However, you can configure the CMA
system to automatically release a Polycom CMA Desktop client license after a
set number of days of inactivity.
Licenses consumed by registered hardware devices are never automatically
released. To release a license from a registered hardware device, an
administrator must manually delete the device from the system.
Polycom, Inc.
385
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Polycom CMA System Site Topology and Dial Plan Set Up
Site topology information describes your network and its interfaces to other
networks, including the following elements:
•
•
Site — A local area network (LAN) that generally corresponds with a
geographic location such as an office or plant. A site contains one or more
network subnets, so a device’s IP address identifies the site to which it
belongs.
Network clouds — A Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) network
cloud defined in the site topology. An MPLS network is a private network
that links multiple locations and uses label switching to tag packets with
origin, destination, and quality of service (QOS) information.
Note that MPLS clouds are not associated with an IP address ranges, so
they can be used to group multiple subnets. They could also represent a
service provider.
While links to MPLS clouds have bandwidth and bit rate limitations, the
cloud is infinite. In this way, clouds reflect the way in which businesses
control bandwidth and bit rate.
•
•
•
•
Internet/VPN — A entity that represents your network’s connection to the
public Internet.
Site link — A network connection between two sites or between a site and
an MPLS network cloud.
Site-to-site exclusion — A site-to-site connection that the site topology
doesn’t permit an audio or video call to use.
Territory — A grouping of one or more sites for which a CMA system is
responsible.
The site topology you create within the CMA system should reflect your
network design. Consider the following information and best practices when
creating your site topology:
•
If possible, connect all sites to an MPLS cloud. MPLS clouds are like
corporate networks, used to connect multiple subnets in multiple sites, but
all servicing a company.
•
Avoid cross loops or multiple paths to a site; otherwise a call may have
different paths to a single destination. The more cross, circular, and multi
paths you have, the higher the number of calculations for a conference.
•
•
•
Link sites that aren’t connected to an MPLS cloud directly to another site
that is connected to an MPLS cloud. Do not create orphan sites.
Calls are routed through a bridge, so bandwidth and bit rate limits for the
site and subnet apply to all calls made using that bridge.
Reserve the Internet/VPN “site” for IP addresses that fall outside your
private or corporate network (for example remote workers), because all
calls routed to the Internet/VPN site will be routed through the site on
your private or corporate network that has Internet access.
386
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
The CMA system site topology function uses a dynamic, embedded mapping
tool that graphically displays the sites, clouds (network and Internet), and site
links (site-to-site or site-to-cloud) in your network.
Within this global and graphical view of the video conferencing network, you
can:
•
•
•
•
Create and link up to 500 sites
Zoom and pan to view specific network components
View system and device alarms
View the video network capacity for sites and site links as indicated by the
color and shape of its icons.
•
Filter the view by site name, territory name, IP address, network devices,
and alerts
Sites List
The Sites page contains a list of the sites defined to the CMA system.
Use the commands in the Actions list to add a site, edit or delete existing sites,
and see information about a site, including the number of devices of each type
it contains.
The following table describes the fields in the Sites list.
Column
Name
Description
Name of the site.
Description of the site.
Description
Polycom, Inc.
387
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Column
Description
Country Code
The country code for the country in which the site is
located.
Area Code
The city or area code for the site. Do not include a
leading zero. For example, the city code for Paris is 01;
however, enter 1 in this field.
Max Bandwidth (Mbps)
Max Bit Rate (Kbps)
The total bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.
The per-call bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.
Note
Bit rate is not the same as bandwidth. Since the bit rate
applies in both directions and there is overhead, the
actual bandwidth consumed is about 2.5 times the bit
rate.
Territory
The territory to which the site belongs, which
determines the CMA system responsible for it.
Add/Edit Site Dialog Box
Use the Add Site dialog box to define a new site in the CMA system’s site
topology and specify which subnets are associated with it. Use the Edit Site
dialog box to redefine information for an existing site.
The following table describes the fields in the Add Site and Edit Site dialog
boxes.
Field
Description
General Info
Site Name
A meaningful name for the site. The name can be up to
32 characters long, and may include spaces, dashes,
and underscores.
Description
A brief description (ASCII only) of the site.
Override ITU Dialing
Rules
Check this box to override the standard dial rules
established by the International Telecommunications
Union.
PBX Access Code
Country Code
Area Code
The access code required to enter the site’s PBX
system.
The country code for the country in which the site is
located.
The city or area code for the site. Do not include a
leading zero. For example, the city code for Paris is 01;
however, enter 1 in this field.
388
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
Field
Description
# of Digits in Subscriber
Number
The number of digits in a phone number. For example,
in the United States, subscriber numbers may have
seven digits or ten digits depending upon the region.
Default LCR Table
Assignment Method
The default least-cost routing table (LCR) for this site.
This LCR table is used for all calls originating from
devices associated with this site. The default is None.
The ISDN number assignment method for the site.
Possible values include:
•
No Auto Assignment. Select this option when
ISDN numbers are not assigned to IP devices.
•
DID (Direct Inward Dial). Select this option when
you assign a range of phone numbers received from
the telephone company service.
•
Gateway Extension Dialing. Select this option
when you have a single gateway phone number and
a range of extensions (E.164 aliases) that are
internal to the company. In this case, calls go
through a gateway. Endpoints are differentiated by
the extension at the end of the dial string.
When a site is assigned an automatic assignment
method, devices without an ISDN number are assigned
one when they register. These numbers allow inbound
calls to reach specific video endpoints. After an ISDN
number is assigned to an endpoint, it is reserved for use
as long as that endpoint remains registered with the
CMA system.
Note
If you do not assign ISDN numbers automatically, you
cannot call IP-only endpoints through an ISDN line.
Territory
Location
Assigns the site to a territory, and thus to a CMA
system.
Specify the geographic location of the site either by
longitude+latitude or country+city.
ISDN Number Assignment—
Assignment Method = DID (Direct Inward Dial)
# Digits in Call Line
Identifier
Enter the number of digits in the Call Line Identifier
(CLID), which is the dialed number. The maximum is 17.
•
•
For example, in the United States, the number of
digits in the CLID is often 7 for outside local calls, 4
for internal calls, or 11 for callers in a different area
code.
This number indicates what part of the full dial string
is sent to the gatekeeper for address resolution.
Polycom, Inc.
389
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
# Digits in Short Phone
Number
Enter the number of digits in the short form of the dialing
number.
•
For example, in the United States, internal
extensions are usually four or five digits.
•
This number indicates what part of the dial string is
sent to the gatekeeper for address resolution in
gateway + extension dialing.
ISDN Number Range -
Start
The starting ISDN number to assign automatically to IP
devices.
ISDN Number Range -
End
The ending ISDN number to assign automatically to IP
devices.
ISDN Number Assignment—
Assignment Method = Gateway Extension Dialing
Gateway Phone
Phone number of the site gateway.
Number
E164 Start
•
•
The starting number in a range of available
extensions to assign automatically to IP devices.
When a device without native ISDN registers, a
number within the start and end range is assigned,
so that the device can be called through an ISDN
line.
E164 End
The ending number in the range of available extensions
to assign automatically to IP devices.
Routing/Bandwidth
Internet calls are not
allowed
Disables call routing through the Internet.
Allowed via H.323
aware firewall
Enables call routing through the Internet, using an
H.323-aware firewall.
Notes
•
For an outbound call to the Internet, you must enter
the firewall gateway service (e.g. a Polycom VBP
appliance) code before the IP address in the dial
string.
•
If you select Allowed via H.323 aware firewall you
must create a site link between this site and the
Internet/VPN site.
390
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
Field
Description
Allowed via H.323
aware SBC or ALG
Enables call routing via the Internet, using an
H.323-aware SBC (Session Border Control) or ALG
(Application Level Gateway) server.
Note
For an outbound call to the Internet, you must enter the
firewall gateway service (for example, a Polycom VBP
appliance) code before the IP address in the dial string.
Call Signaling IP
Address
IP address of the SBC or ALG server. Supports only
IPv4 addresses.
Port
Port address of SBC or ALG server.
Send Unmodified Dial
String to SBC/ALG
Select this option if your SBC or ALG requires that the
original dial string is passed to it. For example, an H.323
Annex O dial string such as [email protected] is
passed directly to the SBC or ALG instead of resolving
company.com to an IP address.
Deselect this option if your equipment requires a dial
string that is converted from company.com to
gatekeeper IP address. This option is appropriate for
the Polycom VBP.
Total Bandwidth
Call Max Bit Rate
The total bandwidth of the pipe at the site.
The maximum bandwidth that can be used for each
intrasite call at the site. The default and maximum value
is 2000000 (2 GB).
Subnets
Subnet IP
Address/Mask
Specifies the subnets within the site. For each subnet,
includes:
•
•
•
•
IP Address range
Subnet mask
Maximum bandwidth for the subnet
Maximum bit rate per call for the subnet
Enterprise Directory Settings—
Endpoint Enterprise Directory security group settings
Universal Security
Group Filter
When in secure mode, search and select groups that
are provisioned to the endpoints to represent the valid
lists of users that can log in as a user or administrator. If
a user is not a member of one of the selected groups
then the user is denied access to the endpoint.
Enterprise Directory
Admin Group
Enterprise Directory
User Group
Polycom, Inc.
391
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Site Links
The Site Links page lists the links defined in the site topology. A link can
connect two sites, or it can connect a site to an MPLS network cloud (see
“Network Clouds” on page 102).
Use the commands in the Actions list to add, edit, or delete a site link. See
the site list.
Add/Edit Site Link Dialog Box
Use the Add Site Link dialog box to define a new site link in the CMA system’s
site topology. Use the Edit Site Link dialog box to redefine an existing site
link. A site link can connect two sites, or it can connect a site to an MPLS
network cloud.
The following table describes the fields in the Add Site Link and Edit Site
Link dialog boxes.
Field
Description
Name
A meaningful name for the site (up to 128 characters).
A brief description of the site (up to 200 characters).
Description
From site
The originating site of the link. The drop-down list
includes all defined sites and the Internet. Can’t be
changed for a site-to-cloud link.
To site
The destination site of the link. The drop-down list
includes all defined sites and an Internet/VPN option.
Can’t be changed for a site-to-cloud link.
Total bandwidth (Mbps)
Call Max bit rate (kbps)
Specifies the total bandwidth limit for this link.
Specifies the per-call bandwidth limit for this link.
Site-to-Site Exclusions
The Site-to-Site Exclusions page contains a list of the direct site-to-site
connections that the system won’t permit a call or session to use.
Use the commands in the Actions list to add and delete site-to-site exclusions.
The following table describes the fields in the list.
Column
Description
From/To Site
Name of one of the two sites connected by the excluded
link.
To/From Site
Name of the other site.
392
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
Territories
The Territories page contains a list of the territories defined in the site
topology. On the right, it displays information about the selected territory.
A territory is a set of one or more sites for which a CMA system is responsible.
By default, there is one territory named Default CMA Territory, and its
primary node (the CMA system responsible for it) is set to this system.
Use the commands in the Actions list to add, edit, or delete a territory. See
the territory list.
Add/Edit Territory Dialog Box
Use the Add Territory dialog box to define a new territory in the CMA
system’s site topology. Use the Edit Territory dialog box to define a new
territory in the CMA system’s site topology.
The following table describes the fields in the Add Territory and Edit
Territory dialog boxes.
Field
Description
Territory Info
Name
A meaningful name for the territory (up to 128
characters).
Description
A brief description of the territory (up to 200 characters).
Primary Node
The primary node of the CMA system responsible for
this territory.
Backup Node
The second node, if any, of the CMA system
responsible for this territory.
Associated Sites
Search Sites
Enter search string or leave blank to find all sites.
Search Result
Lists sites found and shows the territory, if any, to which
each currently belongs.
Select a site and click the right arrow to move it to the
Selected Sites list.
Selected Sites
Lists sites selected and shows the territory, if any, to
which each currently belongs.
Polycom, Inc.
393
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Network Clouds
The Network Clouds page contains a list of the MPLS (Multiprotocol Label
Switching) network clouds defined in the site topology.
Use the commands in the Actions list to add, edit, or delete an MPLS cloud.
Add/Edit Network Cloud Dialog Box
Use the Add Network Cloud dialog box to define a new MPLS network cloud
in the CMA system’s site topology. Use the Edit Network Cloud dialog box to
redefine an existing MPLS network cloud.
The following table describes the fields in the Add Network Cloud and Edit
Network Cloud dialog boxes.
Field
Description
Cloud Info
Name
A meaningful name for the cloud (up to 128 characters).
A brief description of the cloud (up to 200 characters).
Description
Linked Sites
Search Sites
Search Result
Enter search string or leave blank to find all sites.
Lists sites found and shows the territory, if any, to which
each belongs.
Select a site and click the right arrow to open the Add
Site Link dialog box.
Selected Sites
Lists sites linked to the cloud and shows the territory, if
any, to which each belongs.
Polycom CMA System Gatekeeper Functionality
The CMA system gatekeeper provides address translation and network access
control services for endpoints, gateways, and MCUs. It also provides other
services such as bandwidth management and dial plans services. These
additional features allow you to configure and manage your gatekeeping
operations and provide flexibility and scalability.
Note
If your system is in maximum security mode, the CMA system gatekeeper
functionality is not available.
394
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
Default, Redundant, Alternate, and Neighboring Gatekeepers
Default Gatekeeper
Typically during the First Time Setup process, the CMA system is designated
as the default gatekeeper and the default gatekeeper settings are implemented.
The CMA system as the default gatekeeper responsible for:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Default, alternate and neighboring gatekeeper management
Device registration
Address resolution
Bandwidth control and management
Call control signaling
Call management, authorization, access, and accounting
Firewall traversal
When a call originates from the CMA system and the system is unable to
resolve the dialed address, the call can be forwarded to another gatekeeper for
resolution. To enable call forwarding, create a neighboring region and a
dialing rule that routes calls using a particular prefix to the neighboring
gatekeeper.
We recommend keeping the CMA system as the default gatekeeper, so that all
endpoints and other devices on the network capable of automatic registration
will register with it. This allows the CMA system to serve as the centralized
manager of the network and more effectively aid in bandwidth management,
firewall traversal, and device authentication and authorization.
Note
MCUs that register with a GRQ instead of a RRQ like the Polycom RMX system,
will only register with the CMA system when it is enabled as the default gatekeeper
for the zone.
Redundant Gatekeeper
When the CMA system is deployed in a redundant configuration, the
redundant CMA system operates as a redundant gatekeeper in parallel with
the primary CMA system sharing endpoint registration information. If the
primary CMA system becomes unavailable, the redundant CMA system
replaces it until it returns.
Polycom, Inc.
395
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Alternate Gatekeeper
Within the CMA system, you can designate an alternate gatekeeper. In this
case, when an endpoint or other device registers with the CMA system
gatekeeper, the system sends back the alternate gatekeeper information to the
endpoint. Then, if communication with the CMA system fails, the endpoint
will attempt to register with the alternate gatekeeper.
In a redundant configuration, the alternate gatekeeper is the third gatekeeper
in line after the primary and redundant CMA system gatekeepers.
Neighboring Gatekeeper
Neighboring gatekeepers are gatekeepers that manage other H.323 regions
within an enterprise. When a call originates within one gatekeeper region but
that region’s gatekeeper is unable to resolve the dialed address, it is forwarded
to the neighboring gatekeepers for resolution.
Note
A neighboring gatekeeper may require additional configuration to completely
integrate with the CMA system gatekeeper. Also, not all CMA system parameters
correspond to parameters on a neighboring gatekeeper.
Within the CMA system, you can also set up a dial rule that will route calls
with designated prefixes to designated neighboring gatekeepers.
Device Registration
The CMA system manages device registration and offers several choices from
an open registration policy to more restrictive registration policies.
No matter what the gatekeeper registration policy, any endpoint that is
automatically provisioned, any endpoint that is registered with the Global
Address Book, and any endpoint that is added manually to the CMA system
can automatically register with the gatekeeper.
The CMA system gatekeeper registration policies include:
Allow Registration of All Endpoints
This open Allow Registration of All Endpoints registration policy allows any
device that can find the CMA system gatekeeper to register with it. This is the
default policy.
In this case, devices can register to the CMA system automatically:
•
When the device broadcasts a message to find a gatekeeper with which to
register. In this case, specifying a default gatekeeper is important, because
devices that register automatically may find multiple gatekeepers.
396
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
Devices register with the system designated as the default gatekeeper,
unless that gatekeeper is down. Then devices register with the system
designated as the alternate gatekeeper.
When registering, devices send a variety of settings to the gatekeeper
including their IP address, one or more H.323 IDs, and one or more E.164
aliases. These settings appear in the CMA system as Device Details.
•
When devices in dynamic management mode are automatically
provisioned by the CMA system.
And devices can be registered to the CMA system manually:
•
At the device by specifying the IP address of the CMA system as the
gatekeeper.
•
At the device by specifying the IP address of the CMA system as the
Global Directory Service. Once the device in the CMA system Global
Address Book it is registered to the system.
•
At the CMA system by adding the device to the one of the device lists
(Endpoint, MCU, VBP, or DMA lists).
Once an endpoint is registered, users of other registered endpoints can call the
endpoint by using either the H.323 ID, a URI, an E.164 alias, or one of the
services.
Allow Registration of Predefined Endpoints Only
The restrictive Allow Registration of Predefined Endpoints Only registration
policy allows devices to automatically register once they are added to the
CMA system either when they are automatically provisioned, automatically
registered to the Global Address Book, or added to the system manually.
Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites
The moderately open Allow Registration of Endpoints in Defined Sites
registration policy allows endpoints to automatically register if they are within
one of the Dial Plan sites defined to the CMA system, when they are
automatically provisioned, when they are automatically registered to the
Global Address Book, or when they are added to the system manually
Allow Registration of Predefined Prefixes Only
With this controlled registration policy, devices within a range of defined
E.164 prefixes may automatically register with the CMA system.
Polycom, Inc.
397
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Routing Mode
The CMA system has two routing modes.
Direct Mode
In this simplest gatekeeper mode, the CMA system gatekeeper resolves IP
addresses to their E.164 addresses and aliases (similar to the function of a
domain name server) and grants endpoints permission to place calls. Once the
gatekeeper performs these two functions, it plays no further role in the call.
Call signaling and media streams are sent directly between the endpoints in
the call.
In Direct mode, the number of concurrent calls supported by a CMA system
is derived from the number of device licenses at a 3/5 ratio (calls/devices). So,
for example, a system in Direct mode licensed for 5000 devices supports up to
3000 calls.
Use Direct mode when implementing a hierarchical architecture. A
hierarchical architecture is one with multiple gatekeepers, where one
gatekeeper—the CMA system in Direct mode—acts as the directory
gatekeeper at the top of the hierarchy. On the directory gatekeeper, you must
configure all of the other member gatekeepers as neighbors and on the
member gatekeepers you must configure the directory gatekeeper as a
neighbor. However, the member gatekeepers do not have to be neighbored
with each other.
When in Direct mode, some advanced CMA system features do not work.
These features include Simplified Dialing, Conference on Demand, Alternate
Routing, Least Cost Routing, MCU board hunting, and firewall traversal for a
Polycom VBP system in "Enterprise" or "E" mode. (Firewall traversal for a
Polycom VBP system in "Service Provider or "S" mode does work.)
The advantage of Direct mode is that conferences stay connected even if the
gatekeeper fails.
The disadvantage of Direct mode (along with the loss of advanced
functionality) is that during a failure and restart the gatekeeper loses track of
active calls that it was not involved in setting up. In this case, after a failure and
restart, the gatekeeper’s bandwidth calculations will be incorrect until those
calls end. Also, since the Conference Monitoring function uses gatekeeper
data, the monitoring information for those calls may be incorrect or
incomplete.
Routed Mode
In this advanced mode, the CMA system gatekeeper, besides performing the
functions of a Direct mode gatekeeper, also acts as a proxy for the call
signaling H.225 messages that set up the call. In this mode, only the media
streams are sent directly between the endpoints in the call.
398
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
In Routed mode, the number of concurrent calls supported by a CMA system
is derived from the number of device licenses at a 3/10 ratio (calls/devices).
So, for example, a system in Routed mode licensed for 5000 devices supports
up to 1500 calls.
The advantage of Routed mode is that it enables advanced features such as
Simplified Dialing, Conference on Demand, Alternate Routing, Least Cost
Routing, MCU board hunting and firewall traversal for a Polycom VBP system
in "Enterprise" or "E" mode. Routed mode is also supported for the Polycom
VBP system in "Service Provider" or "S" mode.
The disadvantage of routed mode is that a gatekeeper failure and restart
terminates all running conferences that include a registered device. Calls are
not reestablished after a system failure and restart. Conferences show a status
of Active, but participants show a status of Disconnected.
In either mode, CDR information for calls is accurate if the CMA system does
not fail and the endpoints send a DRQ (Disconnect Request) at the end of the
call.
Polycom CMA System Integration with Microsoft Outlook
Polycom now supports two conferencing methods when integrating Polycom
conferencing with Microsoft Outlook: Reserved and Reservationless.
Note
If you wish to implement both reserved conferencing (enabled by a CMA system)
and reservationless or ad hoc conferencing (enabled by a Polycom DMA system),
page 225. However if you do, Polycom does not recommend using both the
Polycom Scheduling Plug-in for Microsoft Outlook (Reserved Conferencing) and
the Polycom Conferencing Add-in for Microsoft Outlook (Reservationless
Conferencing) on the same client system.
Standard Polycom CMA System and Reserved Conferencing
Reserved conferencing is standard with the CMA system. All conferences
scheduled either through the CMA system web scheduler or one of the
Scheduling Plugins are reserved conferences, which means the CMA system
reserves video bridge, network resources, and video endpoints at the
scheduled time. In this case, the calendars for the endpoints are stored and
maintained by the CMA system.
When the conference is scheduled using the Scheduling Plugin for Microsoft
Outlook and the participants use Microsoft Outlook as their E-mail and
calendaring tool, the scheduled conferences are also posted as meetings on the
participants’ Outlook calendars. However, the endpoints themselves do not
have Outlook calendars.
Polycom, Inc.
399
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Polycom Conferencing for Microsoft Outlook, Reservationless Conferencing,
and Calendaring Management
The CMA system can also be used to provision Polycom Conferencing for
Microsoft Outlook, which is reservationless conferencing. When you use this
method:
•
•
•
Video bridge, network resources, and video endpoints are not reserved at
the scheduled time.
A Polycom RMX or DMA system is required to locate available bridge
resources when the meeting begins.
Calendars for the endpoints are stored and maintained by Microsoft
Exchange and the endpoints have their own Outlook calendar.
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook, which requires the Polycom Conferencing
Add-in, allows:
•
Conference organizers to:
— Use Microsoft Outlook and its usual meeting request workflow to
schedule video- and audio-enabled meetings.
— Include recording and streaming into the conference, when required.
•
Meeting participants to:
— Track their video- and audio-enabled meetings on the same calendar
that they track their other meetings.
— Click a link in an E-mail meeting request to join conferences on their
associated video or audio endpoint system.
•
Endpoints to have their own unique credentials and mailbox separate
from the endpoint user, so that endpoints can display their own calendars.
This is especially important for room endpoints.
The CMA system supports the Polycom Conferencing for Outlook solution. It
allows you to provision endpoints with the credentials, mailbox address,
Exchange server IP address, and calendaring service settings they need to use
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook.
To provision endpoints with the information required to support Polycom
Conferencing for Outlook, you must complete the following tasks (after your
sites are set up):
1
2
3
400
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Setup Overview
Polycom CMA System Integration with Microsoft Lync Server
2010 or Microsoft Office Communications Server 2007
The CMA system supports the integration of selected Polycom endpoints with
Microsoft® Lync™ Server 2010 or Microsoft® Office Communications Server
2007. Integration with these unified communications servers allows Polycom
HDX system users to see client users who have been added to the Polycom
HDX system Favorites list and place audio and video calls to them.
Conversely, client users can also see Polycom HDX system users in their client
Contacts List and place audio and video calls to them.
For Polycom HDX systems that are integrated with a Lync or Office
Communications server, the unified communications server replaces the CMA
system as the presence and directory service provider. However, the CMA
system continues to act as the gatekeeper and manager for these endpoint
systems.
The CMA system supports the integration with these unified communications
servers by provisioning endpoints with the credentials, Exchange server IP
address, and communications service settings they need.
To provision endpoints with the information required to integrate with these
unified communications servers, you must complete the following tasks:
1
2
Endpoint Directory and Directory Settings
When an endpoint registers with the CMA system, its information is
automatically entered into the Global Address Book. When information
changes at the endpoint, the Global Address Book is automatically updated as
well. If an endpoint is configured to Allow Directory Changes, additions and
deletions to the Global Address Book are pushed to the endpoint.
Endpoints that get their global directory from the CMA system will either get
the Global Address Book or the enterprise LDAP directory. Two Directory
Setup options allow you to affect which devices and users appear in the
endpoint directory.
Typically, standard endpoints (those that are not dynamically managed)
register for the Polycom GDS and are listed in the CMA system Global
Address Book. The Global Address Book allows standard endpoint users to
call other standard endpoint users by selecting them by name. In this case, the
Global Address Book is limited to 2000 entries, which is the limit that standard
endpoint systems can manage.
Polycom, Inc.
401
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Notes
•
The CMA system Global Address Book lists endpoints. Endpoints may or may
not have users or rooms associated with them. On an endpoint, the Global
Address Book does not list users unless they have endpoints associated with
them.
•
•
If your company has more than 100 endpoints, don’t limit the Global Address
Book on the endpoint side or the endpoint user won’t have access to all Global
Address Book entries.
The CMA system Global Address Book does not support unicode data.
The Include dynamically-managed devices in the Global Address Book
option changes the Global Address Book so that it includes all standard
endpoints and all dynamically-managed endpoints such as CMA Desktop and
Polycom VVX 1500 endpoints in the Global Address Book. In this case, the
Global Address Book limit is increased to 5000 entries. (Dynamically-managed
endpoints are always included in the enterprise LDAP directory.)
By default the Include dynamically-managed devices in the Global Address
Book option is selected. This brings all of your devices and users together into
one endpoint directory. However, you may not want to take advantage of this
feature if you have legacy endpoint systems such as VSX, ViewStation, and FX
endpoints. These endpoint systems cannot handle the increased size of the
Global Address Book. For information on clearing this option, see “Remove or
The second Directory Setup option affects both the Global Address Book and
the enterprise LDAP directory. The CMA system Guest Book includes static
user entries. By selecting the Show Guest Book entries in the Directory, these
static entries are included in the endpoint directory, regardless of whether the
endpoint directory is the Global Address Book or the enterprise LDAP
directory. The Show Guest Book entries in the Directory option is also
selected by default.
402
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
30
Server Setting Operations
This chapter describes how to update the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system configuration settings, many of which were
entered during First Time Setup. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Edit the Polycom CMA System Network Settings
Edit the system Network settings to change the basic network information for
the CMA system.
Note
Changing the IP address via the Windows Network Settings is not a supported
operation. To change the CMA system IP address, you must use this procedure.
To edit the CMA system network settings
1
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Network.
Polycom, Inc.
403
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
Configure these settings on the Network page, as necessary.
Field
Description
System Name
The NetBIOS name (ASCII only) of the CMA system
server. Must be between 6 and 16 characters long;
dashes and underscores are valid characters.
IPv4 Address
The static IPv4 address for the CMA system.
IPv4 Subnet Mask
The network subnet mask for the CMA system IP
address.
IPv4 Default Gateway
DNS Domain
The static IP address of the CMA system gateway.
The DNS domain name suffix for the network in
which the domain name server and CMA system
server reside. For example polycom.com, not the
fully qualified path of <hostname>.polycom.com
.
Note
If instead of entering a single domain controller, you
enter an FQDN that maps to multiple servers, be
sure that all of the mapped servers are directory
domain controllers with global catalogs.
Preferred DNS Server
Alternate DNS Server
The IP address of the preferred domain name server
for the network.
The IP address of the alternate domain name server
for the network.
3
4
Click Update.
If you change the IP address, the system prompts you to restart the CMA
system. We also recommend that you restart the system if you change the
subnet mask.
As required, restart the system.
Edit the Polycom CMA System Time Settings
Edit the System Time server settings to change the CMA system server time
or to synchronize the server with an external NTP server.
To edit the CMA system time settings
1
Go to Admin > Server Settings > System Time.
404
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Server Setting Operations
2
Configure these settings on the System Time page, as necessary.
Field
Description
System Time Zone
The time zone in which the CMA system server
resides.
Auto adjust for
Daylight Saving?
Select this option to adjust the clock automatically for
daylight savings time.
Use Current Time
Select this option to input the current date and time.
Use External NTP
Server Time
Select this option to synchronize the CMA system
date and time with an external NTP server.
Synchronization
IP address or DNS
resolved name
The IP address or fully qualified domain name (ASCII
only) of the NTP server. If needed, enter multiple
servers separated by a space.
Note
Make sure the current system time is correct before synchronizing with an NTP
server. If you set the system to use an external NTP server when the current date
and time are incorrect, the system time may be wrong for the amount of time
specified in the Minutes between synchronization attempts.
3
Click Update.
Integrate with Microsoft Exchange Server for Calendaring
Management
The CMA system supports the Polycom Conferencing for Outlook solution. It
allows you to provision endpoints with the credentials, mailbox address,
Exchange server IP address, and calendaring service settings they need to use
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook.
This section describes the tasks that enable provisioning endpoints for
Polycom Conferencing for Outlook.
Associate Sites with Microsoft Exchange Servers
By default, the CMA system is set up to automatically discover the Exchange
server for the domain in which a site is located. However, if you wish to
associate sites with an Exchange server using its IP address or DNS name,
follow this procedure.
Polycom, Inc.
405
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To associate sites with Microsoft Exchange servers by IP address or DNS name
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Calendaring Management.
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, click Calendared Sites.
The Specify Calendaring Exchange Servers page appears listing the sites
defined on the CMA system.
3
4
Select the check box for each of the sites you need to associate with a
single Exchange server and then click Specify Exchange Server.
In the Add Exchange Server dialog box, enter the Exchange Server
Address or DNS and click Save.
The sites appear in the calendared sites list below.
5
associate sites.
Assign Calendaring Settings to Provisioning Profiles
Calendaring settings are included as part of provisioning profiles.
To assign calendaring settings to provisioning profiles
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Calendaring Management.
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, click Group Information.
The Group Information page appears listing the provisioning profiles
defined on the CMA system.
3
4
Select the check box for each of the provisioning profiles to which you
need to assign the same calendaring settings and then click Specify
Options.
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, configure these options.
Fields
Description
Meeting Reminder
Time
Specifies the number of minutes before the meeting
an endpoint system provisioned for Polycom
Conferencing for Outlook will display a reminder.
Enable Alert Tone
When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will
play a sound along with the meeting reminder. In this
case, the endpoint will only play a sound when the
system is not in a call.
Display Private
Meetings
When enabled, specifies that an endpoint system
provisioned for Polycom Conferencing for Outlook will
display details about meetings marked private.
406
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Server Setting Operations
5
6
Click Save.
The profiles appear in the calendared profiles list below.
assign calendaring settings.
Provision the Exchange Mailbox for Calendaring Service-enabled Endpoints
To use Polycom Conferencing for Outlook (PCO), a Polycom endpoint system
must have a mailbox on the assigned Exchange server, and the Exchange
server must authenticate the endpoint before it can access its mailbox.
To use the CMA system to automatically provision a Polycom endpoint
system, the endpoint system must use the same credentials (username and
password) to access both the Exchange server and the CMA system. Only then
can the CMA system automatically provision a calendaring service-enabled
endpoint system.
To provision the Exchange Mailbox for calendaring service-enabled endpoints
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Calendaring Management.
In the Manage Calendaring dialog box, click Mailbox.
In the Polycom Conferencing for Outlook page, enable Provision
Mailbox and click OK.
For Exchange credentials, each endpoint system will be provisioned with
the same credentials it used to access the CMA system.
For its mailbox, each endpoint system will be provisioned with the
mailbox configured for it in Active Directory. This mailbox must be
pre-configured for the endpoint system on the Exchange server.
Integrate with Microsoft Lync Server 2010 or Microsoft
Office Communications Server 2007
The CMA system supports the integration with Microsoft® Lync™ Server
2010 or Microsoft® Office Communications Server 2007 by provisioning
endpoints with the group and SIP settings they need.
After you set up integration with Microsoft Lync Server or Office
Communications Server, all endpoints receive directory information from one
of those servers. You are no longer using the enterprise directory or the other
directory functions in the CMA system.
This section describes describes the tasks that enable provisioning endpoints
for integration with Microsoft Lync Server or Office Communications Server.
Polycom, Inc.
407
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Provision Group for Microsoft Lync or Microsoft Office Communications Server
Integration
You have set up the Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server group
that needs to be provisioned to endpoints in each automatic provisioning
profile. This controls the directory that endpoints can see.
Notes
•
•
•
You cannot provision integration with a Microsoft Lync or Office
Communications Server via scheduled provisioning.
If the endpoint being provisioned is not capable of integration with a Microsoft
Lync or Office Communications Server, the endpoint will ignore this settings.
The group setting here applies to both Microsoft Lync and Office
Communication Server.
To provision integration with Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Provisioning Profiles > Automatic Provisioning
Profiles.
In the Automatic Provisioning Profiles page, select the profile of interest
and click Edit.
In the Provisioning Fields dialog box, click Microsoft Lync Settings and
enter a Group Name.
The Group Name is the group set in the Microsoft Lync Server or Office
Communication Server.
4
Click OK.
Provision SIP Settings for Microsoft Lync or Microsoft Office Communications
Server Integration
By default, SIP is disabled in site provisioning. This procedure describes how
to change existing site provisioning settings so that they provision integration
with one of these unified communications servers.
To integrate with a Microsoft Lync or Office Communications Server, Polycom
endpoints must have a user account on the Microsoft unified communications
server infrastructure. To have the CMA system automatically provision a
Polycom endpoint for this integration, the endpoint must use the same
credentials (username and password) to access both the unified
communications server and the CMA system. Only then can the CMA system
automatically provision a calendaring service-enabled endpoint system.
408
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Server Setting Operations
To provision SIP for integration with Microsoft Lync or Office Communications
Server
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites.
In the Sites page, select the site of interest and click Edit Site
Provisioning Details.
3
In the Edit Site Provisioning Details dialog box, click SIP Settings and
select these options.
Settings not listed below are optional, based on the configuration of your
systems
Fields
Description
Enable SIP
Specify whether to enable SIP calls.
Automatically
Discover SIP Servers
The CMA system will issue a DNS query to locate the
SIP server and provision that information to
endpoints.
Proxy Server
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP proxy
server for the network.
Registrar Server
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP
registrar server for the network.
•
•
In an Microsoft Office Communications Server
2007 or Microsoft Lync Server 2010 environment,
specify the IP address or DNS name of the Office
Communications Server or Lync Server server.
If registering a remote HDX system with an Office
Communications Server Edge Server or Lync
Server Edge Server, use the fully qualified
domain name of the access edge server role.
Backup Registrar
Server
Specify the IP address or DNS name of a backup SIP
registrar server for the network
Transport Protocol
Indicates the protocol the system uses for SIP
signaling. The SIP network infrastructure determines
which protocol is required.
•
Auto enables an automatic negotiation of
protocols in the following order: TLS, TCP, UDP.
This is the recommended setting for most
environments.
•
•
•
TCP provides reliable transport via TCP for SIP
signaling.
UDP provides best-effort transport via UDP for
SIP signaling.
TLS provides secure communication of the SIP
signaling. TLS is available only when the system
is registered with a SIP server that supports TLS.
When you choose this setting, the system ignores
TCP/UDP port 5060..
Polycom, Inc.
409
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Fields
Description
SIP Server Type
Specify whether the SIP registrar server is a Microsoft
Office Communications Server or a Microsoft®
Lync™ Server 2010. Enabling this setting activates
integration features such as the Microsoft global
directory and Office Communicator contact sharing
with presence.
Verify Certificate
Enable this option when the endpoint system’s
certificate should be verified by the certificate
authority.
Use Enterprise
Credentials
Enable this option when the endpoint system should
use the credentials the user entered at the endpoint
to use for authenticate when registering with a SIP
registrar server.
User Name
Specify the name to use for authentication when
registering with a SIP registrar server, for example,
[email protected]. If the SIP proxy requires
authentication, this field and the password cannot be
blank.
Password
Specify the password that authenticates the system to
the registrar server.
4
Click OK.
View Current Polycom CMA System Licensing
To view current CMA system licensing
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.
The Active License section of the Licenses page displays the following
information.
Field
Description
Activation Key
Expiration Date
Components
The current activation key for the product.
The expiration date of the current license key.
The components for which the CMA system is
licensed.
Seats
The number of seats for which the CMA system is
licensed.
410
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Server Setting Operations
Add Polycom CMA System Licenses
Adding licenses to your CMA system is a two step process:
•
•
These processes are described in the following topics.
Request a Software Activation Key Code
To request a software activation key code
1
In a separate browser page or tab, log into the CMA system server as an
administrator.
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses and record the CMA system
server serial number:
____________________.
3
4
Go to http://support.polycom.com.
In the Licensing & Product Registration section, select
Activation/Upgrade.
5
6
7
Log in or Register for an Account.
Select Site & Single Activation/Upgrade.
In the Site & Single Activation page, enter the serial number you
recorded in step 2.
8
9
Click Next.
Accept the EXPORT RESTRICTION agreement.
10 In the new Site & Single Activation page, enter the software license
number listed on your License Certificate (shipped with the product) and
click Activate.
11 When the activation key appears, record it:
__________-__________-_________-___________
12 Repeat this procedure for each additional license key required.
Enter the Polycom CMA System Activation Key
To enter the CMA system activation key
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.
1
Polycom, Inc.
411
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
Enter the new activation key into the Add New License > Activation Key
field and click Add. (Note that the field is ASCII only.)
Reclaim Polycom CMA Desktop Licenses
To set the threshold for reclaiming inactive Polycom CMA Desktop licenses
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.
Change the Threshold value in the Reclaim Inactive CMA Desktop
1
2
Licenses section of the Licenses page. To reclaim licenses more quickly,
lower the threshold. Set the threshold to zero, to stop reclaiming licenses.
3
Click Update.
Add or Remove a Polycom CMA System Custom Logo
You can add your company’s logo to the CMA system user interface. To avoid
distortion, we recommend adding a logo in GIF, JPG, or PNG format with a
size of 300 x 44 pixels.
To add a custom logo to the CMA system user interface
1
2
3
4
5
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.
In the Current Logo section of the Custom Logos page, click Upload...
In the Select file dialog box, browse to the logo image and select the file.
Click Open.
In a redundant configuration, repeat steps 1 through 4 on the redundant
server.
To remove a custom logo from the CMA system user interface
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.
In the Current Server Logo section of the Custom Logos page, click
Remove.
412
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Server Setting Operations
Add or Remove a Polycom CMA Desktop Custom Logo
You can add your company logo to the Polycom CMA Desktop user interface.
This logo will be displayed on the application user interface before the user
logs in. The following illustration shows the default Polycom CMA Desktop
user interface and a customized Polycom CMA Desktop user interface.
Default Polycom CMA Desktop
Branded Polycom CMA Desktop
To avoid distortion, use a logo in GIF or JPG format with a size of
approximately 260x215 pixels.
Because the Polycom CMA Desktop logo is stored in the CMA system
database, in redundant configurations you do not need to upload the logo to
both servers.
To add a custom logo to the CMA Desktop user interface
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.
In the Current CMA Desktop Logo section of the Custom Logos page,
click Upload...
3
4
In the Select file dialog box, browse to the logo image and select the file.
Click Open.
Once a user logs in, is provisioned, and then logs out, the logo will be
displayed on the Polycom CMA Desktop user interface.
To remove a custom logo from the CMA Desktop user interface
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Custom Logos.
1
Polycom, Inc.
413
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
In the Current CMA Desktop Logo section of the Custom Logos page,
click Restore Default.
Once a user logs in, is provisioned, and then logs out, the default logo will
be displayed on the CMA Desktop user interface.
Edit the Polycom CMA System E-mail Account
To edit the CMA system e-mail account
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.
On the E-mail page, edit the e-mail account (ASCII only) from which the
CMA system will send conference notification e-mails or edit the IP
address of the mail server from which the CMA system will send
conference notification e-mails.
Notes
•
Many e-mail servers will block or discard e-mails without a qualified From:
address. To avoid this issue, make sure each person with Scheduler
permissions has a valid E-mail address.
•
Many E-mail servers will block or discard E-mails from un-trusted domains, in
which case you may need to change the default CMA system E-mail address to
one in a trusted domain.
3
Click Update.
414
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
31
Polycom CMA System SNMP
This chapter provides a discussion of the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) SNMP support. It includes these topics:
•
•
SNMP Overview
Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is a TCP/IP-based
communication protocol that allows network management systems to manage
resources across a network.
SNMP communication takes place between the management system and
SNMP agents, which are the hardware and software that the management
system monitors. An agent collects and stores local system information and
makes this information available to the management system via SNMP.
The CMA system software includes an SNMP agent. It translates local system
information into the format defined by the MIB.
The CMA system resides on a Polycom-branded Dell server. The Dell server
software also includes an SNMP agent and MIB. However, the CMA system
acts as a proxy agent to forward the Dell server MIB alarms and alerts, so the
management system does not need to be configured to receive information
directly from the Dell server MIB.
Polycom, Inc.
415
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Polycom recommends using a MIB browser to explore the CMA system MIB.
A copy of the MIB can be downloaded from the CMA system. For more
page 422. The CMA system MIB is self-documenting including information
about the purpose of specific traps and inform notifications.
It is important to note that you should understand how your SNMP
management system is configured to properly configure the CMA system
SNMP transport protocol requirements, SNMP version requirements, SNMP
authentication requirements, and SNMP privacy requirements on the CMA
system.
The CMA system supports three SNMP levels:
•
•
Disabled—The CMA system SNMP processes are turned off.
SNMPv2c—The CMA system implements a sub-version of SNMPv2. The
key advantage of SNMPv2c is the Inform command. Unlike Traps,
Informs are messages sent to the management system that must be
positively acknowledged with a response message. If the management
system does not reply to an Inform, the CMA system resends the Inform.
SNMPv2c also has improved error handling and improved SET
commands.
One drawback of SNMPv2c is that it is subject to packet sniffing of the
clear text community string from the network traffic, because it does not
encrypt communications between the management system and SNMP
agents.
•
SNMPv3—The CMA system implements the newest version of SNMP. Its
primary feature is enhanced security. The contextEngineIDin SNMPv3
uniquely identifies each SNMP entity. The contextEngineIDis used to
generate the key for authenticated messages.
The CMA system implements SNMPv3 communication with
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity level as defined in the
USM MIB).
— Authentication is used to ensure that traps are read by only the
intended recipient. As messages are created, they are given a special
key that is based on the contextEngineIDof the entity. The key is
shared with the intended recipient and used to receive the message.
— Privacy encrypts the SNMP message to ensure that it cannot be read
by unauthorized users.
416
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System SNMP
Polycom CMA System SNMP Operations
This section describes the CMA system SNMP operations including:
•
•
•
•
•
Enable SNMP Messaging
To enable SNMP messaging you must perform the two tasks:
•
•
Edit the SNMP Settings for a Polycom CMA System
To edit the SNMP settings for a CMA system
1
2
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.
To enable SNMP, select an SNMP Version. For information on the SNMP
3
Configure these settings for the connection between the CMA system and
the SNMP agents on the SNMP Setting page.
Setting
Description
Transport
Specifies the transport protocol for SNMP
communications. SNMP can be implemented over
two transport protocol:
TCP—This protocol has error-recovery services,
message delivery is assured, and messages are
delivered in the order they were sent. Some SNMP
managers only support SNMP over TCP.
UDP—This protocol does not provide error-recovery
services, message delivery is not assured, and
messages are not necessarily delivered in the order
they were sent.
Because UDP doesn't have error recovery services,
it requires fewer network resources. It is well suited
for repetitive, low-priority functions like alarm
monitoring.
Polycom, Inc.
417
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Setting
Description
Port
Specifies the port that the CMA system uses for
general SNMP messages. By default, the CMA
system uses port 161.
Community
For SNMPv2c, specifies the context for the
information, which is the SNMP group to which the
devices and management stations running SNMP
belong.
The CMA system has only one valid context—by
default, public—which is identified by this
Community name. The CMA system will not
respond to requests from management systems that
do not belong to its community.
V3 Context Name
For SNMPv3, specifies the context for the
information. The CMA system has only one valid
context, which is identified by contextName(in our
case—an empty string) and contextEngineID
.
V3 Local Engine Id
Security User
Auth Type
For SNMPv3, displays the CMA system
contextEngineIDfor SNMPv3.
For SNMPv3, specifies the security name required to
access a monitored MIB object.
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication protocol.
These protocols are used to create unique
fixed-sized message digests of a variable length
message.
The CMA system implements communication with
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity
level as defined in the USM MIB).
Possible values for authentication protocol are:
•
•
MD5—Creates a digest of 128 bits (16 bytes).
SHA—Creates a digest of 160 bits (20 bytes).
Both methods include the authentication key with the
SNMPv3 packet and then generate a digest of the
entire SNMPv3 packet.
Auth Password
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication password
that is appended to the authentication key before it is
computed into the MD5 or SHA message digest.
418
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System SNMP
Setting
Description
Encryption Type
For SNMPv3, specifies the privacy protocol for the
connection between the CMA system and the SNMP
agent.
The CMA system implements communication with
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity
level as defined in the USM MIB).
Possible values for privacy protocol are:
•
DES—Uses a 56 bit key with a 56 bit salt to
encrypt the SNMPv3 packet.
•
AES—Uses a 128 bit key with a 128 bit salt to
encrypt the SNMPv3 packet.
Encryption Password
For SNMPv3, specifies the password to be
associated with the privacy protocol.
4
Click Save SNMP Settings.
Add an SNMP Notification Receiver
You can configure the CMA system to send SNMP messages to different
notification receivers (e.g., a network management system).
To add an SNMP notification receiver to a CMA system
1
2
3
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.
In the Notification RCVR Actions section, click Add.
Configure these settings in the New Notification Receiver dialog box.
Setting
Description
IP Address
Transport
Specifies the IP address of the host receiver.
Specifies the transport protocol for SNMP
communications to the host receiver. Possible values
are:
•
•
TCP
UDP
Select the transport protocol for which the host
receiver is configured.
Port
Specifies the port that the CMA system will use to
send notifications. By default, the CMA system uses
port 162.
Polycom, Inc.
419
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Setting
Description
Trap/Inform
Specifies the type of information that should be sent
to the host receiver. Possible values are:
•
Inform—An unsolicited message sent to a
notification receiver that expects/requires a
confirmation message. Introduced with SNMP
version 2c, this option is not supported by
systems that only support SNMP version 1.
•
Trap—An unsolicited message sent to a
notification receiver that does not expect/require
a confirmation message.
SNMP Version
For SNMPv3, specifies the context for the
information.
The CMA system is a proxy-forwarding application. It
passes SNMP requests to its various
SNMP-reporting processes based on the context
information in the SNMP message. For SNMPv3,
this context is identified by contextNameand
contextEngineID
.
V3 Local Engine Id
Security User
Auth Type
For SNMPv3, displays the CMA system
contextEngineIDfor SNMPv3.
For SNMPv3, specifies the security name required to
access a monitored MIB object.
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication protocol.
The CMA system implements communication with
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity
level as defined in the USM MIB).
Possible values for authentication protocol are:
•
•
MD5
SHA
These protocols are used to create unique
fixed-sized message digests of a variable length
message. MD5 creates a digest of 128 bits (16
bytes) and SHA creates a digest of 160 bits (20
bytes).
Auth Password
For SNMPv3, specifies the authentication password
that is appended to the authentication key before it is
computed into the MD5 or SHA message digest.
420
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System SNMP
Setting
Description
Encryption Type
For SNMPv3, specifies the privacy protocol for the
connection between the CMA system and the
notification receiver.
The CMA system implements communication with
authentication and privacy (the authPrivsecurity
level as defined in the USM MIB).
Possible values for privacy protocol are:
•
•
DES
AES
Encryption Password
For SNMPv3, specifies the password to be
associated with the privacy protocol.
Configure Alert Thresholds
The CMA system provides administrators with the ability to configure some
alert thresholds settings.
To configure alert thresholds
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > CMA Alert Threshold Settings.
Configure these thresholds:
Threshold
Description
Used disk space alert
threshold
Whenever the system disk space usage in a
partition (as identified in the CMA Info Dashboard
pane) exceeds this threshold, the system sends an
alert and an SNMP trap.
Valid values for this threshold are between 1-100%.
By default, this threshold is set to 90%.
A threshold setting of 75% or greater is
recommended and no greater than 95%.
Memory usage alert
threshold
Whenever the system memory usage (as identified
in the CMA Info Dashboard pane) exceeds this
threshold, the system send an alert and an SNMP
trap.
Valid values for this threshold are between 1-100%.
By default, this thresh-%old is set to 95%.
A threshold setting between 80-95% is
recommended.
Polycom, Inc.
421
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Threshold
Description
Average CPU usage
alert threshold
Whenever the average system CPU usage (over all
CPUs as identified in the CMA Info Dashboard
pane) exceeds this threshold for the length of time
identified in the Average CPU usage alert
threshold window, the system sends an alert and
an SNMP trap.
Valid values for this threshold are between 1-100%.
By default, this threshold is set to 95%.
A threshold setting between 90-100% is
recommended.
Average CPU usage
alert threshold window
Whenever the average system CPU usage (over all
CPUs as identified in the CMA Info Dashboard
pane) exceeds this threshold for the length of time
identified in the Average CPU usage alert
threshold window, the system sends an alert and
an SNMP trap.
By default, this threshold window is set to 10
minutes. This threshold can be set to between 1-15
minutes.
A threshold setting between 5-10 minutes is
recommended.
3
Click Update.
Download Polycom CMA System MIB Package
The CMA system enterprise MIB relates information about the system. The
information is divided into these categories:
•
•
Configuration—The static state of each component, for example
component type, software version, current owner, values of all configured
parameters.
Status—The dynamic state of each component, for example the number of
connections, number of conferences, number of ports (used and available),
temperature, fan speed, CPU utilization, memory utilization, network link
status, number of dropped packets, jitter measurements, number of
successful calls, number of CPU resets.
•
•
Alerts—To notify that an exception condition has occurred, for example a
power supply failure, link/down up on a major interface, memory usage
exceeding a predefined percentage, connections in an MCU exceeding a
threshold, a logical fault or ungraceful transition.
Conformance—The historical trend for selected groups of data, for
example conference load over time for an MCU, bandwidth consumed
over time for a network device.
422
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System SNMP
To download the MIB package for a CMA system
1
2
3
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.
Click Download CMA MIBs.
In the CMA MIBs dialog box, select the MIB of interest.
Name
Description
Brcm-adapterInfo-MIB
The interface table (ifTable) shows addresses,
physical addresses, names, descriptions etc. of
the network interfaces
DCS3FRU-MIB
DELL-ASF-MIB
Contains all the field replaceable unit names,
serial numbers, and revisions for the
Polycom-branded Dell server. For more
information, see the Dell SNMP documentation.
Trap definitions for the Polycom-branded Dell
server. For more information, see the Dell SNMP
documentation.
INET-ADDRESS-MIB
ITU-ALARM-TC-MIB
MIB-Dell-10892
A definition file for standard conventions included
for reference.
A definition file for standard conventions included
for reference.
The primary MIB for the Polycom-branded Dell
server. It provides 36 traps from the server
motherboard, including system type, voltages,
and temperature readings. For more information,
see the Dell SNMP documentation.
MIB-Dell-10900
MIB-Dell-CM
Trap definitions for the system including
up/down, CPU, Memory, Network, and Disk
monitoring. For more information, see the Dell
SNMP documentation.
Provides information about devices running on
the Polycom-branded Dell server. For more
information, see the Dell SNMP documentation.
POLYCOM-CMA-MIB
RFC1213-MIB
CMA-specific MIB definition
RFC1213MIB definitions included for reference.
The CMA system supports all but "egp".
SNMPv2-CONF
A definition file for standard conventions included
for reference.
Polycom, Inc.
423
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Name
Description
SNMPv2-SMI
A definition file for standard conventions included
for reference.
SNMPv2-TC
A definition file for standard conventions included
for reference.
StorageManagement-MIB Monitoring and information about the hard disks
and RAID configuration on the server.
Polycom recommends using a MIB browser to explore the CMA system MIB.
However, a printed copy of the MIB is available in “Polycom CMA System
information about the purpose of specific traps and inform notifications.
Change the SNMP Communication Port
By default, the CMA system uses port 161 as its standard open port for SNMP
communications. However, you can change this to another open port.
To change the SNMP communication port
1
2
Go to Admin > SNMP Settings.
In the Port field of the SNMP Settings page, type a new communication
port number and click Update SNMP Settings.
424
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
32
Database Operations
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) database integration and operations. It includes these topics:
•
•
Overview of the Polycom CMA System Database
CMA system information is stored in these internal databases:
Database
Description
ReadiManager.bak
The general CMA system database that includes all data
for scheduling, devices, dial rules, device registration, and
site topology.
Logger.bak
XMPP.bak
The CMA system database for call detail records and
gatekeeper diagnostic logs.
The CMA system database for presence information.
The following values are recommended for SQL server HD size:
Readimanager - 2GB with Autogrow
Logger - 4 GB with Autogrow
XMPP - 2 GB.
Polycom, Inc.
425
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The Simple Recovery Model should be enabled for SQL backup mode.
Internal Databases
External Databases
The CMA system automatically optimizes its internal database on an ongoing
basis. It backs up its internal databases daily. The backup files are stored on the
system’s hard disk. The CMA system maintains the last four internal backups.
To keep backups for a longer time period, copy them regularly to a different
location. For more information, see “Copy the CMA System Database Backup
You can integrate the CMA system to an external Microsoft SQL Server
database. Some information about integrating with an external database:
•
CMA systems with 400 or more registered endpoints and redundant
systems require an external database.
•
If you set up an external database, follow your own corporate policies (or
Microsoft best practices) to back it up and maintain it. The CMA system
does not back up its external databases.
•
•
Anytime you switch from the internal CMA system database to an
external Microsoft SQL Server database, some system configuration
settings, for example the enterprise directory settings, must be
reconfigured.
Take steps to minimize database connection failures. For example:
— Ensure you have good network connectivity between the CMA
system and the Microsoft SQL Server. You may even consider
co-locating the CMA system with your Microsoft SQL Server.
— Increase the keep alive checks on the Microsoft SQL Server to once an
hour.
•
If your system does lose connection to the database, you must reboot the
CMA system to restore login capability; the CMA system does not
automatically reconnect to the database. For more information, see
•
•
•
It is recommended that anytime you reboot the external database server,
you also restart the CMA system in the same maintenance window.
You can create the CMA system databases manually using Microsoft SQL
scripts. Contact Polycom Global Services to request the scripts.
Anytime you switch from database sources (internal to external or
external to internal), the default administrator’s password is moved to the
database as part of the switch.
426
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Database Operations
Database Restoration
This section describes how to restore an internal CMA system database. To
restore from an external Microsoft SQL Server databases, use Microsoft SQL
Server Management Studio. Refer to your Microsoft SQL Server Management
Studio documentation for more information.
You can migrate databases as follow.
From...
Internal
Internal
External
To...
Internal
External
External
When you restore internal or external databases:
•
Do not allow users to connect to the server during the restoration process.
Restore all of the system databases at the same time.
•
•
Restore all of the system databases from backups that were taken at the
same time.
•
Restart the CMA system server when the restoration process is finished.
Database Operations
Before performing the database operations described here, Microsoft SQL
Server should already be installed. (For information about the supported
Microsoft SQL Server applications and service pack levels, see the Polycom
CMA System Release Notes for the version you’re running.)
The Microsoft SQL Server Setup wizard and documentation provides
guidance for setting up Microsoft SQL Server. As you use the wizard, make
these choices:
•
For Components to Install, at a minimum choose the SQL Server
Database Services.
•
For Instance Name, select Default Instance and configure the database
instance port (typically 1433).
•
•
For Service Account, select the Use the built-in System account option.
For Authentication Mode, select Mixed Mode and provide a password
that meets your enterprise policy for password length and complexity.
•
For Collation Settings, select SQL collations. The CMA system is only
certified with the Microsoft SQL Server set to US-English Collation
(SQL_Latin1_General_CP1_CI_AS).
Polycom, Inc.
427
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
Error and Usage Report Settings are optional.
Integrate a Polycom CMA System to an External Database
To integrate a CMA system with an external database
1
Using the Microsoft SQL Server Configuration Manager, change the SQL
Server keep alive checks (typically, SQL Server 2005 Network
Configuration > Protocols for MSSQLSERVER > TCP/IP > KeepAlive)
to 3,600,000 milliseconds.
2
3
4
5
At the CMA system interface, go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.
On the Database page, select Use an external SQL Server database.
Enter the Database Server IP address or DNS Name.
Enter the Database Server Port and click Update.
The system will guide you through formatting or upgrading the external
database, as necessary.
6
Click Finish.
Revert a Polycom CMA System to its Internal Database
To revert a CMA system from an external database to its internal database
1
2
At the CMA system interface, go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.
On the Database page, clear Use an external SQL Server database and
click Update.
3
Click Update.
Note
Copy the CMA System Database Backup Files
In addition to backing up and restoring database files, you can copy the
database backup files to and from the CMA system to an external location.
428
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Database Operations
To copy the CMA system database backup files using the web interface
1
At the CMA system interface, go to Admin > Database Backup Files.
The Database Backup Files list appears showing all of the backup files
stored on the CMA system. Files with a timestamp included in the name
are system-generated backup files. Files without a timestamp are user
forced backups.
2
3
In the Database Backup Files list, select the backup files of interest and
click Save.
In the Save As dialog box, browse to a location and click Save.
Reformat the Existing Database
The CMA system has an option that allows you to completely reformat (clean
out) the system’s existing database.
IMPORTANT
Use this option only if your database is corrupted beyond repair or perhaps if you
need to wipe out a test system to prepare it for production data.
To reformat the database, you must use the PlcmDbouser name and password
during the process. This user name is an internal user name found at
Admin > Management and Security Settings > Database Security. Be sure
that you know the password for PlcmDbobefore starting the reformat process.
By default, the password is not listed, but you can reset it. For more
To reformat the existing databases
1
From the CMA system web interface, go to Admin > Server Settings >
Database.
2
3
On the Database page, select Reformat existing database...
In the Reformat Existing Database/Database Maintenance dialog box,
specify the Database Server IP Address and Database Server Port
Number for the database to be reformatted.
4
5
Specify the PlcmDbo user Login ID and Password and click
Reformat/Install Database.
Click Yes to confirm the reformat operation.
The system displays a Reformat/Install Progress bar to indicate that the
system is reformatting the database.
Polycom, Inc.
429
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
430
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
33
Polycom CMA System Redundancy
This chapter describes how to configure a redundant Polycom® Converged
Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
Polycom CMA 5000 System Redundancy Overview
A redundant CMA system configuration offers higher reliability and greater
call success by ensuring that a CMA system server is always available.
A redundant CMA system configuration requires two CMA system servers
and three IP addresses in the same subnet on the same network—one physical
IP address for each of the servers and one virtual IP address dedicated to
endpoint registration.
How Redundancy Works
Terminology is very important in understanding how redundancy works.
In a redundant configuration, one server is licensed as the primary server and
the other server is licensed as the redundant server. The primary server is
always the primary server and the redundant server is always the redundant
server.
In a redundant configuration, there is only one active server. The active server
is the server managing the system. It is the server running all of the CMA
system services. In a normal operational state, the active server is the primary
server. In a failover state, the active server is the redundant server.
Polycom, Inc.
431
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
In a redundant configuration, there is only one standby server. The standby
server is the server that is not managing the system. It is the server running
only the Polycom Service Monitor. In a normal operational state, the
redundant server is the standby server. In a failover state, the active server is
the standby server. (If at anytime you receive a Cannot find servererror
when you try to log into a server, check to see if it is the standby server.)
The Polycom Service Monitor monitors redundancy. In a normal operational
state, the redundant/standby server sends a SEND_REQUEST_STATUSmessage
via TCP every three seconds on port 700 to the primary/active server and
expects the server to answer with a SERVICE_RUNNINGmessage. (These
messages do not include any qualitative data about the health of other
services; they only verify that the active server is available on the network.)
If the redundant service sends three consecutive SEND_REQUEST_STATUS
requests that go unanswered, its Service Monitor initiates a failover and the
redundant server becomes the active server.
The most common reasons for system failovers are power failures and
network disconnections. Note that failures in services do not initiate a failover,
only a server failure.
If both the primary and redundant servers start simultaneously (for example
if both are in the same location and recover from a power failure at the same
time), both servers will initially attempt to become the active server. However,
the redundant server—the server licensed as the redundant server—retreats to
standby status once the system reaches its fully functional state.
An administrator can force a failover via the Switch Server Roles function in
the CMA system user interface. Failover does not require a system restart.
The primary and redundant servers share the external CMA system database,
so what is recorded by one CMA system is read by the other CMA system. An
external Microsoft SQL Server database is required. The CMA system database
information—call records, endpoint registration information, and network
topology configurations—remains consistent and available during a failover
because both servers point to the same database.
Also, the failover to the redundant server seems to occur seamlessly because
the endpoints are registered with the virtual IP address, which remains
constant.
During a failover:
•
Active conferences are dropped from the system. Conference participants
can call back in using the same conference information.
•
Users logged into the CMA system user interface are disconnected during
a failover and returned to the main CMA system web page. Users can log
back in once the failover is completed.
•
Users in the middle of an operation may get an error message, because the
system is not available to respond to a request.
432
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Redundancy
•
The redundant server becomes the active server. Its services start in an
order designed to prevent the new active server from being flooded with
requests from endpoints during startup.
A system failover usually takes approximately 5 minutes, but some system
settings affect how rapidly a redundant system returns to full functionality.
The gatekeeper Registration Refresh period affects how quickly endpoints
re-register with the redundant server after a failover. And if Deny calls
to/from unregistered endpoints is checked, the gatekeeper rejects calls from
endpoints that have not re-registered with the redundant server after a
failover. Therefore, in a redundant system configuration, use a short refresh
period (30 seconds) unless you have many endpoints or a large amount of
network traffic.
Once a failover to a redundant server occurs, the redundant server manages
all system operations until an administrator switches back to the original
primary server via the Switch Server Roles function in the CMA system user
interface.
Notes
•
The CMA system does not automatically switch to the primary server when the
primary server becomes available. An administrator must Switch Server
Roles.
•
A failover or system restart initiates an encryption routine that changes the
private key for a redundant system. Therefore, after a failover or system restart,
schedulers who use one of the scheduling plug-ins will be prompted to re-enter
their login settings to access the system.
Redundant Configuration System Administration
Because the two servers share the external CMA system database, most of their
configuration information is shared. However, certain information is not
stored in the database, so an administrator must manually synchronize this
information. This includes:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Basic network settings such as IP, default gateway, and DNS settings
External database information
Time and external NTP server settings
The current system log level
Custom CMA system logo--upload the same logo to both servers
Software Update profiles for scheduled software updates--upload the
same software package to both servers
Whenever you change information in one of these sections on one server you
should also change it on the other server.
Licensing and upgrading a redundant system is slightly more complex. The
primary and redundant server required different licenses.
Polycom, Inc.
433
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Implement a Redundant Polycom CMA 5000 System
You can set up a CMA 5000 system in a fault-tolerant, high-availability,
redundant configuration. The CMA 4000 system is not available in a
redundant configuration.
This section has two procedures. One describes how to convert an existing
non-redundant CMA 5000 system to a redundant configuration. The other
describes how to configure redundancy on a newly installed system.
To add a redundant Polycom CMA system server to an existing system
1
2
3
4
In a maintenance window when there are no running conferences, verify
that your primary CMA 5000 system is pointed to an external Microsoft
SQL Server database and is properly licensed.
Install the redundant CMA 5000 system as described in the Polycom CMA
Getting Started Guide. During installation, point the redundant CMA 5000
system server to its internal database.
Request the required software activation key code for the redundant
Enter the redundant license onto the redundant CMA 5000 system server.
a
Log into the CMA 5000 system, and go to Admin > Server Settings >
Licenses.
b
Enter the activation key code for the redundant server into the Add
New License > Activation Key field and click Add.
You will receive a message indicating that you’ve entered a
redundant license and the system must be rebooted. DO NOT
REBOOT NOW. The redundant server will automatically reboot
5
6
On the primary server:
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration.
Enter the Virtual IP for the redundant system and click Submit.
The primary system will reboot.
Wait for the primary system to completely reboot and is back online, and
then on the redundant server:
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.
On the Database page, select the Use an external SQL Server
database check box.
c
Enter the database information from the primary server that is, the
database server’s IP address, and SQL server port number in the
Database page.
434
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Redundancy
d
Click Update.
The CMA 5000 system connects to the database server and the
redundant server restarts and comes online.
7
On the primary server, fail over to the redundant server. See “Failover to
To configure redundancy on a newly installed Polycom CMA system.
A redundant CMA system configuration requires the installation of two CMA
system servers on the same network. During First Time Setup, you are
instructed to assign these two servers physical IP addresses and leave them
pointed at their internal databases. This section describes how to complete the
configuration of these newly installed redundant servers. It includes these
topics:
1
2
Note
This procedure describes implementing a new redundant CMA system. For
information on converting an existing system to a redundant system, see “Add or
Configure the External Database for Redundancy
To configure the two redundant servers to use the same external database
1
2
Log into both the primary and redundant CMA 5000 system servers.
On the primary server, go to Admin > Dashboard and click
Shutdown
to shut down the primary server.
3
When the primary server has shutdown completely, on the redundant
server:
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.
On the Database page, select the Use an external SQL Server
database check box.
c
Enter the Database Server IP address or DNS Name.
d
Enter the Database Server Port and click Update.
The system will guide you through formatting or upgrading the
external database. The redundant server boots.
e
After the redundant server restarts completely, log into it again and
select Admin > Dashboard.
Polycom, Inc.
435
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
f
Click Shutdown
to shut down the redundant server.
4
When the redundant server has shutdown completely, on the primary
server:
a
b
c
Turn ON the primary server.
Log into the server and go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.
On the Database page, select the Use an external SQL Server
database check box.
d
e
Enter the Database Server IP address or DNS Name.
Enter the Database Server Port and click Update.
The system will guide you through formatting or upgrading the
external database. The primary server restarts and comes online as
the active server.
Set the Virtual IP Address for the Redundant System
To set the virtual IP address for the redundant system
1
When the primary server has restarted completely, log into the primary
CMA 5000 system server.
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration.
If the two CMA system servers are installed and configured correctly on
the network, both servers are displayed in the table on the Redundant
Configuration page.
3
Enter the Virtual IP for the redundant system and click Submit. For
information about this virtual IP address, see “Add or Remove a Polycom
Note
Set the virtual IP for the redundant server on the primary server only.
The primary server restarts and comes online as the active server.
4
When the primary server has restarted completely, turn ON the
redundant server and wait for it to boot completely.
436
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Redundancy
License a Redundant Polycom CMA System
To license a non-redundant CMA system, see “Add Polycom CMA System
To license a redundant CMA 5000 system
1
Request a separate software activation key code for the primary and
redundant server as described in “Request a Software Activation Key
2
On the primary CMA 5000 system server:
a
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database and verify the database
information. (If you fail to point the server to the correct database, you
must re-enter the license when you change databases.)
b
c
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Licenses.
Enter the activation key code for the primary server into the Add New
License > Activation Key field and click Add.
The license number appears in the list and the number of active
licenses is updated.
d
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration. and
click Switch Server Role.
The system fails over to the redundant server.
3
On the redundant server:
a
b
c
Log into the CMA system using the virtual IP address, and go to Admin
> Server Settings > Licenses.
Enter the software activation key code for the redundant server into
the Add New License > Activation Key field and click Add.
Go to Admin > Dashboard and click Restart
to restart the system.
The system fails over to the primary server.
Failover to a Redundant Polycom CMA 5000 System Server
In a redundant configuration, the CMA 5000 system automatically fails over
from the primary server to the redundant server. However, you can also
manually initiate a failover.
To manually initiate a failover
1
On either server, go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant
Configuration.
Polycom, Inc.
437
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
On the Redundant Configuration page, click Switch Server Role.
The system initiates a failover to the other server.
Discontinue Redundancy on a Polycom CMA 5000 System
Configuration
In some circumstances, you may need to discontinue redundancy. Use this
procedure to do so, but only when the system is in a valid redundant state.
To discontinue a redundant Polycom CMA 5000 system configuration:
1
2
3
Log into the CMA 5000 system using the virtual IP address.
On the redundant server:
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Database.
On the Database page, deselect the Use an external SQL Server
database check box.
c
Click Update.
The redundant server restarts.
4
On the primary server:
a
b
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Redundant Configuration.
On the Redundant Configuration page, click Reset Redundant
Configuration.
The primary system restarts.
438
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
34
Gatekeeper Management
This chapter describes how to work with gatekeepers within the Polycom®
Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system. It includes these
topics:
•
•
•
Primary Gatekeeper Management Operations
By default, the CMA system is made the primary gatekeeper during the First
Time Setup process. Operations for managing the primary gatekeeper
include:
•
•
Edit the Primary Gatekeeper Settings
To edit the primary CMA system gatekeeper settings
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Primary Gatekeeper.
On the Primary Gatekeeper page, make the required changes.
The Primary Gatekeeper Settings include these fields:
Polycom, Inc.
439
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
Gatekeeper
Identifier
The gatekeeper identifier (ASCII-only) on the network,
which is used by the endpoints and CMA system for
communication.
The maximum number of characters is 254. All ASCII
characters are valid.
Gatekeeper
Description
The description (AS.CII only) of this gatekeeper on the
network.
Default Gatekeeper When enabled, indicates that this CMA system is the
default gatekeeper on the network.
Allow Registration
of
Defines for the gatekeeper of which endpoints to allow
to register. For more information, see “Device
Registration
Refresh (seconds)
The number of days that the CMA system gatekeeper
maintains the endpoint registration information, in case
the endpoint has not yet received any.
The default is 30days.
Enter 999to prevent endpoint registrations from
expiring automatically.
Registration
Refresh (seconds)
The interval at which the CMA system sends
“keep-alive” messages to registered endpoints to
determine whether they are online. The default is 300
seconds.
If the endpoint responds with a registration request
message, the endpoint is online. If not, the endpoint is
offline.
When the endpoint is registered to another gatekeeper,
the CMA system still shows the endpoint’s status.
To view the endpoint’s state (Online or Offline), go to
Endpoint> Monitor View.
Note
Endpoints are Offline when they have been turned off
or have been removed from the network. Endpoints
return to an Online state when they have been turned
on or have re-registered with CMA system.
Maximum Neighbor
Gatekeeper Hop
Counts
Limits the number of connections to make when an
endpoint seeks dialing resolution. The default is
3.
Log calls to/from
unregistered
endpoints
Logs calls to and from rogue endpoints. To view call
logs, select System Management > Reports >
Gatekeeper Message Log.
440
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Gatekeeper Management
Field
Description
Deny calls to/from
unregistered
endpoints
Prevents calls to and from rogue endpoints.
Enable Real-Time
Statistics
Select this option to allow the gatekeeper to collect
statistics from the endpoints.
IRR frequency
Specifies the interval (in seconds) at which endpoints
that can report QoS (Quality of Service) measures will
report them to the CMA system.
By default, IRR is set to 0, which is equivalent to
disabling the Real-time Statistics option. The valid IRR
frequency range is 20 to 65535.
Call Model
Describes how the CMA system routes selected H.225
call signaling messages (that is, SETUP, CALL
PROCEEDING, ALERTING, CONNECT, and NOTIFY
message).
Possible values include: Routed or Direct. For more
In any case, Q.931 messages (ARQ, ACF, ARJ, BRQ,
BCF, and BRJ) are always sent through the CMA
system gatekeeper.
3
Click Update.
Configure Prefixed Based Registration
A user with administrator permissions can configure the CMA system so that
only endpoints with specified E.164 prefixes are allowed to register to the
H.323 gatekeeper.
Note that when you apply this policy to a system with existing endpoints, all
existing endpoints that fail to meet the new policy will fail to re-register with
the gatekeeper. This will be flagged in the Endpoint > Monitor View as a
gatekeeper registration error.
To allow only the registration of endpoints with defined E.164 prefixes
1
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Primary Gatekeeper.
On the Primary Gatekeeper page, change the Allow Registration of
setting to Predefined Prefixes Only.
The Valid E.164 Prefixes entry box appears.
2
Enter a range of prefixes in the From and To fields and click Add.
The prefix range appears in the Allowed Prefix Ranges table.
Polycom, Inc.
441
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
Continue adding prefixes ranges as necessary. To delete a range, select
the range and click the Delete button for it.
When you’ve specified all the prefix ranges, click Update.
Alternate Gatekeeper Management Operations
Alternate Gatekeeper Management Operations include:
•
•
•
Add an Alternate Gatekeeper
To add an alternate gatekeeper
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Alternate Gatekeeper.
On the Alternate Gatekeeper page, enter the required gatekeeper
information.
The Alternate Gatekeeper Settings include these fields:
Field
Description
Need to Register Check this box to require that a endpoint register with the
alternate gatekeeper before sending other registration
admission status requests.The default setting is
unchecked.
Alternate
The alternate gatekeeper’s network identifier (ASCII only)
Gatekeeper ID
IP Address
Port
The IP address of the alternate gatekeeper
The port number (usually 1719) that the alternate
gatekeeper uses to communicate with endpoints
Priority
Indicates the alternate gatekeeper’s priority for endpoint
registration. A lower number has higher priority (the range
is
alternate gatekeeper with a priority of 0. The default
setting is
0
to 127), so endpoints would first register with an
0
.
3
Click Update.
442
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Gatekeeper Management
Edit the Alternate Gatekeeper Settings
To edit the alternate gatekeeper settings
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Alternate Gatekeeper.
On the Alternate Gatekeeper page, make the required changes. For more
information, see Alternate Gatekeeper Settings
3
Click Update.
Remove the Alternate Gatekeeper
To remove the alternate gatekeeper settings
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Alternate Gatekeeper.
On the Alternate Gatekeeper page, clear the Need to Register check box.
Click Update.
Neighboring Gatekeeper Management Operations
Neighboring Gatekeeper Management Operations include:
•
•
•
•
View Neighboring Gatekeepers
To view the neighboring gatekeepers
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeepers.
The Neighboring Gatekeepers list appears.
Column
Name
Description
The name of the region
The description of the region
Description
Polycom, Inc.
443
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Add a Neighboring Gatekeeper
To add a neighboring gatekeeper
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeeper.
On the Neighboring Gatekeeper page, click Add Neighbor.
In the Add Neighbor dialog box, enter the required gatekeeper
information and click Save.
The neighboring gatekeeper is added to the system.
Edit a Neighboring Gatekeeper
To edit the settings for a neighboring gatekeeper
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeeper.
On the Neighboring Gatekeeper page, select the neighboring gatekeeper
of interest and click Edit Neighbor.
3
4
In the Edit Neighbor dialog box, make the required changes and click
Update.
You’ll need to reboot the CMA system to make the change effective.
Delete a Neighboring Gatekeeper
To delete a neighboring gatekeeper
1
2
Go to Admin > Gatekeeper Settings > Neighboring Gatekeeper.
On the Neighboring Gatekeeper page, select the neighboring gatekeeper
of interest and click Delete.
3
Click Delete to confirm the deletion.
444
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
35
Management & Security Operations
This chapter describes the Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) system management and security tasks. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Update the Polycom CMA System Software
To update a CMA system with a new software version, complete the following
tasks:
1
2
3
4
5
Download the software upgrade file.
Obtain an upgrade key code.
Save a backup of the CMA system databases.
Perform the software upgrade.
Verify the upgrade.
Polycom, Inc.
445
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
For more information on performing each of these tasks, see the Polycom CMA
System Upgrade Guide.
Manage Certificates
Certificates are a security technology that assists networked computers in
determining whether to trust each other. Each digital certificate is identified by
its public key. The collection of all public keys used in an enterprise to
determine trust is known as a Public Key Infrastructure (PKI).
To manage digital certificates, an enterprise must:
•
Establish a Public Key Infrastructure using one or more Certificate
Authorities (CA). Typically, an enterprise’s IT department has a CA but
commercial CAs may be used as well.
•
Configure each computer that participates in the PKI with a digital
certificate that identifies it. The certificate must be signed by one of the
CAs in the PKI
•
•
Configure each computer that participates in the PKI to trust the PKI's
Certificate Authorities
Ensure that the PKI is used to protect data exchange by configuring each
system to use encryption protocols such as Secure Sockets Layer (SSL)
and/or Transport Level Security (TLS).
Certificates Accepted by the Polycom CMA System
By default, to support encrypted communications and establish a minimum
level of trust, the CMA system presents a self-signed digital certificate to its
clients. This default certificate will typically not be trusted by clients. Web
browsers that connect to the CMA system user interface will display a warning
regarding the certificate.
Participation in a Public Key Infrastructure requires a CMA system to have
been configured with at least one root CA certificate, a current certificate
revocation list (CRL) from the CA, and a digital certificate signed by the CA
that identifies the CMA system.
446
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
Certificates come in several forms (encoding and protocol). The following
table shows the forms that can be installed in the CMA system.
Standard /
Encoding
File Type
Description and Installation Method
PEM
(Base64-encoded
ASCII text)
PKCS #7
standard
Certificate chain containing:
•
A signed certificate for the system,
authenticating its public key.
P7B file
•
•
The CA’s public certificate.
Sometimes intermediate
certificates.
Upload file or paste into text box.
CER (single
certificate) file
Signed certificate for the system,
authenticating its public key.
Upload file or paste into text box.
Certificate text
Encoded certificate text copied from
CA’s E-mail or secure web page.
Paste into text box.
DER
PKCS #12
standard
Certificate chain containing:
(binary format
using ASN.1
Abstract Syntax
Notation)
•
A signed certificate for the system,
authenticating its public key.
PFX file
•
•
•
A private key for the system.
The CA’s public certificate.
Sometimes intermediate
certificates.
Upload file.
PKCS #7
standard
Certificate chain containing:
•
A signed certificate for the system,
authenticating its public key.
P7B file
•
•
The CA’s public certificate.
Sometimes intermediate
certificates.
Upload file.
CER (single
certificate) file
(X.509 standard
format)
Digital certificate that uniquely identifies
the system within the PKI.
Upload file.
Polycom, Inc.
447
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Certificate Operations
In maximum security mode, the root CA certificate must be installed during
First Time Setup. However, you can complete First Time Setup with just the
root CA certificate and the CMA system default self-signed certificate. Then
you can complete the process using the Certificate Management page.
In standard security mode, you can set up certificates at any time.
Use the Certificate Management page to:
•
•
•
•
•
View Certificates and Certificate Details
To view the list of installed certificates
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management.
The Certificate Management page displays the list of currently installed
certificates. By default, the system will display only one certificate. It will
be identified as the CMA server identity certificate. When other certificates
are installed, they will display along with the server identity certificate.
The Certificate Management page has this information.
Column
Description
Status
The status of the certificate. Possible values include:
•
•
Certificate is valid
Certificate is invalid
Identifier
The certificate name as assigned by the CA
448
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
Column
Description
The type of certificate. Possible values are:
Purpose
•
•
•
•
CMA server identity—the system identity
certificate.
Trusted root certificate—the root certificate for a
CA.
Intermediate certificate—certificate from an
intermediate CA.
Trusted peer—certificate from any server or
computer that is not a CA but whose identity is
trusted. The trusted peer certificate must be
signed by one of the CAs installed in the CMA.
Expiration
The expiration date of the certificate.
CRL Next Update
The date by which a new certificate revocation list
from the CA must be uploaded.
IMPORTANT
If an administrator does not upload a new CRL by
the CRL Next Update date, the system will
become unresponsive. Recovering from this
situation requires reinstalling from the recovery
disk, manually reconfiguring of identity and root
certificates, and restoring the system from a
system backup.
2
To view more information about a certificate, select the certificate and
click View Certificate Details.
The Certificate Details dialog box appears with this information.
Section
Description
Certificate Info
Issued To
Purpose and alias of the certificate.
Information about the entity to which the certificate
was issued and the certificate serial number.
Issued By
Validity
Information about the issuer.
Issue and expiration dates.
Fingerprints
SHA1 and MD5 fingerprints (checksums) for
confirming certificate.
Public Key
CRL Info
The CMA public key, which in the public key system
is distributed widely, and is not kept secure.
The date by which the current certificate revocation
list must be replaced by a new list and the version of
the list.
Polycom, Inc.
449
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
Use the arrows to reveal or hide information. Click Close when you are
done.
Create a Certificate Signing Request
Although the initial CMA system configuration permits using the default,
self-signed certificate, normal operation in a secure mode requires that you
install a digital certificate signed by a trusted certificate authority that
uniquely identifies the CMA system within your public key infrastructure.
This can be done by creating a certificate signing request for the CMA system
and submitting it to a certificate authority to be signed.
Note
Although it is common for a system to be identified by any number of digital
certificates, each signed by a different CA, the CMA system currently only supports
a single identity certificate.
This procedure describes how to create a certificate signing request (CSR) to
submit to a certificate authority.
To create a certificate signing request
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management.
The Certificate Management page displays the list of currently available
certificates. By default, the system will have one server certificate
identified as the CMA server identity certificate and one or more root
certificates or certificate chains.
2
Click Create Certificate Signing Request.
If you see the warning “This action will overwrite any previously
generated or uploaded private key. Do you want to continue?,” do one of
the following:
— If you are waiting for a previous request to be signed, click No.
Because the CMA system currently supports only one identity
certificate, only the most recent private key is retained. The digital
certificate resulting from the most recent CSR is the only certificate
that will match the retained private key and is therefore the only
identity certificate that can be installed.
— If this is a new certificate signing request, click Yes to continue.
450
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
3
In the Certificate Information dialog box, enter the identifying
information for your CMA system and click OK.
Field
Description
Country Name
Two-letter (ASCII only) ISO 3166 country code in
which the server is located.
State or Province
Name
Full state or province name (ASCII only) in which the
server is located.
Locality Name
City name (ASCII only) in which the server is located.
Organization Name
Enterprise name (ASCII only) at which the server is
located.
Organizational Unit
Name
Subdivision (ASCII only) of the enterprise at which
the server is located. Optional. Multiple values are
permitted, one per line.
Common Name (CN)
IPv4 Address
The host name of the system (read-only), as defined
in the network settings.
The IPv4 address of the system (read-only), as
defined in the network settings.
IPv6 Address
When applicable, the IPv6 address of the system, as
defined in the network settings.
Email Address
E-mail address (ASCII only) for a contact at the
enterprise.
A File Download dialog box appears.
4
5
In the File Download dialog box, click Save.
In the Save As dialog box, enter a unique name for the file, browse to the
location to which to save the file, and click Save.
6
Submit the file (or text within the file) as required by your certificate
authority.
When your certificate authority has processed your request, it sends you
a signed digital certificate for your CMA system. Some certificate
authorities send only the signed digital certificate while others send all of
the certificates that form the chain of trust (including intermediate and/or
root CA certificates). These certificates may arrive as e-mail text, e-mail
attachments, or be available on a secure web page.
Install a Certificate
This procedure describes how to install a certificate or certificate chain
provided by a certificate authority. It assumes that you’ve received the
certificate or certificate chain in one of the formats accepted by the CMA
Polycom, Inc.
451
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
CAUTION
Installing certificates requires a system restart and terminates all active
conferences.
When you install a certificate, the change is made to the certificate store
immediately, but the system can’t implement the change until it restarts and reads
the changed certificate store.
To install a signed certificate that identifies the CMA system
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management
and click Install Certificates.
A warning appears stating that changes made to the certificates will
require a system restart to take effect.
2
In the Add Certificates dialog box, do one of the following:
— If you have a PFX, P7B, or single certificate file, click Upload
certificate, enter the password (if any) for the file, and browse to the
file or enter the path and file name.
— If you have PEM-format text, copy the certificate text, click Paste
certificate, and paste it into the text box below. You can paste multiple
PEM certificates one after the other.
3
4
Click OK.
If you are uploading a signed identity certificate for the first time, it will
replace the CMA system self-signed certificate.
If you are uploading a signed identity certificate for the first time, you can
verify that the new signed certificate has replaced the default self-signed
certificate:
a
In the list of certificates, select the CMA server identity certificate and
click View Certificate Details.
b
When the Certificate Details dialog box appears, verify that the
information in the Issued To and Issued By sections has been
replaced by the signed public certificate from the certificate authority.
c
Click OK to close the dialog box.
CAUTION
The CMA 6.2 system requires certificates with Client and Server Authentication in
the Enhanced Key Usage field, otherwise the certificate installation will fail.
Upload a Certificate Revocation List
This section describes how to install a certificate revocation list (CRL)
provided by a certificate authority.
452
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
The CMA system requires a CRL for each CA or sub-CA in the certificate
chain. The CMA system also requires that you upload a new CRL at regular
intervals. This interval can be as short as a few days in higher security
environments or a few months in environments with lower security
requirements.
IMPORTANT
If an administrator does not upload a new CRL by the CRL Next Update date, the
system will become unresponsive. Recovering from this situation requires
reinstalling from the recovery disk, manually reconfiguring of identity and root
certificates, and restoring the system from a system backup
To upload a certificate revocation list
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management
and click Upload Certificate Revocation List.
In the Select file dialog box, browse to the location of the CRL that you
obtained from the CA and select the file.
Click Open.
Delete a Certificate
You can delete certificates from the CMA system, but the CMA system
prevents you from deleting any certificate that breaks the identity certificate’s
chain of trust. To delete these certificates, new CA certificates must be installed
and the identity certificate must be replaced.
Caution
Removing certificates requires a system restart, which terminates all active
conferences.
When you remove a certificate, the change is made to the certificate store
immediately, but the system can’t implement the change until it restarts and reads
the changed certificate store.
To delete a certificate
1
2
3
Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management.
The Certificate Management page displays the list of currently available
certificates.
Select the certificate to be deleted and click Delete Certificate.
A warning appears stating that changes made to the certificates will
require a system restart to take effect.
Click Yes to continue.
Polycom, Inc.
453
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
4
When prompted, click Yes to confirm the deletion.
A dialog box informs you that the certificate has been deleted.
View the Expiration Dates for Certificates and CRLs
Certificates and certificate revocation lists expire. To view their expiration
Change the System User Interface Timeout and Number of
Sessions
To change the CMA system user interface timeout and number of sessions
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session
Management.
2
On the Session Management page, configure these settings as needed.
Field
Description
CMA user interface
timeout
By default, the CMA system user interface times out
after 10 minutes of inactivity. Use this procedure to
change the timeout value for the user interface inactivity
timer. Possible value is 5 to 60 minutes.
Maximum number
of sessions per
user
The number of simultaneous login sessions per user ID.
By default, the maximum number of sessions per user
ID is 5. Possible value is 1 to 10 sessions.
Maximum number
of sessions per
system
The number of simultaneous login sessions by all users.
By default, the maximum number of sessions by all
users is 50. Possible value is 2 to 50 sessions.
Note
If this limit is reached, but none of the logged-in users is
an Administrator, the first Administrator user to arrive is
granted access, and the system terminates the
non-Administrator session that’s been idle the longest.
3
Click Update.
454
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
Give Enterprise Users Default Scheduler Role
By default when local users are added to the CMA system, they are assigned
the Scheduler role. By default, when you integrate a CMA system to an Active
Directory, enterprise users are not assigned a role. In this case, you must either
assign each enterprise user a role, or you can use this procedure to give
enterprise users the Scheduler role by default.
To give enterprise users default Scheduler role for a Polycom CMA system
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session
Management.
2
3
Select the CMA access via default profile allowed option.
Click Update.
Change the Message for Enterprise Users without a Role
To change the message enterprise users without a role see when they try to log
into a Polycom CMA system
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session
Management.
2
Edit the Message to be displayed to unauthorized users.
For example, enter a message such as “Your username and password are
valid, but you have no permissions on this system. Contact your IT
department for more information.”
3
Click Update.
Control Remote Desktop Connections to the CMA System
By default, users can access the CMA system using the Windows Remote
Desktop Connection. You can disable this ability.
To control CMA system access with Remote Desktop Connection
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Session
Management.
2
3
Clear the Enable remote desktop connections option.
Click Update.
Polycom, Inc.
455
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Automatic Registration Synchronization
You can configure the CMA system to send registration server addressing
information for the gatekeeper and/or global directory server (GDS) when the
endpoint is registered to the CMA system.
Note
For the CMA system, the GDS is the same as the global address book (GAB).
This automatic registration synchronization service only works for endpoints
that register with the gatekeeper or GDS or are manually added to the CMA
system after the Automatic Registration Synchronization setting is enabled.
So if the Automatic Registration Synchronization setting is enabled and an
endpoint registers with the gatekeeper, the gatekeeper addressing information
is sent to the endpoint. If the Automatic Registration Synchronization setting
is enabled and an endpoint registers with the GDS, the GDS addressing
information is sent to the endpoint. If the Automatic Registration
Synchronization setting is enabled and an endpoint is added manually to the
CMA system, both the gatekeeper and GDS addressing information is sent to
the endpoint.
If automatic discovery and configuration is not successful, you can manually
add endpoints.
Notes
•
Automatic Registration Synchronization works only for endpoints that
register with the gatekeeper or Global Directory Server after the setting is
enabled; it does not automatically register pre-existing endpoints.
•
The CMA system only supports Automatic Registration Synchronization for
Polycom and selected third-party endpoints operating in standard mode. For
supported endpoint types, including third-party endpoint types, see “Endpoint
Types” on page 87.
To enable Automatic Registration Synchronization of endpoints
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Endpoint
Management Settings.
2
In the Automatic Registration Synchronization section of the Endpoint
Management Settings page, select Synchronize endpoint registration
and click Update.
After you have changed this setting, all endpoints you add are
automatically provisioned.
456
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
Set Common Passwords for Endpoints
The Common Password feature allows you to manage endpoints that have the
same global administrative password. However, it cannot reset the
administrative password on endpoints.
If you use the Common Password feature, access to password-protected data
within endpoints is granted if the specified common password matches the
endpoints’ Administrator Password.
To set common passwords for endpoints
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Endpoint
Management Settings.
In the Common Password section of the Endpoint Management Settings
page, select Use a Common Password.
Enter the common User Name and the common password in the
Password and Verify Password fields and click Update.
Note
Leave these settings blank if your Polycom endpoints require individual passwords
or do not have passwords. To configure a global administrative password for all
Polycom endpoints, use scheduled provisioning.
Disable Common Password for Endpoints
To disable common passwords for endpoints
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Endpoint
Management Settings.
2
In the Common Password section of the Endpoint Management Settings
page, clear Use a Common Password and click Update.
The common password feature is disabled. However, the values for the
common password feature are retained in the database, so it can be easily
re-enabled.
Polycom, Inc.
457
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Set Local Account Lockout and Timeout
To set local account lockout and timeout
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Local User
Account Configuration.
2
On the Local User Account Configuration page, configure these settings
as needed.
Field
Description
Account Lockout
Failed login
threshold
Specify how many consecutive login failures cause the
system to lock an account. Possible value is 2 to 10.
Failed login
window (hours)
Specify the time span within which the consecutive
failures must occur in order to lock the account.
Possible value is 1 to 24.
Customized user
account lockout
duration (minutes)
Specify how long the user’s account remains locked.
Possible value is 1 to 480.
Account Inactivity
Customize account
inactivity threshold
(days)
Specify the inactivity threshold that triggers disabling of
inactive accounts. Possible value is 30 to 180.
3
Click Update.
Set Local Password Requirements
The Local Password Requirements page allows users assigned the
Administrator role to change, but not disable password, security
requirements by specifying password age, length, and complexity.
To set local password requirements
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Local Password
Requirements.
458
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
2
On the Local Password Requirements page, configure these settings as
needed.
Field
Description
Password Management
Minimum length
(characters)
Specify the number of characters a password must
contain. Possible value is 8 to 18.
Minimum changed
characters
Specify the number of characters that must be
different from the previous password. Possible value
is 1 to 4.
Minimum password
age (days)
Specify how frequently a password can be changed.
Possible value is 1 to 30.
Maximum password
age (days)
Specify at what age a password expires. Possible
value is 30 to 180.
Password warning
interval (days)
Specify when users start to see a warning about
their password expiration. Possible value is 1 to 7.
Reject previous
passwords
Specify how many of the user’s previous passwords
the system remembers and won’t permit to be
reused. Possible value is 8 to 16.
Password Complexity
Lowercase letters
Specify the number of lowercase letters (a-z) that a
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.
Uppercase letters
Numbers
Specify the number of uppercase letters (A-Z) that a
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.
Specify the number of digit characters (0-9) that a
password must contain. Possible value is 1 or 2.
Special characters
Specify the number of non-alphanumeric keyboard
characters that a password must contain. Possible
value is 1 or 2.
Maximum consecutive Specify how many sequential characters may be the
repeated characters
same. Possible value is 1 to 4.
3
Click Update.
Polycom, Inc.
459
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Add Machine Accounts
For dynamically managed endpoints associated with a room, a user assigned
the Administrator role must associate each room in the CMA system with a
machine account. The machine account allows the room’s endpoint to connect
and authenticate with the CMA system for directory and dynamic
management purposes without using the endpoint user’s account.
You can setup the room and machine account the following ways:
•
You can set up a machine account and create a new room at the same time,
then edit the room to complete the room information.
•
You can create a new room, then create the machine account and associate
the machine account with the existing room. For more informaiotn, see
In a maximum security environment, dynamically managed HDX systems
also require a machine account for each HDX that the CMA system will
manage. The machine account allows the endpoint to connect and authenticate
with the CMA system for dynamic management purposes without using the
endpoint user’s account.
The Add Machine Account dialog box includes the following information.
Field
Description
Enable Machine
Account
Select or clear this option to enable and disable
(respectively) the machine account you create for the
endpoint.
Unlock Machine
Account
Select this option to unlock machine accounts that
become locked when they exceed the Failed login
threshold. This will only happen when the password
expires.
User ID
Enter a unique name for the machine account.
As a best practice, name the machine account in a way
that associates it with the corresponding device. For
example, if your company names endpoint systems for
the system user or room (for example, bsmith_HDXor
Evergreen_Room), then give the machine account an
associated User ID (bsmith_HDX_machineor
evergreen_room_machine).
Password/
Confirm Password
Enter a password for the machine account user ID.
This password must meet the Local Password
Requirements. This password expires in 365 days.
460
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Management & Security Operations
Field
Description
Description
Enter a meaningful description for the endpoint.
Associate with an
existing user or room
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with
a specific user or room. This may be a local or
enterprise user or room.
Associate with a new
room (created
automatically)
Select this option to associate the endpoint system with
a system-generated room. The name of the new room is
the same as the machine account User Name and can
be edited when you edit the room.
Once you have created this machine account on the CMA system, provide this
information to the appropriate HDX system administrator. They should enter
this User ID and Password as the User Name and Password on the HDX
Provisioning Service page.
Note that the machine account password expires after one year. After the
expiration, the HDX login will fail. After three failed login attempts, the
system locks the machine account. You can reset the password and unlock the
machine account by editing it and assigning a new password.
To add a machine account
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Machine
Accounts.
2
3
4
Click Add.
In the Add Machine Account dialog box, complete the fields.
Click OK.
Change Internal Database Passwords
The CMA system uses three user names to access internal databases. You can
change the passwords for those user names to comply with any requirements
you may have to change passwords on a regular basis.
You also use the user listed as PlcmDbo if you should need to reformat your
The system will restart after you change these passwords. Make sure that you
use this function when no conferences are active or scheduled.
To change internal database passwords
1
Go to Admin > Management and Security Settings > Database Security.
Polycom, Inc.
461
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
2
3
4
Select the database user whose password you want to change.
Click Change Password.
In the Change Database User Password dialog, enter the new password
in the New Password and Confirm New Password fields.
If you want the system to generate a password, click Create Password. Be
sure to write down the password that displays.
5
6
Click OK.
Click Apply Password Changes.
The system resets the passwords and restarts. It may take the CMA system
up to 10 minutes to shut down and then restart all server processes.
462
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
36
Dial Plan Setup Operations
This chapter describes how to edit the default Polycom CMA system Dial Plan
settings to support your company’s site topology. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Site Operations
Site operations include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Polycom, Inc.
463
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
View the Graphical Site Topology
To view the graphical site topology
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site Topology.
The Site Topology page appears. It graphically displays the sites and site
links defined to the CMA system.
— Hover over a map element to view information about it.
— Use the slider bar to zoom in or out on the map.
— Select or deselect elements (Site Links, Bandwidth, or Site Names) to
change what is displayed on the map.
— Use the Select Sites drop-down list to filter (by site name, territory
name, IP address, network devices, and alerts) which sites are
displayed on the map.
View the Sites List
To view the Sites list
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites.
The Sites list appears. It includes this information:
Column
Description
Name
Name of the site.
Description of the site.
Description
Country Code
The country code for the country in which the site is
located.
Area Code
The city or area code for the site. Do not include a
leading zero. For example, the city code for Paris is
01; however, enter 1 in this field.
Max Bandwidth
(Mbps)
The total bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.
Max Bit Rate (Kbps)
Territory
The per-call bandwidth limit for audio and video calls.
The territory to which the site belongs, which
determines the CMA system responsible for it.
464
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Add a Site
To add a site
1
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and
Sites > Site Topology.
2
3
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, click Add Site.
In the Add Site dialog box, enter a Site Name and Description for the
site.
4
5
6
Complete the General Info, Routing, Subnet, and if applicable ISDN
Number Assignment, sections of the Add Site dialog box. The minimum
information required is Site Name, Description, Location, and Subnets.
Click OK.
The new site is added to the system and the Edit Site Provisioning dialog
box appears. These are the site-based parameters that the CMA system
automatically provisions to endpoint systems operating in dynamic
management mode.
As needed, edit the default site provisioning details and click Apply.
Note
Not all of the site provisioning parameters apply to all endpoint systems being
provisioned. If an endpoint system does not have a corresponding parameter, it
ignores the parameter.
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
Date and Time Settings
Country
Specify the country code for their location.
Date Format
Specify the date display format.
Auto Adjust for
Specify whether or not to adjust the endpoint’s system clock for daylight savings time.
Daylight Saving Time
Time Format
Specify the time display format.
Polycom, Inc.
465
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
Time Server
Specify whether to connect to a time server for automatic system time settings.
Select Auto to require that the video endpoint system synchronize with an external time
server that is identified by a network domain controller. Because it is identified by a
network domain controller, you do not need to enter the IP address of the time server.
Select Manual to require that the video endpoint system synchronize with an external
time server that may not be identified by a network domain controller. In this case, you
must also enter the IP address of the time server in the Time Server Address field.
If Time Server is set to Off, or if the Time Server is set to Manual or Auto but the
endpoint system cannot connect to the time server, the date and time must be manually
reset at the endpoint.
Primary Time Server
Address
Specify the address of the primary time server when Time Server is set to Manual.
Secondary Time
Server Address
Specify the address of the secondary time server when Time Server is set to Manual.
Timezone
Specify the time difference between GMT (Greenwich Mean Time) and the endpoint
system’s location.
Firewall Settings
Use Fixed Ports
Specify whether to define the TCP and UDP ports.
•
If the firewall is H.323 compatible or the endpoint systems are not behind a firewall,
disable this setting.
•
If the firewall is not H.323 compatible, enable this setting. The endpoint systems will
assign a range of ports starting with the TCP and UDP ports you specify. The endpoint
system defaults to a range beginning with port 3230 for both TCP and UDP.
Note
You must open the corresponding ports in the firewall. You must also open the firewall’s
TCP port 1720 to allow H.323 traffic.
Start TCP Port
Start UDP Port
Lets you specify the beginning value for the range of TCP ports used by the endpoint
systems. The endpoint systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting with the
port you specify.
Note
You must also open the firewall’s TCP port 1720 to allow H.323 traffic.
Lets you specify the beginning value for the range of TCP ports used by the endpoint
systems. The endpoint systems will automatically assign a range of ports starting with the
port you specify.
Enable H.460 Firewall
Traversal
Allows the endpoint system to use H.460-based firewall traversal. For more information,
see the Administrator’s Guide for Polycom HDX Systems.
466
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
NAT Configuration
Specify whether the endpoint systems should determine the NAT Public WAN Address
automatically.
•
•
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that allows HTTP traffic, select Auto.
If the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that does not allow HTTP traffic, select
Manual. Then specify a NAT Public (WAN) Address.
•
If the endpoint systems are not behind a NAT or are connected to the IP network
through a virtual private network (VPN), select Off.
NAT Public (WAN)
Address
When NAT Configuration is set to Manual, specify the address that callers from outside
the LAN should use to call the endpoint systems.
NAT is H.323
Compatible
Specify that the endpoint systems are behind a NAT that is capable of translating H.323
traffic.
Address Displayed in
Global Directory
Specify whether to include the endpoint system’s information in the global directory
•
•
Select Private to exclude the endpoint from the global directory
Select Public to include the endpoint in the global directory
H323 Settings
Enable IP H.323
Use Gatekeeper
Specify whether to enable IP H.323 calls.
When IP H.323 is enabled, Specify whether the endpoint systems will use the CMA
system as its gatekeeper or another gatekeeper. Gateways and gatekeepers are
required for calls between IP and ISDN.
•
•
This Server — The endpoint systems will use the CMA system as their gatekeeper.
Specify — The endpoint systems will use another system as their gatekeeper.
Gatekeeper IP
Address
When Use Gatekeeper is set to Specify, enter the gatekeeper IP address in this field.
Use Gatekeeper for
Multipoint Calls
Specify whether multipoint calls use the endpoint system’s internal multipoint capability or
the Polycom MCU’s Conference on Demand feature. This feature is available only if the
system is registered with a PathNavigator or CMA system gatekeeper.
SIP Settings
Enable SIP
Specify whether to enable SIP calls.
Automatically Discover
SIP Servers
The CMA system will issue a DNS query to locate the SIP server and provision that
information to endpoints.
Proxy Server
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP proxy server for the network.
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the SIP registrar server for the network.
Registrar Server
•
In an Microsoft Office Communications Server 2007 or Microsoft Lync Server 2010
environment, specify the IP address or DNS name of the Office Communications
Server or Lync Server server.
•
If registering a remote HDX system with an Office Communications Server Edge
Server or Lync Server Edge Server, use the fully qualified domain name of the access
edge server role.
Backup Proxy Server
Specify the IP address or DNS name of a backup SIP proxy server for the network.
Polycom, Inc.
467
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
Backup Registrar
Server
Specify the IP address or DNS name of a backup SIP registrar server for the network
Transport Protocol
Indicates the protocol the system uses for SIP signaling. The SIP network infrastructure
determines which protocol is required.
•
Auto enables an automatic negotiation of protocols in the following order: TLS, TCP,
UDP. This is the recommended setting for most environments.
•
•
•
TCP provides reliable transport via TCP for SIP signaling.
UDP provides best-effort transport via UDP for SIP signaling.
TLS provides secure communication of the SIP signaling. TLS is available only when
the system is registered with a SIP server that supports TLS. When you choose this
setting, the system ignores TCP/UDP port 5060..
SIP Server Type
Verify Certificate
Specify whether the SIP registrar server is a Microsoft Office Communications Server or
a Microsoft® Lync™ Server 2010. Enabling this setting activates integration features
such as the Microsoft global directory and Office Communicator contact sharing with
presence.
Enable this option when the endpoint system’s certificate should be verified by the
certificate authority.
Use Enterprise
Credentials
Enable this option when the endpoint system should use the credentials the user entered
at the endpoint to use for authenticate when registering with a SIP registrar server.
User Name
Specify the name to use for authentication when registering with a SIP registrar server,
and the password cannot be blank.
Password
Specify the password that authenticates the system to the registrar server.
Provisioning Settings
Provisioning Polling
Interval (minutes)
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for new
provisioning information.
By default, this interval is 60 minutes. For performance reasons, the minimum positive
value for this interval is 5 minutes. There is no maximum value enforced. When the value
of this interval is set to 0, the endpoint systems do not poll the CMA system for new
provisioning information.
Software Update
Polling Interval
(minutes)
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for a new
software update package.
By default, this interval is 60 minutes. For performance reasons, the minimum positive
value for this interval is 5 minutes. There is no maximum value enforced. When the value
of this interval is set to 0, the endpoint systems do not poll the CMA system for a new
software update package.
Quality of Service Settings
Video Type of Service
Value
Specify the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for video packets.
Audio Type of Service
Value
Specify the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for audio packets.
468
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
FECC Type of Service
Value
Specify the IP Precedence or Diffserv value for Far End Camera Control packets.
Type of Service Field
Specify the service type and the priority of IP packets sent to the system for video, audio,
and far-end camera control:
•
IP Precedence — Represents the priority of IP packets sent to the system. The value
can be between 0 and 5.
•
DiffServ — Represents a priority level between 0 and 63. If this setting is selected,
enter the value in the Type of Service Value field.
Maximum
Transmission Unit Size
(bytes)
Specify the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) size used in IP calls. If the video
becomes blocky or network errors occur, packets may be too large; decrease the MTU. If
the network is burdened with unnecessary overhead, packets may be too small; increase
the MTU.
Enable PVEC
Enable RSVP
Allows the endpoint system to use PVEC (Polycom Video Error Concealment) if packet
loss occurs. PVEC delivers smooth, clear video over IP networks by concealing the
deteriorating effects of packet loss
Allows the endpoint system to use Resource Reservation Setup Protocol (RSVP) to
request that routers reserve bandwidth along an IP connection path. Both the near site
and far site must support RSVP in order for reservation requests to be made to routers
on the connection path.
Enable Dynamic
Bandwidth
Specify whether to let the endpoint system automatically find the optimum line speed for
a call.
Maximum Transmit
Bandwidth (Kbps)
Specify the maximum transmission line speed.
Maximum Receive
Bandwidth (Kbps)
Specify the maximum reception line speed.
Security Settings
Security Profile
Read-only field. Displays the security level of the CMA system.
Use Room Password
for Remote Access
Specify whether the local endpoint system password and remote access password are
the same.
Room Password
Enter or change the local endpoint system password here.
When the local password is set, you must enter it to configure the system Admin Settings
using the remote control. The local password must not contain spaces.
Administrator ID
Enter the administrative account that should be used to access the endpoint system
remotely.
Remote Access
Password
For endpoint systems, enter or change the remote access password here.
When the remote access password is set, you must enter it to upgrade the software or
manage the endpoint systems from a computer. The remote access password cannot
include spaces.
Polycom, Inc.
469
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
Meeting Password
Specify the password users must supply to join multipoint calls on this endpoint system if
the call uses the internal multipoint option, rather than a bridge.
This field can also be used to store a password required by another endpoint system that
this system calls. If a password is stored in this field, you do not need to enter it at the
time of the call; the endpoint system supplies it to the system that requires it. The
meeting password cannot include spaces.
Enable Secure Mode
Specify whether to operate in secure mode (also known as security mode), which uses
TLS, HTTPS, AES, digital signatures, and other security protocols, algorithms, and
mechanisms. These protocols encrypt management communication over IP, preventing
access by unauthorized users.
When devices at a site are provisioned to operate in secure mode, the CMA system can
only perform the dynamic management operations of automatic provisioning, automatic
software update, and directory and presence services for the devices. The CMA system
cannot perform monitoring or control operations for the devices.
For more information, see the Administrator’s Guide for Polycom HDX Systems.
AES Encryption
Specify how to encrypt calls with other sites that support AES encryption.
•
•
Off—No encryption is used.
When Available—AES Encryption is used with any endpoint that supports it, even if
the other endpoints in the call don’t support it.
•
•
Required for Video Calls Only—AES Encryption is used for all video endpoints in
the call. Analog phone and voice over ISDN connections are allowed. Video
endpoints must support AES Encryption to participate in the call.
Required for All Calls—AES Encryption is used for all video endpoints in the call.
Analog phone and voice over ISDN connections are not allowed. All endpoints must.
support AES Encryption to participate in the call.
Enable Web Access
Enable Telnet Access
Enable SNMP Access
Specify whether to allow remote access to the endpoint system by the web.
Note
The endpoint systems will restart if the remote access settings are changed. This setting
does not deactivate the associated port, only the application. Use the Web Access Port
setting to disable the port.
Specify whether to allow remote access to the system by Telnet.
Note
The endpoint systems will restart if the remote access settings are changed. This setting
does not deactivate the associated port, only the application. Use the Web Access Port
setting to disable the port.
Specify whether to allow remote access to the system by SNMP.
Note
The endpoint systems will restart if the remote access settings are changed. This setting
does not deactivate the associated port, only the application. Use the Web Access Port
setting to disable the port.
470
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
Web Access Port
Specify the port to use when accessing the endpoint system’s web interface.
If you change this from the default (port 80), specify a port number of 1025 or higher, and
make sure the port is not already in use. You will need to include the port number with the
IP address when you use the Polycom HDX web interface to access the system. This
makes unauthorized access more difficult.
Note
The system restarts if you change the web access port.
Allow Video Display On
Web
Specify whether to allow viewing of the room where the endpoint system is located, or
video of calls in which the endpoint system participates, using the endpoint system’s web
interface.
Note
This feature activates both near site and far site video displays in Web Director.
NTLM Version
Specify the NTLM version the endpoint system should use to authenticate.
Security Settings 2
Idle Session Timeout in
Minues
When sessions are enabled, Specify the number of minutes your system can be idle
before the session times out.
Lock Port after Failed
Logins
Specify the number of failed login attempts allowed before the system locks the account.
If set to Off, the system will not lock the user account due to failed login attempts.
This selection controls local and web interface login attempts. For example, if you select
3 here, a user who fails to log in properly twice on the web interface and twice on the
local interface is locked out on the fourth attempt.
Failed Login Window in
Hours
Specify the amount of time that the account remains locked due to failed login attempts.
Specify the amount of time that the port remains locked due to failed login attempts.
Specify how many links a certificate chain can have. The term peer certificate refers to
Port Lock Duration in
Minutes
Maximum Peer
Certificate Chain Depth any certificate sent by the far-end host to the HDX system when a network connection is
being established between the two systems.
Verify Certificates for
all Web Access
Specify whether the endpoint requires certificate validation to acces the endpoint.
Whitelist
Enable Whitelist of IPs
When a whitelist is enabled, allows access to an endpoint’s web interface only by those
systems with an IP address that matches a pattern using regular expression notation.
Polycom, Inc.
471
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
For the endpoint systems at the site being provisioned...
Enter all IPs allowed to
Connect via the web
Specify (by IP addresses using regular expression notation) which systems can access
an endpoint’s web interface. Addresses are matched by pattern, which means that you
could allows IP address that you did not mean to allow. For example, if you entered an IP
address of 15.1.2.111, all of the following results would match:
•
•
•
15.1.2.111
15.182.1.11
15.1.252.111
If you want to allow a range of IP addresses, use the * wildcard instead. For example,
enter 10.11.*.* to allow all IP addresses that begin with 10.11.
General Settings
Heartbeat Posting
Interval (minutes)
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for a
heartbeat.
In Call Stats Posting
Interval (minutes)
Specify the frequency at which the endpoint systems poll the CMA system for in call
statistics.
Calendaring Settings
Automatically Discover
Exchange Server
Specify that the CMA system should discover the Microsoft Exchange server for the site
by searching DNS records.
Specify Exchange
Server
Specify that the CMA system should use the Microsoft Exchange server specified in the
Exchange Server Address field.
Exchange Server
Address
Specify the IP address or DNS name of the Microsoft Exchange server for the site.
LDAP Settings
Group Display Name
Specify whether the CMA system should identify groups by their common name (cn) or
their DisplayName. These names are extracted from the Active Directory.
User Display Name
Specify whether the CMA system should identify users by their common name (cn) or
their DisplayName. These names are extracted from the Active Directory.
Enterprise Directory
Admin Group
Specify the Active Directory group whose members should have access to the Admin
settings on the HDX system. This name must exactly match the name in the Active
Directory server for authentication to succeed.
Enterprise Directory
User Group
Specify the Active Directory group whose members should have access to the User
settings on the HDX system. This name must exactly match the name in the Active
Directory server for authentication to succeed.
472
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
View Site Information
To view information about an existing site
1
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and
Sites > Site Topology.
2
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click
Site Information.
The Site Information dialog box displays the following site information.
Column
Name
Description
Name of the site.
Description of the site.
Description
Location
The specified location of the site identified either by
longitude + latitude or by country + city.
Bandwidth (Mbps)
Bandwidth Used
Device Types
The specified total bandwidth limit for audio and
video calls.
Identifies the percentage of the maximum bandwidth
currently occupied with audio and video calls.
Identifies the type (Bridges, DMAs, VBPs, and
Endpoints) and number of devices assigned to the
site.
Alarms
Identifies the device alarms present within the site.
Alarm information includes Status, Device Name,
Device Type, and Description. Click Details to view
more device details.
Subnets
Identifies the subnets within the site. Subnets
information includes Bandwidth Used, Subnet
(name), and (maximum) Bandwidth.
Assign Locations to a Site
Location has not always been a required field for sites. If your existing sites do
not include location information, use the Assign Locations action to update
your sites.
To assign a location to an existing site
1
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and
Sites > Site Topology.
2
Click Assign Locations.
Polycom, Inc.
473
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
4
In the Assign Locations to Sites dialog box, select the site of interest and
click Specify Location.
To specify a location by city name:
a
b
c
From the Enter Location By drop-down list, select Search for City.
If you know it, select the Country name for the location.
Enter the name of the City and click Search.
The system returns the list of cities that match your entry.
d
Select the appropriate city using the Country, Division, and
Subdivision fields to identify it and click Select.
5
To specify a location by latitude and longitude in decimal degrees format:
a
b
c
From the Enter Location By drop-down list, select
Latitude/Longitude (Decimal format).
Enter the Latitude and Longitude coordinates in decimal degrees (for
example, Baltimore has a latitude of 39.3° and a longitude of 76.6°).
Enter a Location Name. The system uses this location name for
reference only; it does not validated the location name against the
latitude and longitude coordinates that you enter.
d
Select the Country name for the location and click Select.
The system uses the coordinates you input to place the site in the
proper location on its site topology map.
6
To specify a location by latitude and longitude in DaysMinutesSeconds
format:
a
b
c
From the Enter Location By drop-down list, select
Latitude/Longitude (DDD:MM:SS format).
Enter the Latitude and Longitude coordinates in the required format
and select
Enter a Location Name. The system uses this location name for
reference only; it does not validated the location name against the
latitude and longitude coordinates that you enter.
d
Select the Country name for the location and click Select.
The system uses the coordinates you input to place the site in the
proper location on its site topology map.
474
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Edit Site Settings
Note
Changing network topology may affect the accuracy of reports based on this
information. To retain historical data for the current network topology, generate
reports before making changes.
To edit settings for a site
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and
Sites > Site Topology.
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click
Edit Site.
Edit the General Info, Site Routing, Site Subnet, and if applicable ISDN
Number Assignment, sections of the Edit Site dialog box. For
4
Click OK.
Edit Site Provisioning Settings
To edit the site provisioning settings for a site
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and
Sites > Site Topology.
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click
Edit Site Provisioning Details.
As needed, edit the site provisioning details and click Apply. For
4
Click OK.
Polycom, Inc.
475
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Delete a Site
Note
Devices that belonged to a deleted site are automatically reassigned to support
Internet and VPN calls.
To delete a site
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Sites or Admin > Dial Plan and
Sites > Site Topology.
In the Sites list or Site Topology page, select the site of interest and click
Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Set Up SIP
The CMA system supports SIP to establish conference connections. If you
want to use SIP, you must enable it and configure SIP settings. You must also
upload SIP URI data.
To implement SIP, complete the following tasks
1
Configure the SIP settings for each site.
When you add a site to the CMA system, you also set up site provisioning,
which includes the SIP settings. Be sure to enable SIP and configure the
servers, protocol, and credentials needed for your SIP sever. See “Add a
2
Import SIP URI data.
After you enable and configure SIP, you must import your endpoint SIP
data from your SIP server. The import provides the CMA system with all
of the URI data it needs to use SIP.
Note
If you are using Microsoft as your SIP server, you do not need to import SIP URI
data. The CMA system can retrieve the SIP URI from the enterprise directory.
476
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
a
Create a CSV file in the format described here. The import requires a
CSV file in the following format:
domain,username,deviceType,URI
where:
»
domain—Specifies the domain the user uses to log in to the CMA
system.
»
»
username—Specifies the CMA system user name.
deviceType—Specifies the device type (valid values are HDX,
VVX, and CMADesktop).
»
URI—Specifies the SIP URI for this user.
For example:
local,johndoe,HDX,[email protected]
From the CMA system, go to Admin > Uploads.
Click Upload.
b
c
d
Navigate to the CSV file, select it, and click Open.
Whenever you add new users or rooms or need change a SIP URI, you
must provide SIP URI data. For the methods available for editing the SIP
Edit SIP URI Data
You can edit SIP URI data in the following ways:
•
Upload a CSV file that has changes or new data.
— Data in the CSV file is added to any existing data.
— For information about the CSV file format and the upload process, see
•
Edit individual users or rooms.
— For each CMA system user or room, you can add or edit the SIP URI
in the Dial String Reservations section of the Edit User or Edit Room
dialog box.
Polycom, Inc.
477
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Site Link Operations
When you add a site link, you enter the starting and ending sites of the link
and the maximum bandwidth and bit rates available for calls (audio and
video) that use the link. Links are bidirectional. After you have created a link
from Site A to Site B, you automatically have a bi-directional link from Site B
to Site A, although the link appears as unidirectional.
Note
The bit rate can be set at the network level, the device level, and the conference
level. If there is a discrepancy between these bit rate settings, the system
implements the lowest bit rate setting. The only exception, is that the bit rate in the
RMX profile takes precedence over the bit rate in the conference settings.
Field
Description
Name
Name (ASCII only) of the inter-site link.
Description (ASCII only of the inter-site link.
Description
From Site
Identifies the first site to be linked. The drop-down list
includes all defined sites and the Internet.
To Site
Identifies the other site to be linked. The drop-down list
includes all defined sites and an Internet/VPN option.
Total Bandwidth (kbps)
The maximum available bandwidth for audio and video
calls, which you set at the gateway or router.
Call Max Bit Rate (kbps) The maximum bit rate allowed for an audio and video
call.
Site-link operations include:
•
•
•
•
478
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
View the Site Links List
To view the Site Links list
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.
The Site-Links list appears.
Column
Description
Name
Name of the link
Description
From Site
To Site
Description of the link
First site reached in the call route
Final site reached through this call link
Max Bandwidth
The maximum available bandwidth for audio and video
calls, which you set at the gateway or router. Only applies
to direct links.
Max Bit Rate
(kbps)
The maximum bit rate allowed for an audio and video call.
Only applies to direct links.
Add a Site Link
Before you can create a site link, you must add two or more sites to the system.
To add a site link
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.
In the Site-Links page, click Add.
In the Add Site-Link dialog box, enter a Name and Description for the
link and select the starting (From Site) and ending (To Site) sites.
4
Enter the Bandwidth and Max Bit Rate and click Save.
The new link appears on the Site Links page.
Edit a Site Link
You may need to edit site links when network changes are made.
If you make a bandwidth change, the current load is not affected; however, the
bandwidth available for future conferences may be affected.
Polycom, Inc.
479
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To edit a site link
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.
In the Site-Links list, select the link of interest and click Edit.
In the Edit Site-Link dialog box, edit the Name, Description, Bandwidth
or Max Bit Rate.
4
Click Save.
Delete a Site Link
You can remove site links from the Polycom CMA system.
Note
Avoid removing a link on which a scheduled conference depends.
To delete a site link
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-Links.
In the Site-Links list, select the site link of interest and click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Site-to-Site Exclusions
Create site-to-site exclusions to explicitly deny connection between two sites
for audio or video calls.
Site-link exclusion operations include:
•
•
•
•
View the Site-to-Site Exclusion List
To view the Site-to-Site exclusion list
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-to-Site Exclusion.
The Site-to-Site Exclusions list appears.
480
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Add a Site-to-Site Exclusion
Before you can create a site link exclusion, you must add two or more sites to
the system.
Exclusions are by definition bilateral. No call traffic is allowed to flow across
the site-link in either direction.
To add a site-to-site exclusion
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Site-to-Site Exclusions.
In the Site-to-Site Exclusions page, click Add.
In the Add Site-to-Site Exclusions wizard:
a
Select the first site of the From/To site pair (by clicking the appropriate
button). If needed, use the Search Site field to find the site.
b
Select the second site of the From/To site pair (by enabling the
appropriate check box) and click Continue. You can select more than
one site, if needed.
c
Review the site-to-site exclusion and if it is correct, click Save
Exclusion.
Edit a Site-to-Site Exclusion
You cannot edit a site-to-site exclusion; you can only delete it and then re-add
it.
Delete a Site-to-Site Exclusion
To delete a site-to-site exclusion
1
2
Go to Dial Plan and Sites > Site-to-Site Exclusions.
In the Site-to-Site Exclusions page, select the exclusion of interest and
click Delete.
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Polycom, Inc.
481
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Territories
A territory is a set of one or more sites for which a CMA system is responsible.
By default, there is one territory named Default CMA Territory, and its
primary node (the CMA system responsible for it) is set to this system. For
Territory operations include:
•
•
•
•
View the Territory List
To view the Territories list
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.
The Territories list appears.
Add a Territory
To add a territory
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.
In the Territories page, click Add.
Complete the Territory Info and Associated Sites sections of the Add
4
Click OK.
Edit a Territory
To edit a territory
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.
In the Territories page, select the territory of interest and click Edit.
482
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
3
4
Change the Territory Info and Associated Sites information of the Add
Territories dialog box as needed. For information about these fields, see
Click OK.
Delete a Territory
To delete a territory
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.
In the Territories page, select the territory of interest and click Delete.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Network Clouds
To simplify the network topology, define network clouds to represents a hub
with many sites connected to each other such as a private network or VPN.
Network cloud operations include:
•
•
•
•
View the List of Network Clouds
To view the Territories list
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Territories.
The Territories list appears.
Add a Network Cloud
To add a network cloud
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Network Clouds.
In the Network Clouds page, click Add.
Polycom, Inc.
483
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
4
In the Cloud Info section of the Add Network Cloud dialog box, enter a
unique and meaningful Name and Description for the cloud.
To create a link between a site and the network cloud:
a
b
Click Linked Sites.
In the Search Sites field, enter all or part of the site name or location
and click Find.
The list of sites containing the search phrase appear in the Search
Results column.
c
Select one or more sites to link with the network cloud and then click
the right arrow to move them to the Selected Sites column.
5
Click OK.
Edit a Network Cloud
To edit a network cloud
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Network Clouds.
In the Network Clouds page, select the network cloud of interest and
click Edit.
3
Edit the Cloud Info or to create a link between a site and the network
cloud:
a
b
Click Linked Sites.
In the Search Sites field, enter all or part of the site name or location
and click Find.
The list of sites containing the search phrase appear in the Search
Results column.
c
Select one or more sites to link with the network cloud and then click
the right arrow to move them to the Selected Sites column.
4
Click OK.
Delete a Network Cloud
To delete a network cloud
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > Network Clouds.
In the Network Clouds page, select the network cloud of interest and
click Delete.
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
484
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Dial Plan Service Operations
Dial plan services are special features that video endpoint system users can
invoke by dialing the prefix assigned in the CMA system to that service.
The CMA system has two default dial plan services:
•
•
These services can be edited and disabled, but not deleted.
You can also add other gateway or If a service does not appear automatically
when a device registers with the CMA system, you can define the service
manually so that it is available for video endpoint system users. In addition,
you can add services for certain third-party MCU services.
Conference on Demand
With Conference on Demand, video endpoint system users can start an
unscheduled multipoint conference from their endpoint rather than
requesting this service from an administrator.
The initiating endpoint uses the capabilities made available through the MCU.
When Conference on Demand is enabled on the endpoint, the CMA system
sends the call directly to the MCU.
Note
Conference on Demand is only available on Polycom RMX and MGC MCUs. It is
not available on Polycom RMX 1000 MCUs.
The following table provides details on how the Conference on Demand
service is configured.
Field
Description
General Info
Service Type
Enable
Conference on Demand (read only)
Indicates whether or not the service is enabled
Available for New Groups
Indicates whether or not the service is available for
new user groups
Description
Description (ASCII only) of the service. By default for
this service, Conference on Demand
Service Prefix
The prefix (ASCII only) for the service. By default for
this service: con
Polycom, Inc.
485
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Conference on Demand—MCU Properties
Login ID User login (ASCII only) for the MCU hosting the
Description
conference. This user account must be authorized to
create new conferences.
Password
Password (ASCII only) for the user login. Each time
you modify the password for the MCU, you must also
modify it in this page.
H.323 Network Service
The corresponding service created on the MCU to
implement this CMA system service. Set on the MCU
(ASCII only).
Default Conference Properties
MGC: Video Session Indicates what users see. Set to Continuous
Presence for this service.
Notes
•
MGC only. For RMX MCUs, the profile determines
this setting.
•
Select Transcoding to support IP and ISDN calls.
MGC: Bit rate (Kbps)
Default bit rate for calls.
Notes
•
MGC only. The RMX MCU bit rate is dictated by
the RMX profile.
•
The video endpoint system that starts the
Conference on Demand call may use a higher or
lower bit rate than is specified in this page.
RMX: Profile Name
The name of the RMX profile that has the conference
settings for the conference.
Simplified Dialing
Simplified dialing is a service that allows video endpoint system users to
access gateway services by dialing 9, and then the phone number or other
dialing string. Simplified dialing is enabled by default.
To use simplified dialing, the following settings are also required:
•
Sites must specify the country code, city and area code, and number of
digits in the subscriber line.
•
The gateway must be registered with the CMA system and display in the
List of Devices page.
•
•
Gateway services must be defined.
The LCR table must be defined.
486
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Field
Description
Service Type
Enable
Name of the service (read only)
Indicates whether this service is enabled
The service is available for new user groups
Description of the service
Available for New Groups
Description
Service Prefix
The prefix for this service: 9.
Gateway Service
These services are provided by a gateway to endpoints. For example, gateways
usually have distinct services for each speed they support (128 Kbps, 384 Kbps,
512 Kbps, and so on) and a service for audio-only calls.
Gateway services tell the CMA system how to route the call during conversion
between IP and ISDN.
Note
Gateway and MCU services must be defined in both the CMA system and the MCU
platform. They must be defined exactly the same in both locations. If you enter this
information manually, be sure to type it exactly as it is entered in the MGC or RMX
system.
You can simplify entry of services by making sure that the MCUs and gateways on
your video conferencing network are set to register with the gatekeeper in the CMA
system. This setting assures the information appears automatically in the List of
Services page.
You must define a gateway service for each bit rate available. These services
should appear automatically in the list when the gateway registers with the
CMA system. If gateway services do not appear, you can enter them manually.
If the List of Services page does not include gateway services, alternate
routing and least-cost routing are disabled. For details, see the following table.
Field
Description
Service Type
Enable
Type of service
Indicates whether this service is enabled
The service is available to new user groups
Description of the service
The prefix for this service.
Available for New Groups
Description
Service Prefix
Must be a registered E.164 alias for the corresponding
gateway in the Devices page for Directory Setup.
Polycom, Inc.
487
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Field
Description
For use in simplified dialing
Device Capability
Specify the type of connection the device can handle.
Select all that apply. Options are:
•
H.320. Supports video and voice using the ITU
H.320 standard.
•
•
Voice. Supports voice over the PSTN network.
Other. Supports a protocol other than H.320 or
voice, such as H.321 or video over ATM.
Bit Rate (Kbps)
The maximum rate at which the calls can connect.
Note
If you select Unknown, this service cannot support
simplified dialing.
Insert between prefix and
first number
Specify the character to insert in the dial string
between the prefix and the first number.
For example, if you specify * as the character, the
sequence the user enters would be:
77*2125551212
Insert between phone
number
Specify the character to insert in the dial string
between phone numbers.
For example, if you specify # as the character to
separate numbers, the sequence the user enters
would be:
77*5551212#5651213
Append after full dial
string
Specify the character to append after the full dial
string.
To process the call, certain gateways require a symbol
be appended after the final dialing number.
For example, if you specify ** as the characters to
append after the final dialing number, the sequence
the user enters would be:
77*5551212#5651213#2223232**
Warning: The CMA system does not recognize dial
strings that require termination after the ISDN number
and have an extension after the terminated ISDN.
For example, the CMA system does not recognize the
following dial string:
165024710000**3452
488
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
MCU Service
These services allow devices to use specific MCU features and settings when
making a call. For example, an MCU can define a service for a multipoint video
call with continuous presence at 384 Kbps and another service for video
switching at 256 Kbps.
MCU services and their associated prefixes are defined at the MCU. For MGC
or RMX MCUs, the MCU services should appear automatically in the List of
Services page when the MCU registers with the CMA system. Because
third-party MCUs may not automatically register, you must enter them
manually in the CMA system.
Use MCU services to dial the IP gateway segment that translates between IP
and ISDN, in conference calls with two or more participants, or continuous
presence.
Field Name
Description
Service Type
Enable
Type of service.
Indicates whether this service is enabled or not.
The service is available for new user groups.
Available for New Groups
Description
Description of the service. To identify it easily in the
List of Services page, include the prefix and the
MCU feature (for example, 384 K video switching).
Service Prefix
The prefix for this service, which must be a E.164
alias that is registered for the MCU on the Device
page.
Services operations include:
•
•
•
•
Polycom, Inc.
489
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
View the Services List
This page shows the services that have been defined in your dial plan. These
services are available when you place unscheduled calls.
Note
E.164 aliases appear in this list as follows:
•
•
For MGC and RMX devices, they appear as gateway services.
For a device’s H.323 services, they (including the alias prefix) appear as MCU
services. Gateway service prefixes are the E.164 aliases of the MCU’s gateway
session profiles.
To view the Services list
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.
The Services list appears.
Column
Prefix
Description
Prefix of the service.
Type
The type of service. Available types include System,
Gateway, and MCU.
Description
Enabled
Description of the service.
Tip: When completed automatically, the description
reflects the value entered in the MGC or RMX
manager.
By default, services are enabled. To disable them,
clear the Enabled check box.
Add a Service
If a gateway or MCU service does not appear automatically when the device
registers with the CMA system, you can define the service manually so that it
is available for use in unscheduled calls. In addition, you can add services for
certain third-party MCU services.
To add a service
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.
In the Services list, click Add Service.
Complete the General Info, and if applicable Simplified Dialing or
Conference on Demand, sections of the Add Service dialog box.
490
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
4
Click OK.
The new service is added to the system.
Edit a Service
You can make changes to a service.
Note
Be sure that the information you enter in the CMA system matches the information
entered in the MCU.
To edit a service
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.
In the Services list, select the service of interest and click Edit Service.
As required, edit the General Info, and if applicable Simplified Dialing
or Conference on Demand, sections of the Edit Service dialog box.
4
Click OK.
Delete a Service
You can delete a gateway or MCU service from the CMA system. You cannot
delete the Conference on Demand or Simplified Dialing service.
To delete a service
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Services.
In the Services list, select the service of interest and click Delete Service.
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
Notes
•
The system returns an error message if you attempt to delete any services that
were added automatically when the MCU registered with the CMA system. To
avoid this, first unregister and then delete the MCU.
•
MCU services added manually from the Services page are not affected by this
error.
Polycom, Inc.
491
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Dial Rule Operations
Dial rules describe how the CMA system gatekeeper should resolve addresses
in an incoming dial string to route a call. This dial string may include an IP
address, a string of numbers that begin with a prefix associated with a service,
a string that begins with a country code and city code, or a string that matches
a particular alias for a device.
Dial strings may match multiple dial rules. However, you can assign a priority
to each dial rule. When the CMA system gatekeeper receives a call request and
associated dial string, it reviews the dial rules in order of priority. The first
matched (highest priority) dial rule is executed.
Field
Description
General Info
Name
Name (ASCII only) of the dial rule.
Description
Description (ASCII only) of the dial rule, which can be
up to 256 characters long.
Priority
Priority number of the dial rule, which determines which
rule the CMA system uses first. The smaller the number
the higher the priority.
More than one dial rule may have the same priority. In
that case, rules with the same priority are applied in
random order.
Enabled
Select the check box to enable the rule.
Pattern Type
Specify the type of pattern to be matched. Available
patterns include:
•
•
•
•
•
Local Directory Services
DNS Name
IP Address
Prefix
Prefix Range
Applicable Site
Site to which this pattern applies. You can select a
specific site or all sites.
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is
Local Directory Services.
Routing Action > Dial String Manipulation
IP Address Pattern Data Specify the criteria (ASCII only) to use to match the
pattern type and additional changes to make when
routing the call.
This field is available when the Pattern Type is DNS
Name, IP Address, or Prefix.
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is
Local Directory Services or Prefix Range.
492
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Field
Description
Start Value
The starting number to use as a prefix, which displays
only for rules with the Prefix Range pattern type.
End Value
The ending number to use as a prefix, which displays
only for rules with the Prefix Range pattern type
# Characters to remove
Number of digits to remove (from the start or from the
end) of the dialed string
This field is available when the Pattern Type is Local
Directory Services, Prefix, and Prefix Range.
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is DNS
Name or IP Address.
Prefix to add
Prefix to add to the dialed string
This field is available when the Pattern Type is Local
Directory Services, Prefix, and Prefix Range.
This field is not available when the Pattern Type is DNS
Name or IP Address.
Routing Action > Action to perform
Action
Specify what action to take for calls that match the
pattern type and criteria.
Action to perform when the pattern is matched.
Depending on the Pattern Type, options may include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Route
Block
Route within region
Route out of region
Route to a gateway with LCR applied
Route to a gateway service
Route to a list of gateway services
Route to a trusted neighbor
Trusted Neighbors
Available Region
When the action is Route to a trusted neighbor, select
the region to which you want to route.
Gateway Services
Selected Gateway
When the action is Route to a gateway service, this
Services (prioritized)
field lists the selected gateway services.
You can define multiple gateway services for a rule. The
first in the list is the default gateway service. Others are
used in priority order when the primary gateway service
is not available.
Polycom, Inc.
493
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Default Dial Rules
The CMA system has three default dial rules. With these defaults, the system
can route most calls except those requiring an external DNS lookup.
•
•
•
Internal IP - This dial rule allows the system to identify the incoming dial
string as an IP addresses and routes the call out of the region. By default,
this dial rule applies to all sites.
Alias - This dial rule allows the system to identify the incoming dial string
as belonging to the local directory and routes the call to the local device or
service, as required.
DNS Name - This dial rule allows the system to identify the incoming dial
string as a DNS name and block the call.
Note
Do not delete the default dial rules or the CMA system will not be able to route calls
correctly. You can disable a dial rule by editing it and clearing the Enabled check
box for the rule.
Parts of a Dial Rule
A dial rule consists of a pattern type paired with a routing action. When the
dialed string uses a pattern that matches the pattern type, the associated rule
is applied.
Pattern Types
A pattern type tells the CMA system how to find a match for the dial string.
The following table shows the available pattern types.
Pattern Type
Description
Local Directory
Services
Search the List of Devices and List of Services.
Includes aliases, which are searched before the service
prefix.
DNS Name
IP Address
Prefix
Look up a DNS Name
Look for an IP addresses in the IPV4 format
Look for a prefix specified in the dial rule
Prefix Range
Look for a prefix within the range of prefixes specified in
the dial rule
494
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Routing Actions
A routing action informs the CMA system what to do based on the dial rule’s
associated pattern type. The following table shows the available routing
actions.
Routing
Action
Pattern
Type
Description
Route
Block
All
Allow the call to pass
Block the call
All
Route within
region
IP Address
Route to any IP address inside the region
Route out of
region
IP Address
Route to any IP address outside the region
Note
The originating site’s Internet access rules still
apply.
Route to a
gateway with
LCR
Prefix and
Prefix
Range
Remove the prefix specified in the dial rule and
route the remaining dial string to a gateway
service, which has the specified LCR table
Route to a
gateway
service
Prefix and
Prefix
Range
Remove the prefix specified in the dial rule and
route the remaining dial string to the specified
gateway service
Route to a list
of gateway
services
Prefix and
Prefix
Range
Modify the dial string specified in the dial rule and
route the remaining dial string to the specified
gateway service.
Route to a
trusted
neighbor
Prefix and
Prefix
Range
Modify the dial string as specified in the dial rule
and ask the specified neighboring gatekeeper to
route the modified dial string. If the neighboring
gatekeeper agrees, route the call.
Note
The neighboring gatekeeper must be configured
as a region in the CMA system.
Examples of Custom Dial Rules
You use custom dial rules to perform these tasks:
•
Block calls. For example, you can block all calls to 900 numbers, which
usually charge a per-minute fee. Create a dial rule with these settings:
— Pattern type: Prefix
— Prefix to match: 900
— Routing action: Block
Polycom, Inc.
495
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
Route to a neighboring gatekeeper. If you have entered information
about neighboring gatekeepers in the List of Regions page, you can create
a rule to route calls to another gatekeeper. Create a dial rule with these
settings:
— Pattern type: Prefix Range
— Prefixes to match: Specify the range.
— Routing action: Select Route to a trusted neighbor and the region for
the neighboring gatekeeper to which you want to route calls.
•
IP-specific routing. You can specify which calls may connect, according to
the IP address. For example, you could allow calls from San Jose to
Atlanta, but not from San Jose to Pleasanton.
Dial Rule operations include:
•
•
•
•
View the Dial Rules List
To view the Dial Rules list
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.
The Dial Rules list appears.
Column
Name
Description
The name of the dial rule
Pattern Type
The pattern type in use for this rule. Options are:
•
•
•
•
•
Local Directory Services
DNS Name
IP Address
Prefix
Prefix Range
Pattern Data
Additional criteria that must be met to apply this rule
496
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Column
Description
The routing action used by this rule. Options are:
Routing Action
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Route
Block
Route within region
Route out of region
Route to a GW with LCR applied
Route to a GW service
Route to a list of GW services
Route to a trusted neighbor
Note
Not all actions are available for all pattern types.
Site
The sites for which this rule is used. May be all sites or a
specific site
Priority
The priority assigned this rule
Enabled
Indicates whether or not the dial rule is enabled
Add a Dial Rule
To add a dial rule
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.
In the Dial Rules list, click Add Dialing Rule.
Complete the General Info, Routing Action, Trusted Neighbors, and
Gateway Services sections of the Add Dialing Rule dialog box.
4
Click OK.
The new dial rule is added to the system.
Enable or Disable Dialing Rules
You can enable or disable dial rules.
Note
Use caution when changing the default dial rules, which enable basic operations in
the CMA system.
Polycom, Inc.
497
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
To enable or disable a dialing rule
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.
In the Dial Rules list, select the dial rule of interest and click Edit Dialing
Rule.
3
4
On the Dial Rules - General Information page, check or clear the
Enabled check box.
Click OK.
Edit a Dial Rule
To edit a dial rule
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > Dial Rules.
In the Dial Rules list, select the dial rule of interest and click Edit Dial
Rule.
3
4
In the Edit Dial Rule dialog box, make the required changes.
When you are finished, click OK.
Least-Cost Routing Operations
Least-cost routing (LCR) allows the CMA system to route ISDN or POTS calls
made on paths that incur the lowest expense. You can route calls from one site
through a gateway in another site by referencing LCR tables.
Least-cost routing is useful when sites already have a high-bandwidth
connection between them.
Least-cost routing works with the CMA system’s other routing features.
Setting up least-cost routing requires you to:
•
•
•
Determine the LCR information to enter in the CMA system.
Create LCR tables.
In the device record for MCUs:
— Define an H.320 service and select the LCR table to use.
— Define a gateway service and select the H.320 service associated with
the LCR table.
Note
Make sure the LCR tables you define match the network setup.
498
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
You cannot use least-cost routing when:
•
•
•
The route cannot be identified.
The required resources are unavailable.
Bandwidth limitations exist on the WAN.
How Least-Cost Routing Works
Each LCR table defines dial strings, which include the country code, area code,
prefix, and a weighted cost for commonly made calls. You usually create one
LCR table per site.
The following table is an example of an LCR table.
Country Code
Area Code
408
Prefix
Weighted Cost
1
1
1
1
565
0
0
0
5
408
650
415
The CMA system compares the dial string for a call to the dial strings in LCR
tables. The dial string can match at the country code, area code, or prefix level.
The CMA system reads the “# of digits to strip” field to determine how many
digits to remove.
Note
For areas of the United States that do not require you dial an access code before
the area code, exclude this number when you define the number of digits to strip.
Before determining the final call routing, the CMA system considers cost
(through LCR tables), bandwidth resources (through site topology and device
group policies), and gateway availability.
Example of Least-Cost Routing
Company ABC has three sites: Site A in San Jose, CA, Site B in Monterey, CA,
and Site C in Washington, D.C. All sites have gateways.
LCR Tables for Three Sites
The LCR tables included area codes that are used frequently in each site and
considered that calls are made frequently from Site C to Southern California.
Polycom, Inc.
499
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
The following table lists area codes for the San Francisco Bay Area and
Southern California. The prefix 755 for the 408 area code applies for all
numbers in Site A.
Area Code
408
Prefix
Weighted Cost
755
0
408
0
650
0
510
0
925
0
415
5
831
5
213
10
10
10
20
310
714
The following table lists area codes for Washington, D.C., Eastern Maryland,
and Northeastern Virginia.
Area Code
202
Prefix
Weighted Cost
238
0
202
0
240
0
301
0
741
0
703
0
410
5
443
5
540
5
804
10
20
500
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
The following table lists area codes for San Jose, Monterrey, and Southern
California.
Area Code
831
Prefix
Weighted Cost
477
0
831
0
408
5
213
10
10
10
20
310
714
Call Scenario One
Site C can call San Jose using ISDN through one of two routes:
•
Through the Site C gateway to the local phone system, making a long
distance connection, at a higher cost per minute.
•
From Site C through the direct inter-site link to Site A and out its gateway,
at a lower cost per minute.
Note
If you dial an area code that is not in an LCR table, the call goes through the
gateway from which the call originates.
Call Scenario Two
Calls are frequently made from Site C to Los Angeles. The area codes for some
parts of Southern California are included in the LCR tables for Sites A and B,
because it is less expensive to make an intrastate long distance call within
California than an interstate long distance call from Washington, D.C. to Los
Angeles.
By including Southern California area codes in LCR tables for San Jose and
Monterey, if the bandwidth for the San Jose gateway is saturated, the call from
Site C can be routed through the Monterey gateway. The priority is to call from
Site A or Site B, because the LCR tables share a relative cost to dial the area
codes for Los Angeles.
Polycom, Inc.
501
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Determining Area Codes
It is recommended you enter area codes for:
•
•
•
The area in which the site is located.
The area surrounding the site.
Frequently called numbers.
You should also include special rate plans for intrastate calling.
Determining Country Codes
If you make international calls and you determine that calls to a certain
country are less expensive from a particular gateway, enter the dial string for
this country in the LCR table for the selected gateway.
Determining the Weighted Cost
When you enter call strings in an LCR table, associate a weighted cost with
each one. You can base the cost on a monetary value or ratio that compares
costs between several locations. The weighted cost determines which call
string is most cost-effective to use.
You can calculate costs for the following types of calls:
•
•
•
•
•
Local
Local toll
Intrastate
Interstate
International long distance
Field
Description
Name
Name (ASCII only) for the LCR table.
Description
Country
City Code
Prefix
(Optional) (ASCII only)
Country code for the location to which this call is made.
City or area code for the location to which this call is made.
The prefix is the first three numbers in a 7-digit dial string.
The number of digits to strip before dialing.
# Digits to Strip
Cost
Weighted cost for each call to the selected area or city
code.
502
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
LCR operations include:
•
•
•
•
View the Least Cost Routing Tables List
Column
Name
Description
Name of the LCR table.
Description of the LCR table.
Description
To display the list of least cost routing tables
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.
The LCR Tables list appears.
Add a Least Cost Routing Table
To add a LCR table
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.
In the LCR Tables list, click Add LCR.
In the Add LCR Tables dialog box, enter the Name, Description, and
New Route information required to create a new table.
4
5
6
Click Add.
Repeat step 3 and 4 for add additional routes to the table.
Click OK.
Edit a Least Cost Routing Table
To edit an LCR table
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.
In the LCR Tables list, select the table of interest and click Edit LCR.
Polycom, Inc.
503
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
3
4
In the Edit LCR dialog box, edit the Name, Description, and New Route
information as required.
Click Save.
The changes you made apply to all MCUs associated with a gateway
service that uses this LCR table.
Delete a Least Cost Routing Table
To delete an LCR table
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Dial Plan > LCR Tables.
In the LCR Tables list, select the table of interest and click Delete LCR.
Click Delete to confirm the deletion.
E.164 Numbering Scheme
E.164 Implementation in the CMA System
The Polycom E.164 implementation is based on an E.164 Telecommunications
Recommendation and provides E.164 functionality within the Polycom CMA
environment.
The CMA system provides the ability to automatically generate E.164 aliases
through its E.164 numbering scheme feature. This feature effectively works as
an E.164 alias generator and allows for two types of E.164 number generation:
default or custom. When the CMA system is setup correctly, it will generate
one E.164 alias per dynamically-managed endpoint.
E.164 Alias Assignment
The CMA system can assign an E.164 alias to each dynamically-managed
endpoint at the time of first registration with the CMA System. An E.164 alias
assignment will be based on the default E.164 numbering scheme or on a
specified E.164 numbering scheme, if one has been setup. However, if an E.164
alias already exists in a Dial String Reservation for a User or Room, then it will
have priority over the E.164 number generation.
E.164 aliases may also originate from other CMA system sources to include a
User or Room Dial String Reservation, a Guest E.164 designation, and an E.164
alias provided directly at the endpoint (this opton is only applicable to some
non-dynamically-managed endpoints).
504
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Within the CMA system, an E.164 alias provided in a Dial String Reservation
has a higher priority than a generated E.164 alias.
A single user with multiple endpoints may be assigned a unique E.164 alias
per endpoint.
IMPORTANT
H.323 must be enabled on an endpoint and the it must be registered with the
Gatekeeper, prior to the CMA system’s application of the E.164 numbering
scheme.H.323 can be enabled on an endpoint through the CMA system’s site
provisioning functionality. See “Add a Site” on page 461.
E.164 Numbering Scheme Default Settings
The E.164 numbering scheme functionality consists of three main parts: prefix,
base field, and suffix. The entire E.164 numeric string has a 15-digit maximum.
Prefix
Base Field
Suffix
Based on Device Type
Specify Number Range
No Suffix
Choosing this selection
will automatically
associate a unique
two-digit identifier to each
dynamically-managed
endpoint type. See the
Settings” section.
The number range has
been preset to 1000 and
9999.
A suffix will not be
assigned to the Default
E.164 Numbering
Scheme (Aliias).
Important
When a numeric range
runs out of numbers, the
number generation
operation will fail.
The number below is only
an example of a Prefix
assignment.
The number below is only
an example of a Base
Field assignment.
The lack of a number
below, is only an example
of a No Suffix
assignment.
44 (sample value)
1009 (sample value)
(blank sample value)
E.164 Numbering Scheme Explained
To give you an idea of how an E.164 numbering scheme would appear, see
example below. Please note that the example is based on sample default values
provided in the table above.
Polycom, Inc.
505
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
441009 (an example of an E.164 Alias)
Here the Prefix is derived from the Based on Device Type selection, in this
case, the “44” in the sample is referring to a Polycom RealPresence Group
Series endpoint, this number will normally adjust to match the actual endpoint
type.
The “1009” assignment is a sample Base Field result derived from the Number
Range selection, in this example, the range is between 1000 and 9999.
The Suffix portion of this example was set to No Suffix , which means that a
suffix value will not be appended to the resulting E.164 Alias.
506
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
Field
Description
Prefix
The Prefix is the first part of the E.164 Numbering
Scheme and containz up to three options
•
•
•
No Prefix
A Number (specify)
Based on Devicey Type, available only if shown
The fist option, No Prefix, means that there will not be
any digits listed in front of the Base Field assignment
The second option, A Number,(specify) allows for the
specification of up to 7 digits, be careful, not to go over
the allowable15-digit maximum.
The third option, Based on Device Type, will only be
visible in the Prefix if if it has not been already selected
in the Suffix.
If the Based on Device Type selection is available for
selection, it will use the two-digits predefined device
Base Field
There are two available options for the Base Field
•
•
Specify Number Range...
Phone Number
The first opton, Specify Number Range..., allows for the
designation of a numeric range.The range may fall
anywhere from 0 through 9999999999.
The second option, Phone Number, allows for the
assignment of a phone number from the Actrive
Directory along with the number of digits to utilize from
the phone number, and can range anywhere between 3
to 10 digits. Or, in the event a phone number does not
exist, a numeric range will be used instead, if defined,
and it can be anywhere from 0 through 9999999999
Suffix
The suffix is the last part of the three-part E.164
Numbering Scheme and may contain up to three of its
own options.
•
•
•
No Suffix
A Number (specify)
Based on Device Type.
The first option, No Suffix, means that there will not be
any digits listed after the Base Field designation of the
E.164 Alias.
The second option, A Number (specify), allows for the
specification of up to 7 digits, be careful not to exceed
the allowable 15 digit minimum.
The third option, Based on Device Type, will use the
two-digits predefined device type. See the Based on
Device Type Settings section.
Polycom, Inc.
507
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Based on Device Type Settings
The CMA system’s Based on device Type option is mutually exclusive to the prefix or
suffix portion of the E.164 numbering scheme functionality.
The CMA system will generate this type of prefix or Suffix by matching the actual
endpoint type to the predefined CMA system values listed below.
RealPresence Group Series ------ 44
CMA Desktop ------------------------- 22
RealPresence Desktop ------------- 66
VVX -------------------------------------- 33
RealPresence Mobile --------------- 55
HDX --------------------------------------11
Generating E.164 Aliases
An Administrator may choose to use the default E.164 number generation
scheme or create a distinct E.164 numbering scheme that is better suited to
their existing IT environment.
To use the E.164 number generation scheme, ensure that H.323 functionality is
enabled on the endpoints. H.323 can be enabled on the endpoints via site
provisioning through the CMA system. For more information about site
provisioning, see “Add a Site” on page 461.
To customize an E.164 number generation scheme
1
2
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites > E.164 Numbering Scheme
In the Prefix section, select your option. The available options are: No
Prefix, A Number (specify), Based on Device Type (if available for
selection).
3
4
In the Base Field section, select your preferred option. The available
options are: Specify Number Range and Phone Number.
In the Suffix section. select your preferred option. The available options
are: No Suffix, A Number (specify), Based on Device Type (if available
for selection).
5
Click Update.
Setting-up an E.164 Alias in a User Dial String Reservation
To setup an E.164 alias for an existing user
1
2
Go to User > Users
Highlight a specific user.
508
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Dial Plan Setup Operations
3
4
5
6
7
Click on Edit. The Edit User dialog will display.
Click on Dial String Reservations.
Select your endpoint type.
In the E164 field, enter an E.164 Alias.
Click Apply then Update.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Go to User > Users
Click on Add. The Add User dialog will display.
Click on Dial String Reservations.
Select your endpoint type.
In the E164 field, type in an E.164 Alias.
Click Apply then Update.
Setting-up an E.164 Alias in a Room Dial String Reservation
To setup an E.164 alias for an existing room
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Go to Admin > Rooms
Highlight a specific room.
Click on Edit. The Edit Room dialog will display.
Click on Dial String Reservations.
Select your endpoint type.
In the E164 field, type in an E.164 Alias.
Click Apply then Update.
To setup an E.164 alias for a new room
1
2
3
4
5
6
Go to Admin > Rooms
Click on Add. The Add New Room dialog will display.
Click on Dial String Reservations.
Select your endpoint type.
In the E164 field, type in an E.164 Alias.
Click Apply then Update.
Polycom, Inc.
509
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Note
The total number of digits specified for an E.164 numbering scheme (alias) must be
15 digits or less. If a user’s phone number is assigned to the Base Field, the system
reserves one digit to differentiate between the user’s multiple devices. In this case,
the total number of digit cannot exceed 14 digits
The E.164 number generation is only applicable to dynamically-managed
endpoints.
510
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
37
Remote Alert Setup Operations
This chapter describes how to configure the Polycom® Converged
Management Application™ (CMA®) system to send alerts to users via E-mail
for specific types of system and endpoint events. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
•
Set Up Remote Alerts
The CMA system remote alerts functionality is very flexible. It allows you to:
•
•
Assign different severity levels to different classifications of CMA system
and Endpoint alerts.
Create different alert profiles so that different types of alerts can be sent to
different people. So if you have administrators who specialize by device
type (for example bridges, endpoints, or servers), you can create profiles
that notify each type of administrator of failures related to those specific
types of devices.
To set up remote alerts, you must complete the following tasks:
1
2
3
4
5
6
Polycom, Inc.
511
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Set Up CMA System-generated E-mail Account
To set the CMA system-generated E-mail account
1
2
Go to Admin > Server Settings > E-mail.
On the E-mail page, enter the E-mail account (ASCII only) from which
the CMA system will send conference notification E-mails and system
alerts.
By default, the CMA system E-mails are sent from the
3
Specify the IP address of the mail server from which the CMA system will
send conference notification E-mails.
Notes
•
Many E-mail servers will block or discard E-mails without a qualified From:
address. To avoid this issue, make sure each person with Scheduler
permissions has a valid E-mail address.
•
Many E-mail servers will block or discard E-mails from untrusted domains, in
which case you may need to change the default CMA system E-mail address to
one in a trusted domain.
4
Click Update.
Enable CMA System Remote Alerts
To enable Polycom CMA system remote alerts
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Server Settings > Remote Alert Setup.
On the Remote Alert Setup page, select Enable Remote Alerts.
Set a Remote Alert quiescent time, which is the amount of time (in
minutes) the system should wait after alerts have been detected but not
cleared before starting the alert notification process, and if applicable, the
remote alert notification process.
4
Click Update.
512
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Remote Alert Setup Operations
Set CMA System Remote Alert Level Settings
The CMA system monitors and reports events regarding its performance,
connections, and services. It categorizes alerts into three alert levels: Info,
Minor, or Major.
By default the Alert Severity Level is set to Info for all of the CMA Alert
Types it reports. You have these options:
•
You can leave all of the Alert Severity Levels set to Info and create a single
remote alert profile that allows you to notify all users assigned that profile
about system events of all types.
•
You can change some of the Alert Severity Levels to either Minor or
Major and create multiple remote alert profiles that notify different users
of system events of different types and severity levels.
To set the CMA system remote alert level settings
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > CMA Alert Level Settings.
On the CMA Alert Level Settings page, change the Alert Severity Level
for the following CMA Alert Type system events, as required.
Alert Type
Alert indicates...
Bridge Down
A Polycom MCU (RMX or MGC) has failed.
The connection to the database has been lost.
Database Connection
Down
Enterprise Directory
Connection Down
The connection to the enterprise directory server has
been lost.
Enterprise Directory
System Account
Password Failure
The connection to the enterprise directory server
could not be established because the account
password was incorrect.
CMA Failover
Occurred
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.)
The system has failed over from one system server
to the other.
License Capacity
Threshold Exceeded
The number of available seats defined by the
installed license is within 5% of the total license
capacity.
Bridge Time
Discrepancy
A difference between the clock on the Polycom MCU
(RMX or MGC) and the CMA system clock.
CMA Monitor Service
Stopped
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.) The
CMA system redundancy monitoring service is not
running.
Polycom, Inc.
513
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Alert Type
Alert indicates...
Redundant Server
Down
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.) The
connection or synchronization between the primary
and secondary server has been lost.
Redundancy Conflict
(In redundant CMA system configurations only.) Both
the primary and secondary system servers believe
they are the active server.
Site Bandwidth
Threshold Exceeded
The site bandwidth threshold, which is set at 90% of
capacity, has been exceeded.
Subnet Bandwidth
Threshold Exceeded
The subnet bandwidth threshold, which is set at 90%
of capacity, has been exceeded.
Site Link Bandwidth
Threshold Exceeded
The site link bandwidth threshold, which is set at
90% of capacity, has been exceeded.
Active Call Exceeded
90% of Maximum
The number of active calls has exceeded 90% of the
maximum allowed. This value is dependent on the
call model (routed or direct) and the total number of
licenses.
•
In routed mode, the maximum number of active
calls is 30% of the total number of licenses.
•
In direct mode, the maximum number of active
calls is 60% of the total number of licenses.
Active Call Exceeded
100% of Maximum
The number of active calls has exceeded 100% of
the maximum allowed. This value is dependent on
the call model (routed or direct) and the total number
of licenses.
•
In routed mode, the maximum number of active
calls is 30% of the total number of licenses.
•
In direct mode, the maximum number of active
calls is 60% of the total number of licenses.
E164 Alias
Assignment Failed
The CMA system was unable to assign an E.164
alias to the endpoint.
Certificate Expiration
Warning
The specified certificate will expire in 30 days. If the
certificate is not renewed within 30 days, the alert
continues daily.
Certificate Expired
Warning
The specified certificate has expired. The alert
continues daily until the certificate is renewed or
removed.
Database Backup
Failure
The database backup has failed.
Used disk space
reaches ___% of the
total disk space
Disk space threshold, as entered in the text box, has
been exceeded.
514
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Remote Alert Setup Operations
3
Click Update.
Set Endpoint Alert Level Settings
Monitored endpoints send events to the CMA system. The CMA system
categorizes and reports endpoint alerts into three alert levels: Info, Minor, or
Major.
By default the Alert Severity Level is set to Info for all of the Endpoint Alert
Types it reports. You have these options:
•
You can leave all of the Alert Severity Levels set to Info and create a
remote alert profile for each endpoint type being monitored that allows
you to notify all users assigned that profile about all endpoint events
applicable to that endpoint type.
•
You can change some of the Alert Severity Levels to either Minor or
Major and create multiple remote alert profiles that notify different users
of endpoint events of different types and severity levels.
To set the endpoint alert level settings
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Endpoint Alert Level Settings.
On the Endpoint Alert Level Settings page, change the Alert Severity
Level for the different types of endpoint events as required.
Alert Type
Alert indicates...
Remote Control
Battery Low
The battery in the endpoint’s remote needs to be
replaced.
Credentials
Required
The endpoint system requires that the user enter a valid
username and password.
Credentials
Failed
An attempt to log into the endpoint system failed.
HTTP Forbidden
The endpoint must be used in https:mode only.
Device Not
Responding
The endpoint is not responding to the CMA system.
Heartbeat
Timeout
The endpoint did not send a heartbeat to the CMA system
within the required timeout period.
Gatekeeper
Status Unknown
The CMA system gatekeeper cannot determine the
connection status of the endpoint.
Gatekeeper
Rejected
The CMA system gatekeeper rejected the endpoint’s
attempt to register.
Gatekeeper
Unregistered
The endpoint is not registered to the gatekeeper.
Polycom, Inc.
515
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Alert Type
Alert indicates...
Directory Status
Unknown
The CMA system gatekeeper cannot determine the
directory status of the endpoint.
Directory Not
Registered
The endpoint is not registered to the directory service.
Presence Status
Unknown
The CMA system gatekeeper cannot determine the
presence status of the endpoint.
Presence
The endpoint is not registered to the presence service.
Unregistered
User Assistance
Request
The endpoint user sent a request for help.
Management
URL Not Set
The CMA system is not one of the management URLs set
on the endpoint, possibly because the management URL
list is full.
Note
Because endpoint systems do not have an interface to
manually delete management URLs, if the management
list is full you must disconnect the endpoint’s network
cable for two minutes. This should clear up all the mgmt
server URLs.
Touch Control
Disconnected
The Touch Control device that was connected to the listed
HDX is no longer connected to the HDX.
Touch Control
Software
The software version of the Touch Control platform is not
compatible with the Endpoint software version.
Incompatiblewith
Endpoint
SIP URI Not
Provisioned
A dynamically-managed endpoint at a site with SIP
enabled does not have a SIP dial string reservation. The
endpoint is provisioned without SIP enabled.
SIP Status
Unknown
The SIP server cannot determine the status of the
endpoint.
SIP Unregistered The endpoint is not registered with the SIP server.
3
Click Update.
Add a Remote Alert Profile
You can add a remote alert profile to identify which device alerts from which
devices should be sent as part of a remote alert profile. Note that using a
combination of setting alerts by device type and by specific types, provide
additional granularity in managing device alerts.
516
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Remote Alert Setup Operations
To add a remote alert profile
1
2
3
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, click Add.
In the Add Remote Alert Profile dialog box, enter a Name and
Description for the profile.
4
5
To activate the profile, select Enable Profile.
Configure one of the following:
— To have all CMA system alerts sent as part of this profile, select Info,
Minor, and Major.
— To have a subset of CMA system alerts sent as part of this profile,
select any combination of Info, Minor, or Major. These selections
work in conjunction with the CMA system alert level settings you
chose previously.
— To have no CMA system alerts sent as part of this profile, leave Info,
Minor, and Major cleared.
6
To use the device type to identify which devices and device alerts should
be sent as part of this profile, click Alert by Device Type and configure
one of the following. For endpoint systems, these selections work in
conjunction with the endpoint alert level settings you choose previously.
a
b
c
To have all device alerts for all device types sent as part of this profile,
in the Device Type Alert Level Mapping page, select Info, Minor, and
Major for all of the device types.
To have a subset of device alerts for all device types sent as part of this
profile, in the Device Type Alert Level Mapping page, select any
combination of Info, Minor, or Major for each device type.
To have all device alerts for a subset of device types sent as part of this
profile, in the Device Type Alert Level Mapping page, select Info,
Minor, or Major for each device type to be included in the profile.
Alerts for those device types that do not have an alert level selected
will not be included.
7
To use the device name to identify which devices and device alerts
should be sent as part of this profile, click Alert by Device.
Notes
•
If you set device alerts for specific devices, these settings override settings
made on the Alert by Device Type page. The settings are not cumulative.
•
You cannot set the system up to send device alerts for specific desktop video
endpoints. Polycom CMA Desktop and Polycom PVX endpoints are not
displayed in the Available Device list.
a
As needed, use the Filter to customize the device list.
Polycom, Inc.
517
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
b
c
In the Available Devices list, select the devices to add to the profile.
Use CTRL to select multiple devices.
Click the down arrow to add the devices to the Monitored Devices list
and configure one of the following:
»
»
»
To have all device alerts for all selected devices sent as part of this
profile, for the devices in the Monitored Devices list, select Info,
Minor, and Major for each device.
To have a subset of device alerts for all selected devices sent as
part of this profile, for the devices in the Monitored Devices list,
select any combination of Info, Minor, or Major for each device.
To have all device alerts for a subset of device types sent as part of
this profile, for the devices in the Monitored Devices list, select
Info, Minor, and Major for each device to be included in the
profile. Alerts for those devices in the Monitored Devices list that
do not have an alert level selected will not be included.
8
Click OK.
Associate a Remote Alert Profile With a User
To associate a remote alert profile with a user
Go to User > Users.
To search for a user:
In the Search field of the Users page, search for the user of interest.
1
2
a
Note
Searches for a user on the CMA system Users page are case-insensitive, prefix
searches of the Username, First Name, and Last Name fields.
b
To search both local and enterprise users, clear the Local Users Only
check box and press Enter.
The first 500 users in the database that match your search criteria are
displayed in the Users list.
c
If the list is too large to scan, further refine your search string.
3
4
5
6
Select the user of interest and click Edit User.
In the Edit User dialog box, click Associated Alert Profile.
Select the Remote Alert Profile to associate with the user.
Click OK.
518
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Remote Alert Setup Operations
Edit a Remote Alert Profile
To edit a Remote Alert Profile
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, select the profile of interest and click
Edit Remote Alert Profile.
3
4
As required, edit the General Info, Alert by Device Type, and Alert by
Device sections of the Edit Remote Alert Profile dialog box.
Click OK.
Disable a Remote Alert Profile
To disable a Remote Alert Profile
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, select the profile of interest and click
Edit Remote Alert Profile.
3
4
Clear Enable Profile.
Click Update.
Delete a Remote Alert Profile
To delete a Remote Alert Profile
1
2
Go to Admin > Alert Settings > Remote Alert Profiles.
On the Remote Alert Profiles page, select the profile of interest and click
Delete Remote Alert Profile.
3
Click Yes to confirm the deletion.
The profile is deleted from the CMA system.
Polycom, Inc.
519
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Disable CMA System Remote Alerts
To disable all (system and device) CMA System remote alerts
1
2
3
Go to Admin > System Settings > Remote Alert Setup.
On the Remote Alert Setup page, clear Enable Remote Alerts.
Click Update.
520
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
38
System Management and
Maintenance
This chapter describes the following Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) system operations topics:
•
•
Management and Maintenance Overview
The CMA system requires relatively little ongoing maintenance beyond
monitoring the status of the system and downloading backups you want to
archive. All system management and maintenance tasks can be performed in
the management interface. See the appropriate topic for your user role:
•
•
Administrator Responsibilities
As a CMA system administrator, you’re responsible for the installation,
configuration, and ongoing maintenance of the system. You should be familiar
with the following tasks and operations:
•
•
•
Installing licenses when the system is first installed and when additional
Monitoring system health and performing the recommended regular
Using the system tools provided to aid with system and network
diagnostics, monitoring, and troubleshooting. See “System
Services personnel may ask you to use these tools.
Polycom, Inc.
521
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
Upgrading the system when upgrades/patches are made available. See
Administrative Best Practices
The following are some of our recommendations for administrative best
practices:
•
•
Perform the recommended regular maintenance.
Except in emergencies or when instructed to by Polycom Global Services
personnel, don’t reconfigure, install an upgrade, or restore a backup when
there are active conferences on the system. Many of these operations will
require a system restart to complete, which will result in conferences being
dropped.
•
•
•
Before you reconfigure, install an upgrade, or restore a backup, manually
create a new backup of the system settings. Then download and archive
this backup in the event that something unforeseen occurs and it becomes
necessary to restore the system to a known good state.
For proper name resolution and smooth network operations, configure at
least one DNS server in your network configuration, and preferably two
or more. This allows the CMA system to function properly in the event of
a single external DNS failure.
Configure at least one NTP server in your time configuration and
preferably two or more. Proper time management helps ensure that your
cluster operates efficiently and helps in diagnosing any issues that may
arise in the future. Proper system time is also essential for accurate audit
and CDR data.
Auditor Responsibilities
As a CMA system auditor, you’re responsible for managing the system’s
logging and history retention. You should be familiar with the following
configurations and operations:
•
•
Configuring logging for the system. These settings affect the number and
the contents of the log archives available for download from the system.
Polycom Global Services personnel may ask you to adjust the logging
configuration and/or download and send them logs.
Configuring history retention levels for the system. These settings affect
how much system activity history is retained on the system and available
for download as CDRs.
522
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Management and Maintenance
Auditor Best Practices
The following are some of our recommendations for auditing best practices:
•
Unless otherwise instructed by Polycom Global Services, configure
logging at the production level with a rolling frequency of every day and
a retention period of 60 days. If hard drive space becomes an issue,
decrease the retention period incrementally until the disk space issue is
resolved.
•
•
Download log archives regularly and back them up securely (preferably
offsite as well as onsite).
Export CDRs regularly and back them up securely (preferably offsite as
well as onsite).
Recommended Regular Maintenance
Perform the following tasks to keep your CMA system operating trouble-free
and at peak efficiency. These tasks can be done quickly and should be run at
least weekly.
Create and Archive Backups
Log into the CMA system, go to Admin > Backup System Settings and Create
General System Health and Capacity Checks
On the Dashboard verify that there are no alerts indicating problems with any
part of the system. For more information, see “Polycom CMA System
Certificates
Go to Admin > Management and Security > Certificate Management and
verify that the list of certificates contains the certificates you’ve installed and
looks as you would expect (an archived screen capture may be helpful for
comparison).
Display the details for any certificate you’ve installed and verify they are as
expected (an archived screen capture may be helpful for comparison). For
CDR export
If you want to preserve detailed call and conference history data in
spreadsheet form off the Polycom CMA system, periodically download the
system’s CDR (call detail record) data to your PC.
Polycom, Inc.
523
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
524
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
39
System Backup and Recovery
Operations
This chapter provides an overview of the Polycom® Converged Management
Application™ (CMA®) backup and recovery procedures.
The backup and recovery of a CMA system includes backup and recovery of
the CMA system internal database and the backup of the CMA system
configuration settings. It includes these topics:
•
•
Backup Internal Databases and System Configuration
Users assigned the Administrator role have two backup options. They can:
•
•
Generate backups of just the internal CMA database files (.bakformat)
OR
Create and download a system backup archive (.zipformat), which
includes both the internal database backup files and the system settings.
We recommend creating and downloading a system archive weekly. This
archive makes system restoration much simpler.
Polycom, Inc.
525
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Backup the CMA System Internal Databases
This topic describes how to create a backup of the CMA system internal
database files. These database backup files cannot be used to restore the
internal databases to a CMA system. These files can be used for
troubleshooting or to migrate the system to an external database system.
To backup the CMA system internal databases only
1
From the CMA system web interface, go to Admin > Backup System
Settings.
2
When the Backup System Settings page appears, click Generate
Database Backup Files.
A dialog box appears indicating that the database backup has been
initiated and the operation will take some time.
3
To view the list of backup files including those generated in step 2, go to
Admin > Database Backup Files.
The Database Backup Files list appears showing all of the backup files
stored on the CMA system. Files with a timestamp included in the name
are system-generated backup files. Files without a timestamp are user
forced backups.
4
5
To save the downloaded backup files only, select the backup files of
interest and click Save.
In the File Download dialog box, click Save, browse to a location on your
system, and click Save.
Backup the CMA System Settings
This topic describes how to create a backup archive of a CMA system,
including system configuration settings and internal database files. Once the
backup archive is downloaded, it can be used to restore the system to its last
archived configuration after a disastrous system failure.
To backup the CMA system settings
1
2
3
From the CMA system web interface, go to Admin > Backup System
Settings.
When the Backup System Settings page appears, click Create and
Download a Backup Archive.
In the Select location for download dialog box, enter a unique File name,
browse to a location on your system and click Save.
A File Download dialog box displays the progress of the download
operation.
526
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Backup and Recovery Operations
4
5
When the operation is completed, click OK.
Restore Database and System Configuration
A user assigned the Administrator role can restore a CMA system using a
backup archive. To restore an CMA system, follow the procedures in this
topic.
To restore a system from a backup archive
1
2
Perform First Time Setup. For more information about First Time Setup,
see the Polycom CMA System Getting Started Guide for this release.
3
configuration. The archived configuration will overwrite the
configuration that resulted from First Time Setup. The only CMA system
configuration settings not included in the archive and thus not
overwritten are the network settings and the security certificates required
for an operational system.
In cases when the CMA system is functional, but the configuration or database
is corrupted, the backup archive can also be used to return a CMA system back
to its last known good archive. As long as the network settings and security
certificates are operational, the last known good archive will return the CMA
system to its former functional state.
Restore to Factory Default Image
In a disaster recovery situation, your Polycom Global Services (PGS) support
representative may be required to restore your CMA system to its factory
default image.
To perform this disaster recovery procedure, you will need the Restore to
Factory Default DVD that shipped with the CMA system server. This DVD
has the base image of the CMA system server software.
WARNING
•
This is a last resort, so never do this without being instructed to do so by PGS
support.
•
•
This process will wipe out your system database and all other system data.
The Restore to Factory Default DVD is specific to the CMA system server type
and version.
Polycom, Inc.
527
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Restore from a Backup Archive
A user with the Administrator role can restore the CMA system using a
backup archive.
To restore a backup archive
1
2
Go to Admin > Backup System Settings.
In the Select Archive File section of the Backup System Settings page,
click
.
3
4
In the Select file to upload dialog box, select the archive file to upload
and click Open.
Click Restore from Backup Archive.
Two warnings appear about the backup process. The second warns that
the process is irrevocable and may result in an usable system.
5
Click OK.
The system uses the archive file to restore the CMA system to the state of
the backup files.
When the CMA system is functional, but the configuration or database is
CMA system to its last known good archive. As long as the network settings
and security certificates are operational, the last known good archive will
return the CMA system to its former functional state.
528
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
40
System Troubleshooting
This chapter provides Polycom® Converged Management Application™
(CMA®) system troubleshooting information. It includes the following topics:
•
•
Troubleshooting Utilities Dashboard
The CMA system has a Troubleshooting Utilities dashboard that brings
together on one page access to all of the information you might need to
diagnose system issues. It includes access to various diagnostic files and
informational panes.
The diagnostic files include:
•
Traces—Use this option to generate and download a network sniffer trace
that can help you examine the traffic to and from the CMA system.
•
Windows Event Logs—Use this option to generate and download a
WindowsEventLogs.zipfile that includes the Application, Security, and
System logs. These logs store events logged by applications, events
related to logon and resource use, and events logged by Windows system
components respectively. For more information about these event logs,
•
CMA System Logs—Use this option to generate and download a
GetAllLogs.zipfile that includes all of the CMA system log files. For
more information about these system logs, see “View and Export System
Polycom, Inc.
529
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
•
CMA System Report—Use this option to generate and download a
SystemInfo.txtfile that describes the system configuration. For more
•
•
Database Backup—Use this option to initiate a backup of selected CMA
internal databases.
Test Network Connection—Use this option to perform a Traceroute or
Ping operation. Traceroute allows you to investigate the route path and
transit times of packets as they travel across an IP network. Ping allows
you to test the availability of a host on an IP network..
•
Synchronize Certificate Stores—Use this option to reset all certificate
stores with the currently uploaded certificates and certificate revocation
lists (CRLs).
The information panes include:
•
Systems—Displays summary information about the devices registered
•
CMA Configuration—Displays information about the configuration of
•
•
•
•
CMA Info—Displays general information about the CMA system. For
CMA Licenses—Displays information about how the CMA system is
Gatekeepers—Displays information about the CMA system as a
Users Logged In—Displays the type and number of users that are
currently logged into the system. For more information, see “Users
•
Services—Displays information about the CMA system services. For more
530
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting Specific Types of Issues
This section describes information on troubleshooting specific types of issues
on the CMA system. It includes these topics:
•
•
•
•
Registration Problems and Solutions
Problem
Description
Solutions
Unable to place calls to an
MCU conference room from
a registered Polycom HDX
system
The CMA system rejects the ARQ
stating that the "endpoint is not
registered" to the gatekeeper even
though the system indicates it is
registered.
•
The MCU is not registered to the
gatekeeper
When the gatekeeper
registration is set to auto-
discovery, endpoints do not
register.
When auto-discovery is used, a
GRQ message is broadcast and
sent over multicast. However, the
CMA system must be able to
receive one of these messages, and
does not respond to this message if
it is not the default gatekeeper.
•
•
Verify that the Default Gatekeeper
check box is selected in the Admin >
Gatekeeper Settings > Primary
Gatekeeper page.
Verify that a UDP broadcast from the
endpoint’s network can reach the CMA
system, or that multicast is enabled on
all routers between the endpoint and
the CMA system.
An endpoint cannot register
with the CMA system.
The endpoint is configured to use
the CMA system as its gatekeeper,
but is being rejected during
registration.
•
Review the gatekeeper diagnostic logs
for the RRQ attempt by the endpoint
and determine the RRJ reason.
•
•
Verify that the endpoint alias is not a
duplicate of other endpoint aliases.
In the gatekeeper diagnostic log, an
error has occurred during the
RRQ/RCF process that caused the
registration to fail.
Verify that the endpoint does not have
NAT enabled.
•
•
Verify that enough licenses remain.
An endpoint cannot register
with the CMA system.
An endpoint cannot register with
CMA, but the gatekeeper
diagnostics do not indicate a
problem.
Verify that the IP address that the
gatekeeper sent to the endpoint is
correct.
The gatekeeper sent the RCF
message, but the endpoint did not
receive it.
Polycom, Inc.
531
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Problem
Description
Solutions
The MCU cannot register
with the CMA system.
Some MCU vendors register with a
GRQ message instead of an RRQ
message.
•
Verify that the Default Gatekeeper
check box is selected in the Admin >
Gatekeeper Settings > Primary
Gatekeeper page.
Some MCU vendors do not retry
registration after a first attempt has
failed.
•
•
Reset the MCU or MGC card to force
registration to occur.
An endpoint shows that it is
not registered to the
gatekeeper in the
The CMA system receives the RRQ
message, but not the LWRRQ
message from the endpoint.
Reboot the endpoint.
Gatekeeper Registration
field in the Device Status.
The endpoint did not send a
LWRRQ message within the offline
timeout period specified in the
Admin > Gatekeeper Settings >
Primary Gatekeeper page.
The RadVision OnLAN
MCU continually changes
state: from online to offline
and offline to online.
The Radvision OnLAN MCU ignores
the RCF Time to Live (TTL) field,
which is filled in with the value that
the administrator specified in the
offline timeout field in the Admin >
Gatekeeper Settings > Primary
Gatekeeper page.
•
Reconfigure the Radvision OnLAN
MCU to send the registration requests
in the same time period specified in
CMA.
•
•
Add the MCU manually.
Reboot the MCU to force registration to
occur.
Some endpoints are not
assigned ISDN numbers.
A registered H.323-only system was
not assigned an ISDN number. The
system could belong to a network
that does not have ISDN number
ranges assigned to it.
•
Verify that the endpoint belongs to the
site that has assigned ISDN number
ranges. To do so, go to Admin > Dial
Plan and Sites > Sites and make sure
the site has the correct ISDN range
specified in the ISDN Number
No ISDN numbers are available to
assign.
Assignment pane.
•
•
Verify that ISDN numbers are available
to assign.
Verify that the RCF message “Can’t find
ISDN free pool” from the gatekeeper
returns to the endpoint.
Endpoints that were
previously registered and
auto-assigned ISDN
numbers are being rejected
when attempting to register.
Inconsistent configuration in ISDN
number assignment has occurred.
•
•
Verify that the previous ISDN range was
changed.
When the CMA system is
restarted, some registrants
that were previously online
are now offline.
Some endpoints do not reregister
when the CMA system goes down.
Reboot the MCU.
Some MCUs do not reregister
automatically after two retries.
532
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Troubleshooting
Point-to-Point Calling Problems and Solutions
Problem
Description
Solutions
ViewStation and ViaVideo
have an incorrect RAS IP
address.
These endpoints are configured with
a NAT address and may not receive
the RCF message from the
gatekeeper.
The endpoints need to be reconfigured to
disable NAT.
A call with an alias as the
dial string from a registered
endpoint cannot be placed
to another registered
endpoint. The two endpoints
are in different sites.
•
The site link between the sites
in which the endpoints reside is
not correctly defined or is
missing.
•
•
•
Go to Admin > Dial Plan and Sites >
Site Links and make sure that a site
link exists between the two networks.
Make sure that the IP addresses of
both endpoints are included in their
respective sites.
•
•
No bandwidth is available to the
site link.
The calling bit rate is higher
than the bit rate defined in the
site link.
If site topology is defined for both
endpoints, verify that there is enough
bandwidth in the site links between the
two sites.
•
•
ISDN alternate routing is not
available.
•
•
Verify that the dialing bit rate is lower or
equal to that of the maximum bit rate
defined for the site links.
Dialing rules may not be
enabled or may be set to block
instead of route.
If the endpoint is ISDN capable, verify
that the ISDN parameter is correct.
Dialing by IP address fails.
A registered endpoint cannot call an
unregistered endpoint by IP address
within the same site.
•
•
•
Check the Reports > Gatekeeper
Message Log for error messages.
Verify that the registered endpoint is
registered.
A dialing rule is not enabled or is set
to block instead of route.
Verify that the Deny calls to/from
unregistered endpoints check box is
cleared. Go to Admin > Gatekeeper
Settings > Primary Gatekeeper to
change this setting.
•
Verify that the IP address dialing rule is
enabled and set to route.
Polycom, Inc.
533
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
MCU and Gateway Dialing Problems and Solutions
Problem
Description
Solutions
Call fails when using an
MCU service.
The call using the MCU service is
rejected because of one of the
following:
•
Check the Reports > Gatekeeper
Message Log for error messages
indicating why the call failed.
Dialing an MCU service
results in a network error.
•
•
•
The MCU is not registered.
The MCU is offline.
•
•
Verify that the MCU is registered.
Verify that the MCU is online. If the
device is offline, reboot it.
The MCU prefix is not
registered as an E.164 alias.
•
Verify that the MCU service is
available. Go to the Admin > Dial Plan
and Sites > Services page. Verify that
the MCU service prefix is enabled and
listed.
•
The MCU resource issue was
sent through resource
allocation indication or resource
allocation.
•
•
The dialing rule is not enabled.
The priority of the dialing rule
may be too high.
•
Services are not enabled.
Simplified dialing does not
work.
The call using the simplified dialing
service is rejected because of one
of the following:
•
•
Check the Reports > Gatekeeper
Message Log for error messages.
When you dial 9, you
receive a network error.
Verify that the gateway and simplified
dialing service prefix is enabled. Go to
Admin > Dial Plan and Sites >
Services.
•
The simplified dialing prefix
service in the system
configuration is disabled.
•
•
•
No gateway services are
available.
•
Verify that the gateway is registered.
There is insufficient BRI/PRI
bandwidth.
The call uses a higher bit rate
than the device policy group
allows.
534
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Troubleshooting
Conference On Demand Problems and Solutions
Problem
Description
Solutions
Dialing a Conference On Demand
fails.
The endpoint dials a CON service,
and the call is rejected because of
one of the following:
•
•
Check the diagnostics log for an
ARJ reason from this endpoint.
Inviting other endpoints into a
conference using the CON service
fails.
Verify that the MCU is
registered with the CMA system
and is online.
•
•
•
•
The MCU is not registered or is
offline.
The CMA system cannot log
into the MGC.
•
Verify that the MCU registered
with the CMA system has the
MCU’s IP address filled out in
the Devices list.
The MGC has no resource
available for the call.
•
•
•
•
Verify that the MCU login ID and
password for the CON service
are correct.
The MGC’s IP address is not
entered in the CMA system.
Verify that the H.323 network
service that the MCU is using is
set as the default service.
Verify that the MCU has enough
available resources to start this
conference.
Verify that the CON service is
enabled. Go to Admin > Dial
Plan and Sites > Services.
Gatekeeper Cause Codes
Cause
Code
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
Description
The gatekeeper is out of resources
The gatekeeper has insufficient resources
The gatekeeper registration version is invalid
The call signal address is invalid
The registering device’s address is invalid
The registering device’s terminal type is invalid
The registering device’s permissions are invalid
The conference ID is invalid
The registering device’s ID is invalid
The caller’s device is not registered
The called party’s device is not registered
Polycom, Inc.
535
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Cause
Code
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
203
208
221
222
Description
The registering device’s permissions have expired
The registering device has a duplicate alias
The call transport is not supported
The called device has a call in progress
The call has been routed to the gatekeeper
Cannot request a drop for others
The registering device is not registered with the gatekeeper
Unknown reason
Permission failure
Discovery permissions have expired
The device is not registered
No bandwidth available
Location not found
Security access denied
Quality of service not supported
Resources are exhausted
Invalid alias
Cannot unregister others
Quality of service control is not supported
Incomplete address
Registration permissions have expired
Call routed to SCN
Inconsistent alias
Call rejected at destination
Incorrect address
The far end is busy
The far end is not responding
536
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
A
System Security and Port Usage
This section provides an overview of the port usage and security required by
the Polycom® Converged Management Application™ (CMA®) system and
includes a comprehensive list of services and clients on the system that are
required for normal operation. It includes these topics:
•
•
Open Inbound Ports on the Polycom CMA System
The following table lists the open inbound ports on the CMA system and
provides a description of their use.
Port
Description
TCP 80
HTTP web server, through which the web application displays
and where Polycom endpoints post status messages
TCP/UDP 161
TCP 389
SNMP listener
Directory services (LDAP)
HTTPS web server listener
TCP 443
TCP 700
(Polycom proprietary service) Service monitor for redundant
Polycom CMA servers
TCP/UDP 1718
TCP/UDP 1719
TCP/UDP 1720
TCP 3601
H.323 gatekeeper listener--gatekeeper discovery
H.323 gatekeeper listener--gatekeeper statistics
H.323 gatekeeper listener--host call
(Polycom proprietary service) Global Address Book listener
with which endpoints register
TCP 3389
TCP 5222
Remote desktop
Presence service (XMPP)
Polycom, Inc.
537
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
Port
Description
TCP 4449
(Polycom proprietary service) OpenDS (Data store for site
topology) admin port
TCP 8989
(Polycom proprietary service) OpenDS (Data store for site
topology) replication port
Note
Third-party port-scanning software may incorrectly identify the Polycom proprietary
services as IANA-registered services, since identification is made by port number
only and not by the actual protocol being transmitted:
Outbound Ports Used by the Polycom CMA System
The following table lists all outbound ports that the CMA system uses to
communicate with other systems, including endpoints, bridges, database
servers, and other network equipment.
As a standard H.323 gatekeeper, the CMA system uses ports 1024-65535 for
dynamic TCP and UDP traffic.
Port
Description
TCP 20
Used to FTP data to endpoints.
TCP 21
TCP/UDP 24
TCP/UDP 25
TCP/UDP 53
TCP 80
Used to access the telnet interfaces on endpoints.
Used to send E-mail messages to SMTP servers.
Used to access domain name servers (DNS).
Used to access the web application on endpoints and MGCs,
version 7.x and higher.
TCP 135
TCP 137
TCP 139
Active Directory (AD) Single Signon (NetBios/NTLM).
TCP/UDP 389
TCP 443
Used to access directory (LDAP) services
Secure access to endpoint devices (SSL) including Polycom
CMA Desktop.
TCP 445
AD Single Signon
TCP/UDP 636
TCP 1205
Used to access LDAP over TLS/SSL (LDAPS)
Used to access MGCs for management and monitoring
538
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Security and Port Usage
Port
Description
TCP/UDP 1719
TCP/UDP 1720
TCP/UDP 3268
Used by the gatekeeper for H.323 RAS messages
Used by the gatekeeper for Q.931 signaling
Used to access the Microsoft Active Directory Global Catalog
using StartTLS.
TCP/UDP 3269
TCP/UDP 3603
Used to access the Microsoft Active Directory Global Catalog
using LDAP-S.
Used for HTTP communication with the Polycom PVX client
Used to access MGCs for management and monitoring
TCP 5001
TCP 1205
Polycom, Inc.
539
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Polycom CMA System Operations Guide
540
Polycom, Inc.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|